summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes4
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
-rw-r--r--old/64262-0.txt10255
-rw-r--r--old/64262-0.zipbin144622 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/64262-h.zipbin323658 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/64262-h/64262-h.htm12591
-rw-r--r--old/64262-h/images/colophon.jpgbin18421 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/64262-h/images/cover.jpgbin152708 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/64262-h/images/end_illo.jpgbin7394 -> 0 bytes
10 files changed, 17 insertions, 22846 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d7b82bc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+*.txt text eol=lf
+*.htm text eol=lf
+*.html text eol=lf
+*.md text eol=lf
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3be6435
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #64262 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/64262)
diff --git a/old/64262-0.txt b/old/64262-0.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index 37d1ab9..0000000
--- a/old/64262-0.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,10255 +0,0 @@
-The Project Gutenberg eBook of Buffalo Bill's Big Surprise, by Colonel
-Prentiss Ingraham
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
-most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms
-of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you
-will have to check the laws of the country where you are located before
-using this eBook.
-
-Title: Buffalo Bill's Big Surprise
- The Biggest Stampede on Record
-
-Author: Colonel Prentiss Ingraham
-
-Release Date: January 11, 2021 [eBook #64262]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-Produced by: David Edwards, Susan Carr and the Online Distributed
- Proofreading Team at https://www.pgdp.net
-
-*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK BUFFALO BILL'S BIG SURPRISE ***
-
-
-
-
- Buffalo Bill’s Big Surprise
-
- OR,
-
- The Biggest Stampede on Record
-
- BY
-
- Colonel Prentiss Ingraham
-
- Author of the celebrated “Buffalo Bill” stories published in the
- BORDER STORIES. For other titles see catalogue.
-
-
- [Illustration: (Colophon)]
-
-
- STREET & SMITH CORPORATION
- PUBLISHERS
- 79-89 Seventh Avenue, New York
-
-
-
-
- +----------------------------------+
- | |
- | Copyright, 1914 |
- | By STREET & SMITH |
- | ----- |
- | Buffalo Bill’s Big Surprise |
- | |
- +----------------------------------+
-
-
- All rights reserved, including that of translation into foreign
- languages, including the Scandinavian.
-
-
-
-
- CONTENTS
-
- PAGE
- IN APPRECIATION OF WILLIAM F. CODY 1
- I. BAD NEWS. 5
- II. THE OUTLAWS’ ALLY 11
- III. PLOTTING WITH A FOE. 15
- IV. BURSTING SHELLS. 22
- V. THE RETURN. 31
- VI. THE FORGED LETTER. 48
- VII. THE FLIGHT. 56
- VIII. IN THE INDIAN VILLAGE. 65
- IX. BUFFALO BILL’S BOLD VENTURE. 86
- X. THE RESCUER REACHES THE GOAL. 91
- XI. THE GUARD OF HONOR. 96
- XII. CORRALLED BY INDIANS. 101
- XIII. THE RIDE FOR HELP. 107
- XIV. THE BLACK TROOPERS AT BAY. 113
- XV. A VERY STRANGE FIND. 118
- XVI. THE NEGRO MESSENGER. 123
- XVII. TWO SHOTS. 129
- XVIII. THE BAD MAN OF THE BIG HORN. 137
- XIX. A DOUBLE ESCAPE. 143
- XX. BLACK SCOUTS ON THE TRAIL. 147
- XXI. TO THE RESCUE. 152
- XXII. BLACK BILL’S LONE HAND. 159
- XXIII. BLACK BILL’S PRISONER. 165
- XXIV. THE LOST VALLEY. 171
- XXV. UNSEEN FOES. 178
- XXVI. FACE TO FACE WITH ENEMIES. 185
- XXVII. A DISCOVERY. 194
- XXVIII. A LIVING TOMB. 201
- XXIX. THE RESCUE. 207
- XXX. OUT OF DEVIL’S DEN. 212
- XXXI. ANOTHER STRANGE STORY. 215
- XXXII. UNDER A CURSE. 223
- XXXIII. THE HACIENDA. 230
- XXXIV. HAUNTED. 237
- XXXV. THE SEARCH OF THE RUIN. 243
- XXXVI. THE FIRST NIGHT. 249
- XXXVII. A DEAD GHOST. 255
- XXXVIII. ON SECRET WORK. 261
- XXXIX. THE SCOUT’S RETURN. 270
- XL. THE SHOT ON THE CLIFF. 281
- XLI. THE FIGHT IN THE SLEUTHS’ CAMP. 289
- XLII. A STARTLING VISIT. 302
- XLIII. THE FAIR HERMIT. 310
- XLIV. REVEALED. 316
-
-
-
-
- IN APPRECIATION OF WILLIAM F. CODY
-
- (BUFFALO BILL).
-
-
-It is now some generations since Josh Billings, Ned Buntline, and
-Colonel Prentiss Ingraham, intimate friends of Colonel William F.
-Cody, used to forgather in the office of Francis S. Smith, then
-proprietor of the _New York Weekly_. It was a dingy little office on
-Rose Street, New York, but the breath of the great outdoors stirred
-there when these old-timers got together. As a result of these
-conversations, Colonel Ingraham and Ned Buntline began to write of
-the adventures of Buffalo Bill for Street & Smith.
-
-Colonel Cody was born in Scott County, Iowa, February 26, 1846.
-Before he had reached his teens, his father, Isaac Cody, with his
-mother and two sisters, migrated to Kansas, which at that time was
-little more than a wilderness.
-
-When the elder Cody was killed shortly afterward in the Kansas
-“Border War,” young Bill assumed the difficult rôle of family
-breadwinner. During 1860, and until the outbreak of the Civil War,
-Cody lived the arduous life of a pony-express rider. Cody volunteered
-his services as government scout and guide and served throughout
-the Civil War with Generals McNeil and A. J. Smith. He was a
-distinguished member of the Seventh Kansas Cavalry.
-
-During the Civil War, while riding through the streets of St. Louis,
-Cody rescued a frightened schoolgirl from a band of annoyers. In true
-romantic style, Cody and Louisa Federci, the girl, were married March
-6, 1866.
-
-In 1867 Cody was employed to furnish a specified amount of buffalo
-meat to the construction men at work on the Kansas Pacific Railroad.
-It was in this period that he received the sobriquet “Buffalo Bill.”
-
-In 1868 and for four years thereafter Colonel Cody served as scout
-and guide in campaigns against the Sioux and Cheyenne Indians. It was
-General Sheridan who conferred on Cody the honor of chief of scouts
-of the command.
-
-After completing a period of service in the Nebraska legislature,
-Cody joined the Fifth Cavalry in 1876, and was again appointed chief
-of scouts.
-
-Colonel Cody’s fame had reached the East long before, and a great
-many New Yorkers went out to see him and join in his buffalo hunts,
-including such men as August Belmont, James Gordon Bennett, Anson
-Stager, and J. G. Heckscher. In entertaining these visitors at Fort
-McPherson, Cody was accustomed to arrange wild-West exhibitions. In
-return his friends invited him to visit New York. It was upon seeing
-his first play in the metropolis that Cody conceived the idea of
-going into the show business.
-
-Assisted by Ned Buntline, novelist, and Colonel Ingraham, he started
-his “Wild West” show, which later developed and expanded into “A
-Congress of the Rough Riders of the World,” first presented at Omaha,
-Nebraska. In time it became a familiar yearly entertainment in the
-great cities of this country and Europe. Many famous personages
-attended the performances, and became his warm friends, including Mr.
-Gladstone, the Marquis of Lorne, King Edward, Queen Victoria, and the
-Prince of Wales, now King of England.
-
-At the outbreak of the Sioux, in 1890 and 1891, Colonel Cody served
-at the head of the Nebraska National Guard. In 1895 Cody took up the
-development of Wyoming Valley by introducing irrigation. Not long
-afterward he became judge advocate general of the Wyoming National
-Guard.
-
-Colonel Cody (Buffalo Bill) died in Denver, Colorado, on January
-10, 1917. His legacy to a grateful world was a large share in
-the development of the West, and a multitude of achievements in
-horsemanship, marksmanship, and endurance that will live for ages.
-His life will continue to be a leading example of the manliness,
-courage, and devotion to duty that belonged to a picturesque phase
-of American life now passed, like the great patriot whose career it
-typified, into the Great Beyond.
-
-
-
-
- BUFFALO BILL’S BIG SURPRISE.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER I.
-
- BAD NEWS.
-
-
-It was at Fort Advance, one of the smaller frontier posts on the
-Indian border, just about the hour of sunset. Buffalo Bill and
-Colonel Carr, the commandant of the fort, were chatting together when
-suddenly Buffalo Bill raised his hands and pointed across the plains.
-
-A horseman could be seen in the distance, and he was approaching at a
-furious gallop.
-
-Buffalo Bill scanned the figure for a moment in silence.
-
-“It is Hugh Hardin, the oldest of my scouts,” he said, “and I am
-willing to bet a few cigars that he brings news of a fresh Indian
-uprising.”
-
-It was, indeed, Hugh Hardin, and a moment later he had pulled up his
-steed before Buffalo Bill and Colonel Carr, and, after saluting his
-superior officers, was making his report.
-
-It was to the effect that the Indians to the number of several
-thousands were on the warpath, under command of Death Face and
-several other of their chiefs.
-
-“I scouted near their camp,” said Hugh Hardin, “and I know that there
-is at least one white man in their number. I saw him. He is Eagle,
-a well-known outlaw. He was formerly chief of the band known as the
-Renegade Red Riders, which you broke up, Buffalo Bill, not long ago.”
-
-“What! Eagle, the outlaw chief!” exclaimed the colonel. “I thought
-you killed him, Cody?”
-
-“I followed him and drove him off a precipice into Rapid River--man
-and horse,” said Cody; “but it looks as if he had escaped by
-swimming, and joined the redskins, now that his own band is wiped
-out. Are you sure that he is with the Indians?”
-
-“Perfectly,” said Hugh Hardin.
-
-“That man must be captured at all hazards,” said the colonel. “I
-shall immediately order out a troop of cavalry, as well as a battery
-of infantry, and send them on to oppose the Indians.”
-
-An hour later the detachment of cavalry and artillery, under command
-of Lieutenant Worth, one of the most popular young officers in the
-post, was starting for Rapid River.
-
-Two other commands of artillery and cavalry were dispatched
-immediately afterward.
-
-Buffalo Bill headed the column, of course, and when, early the next
-day, after a hard night ride, they were within a few miles of the
-river, he advised the lieutenant to call a halt.
-
-“I will go forward myself on a scout,” he said, “before the Indians
-discover that there is a body of soldiers in the vicinity.”
-
-“I suggest that you take one of the men in my troop, Sergeant
-Fallon, as an assistant. He has lived with the Indians for years,
-and can disguise himself perfectly as one, and speak the language
-well. Besides, they say that he has powerful friends among the Sioux
-chiefs. He can enter the camp in disguise, perhaps.”
-
-Sergeant Fallon, a tall, lean, dark-faced man, stepped forward at
-the command of Lieutenant Worth, and, after a few words with Buffalo
-Bill, went off to disguise himself as an Indian, a complete disguise
-having been brought along with the artillery equipments by command of
-Lieutenant Worth.
-
-“He is a mysterious man, evidently well educated,” said the
-lieutenant to Buffalo Bill, “and no one knows why he entered the
-army, as he is reputed to be very wealthy. He has good cause to
-wish to be revenged on Eagle, the outlaw chief. Eagle captured his
-daughter, Lucille Fallon, when she was on her way West, to hold her
-for ransom, and it was you yourself who rescued her when you wiped
-out Eagle’s band.”
-
-“I remember the occasion,” said the great scout; “but here comes the
-man, and he looks like an Indian, indeed.”
-
-Sergeant Fallon’s disguise was perfect, and an hour later the scout
-and he set out.
-
-When they reached Rapid River, Fallon decided to swim his horse
-across and enter the Indian camp disguised as he was, and Buffalo
-Bill, knowing from what he had seen and heard of the man that he
-could thoroughly trust him, allowed him to do so.
-
-Buffalo Bill accompanied him as far as the river, and watched him
-across. He lost his form after he had got halfway across, but waited
-until he was sure that Fallon had reached the other side and found
-the Indian guards.
-
-Hearing no outcry or shot, he muttered:
-
-“I guess he’s all right, but his danger is great.
-
-“The man grows upon me more and more, and I am sure that he has once
-held a high position and been in command of men.
-
-“Well, if he gets back in safety, I will use my influence to get him
-the commission he richly deserves.”
-
-So saying, the scout gazed in silence for a while over the weird,
-wild scene, lit up by the moonlight into picturesque beauty, and
-then, turning his horse, rode back to his camp for the night.
-
-The sergeant, meanwhile, had crossed the river, been met by the
-guards, and then rode to the camp beyond the ridge.
-
-To his surprise, he found there over a hundred Indian braves, and
-about a camp fire built out of sight up in a niche of the cliff stood
-several forms, upon whom his eyes were at once riveted.
-
-Fighting Bird, an old Sioux chief, was there, and near him stood
-the young chief, Death Face, while, seated upon a rock near, was
-a splendid type of a redskin leader, a man of almost herculean
-proportions, robed in gorgeous costume of tanned doeskin heavily
-embroidered with wampum, and wearing a war bonnet of barbaric
-splendor. His face was bold, rugged, crafty, intelligent, and
-merciless.
-
-That countenance was furrowed with age, silver threads streaked
-his raven locks, but he was still the mighty leader of his people,
-the grand old fighter, plotter, good general, merciless foe of the
-palefaces, Iron Eyes, the head chief of his tribe.
-
-By his side stood a fourth person.
-
-It was one of elegant form, handsome face, dark and sinister, fine
-though it was. He was dressed in a black fatigue suit of army style,
-wore buttons of ten-dollar gold pieces, diamond studs and sleeve
-buttons in his negligee silk shirt, a massive watch chain, and a
-large, brilliant ruby upon the little finger of his left hand, his
-right being covered with a red glove.
-
-This man had a cigar between his lips, stood like one waiting to be
-photographed, one booted foot resting upon a rock before him, and his
-elbow leaning upon his knee as a rest.
-
-His spurs were of gold, his belt of arms showed that they were
-ornamented with the same precious metal, and, altogether, he was a
-most picturesque and striking figure, a man to stand in awe of.
-
-As the sergeant approached, old Iron Eyes arose and greeted him,
-greeted him as he would one for whom he held both reverence and
-affection.
-
-“Iron Eyes is surprised at meeting his paleface brother, the great
-medicine chief, White Wolf. The Iron Eyes has with him another great
-chief of the paleface race, the Eagle, his brother and ally, and here
-is my son, the mighty young chief who will some day wear the war
-bonnet of old Iron Eyes.
-
-“It gladdens my heart to again see my brother, the White Wolf. He is
-welcome, and he has proven my friend.”
-
-Such was the welcome and the introduction of the sergeant to those
-assembled about the camp fire in the little ravine among the cliffs.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER II.
-
- THE OUTLAWS’ ALLY.
-
-
-Sergeant Fallon was perfectly calm under the ordeal he was passing
-through. He greeted the old chief most reverently and kindly, offered
-his hand to the outlaw, for he wished to feel his grip and remember
-it, and saluted the young son of Iron Eyes courteously, while he did
-not by any means ignore Fighting Bird.
-
-But he lost no time in at once saying:
-
-“I am here unexpectedly to-night, for I wish to tell the great chief
-that his foes are not sure that he has warriors camped here, and they
-intend to send out scouts on foot to cross the river and find out. By
-drawing your braves far back, putting out your camp fires, and not
-one being seen, the scouts will come over and find no braves here.
-
-“They will report this to their chiefs, and then when another night
-the force attempts to cross, the warriors of Iron Eyes will be here
-to ambush them.”
-
-The words of the disguised sergeant were listened to in silence, but
-with great interest, and old Iron Eyes said:
-
-“The Chief White Wolf speaks with wisdom, and my warriors shall at
-once draw back to cover.”
-
-“Yes, it will be the very thing to do, for if the soldiers believe
-that you have withdrawn your guards from the fords, they will cross,
-hoping to surprise you, and dash upon an ambush and be beaten back
-right here, as they should be.”
-
-“I would send couriers to the other bands, also, chief,” the outlaw
-joined in, “to have them also fall back for the night. Would you not,
-White Wolf?”
-
-“It would be just what I should do, sir,” answered the sergeant.
-
-Orders were at once given to put out the camp fires, get the ponies
-and camp outfit, and retreat over the range half a mile back.
-
-The sergeant went along and rode with Iron Eyes, the two talking
-together like old friends.
-
-When they had come to a halt, the outlaw stepped up to the sergeant
-and asked:
-
-“What force is on the other side, sir?”
-
-“There are three commands, sir; two of considerable strength, the
-other not so large.”
-
-“Have they any guns?”
-
-“All three commands have artillery, sir.”
-
-“And infantry?”
-
-“Mounted infantry, with cavalry and guns.”
-
-“Then Carr is in earnest?” said the outlaw.
-
-“Yes, sir, he seems determined.”
-
-“There are three men there whom I hate. I will give a reward to get
-their scalps.”
-
-“Who are they, sir?”
-
-“One is Lieutenant Worth, who has been a persistent foe of my band
-of Red Riders; one is Buffalo Bill, and the other is Sergeant Fallon.”
-
-“I know them all, sir.”
-
-“They have both been strong allies to wipe me out, and here I am a
-fugitive to-day with no men left, and must begin life anew to gain
-both gold and revenge. But I am not dead yet, and I will have both.”
-
-“You are right, Captain Eagle,” said the sergeant.
-
-“May I ask your name, my friend?”
-
-“My name is Louis, sir.”
-
-“What position do you hold under Colonel Carr?”
-
-“I am in the ordnance department, but hold only an inferior position.”
-
-“You have once dwelt among the Indians?”
-
-“Yes, as a fugitive from my own people, I became a renegade and was a
-medicine chief. When I could do so I returned to my people, unknown,
-however, to work like you, for gold and revenge. Some day I will have
-both.”
-
-“See here, you are just the man that can aid me, and in doing so help
-yourself.”
-
-“I am willing, if there is any money in it.”
-
-“There is, and big money, too, for you.”
-
-“I am your man, Captain Eagle,” was the earnest reply.
-
-The outlaw was evidently greatly excited through some thought that
-had crossed his mind. He paced to and fro for a minute, his hands
-clasped behind his back, his whole bearing that of one who was moved
-by strong emotion.
-
-Again turning to the sergeant, he said, and in a perfectly calm tone:
-
-“You dwell at Fort Advance, of course?”
-
-“Yes, sir.”
-
-“Do you know Sergeant Fallon well?”
-
-“He is my most intimate friend, and I occupy his quarters.”
-
-“Good! Have you any love for him?”
-
-“I have for him, sir, the deepest hatred, as he has been my worst
-enemy, and at times I have been tempted to take his life.”
-
-“Then you are the very man I want for an ally--what do you say?”
-
-“I will serve you, sir, as I can serve myself in doing so.”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER III.
-
- PLOTTING WITH A FOE.
-
-
-The outlaw leader seemed pleased with the idea of his ally’s hatred
-for Sergeant Fallon, and said, when he was told that he would serve
-him:
-
-“Well, you will have to go slow, and there is much to be done.”
-
-“I am ready.”
-
-“I’ll tell you just what my plan is, and see what you think of it.”
-
-“I’ll frankly tell you what I think.”
-
-“I believe you, for the chief speaks of you in the highest terms, in
-fact loves you as a brother, and the only thing I had against you was
-that, after being a renegade, you went back to your people.”
-
-“It was, as I said before, for a purpose.”
-
-“Ah, yes; but now to my plot with you.”
-
-“I am all attention.”
-
-“You, of course, know the sergeant’s daughter?”
-
-“I do.”
-
-“She is an heiress, you know?”
-
-“I have heard so; in fact, I know that it is the case, from the
-sergeant.”
-
-“I had her a captive, with others, but Buffalo Bill guided Lieutenant
-Worth, Sergeant Fallon, and others to my retreat and rescued the
-prisoners, destroying my band and making me fly as a fugitive for
-shelter with my good friend, Iron Eyes.”
-
-“I see.”
-
-“Now, I wish to get possession of Lucille Fallon, the sergeant’s
-daughter.”
-
-“Ah!”
-
-“And that is what I wish you to aid me in.”
-
-“I can do it if any man can.”
-
-“My plan is for you to notify me, by a letter left at a certain spot
-on the Overland trail, which I will describe to you, when I can get
-possession of her. She can be called to Pioneer City through an
-excuse of some kind to meet a lawyer there who will not come farther
-on, and I will hold up the coach and capture her.”
-
-“But your men are all dead or prisoners?”
-
-“Yes, but I am organizing another band out of new material, men who
-will serve my purpose even better than the others did.”
-
-“You wish to capture the girl and get a big ransom for her?”
-
-“That is just it, and Sergeant Fallon with her.”
-
-“You wish both?”
-
-“I do, the one for revenge, the other for gold.”
-
-“Well, I believe I can arrange it.”
-
-“You must understand the whole situation, the name of the girl’s
-lawyer in New York, something of the facts of the case of her
-inheritance, and just what to do. Now, when she was my captive,
-I looked over her papers, and I have the name and address of the
-lawyer, in fact, one of his letters, and I can forge his writing
-perfectly.
-
-“I will write the letter to her, mail it from Pioneer City, telling
-her that, writing as the lawyer, I cannot come any farther, as I am
-suffering with an attack of rheumatism, and that she and her father
-must come to me, the lawyer, mind you, by return coach. I will then
-lie in wait on the trail and capture them.”
-
-“A good idea.”
-
-“There is another thing: You must see to it that the girl’s jewels
-and money are taken along, though she must not know this. Smuggle
-them on the coach in some way, for you can get possession of them,
-intimate as you are at the sergeant’s home, and I will share with
-you.”
-
-“Thank you. I know where the money and jewels are kept, and I can get
-them, and will see that they go through with the sergeant and his
-daughter, never fear.”
-
-“Is Jack Jessop, the star driver, driving now?”
-
-“Oh, yes.”
-
-“It will be his last trip, for I’ll bury him on Monument Hill. He is
-too plucky a man to be in the Overland coach-driving business, and so
-he goes under.”
-
-“It is just as well, I guess, though I rather like Jack.”
-
-“Well, now, we’ll go over the whole matter again, and just as soon
-as you return to the fort notify me by letter what you think can be
-done, or if you can think of any better plan. The place to leave the
-letter is under the end of the third board of the Cañon River bridge,
-where it projects over the land, as I suppose it must, though I have
-not seen the new structure. At any rate, look well for a spot there,
-and I’ll find it, for I’ll take to the trail soon with my new band.”
-
-“I’ll prepare the way for you, Captain Eagle, never fear,” was the
-answer of the sergeant, and then the two went all over the same
-ground again, the outlaw asking many questions about the fort and its
-people, and coming to what he considered was a thorough understanding
-with the man whom he little dreamed to be his foe.
-
-This conversation being ended, the sergeant held a powwow with his
-old friend Iron Eyes, the outlaw, Death Face, and Fighting Bird being
-present.
-
-It being then a couple of hours after midnight, Sergeant Fallon
-suggested that he would make a visit to the ford to see if the enemy
-had sent their scouts across, and send back word by a couple of
-warriors who would accompany him, as he would then be compelled to go
-on back to the command where he was expected to serve as the Indians’
-spy.
-
-Two young braves were, therefore, called to accompany him, and Iron
-Eyes said that he had increased the force of guards at each ford by
-fifty men, while several hundred more braves under Death Face would
-camp at the first mountain pass on the trail, where they could give
-battle to the soldiers, and be reënforced readily from the village.
-
-Iron Eyes himself would return to his village, and Captain Eagle was
-to remain at the ford, being at liberty to go where he pleased.
-
-Assured by these facts, and accompanied by the two braves, the
-sergeant set out upon his return.
-
-He left the braves on the ridge, advanced alone to the river, and
-discovering, by the sign agreed upon between them, that Buffalo Bill
-had been there, he went back and told the warriors to return and
-report to Iron Eyes that a scout from the soldiers had been across
-the river, so that they could come back into their camp again.
-
-Then he rode into the river to cross.
-
-The sergeant was greeted by Buffalo Bill as he rode out of the water,
-the two friends clasping hands warmly.
-
-“I am glad, indeed, to see you again, sergeant, for I was becoming
-very nervous about you.”
-
-“I was delayed, as I did not dare appear anxious to get back.”
-
-“I found Iron Eyes, Death Face, and the outlaw in camp when I went
-over, and a number of warriors, as well, so I decided to get them
-well out of the way at once, and would not delay for the time agreed
-upon.
-
-“I found, upon my return to the ford, that you had been there and
-crossed. I gave the chief a great ghost story about the soldiers, and
-I had an hour’s chat with the outlaw,” and Fallon related all his
-conversation with the outlaw.
-
-“When he holds up the coach he will not only find Sergeant Fallon in
-it, but Buffalo Bill, Lieutenant Worth, and a few good scouts and
-soldiers, with others following on behind, and a few more to head
-off the outlaws, so that we will catch the whole outfit,” said the
-sergeant.
-
-“The very thing to be done, sergeant; but who has the outlaw chief
-for a band?”
-
-“That is the question, Cody.”
-
-“Doubtless redskins?”
-
-“I had that idea at first, but he spoke of going to Pioneer City,
-where he had friends, and I believe he will get men there, and more
-than he had before, from what he gave out in the way of hints.”
-
-“Then, to be sure, we will have to be well provided with men, say one
-on the box with Jack Jessop, who is also to be counted when it’s a
-scrimmage, and a dozen can pack away in the coach. Then a few scouts
-and soldiers on the trail behind the coach, some more of my men ahead
-and we’ll rope in the entire outfit, as you suggest.”
-
-“We’ll do it, and arrange with the lieutenant, but keep it as secret
-as the grave. When the letter comes we will then be ready to go out
-on the first coach, and the man who rides on the box with Jack Jessop
-can wear a hat and clothes to appear to be my daughter, for she rode
-all the way through on the box, you know. But here we are at camp.”
-
-Day had dawned, and the camp was astir, though the men were not
-building any fires, but were preparing to eat a cold breakfast.
-
-Having washed off his paint and changed his clothes, the sergeant and
-Buffalo Bill went directly to the quarters of the lieutenant.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER IV.
-
- BURSTING SHELLS.
-
-
-Before nightfall the two reserve commands had reached the fords, to
-which they had been guided by the scout sent to each of them.
-
-They found them good camping places, water, wood, and grass in
-plenty, and which could be readily defended if need be.
-
-There were a dozen fires built by those sent on ahead, and the
-officers in command were delighted to learn that there was a chance
-for a brush with the Indians, for, being ordered to the front, they
-believed there would be.
-
-It was just before sunset that Lieutenant Worth, Buffalo Bill, and
-Sergeant Fallon rode into the camp at the upper ford, and were
-welcomed by the officers and men.
-
-“Percy, how is your gun placed?” asked Lieutenant Worth of the
-officer in charge.
-
-“It commands the ford and the other shore, though it is not in
-position to be seen.”
-
-“All right, run it into position as soon as Buffalo Bill shows you,
-just to toss a shell or two, for he has been devoting the past day to
-studying the Indian camps at two of the fords,” said the lieutenant,
-with a smile, while the scout remarked:
-
-“Say night, rather, lieutenant, for I’ve been resting by daylight.”
-
-Going to a point which commanded a view of the other shore, Buffalo
-Bill ran his glass over it and said:
-
-“Sergeant, when I reconnoitered, the camp was in those willows.”
-
-“Yes, that is it; and the ponies are corralled over beyond them.”
-
-“I’ll see if I can put a shell there,” and the officer in charge of
-the guns sighted one himself, a sergeant training the other.
-
-“Fire!”
-
-The six and twelve-pounders flashed together, and shells went
-shrieking across the river.
-
-One burst directly in the willows, the other beyond, where the
-sergeant had said the horses were.
-
-There was a neighing of horses, several ponies dashed into view, and
-it was certain that the shells had been a startling surprise to the
-redskins in camp.
-
-“Percy, I wish one of your guns sent at once down to my camp, and
-with full speed, for I shall drop a shell or two into the camp across
-the river from me, and then push on down to the other camp, and have
-them give the reds a surprise, though we do not know just where they
-are located at the lower ford, and must guess at it.
-
-“Toss a few more shells over there, and then limber up and get the
-gun away, whichever one you care to send.”
-
-Half a dozen more shells were sent flying into the Indian camp, and
-then the gun was sent down to the camp of Lieutenant Worth, who,
-after supper with his officer comrades there, rode away with Buffalo
-Bill, the sergeant, and the three men sent there in the morning to
-build fires, back to his camp.
-
-He found it no easy task to overtake the gun, the crew being anxious
-to reach their position and throw in a few shells before word could
-be sent down from the upper ford, though the firing would naturally
-be heard there, the sound traveling by the river.
-
-The gun was dragged to the ridge, and the sergeant pointed out just
-where the camp and corral of ponies were.
-
-“Aim it yourself, sergeant,” ordered Lieutenant Worth.
-
-The sergeant did so, and the shell was seen to burst right behind the
-ledge.
-
-Wild yells followed, and, with the firing of a second shell into the
-corral of ponies, it also struck home, for horses neighed wildly in
-fright.
-
-“Give them a few more shells, sergeant, and then the gun can go to
-camp, while we hold on down to the lower ford.”
-
-This was done, the gun retreated to camp, and Lieutenant Worth,
-Buffalo Bill, and Sergeant Fallon followed on down the river trail to
-the lower ford.
-
-It was some fifteen miles distant, and over a rough trail; but they
-reached the camp soon after midnight, and found the officer in
-command and his men all under arms and ready for the fray, for they
-had heard the firing from the middle ford and expected to be called
-upon to move at any time.
-
-“It is no alarm, Benedict, at least to us, though it is for the
-Indians.
-
-“I took a fancy to let the redskins know we were across here in very
-heavy force, as Sergeant Fallon had so reported to them, and got
-Percy to open on them, and, borrowing one of his guns, I did the
-same, and now I wish you to stir them up.”
-
-“With great pleasure, Lieutenant Worth,” answered Lieutenant
-Benedict, who was in command.
-
-“Have you any idea of just where their camp and corral is?”
-
-“I reconnoitered with my glass just before sunset and think I found
-their camp, and behind it is a meadow where I saw a pony astray.”
-
-“We’ll chance it.”
-
-Accordingly, the guns were placed in position, the spots pointed out
-to the gunners, and first one, then another roar came, the shells
-went shrieking on their errands, and bursting just where it was
-intended they should.
-
-Again startled yells answered, and then half a dozen more shells went
-crashing into the timber on the other side.
-
-“Give them a couple of shots just at dawn, Benedict, and the other
-camps will do the same to show them that we have guns at each ford.
-
-“We will camp at the fords for a couple of days yet, and then return
-by easy marches to the fort, for I do not believe a redskin will
-venture across the river for a long while to come. Eh, Cody?”
-
-“I do not think so, either, sir, unless Eagle, the outlaw, puts them
-up to some act of deviltry,” was the scout’s answer, and, after a
-snack, the lieutenant and his two companions returned to their own
-camp.
-
-The stay of the commands at the fords was continued for three days
-longer, and every morning and evening what the troops called the
-“sunrise and sunset guns” were fired across the river at the Indian
-camps, the guns being loaded with shell.
-
-Since the first night of the firing not an Indian had been seen or
-heard. They were either gone or in hiding farther off.
-
-Sergeant Fallon volunteered to go across and discover, making the
-site of the three fords in the night along the trail upon the other
-side, but Lieutenant Worth said that he did not care to have him take
-any more chances.
-
-Then the sergeant said it would be well for him to cross just where
-he had before, and let the Indians feel that he was still trying to
-serve them, also giving them another ghost story about the troops
-intending to remain for some time.
-
-Thus urged, the lieutenant yielded, and, rigging out in his Indian
-costume once more, Sergeant Fallon rode slowly away from the fort
-after supper one night.
-
-Lieutenant Worth and Buffalo Bill accompanied him to the river, and
-then waited.
-
-It was bright moonlight, and the other shore could be plainly seen,
-the officer and the scout watching the sergeant all the way across
-and until he disappeared in the shadows of the other side.
-
-They waited two hours before they saw him come again into sight. He
-rode into the river, came across, and joined them back in the shadows
-on the ridge.
-
-“Have they gone, sergeant?” asked the officer.
-
-“No, sir, they are there, only camped well back, and with half a
-dozen braves on guard at a time, while their force now numbers a
-couple of hundred men at each ford.”
-
-“Give me the location of their camp, and we will toss a shell over
-there in the morning.”
-
-“Pardon me, lieutenant,” said Buffalo Bill, “but that would
-compromise the sergeant, as they would understand that through him
-only the location could have been found out.”
-
-“You are right, Cody, and it would not do.”
-
-“You could hardly reach there as it is, sir, for they are well
-protected; but, as Cody says, it might bring suspicion upon me, and I
-was received in a most friendly manner.”
-
-“Was Iron Eyes there?”
-
-“No, sir; he is back at the village, and Death Face commands five
-hundred warriors at the pass where they would hope to check your
-advance, with the braves who would retreat from the fords, and others
-who would come from the camp.
-
-“They have planned well, indeed, sir, and are in dread of your
-advance, for they think you have two-thirds of the force from the
-fort. Fighting Bird is in command at the ford here, and he is a
-plucky, able chief. The shots did some damage at each ford, for half
-a dozen warriors were killed opposite to us, two at the upper camp,
-and one at the lower, while a score were wounded, as the shells
-dropped right into their midst. Then, too, they lost a number of
-ponies by the shelling.”
-
-“We did do some service then, at random.”
-
-“Yes, sir, and they will be most cautious about recrossing the river
-for some time to come.”
-
-“I hope they will not allow us to rust in camp.”
-
-“No danger of that, lieutenant, for they are Indians, and they will
-break out in a new spot when they think you have forced them to lie
-quiet,” remarked Buffalo Bill.
-
-“There is one thing I did not like, lieutenant.”
-
-“What is that, sergeant?”
-
-“The outlaw chief has left the camps.”
-
-“Indeed?”
-
-“Yes, sir.”
-
-“When did he leave?”
-
-“The day after my visit, sir.”
-
-“Where did he go?”
-
-“I was told by Fighting Bird that the outlaw seemed sorry to have
-trusted me, after I left, and told Iron Eyes so. Iron Eyes and Death
-Face laughed at him, and he said that he had made a mistake, but
-would rectify it, and soon after he left the camp. I asked where he
-had gone, but Fighting Bird said he did not know; but he thought to
-the village of the palefaces, meaning Pioneer City.”
-
-“But he would not dare to cross the fords?”
-
-“It seems, sir, that he knows of another ford up the river to which
-no trail leads, but where there is really a good crossing, and he
-went there. He wished to lead a band of warriors around that way to
-attack the upper camp, but the Indians were too much afraid of the
-big guns to listen to it.”
-
-“It’s well for us they were; but would he dare go to Pioneer City,
-where he must be known?”
-
-“Yes, lieutenant, for you know he always wore a mask as an outlaw,
-and no one saw his face.”
-
-“His face is not known in Pioneer City, and I never saw it that I
-know of,” the scout remarked.
-
-“But is he masked now?”
-
-“No, sir.”
-
-“Then you saw his face?”
-
-“I did, sir, and I would know it again if I met his ghost in Hades,”
-was the sergeant’s emphatic response, for a moment did he break out
-from his accustomed quiet mien.
-
-“Describe him, sergeant, please.”
-
-“A man six feet in height, sir, herculean in strength, and with a
-dark, intellectual face, cynical, stern, and very handsome, but for
-its look of cruelty. He has a long dark mustache, and his hair hangs
-upon his shoulders. He is a very striking-looking man, sir, and
-worthy of a better calling, to judge by his appearance.”
-
-“Well, I hope to have a close look at him some day; but what do you
-think he went to Pioneer City for?”
-
-“I told you, sir, of his intended letter to my daughter, and as it
-seems he grew suspicious of me, my idea is that he has gone there to
-plot to get her into his power at once.”
-
-“By the Lord Harry! but you may be right, sergeant. We will break
-camp at daylight and push for the fort. Come, I’ll send couriers to
-the other camps to move, also,” and the three returned at a gallop to
-the camp.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER V.
-
- THE RETURN.
-
-
-When the three forces got under way they marched at a speed according
-to the distance they had to travel, that all might make the same camp
-the first night on the way.
-
-The command from the lower ford made twenty miles, and, camping
-early, they were joined in the afternoon by the party under
-Lieutenant Worth.
-
-At dark the third command, under Lieutenant Percy, came in, and
-Walter Worth surveyed his little army with pride at being the
-superior officer.
-
-When they pulled out from camp early the next morning, seeing that
-the news that the outlaw had gone to Pioneer City made Sergeant
-Fallon anxious, he said to him:
-
-“Sergeant, you and Buffalo Bill can push on ahead to the fort, for
-the command cannot get in to-night without crowding the horses very
-hard and riding late, and there is no necessity for either.”
-
-The face of the sergeant brightened at the order of the lieutenant,
-and he said:
-
-“Thank you, sir; I shall be most happy to go on ahead.”
-
-“Say to Colonel Carr I will arrive with the command to-morrow, not
-caring to push the cattle.”
-
-“Yes, sir.”
-
-The sergeant at once reported to Buffalo Bill what the lieutenant
-had said, and the two started off at a pace more than double that at
-which the troops were traveling, retarded as they were by the guns, a
-couple of ambulances, and some pack mules.
-
-The sun was yet above the horizon when the sentinel on the watchtower
-reported the coming of two horsemen by the trail leading to the
-Indian country.
-
-The coming of the scout and Sergeant Fallon was soon reported to the
-colonel.
-
-Their stories were told, the sergeant telling his first, and both
-were listened to with the greatest attention by the colonel, who then
-said:
-
-“Sergeant, your daring and gallant conduct shall be reported, with a
-strong recommendation, added to others already sent to Washington,
-for your promotion to a lieutenancy.”
-
-“I thank you, sir.”
-
-“It will be a well-won appointment, sergeant, but, as you request
-it, it will be best to say as little as possible about your going
-into the Indian lines, as it might reach the ears of the outlaw, who
-you say left the camps after your first visit, presumably going to
-Pioneer City.”
-
-“Yes, sir.”
-
-“Then he will be up to more deviltry, I fear; but, sergeant, your
-daughter is not here, you know, or had you heard of her departure?”
-
-“My daughter not here, sir?” Sergeant Fallon’s face turned to the hue
-of death.
-
-“Don’t be alarmed, man, for she only went by Jack Jessop’s coach this
-morning to Pioneer City to see her lawyer, who wrote to her that he
-was laid up there with rheumatism, and wished both of you to come on
-there.
-
-“As she did not know you would return, she went alone; but what ails
-you, sergeant?”
-
-“Colonel Carr, that letter was a trick of the outlaw chief to get my
-child into his clutches again!” gasped the sergeant.
-
-The words of the sergeant fairly startled the colonel, and he looked
-anxiously toward the scout and said:
-
-“Cody, the sergeant is too deeply moved to speak.
-
-“Tell me yourself what this means?”
-
-“It means, colonel,” answered Buffalo Bill, “that while in the Indian
-lines Sergeant Fallon had a long talk with Eagle, the outlaw leader,
-and became his ally in an intended capture of himself, the sergeant,
-and Miss Fallon. A compact was entered into between them, as I
-understood it from Sergeant Fallon, that he should inveigle himself
-and Miss Fallon to take the coach to Pioneer City, and he would hold
-it up and capture them.
-
-“The outlaw had seen Miss Fallon’s papers and letters, when she was
-his captive, copied the address of her lawyer, and secreted a letter
-of his so as to forge his writing and signature.
-
-“A letter to her was to be written from Pioneer City, pretending to
-come from the lawyer and saying, as he was laid up and unable to come
-to the fort, she must come to him on a most important legal matter
-that he would explain.”
-
-“I see it all, and she has fallen into the trap, for it was to
-Pioneer City that the outlaw went to carry out his infernal plot.
-Sergeant, you have my deepest sympathy, and we will do all we can to
-rescue your daughter, I assure you.”
-
-“I feel that, sir; but she is now in that man’s power, and----”
-
-“Colonel Carr, may I offer a suggestion?” said Buffalo Bill suddenly.
-
-“Out with it, Cody.”
-
-“The outlaw crossed the river at a point beyond the upper ford, the
-Indians told the sergeant, at a secret ford known to him alone.
-
-“Now, I believe he carried Indians along with him, so a trail will be
-left, and if he has captured Miss Lucille he will most surely take
-her to the village of old Iron Eyes, for nowhere else could he carry
-her in safety.”
-
-“Yes, Cody.”
-
-“If he held up the coach to-day it was on the other side of Cañon
-River bridge, and it is as far for him to ride from there to his
-secret crossing of the river as it is for us to go down from here,
-and by hard riding we could get there first, sir; begging your
-pardon, if we could start at once, push through and meet Lieutenant
-Worth, we could----”
-
-“Cody, you have hit the nail on the head, and you and the sergeant
-shall start within half an hour on your ride.
-
-“You, sergeant, can ride my best charger, Spur, for he needs
-exercise, and Lieutenant Worth will go back with you and take what
-men he deems necessary, leaving the command to Lieutenant Percy to
-bring on. Say to Lieutenant Worth, sergeant, that such is my wish.
-
-“Let him pick his horses, and you should reach him in time to-night
-to get a short rest there for yours, and be away all together at
-dawn.”
-
-“We will, sir; and I thank you deeply for your great kindness. We
-will start within half an hour, sir, but I dislike to force Scout
-Cody and others on such a hard ride,” said Sergeant Fallon earnestly.
-
-“Oh, don’t mind me, sergeant, for I’ve had more rest of late than I
-wanted,” said Buffalo Bill dryly.
-
-“Well, now be off, and remember, sergeant, you are to ride my horse,
-Spur.”
-
-“Thank you, sir.”
-
-With wishes for their success, the colonel saw them depart hastily
-for their respective quarters.
-
-The long ride they had had was forgotten by both men, for what did
-they care for fatigue when it was to save Lucille from the power of
-the hated outlaw chief?
-
-Buffalo Bill hastened to his quarters to change his clothing, and
-order two of his best horses brought out, for the scout was noted for
-the splendid animals he always had ready for use.
-
-One of them he intended to ride, the other to be used as a pack
-animal, and he ordered a good supply of provision put in the pack
-saddle, and within an hour after leaving the colonel’s quarters he
-was ready for the trail. He had his supper, and just at dark rode up
-to the sergeant’s quarters.
-
-“Time, sergeant, time!” he called.
-
-The colonel’s magnificent roan, Spur, was there, with the sergeant’s
-saddle and bridle on, and there was a place in the pack saddle for
-what the soldier wished to carry along.
-
-These were stowed away, and the two friends rode out of the fort side
-by side, the pack horse traveling behind.
-
-The traps of the horsemen had been so divided up that the saddle
-horses had only the weight of the riders, the pack animal carrying
-the balance.
-
-They were gazed upon as they rode away back on the trail they had
-come, the soldiers wondering at their going so soon after their
-return.
-
-As they left the gate, the scout urged his horse into a slow canter,
-the sergeant’s and the pack horse settling down to the same steady
-pace.
-
-Thus they went on their way through the darkness, leaving mile after
-mile behind them.
-
-“We will reach the camp by midnight, sergeant, and that will give our
-horses and ourselves a good rest until dawn, and allow Lieutenant
-Worth ample time to select his men.”
-
-“What number do you think he will take, Cody?”
-
-“I should say six of my men and as many soldiers, and this, with the
-lieutenant and ourselves, will give us fifteen.”
-
-“Enough, if Lieutenant Worth picks the men.”
-
-“Which he will do, and yet a few more would not be amiss.”
-
-“Well, suggest it, for he is most reasonable.”
-
-“He is, indeed, and one of the bravest and most brilliant young
-officers I ever knew.”
-
-“You are right there, and he is making his way well to the front.”
-
-Seeing that they were not distressing their horses, the two kept them
-at a still more rapid pace, and it was just before midnight that they
-dashed up to the camp.
-
-Lieutenant Worth was at once aroused and the situation explained to
-him, and before the sergeant could deliver the colonel’s message he
-cried:
-
-“I’ll take a score of men and go back with you, for that villain must
-be run down. You know your men best, Cody, so pick out from the three
-commands together here ten of your best scouts, and let them take
-the finest horses, whether their own or not. You, Sergeant Fallon,
-pick a corporal and ten troopers, and see that they get the very best
-mounts. The quartermaster shall at once get supplies for a couple of
-weeks’ stay, for we must go well prepared, and----”
-
-“I go, too, Lieutenant Worth, for I shall be needed,” cried Surgeon
-Denmead, who was present at the interview.
-
-“Ah, Denmead, always the right man in the right place, and I am glad
-you spoke, for I will be glad to have you along.”
-
-“Now, prepare all, for we must be in the saddle within the hour.”
-
-There was no use saying wait until dawn, for the dashing young
-cavalry officer said:
-
-“We will go ten miles on our way and then camp, for I’ll feel then as
-though we had started. If your horses are blown, Cody, you can take
-others.”
-
-“I’ll ride another, sir, as will Sergeant Fallon, and take an extra
-pack horse, too, so the three we pushed to the camp here can run
-loose and thus rest.”
-
-“Yes, and I’ve ordered half a dozen extras driven along loose in case
-of breakdowns, for there must be no delay on this ride.”
-
-The party who were to make the ride then had supper, and in just one
-hour after the arrival of Buffalo Bill and the sergeant in camp, the
-party, twenty-five all told and thirty-five horses, rode off on their
-expedition to rescue Lucille Fallon.
-
-“Set the pace, Cody, and don’t make it too slow,” said Lieutenant
-Worth, and Buffalo Bill rode to the front, the sergeant with him.
-
-Behind rode Lieutenant Worth and Surgeon Denmead, then the corporal
-and his troopers, the pack horses and extras following, and the
-scouts bringing up the rear in two detachments, under Will Palmer and
-Hugh Hardin respectively.
-
-When ten miles had been passed over, Buffalo Bill began to look for a
-camping place, when Lieutenant Worth called out:
-
-“The horses are all right, Cody, so give them another hour of it, and
-we’ll reach a good halting place.”
-
-Another hour was given them, and the scout led the command to a fine
-camp where water, grass, and wood were plentiful.
-
-They quickly staked out the animals, one scout was put on duty, with
-orders to call a relief after one hour, and he to do likewise, until
-four hours had passed, when breakfast would be eaten and the ride
-resumed.
-
-The men threw themselves down upon their blankets and were soon fast
-asleep.
-
-Feeling that all was being done that was possible for the rescue of
-his daughter, Sergeant Fallon, knowing his need of rest, followed
-Buffalo Bill’s example, and dropped off into a deep slumber.
-
-Two soldiers and two scouts were awakened by the sentinel to get
-breakfast, and the others were allowed to sleep on until it was ready.
-
-The meal disposed of, the horses were saddled, and, mounting, away
-they started on another mad ride.
-
-Buffalo Bill was leading the command as guide and scout, and
-constantly by his side kept Sergeant Fallon, while Lieutenant Worth
-and Doctor Denmead were not far in the rear.
-
-The halt was made at noon, but not for two hours, as a consultation
-and look at the horses showed that they were not yet used up, save
-two, that were left behind.
-
-“They will get a rest when we reach the river to-night, so push them
-for all they are worth, Bill,” said the lieutenant.
-
-“Yes, sir; and we must reach the river while it is daylight to find
-that trail, and so wait there, for he may come up in the night and go
-across,” answered Buffalo Bill.
-
-The halt was, therefore, made at noon for an hour only, and yet the
-horses were stripped and rubbed down while they fed.
-
-Then the party mounted again and pushed on, the scout setting even a
-faster pace than before. He was determined to strike the river above
-the upper ford, and from there up look for the trail coming out where
-the outlaw crossed. To do this, hard riding must be made.
-
-Another horse dropped out during the afternoon, and a second soon
-after. They were left by the trail side.
-
-Buffalo Bill glanced back to see if he was pushing too hard, but the
-lieutenant waved him on, and the sergeant’s face brightened, as he
-said, in a low tone:
-
-“God bless that noble young man.”
-
-“Oh, he’s got the nerve to push to the end,” answered Buffalo Bill,
-and as he spoke, Lieutenant Worth called out:
-
-“Your horses can stand the strain, Bill, so you and the sergeant push
-on ahead, and I’ll send what men after you I can pick out with the
-best animals. The rest of us can follow, but you go on and try and
-pick up the trail.”
-
-The splendid animals ridden by Buffalo Bill and the sergeant were yet
-capable of hard work, as was also the one ridden by Lieutenant Worth,
-but he felt that he had better remain with the men.
-
-So he picked out several of the scouts whose horses seemed less
-distressed, and told them to push on with their chief.
-
-So on went Buffalo Bill, the sergeant and four scouts following, the
-rest bringing up the rear at a slower pace.
-
-Buffalo Bill looked back and saw that they were dropping the command
-fast enough for the good of the animals, and so held at the reserved
-pace he had set.
-
-On, on they went, halting at a brook for a few swallows of water,
-again a few mouthfuls of grass, and then on once more.
-
-The river at last came in sight as they descended a ridge.
-
-They had crossed the trail leading back from the upper ford half an
-hour before.
-
-Riding down from the ridge, they reached the river just three miles
-above the ford. Here they halted for a moment, two of the scouts’
-horses having failed them.
-
-The animals were all panting like hounds, and the riders relieved
-them of their weight, and began to go on foot along the river bank,
-the scout remarking:
-
-“There is certainly no crossing between us and the ford, for I have
-ridden this far above it several times.
-
-“It is above that the secret crossing is, and the outlaw would hardly
-have risked it had it been nearer to where the soldiers’ camp was.”
-
-“So I think,” the sergeant remarked.
-
-So on they went, the scout and sergeant walking rapidly and viewing
-every foot of ground, while the scouts followed behind leading their
-horses.
-
-Thus a mile had been gone over, and the face of the sergeant grew
-anxious, for he saw that the sun was drawing near the horizon.
-
-Buffalo Bill’s face was placid, for he never relieved his thoughts,
-no matter what was his distress of mind.
-
-On they went, limbering up their legs from long riding by rapid
-walking.
-
-At last they came to a rise, when the scout halted. He saw that there
-were two ridges running to the river, a deep ravine between them.
-
-Across the river he saw that there was a sand bar, and a point of
-sand stretched out into the stream, the swift flow being on the side
-where they stood.
-
-The channel here looked narrow, too, and, examining the water, it
-appeared to be more shallow than above and below.
-
-“Sergeant, I think here is the crossing.”
-
-“The same thought was mine, sir.”
-
-“Of course, they would have to swim their horses for several hundred
-yards, but by riding out upon that sand bar which is well above, they
-would land, forced down by the current, about at this ravine--in
-fact, if they were swept by, would not land at all.”
-
-“If they crossed from this side, sir?”
-
-“They would have to ride in yonder above at that break in the bank,
-and that would bring them on the sand-bar point. I will go there
-and see if they could get down to the river, while you look down in
-the ravine for their trail,” and the scout started on his way, to
-suddenly call out to the sergeant, who was climbing down the ravine:
-
-“Here is the trail coming out, and there were a score of them.”
-
-The sergeant, at the call of Buffalo Bill, hastened to where he
-stood. He was passing around the descent to the river between the two
-ridges, and had found a trail.
-
-Reaching the spot, the trail was there, made by all of two dozen
-horses, they decided after an examination.
-
-“It goes straight down the ravine to the river, and was, as you said,
-the landing when they rode in from the bar.”
-
-“Yes, sergeant.
-
-“We will leave the boys here and go on to that break up yonder, for
-there is where I feel sure they must cross, and, if my memory serves
-me right, there is no other for many a long mile above.”
-
-Calling to the scouts to halt there where they were, Buffalo Bill and
-the sergeant pushed rapidly on to the break in the bank, nearly a
-mile above.
-
-They reached it just as the sun touched the horizon, and a glance
-showed that it was a ravine like the one below, narrow, rocky, and
-steep.
-
-But from that point a descent into the river could rapidly be made,
-and as the stream had a bend there, a swim would carry them across
-for a landing on the sand bar below.
-
-Going around to the head of the ravine, Buffalo Bill and the sergeant
-came to a halt, as though they had been shot at.
-
-“Too late!” said Buffalo Bill.
-
-“They have crossed,” said the sergeant, and his face was white.
-
-“Yes, not two hours ago, from the looks of the trail.
-
-“That man knows the secret pass through Skeleton Range, or he could
-never have reached here in this time, for that cuts off all of thirty
-miles in coming from the Overland Trail to the upper ford.”
-
-“Yes, I have followed the regular trail, long ago, but knew of no
-secret pass.”
-
-“There is one, however, as an old trapper once led me through it. The
-outlaw must have known it, to have reached here before us, riding as
-we have, for, remember, it is just twenty-four hours since we left
-the fort, and we have come a little over a hundred miles.”
-
-“Very true; we have done our duty, but in vain, for my daughter is
-still in that man’s power, and has been carried on to the Indian camp
-in the mountains.”
-
-“I fear so.”
-
-“What can we do now?”
-
-“I’ll tell you.
-
-“We came here on foot, so have left no trail. We will go to the lower
-ravine and join the boys, then draw off for a camp, for horses and
-men must rest.”
-
-“True.”
-
-“We passed a spot some distance back that will make a splendid camp,
-back from the river, and where the fires cannot be seen by the
-Indians, who must still be guarding the fords.”
-
-“Yes.”
-
-“Now to see if this trail was made by the same party, for I took
-notice of peculiarities I can readily discover, as there were two
-shod horses, and large animals, the others being ponies.”
-
-“That means the outlaw’s two horses and the ponies of the Indian
-allies.”
-
-“Just that,” and the two began to examine the trail.
-
-“Yes, here are the tracks of the two iron-shod horses, Mr. Cody.”
-
-“There are more shod horses--six more, sergeant--and that means----”
-
-“The six horses of the stagecoach,” quickly interrupted the sergeant.
-
-“Just that.”
-
-“That tells the story, then, for the other tracks agree. It is
-growing dark, so let us hurry back and make a camp for the tired men.”
-
-They walked rapidly back down the river bank, joined the two scouts
-awaiting them, and told the sad story to them that they were too late!
-
-Mounting their horses, they rode back in the gathering twilight for
-a mile, when they met the other two scouts, who had dropped back on
-account of their horses.
-
-They had halted just where the scout intended to make the night camp,
-and, seeing that the place was thoroughly sheltered, they began to
-build fires.
-
-Just as the fires began to burn well, the command came in sight, and
-the tired horses gained courage and hastened on.
-
-They were soon all there, the stragglers dropping in one by one, and
-a sadness fell upon all as they heard the ill-omened words: “Too
-late!”
-
-Lieutenant Worth listened, with stern face and flashing eyes.
-
-Then he said:
-
-“Our first duty is to care for our worn-out cattle.
-
-“Then we will have supper, and, afterward, hold a council of war,
-Bill, and decide what must be done, for Miss Fallon shall be rescued;
-yes, and that villain, Lamar, must be hanged.
-
-“Those two duties must and shall be done!”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER VI.
-
- THE FORGED LETTER.
-
-
-Lucille Fallon was surprised when she received a letter by mail,
-posted at Pioneer City, and addressed in the well-known hand of her
-lawyer.
-
-It was short, and merely told her that certain legal technicalities
-having arisen that required her signature, and her father’s, to
-papers he held, he had decided to come himself and get them, and had
-reached Pioneer City, where, on account of an attack of rheumatism,
-he was compelled to halt and ask the sergeant and herself to come to
-him.
-
-Lucille expressed her surprise that any business had been so
-important as to bring the lawyer out to the wild West, but she
-concluded to go, and regretted the absence of her father.
-
-Perhaps she could do without him, and, if not, she would urge the
-lawyer to return with her to the fort, where he would be well cared
-for.
-
-There were no other passengers, and with a small satchel as her only
-baggage, she mounted to the box with Jack Jessop and rolled away
-from the fort. She enjoyed the bright morning and beautiful scenery
-immensely, and Jack was glad to entertain his fair companion.
-
-The bridge was crossed over the river, and then began the pull up a
-long hill.
-
-Suddenly, as though by magic, a score of forms arose, it appeared
-from the ground.
-
-They came from behind trees and rocks, and they came like so many
-apparitions.
-
-They were all dressed in buckskin, wore slouch hats and masks, while
-they carried rifles in their hands and were armed with a belt of
-weapons as well.
-
-They were all on foot, save one.
-
-That one was mounted on a fine horse, and came out from behind a
-group of rocks. He sat his horse splendidly, wore a belt of arms, but
-carried no rifle. A broad sombrero sheltered his head, his hair fell
-upon his shoulders, and he was dressed in a black suit with gold-coin
-buttons. His face was masked completely, and his hands were covered
-with red gauntlet gloves. There was no mistaking the man, for it was
-Captain Eagle, chief of the Red Hand Riders.
-
-“That imp of Satan, ther chief o’ ther Red Hands, by all that’s
-holy!” growled Jack Jessop.
-
-Lucille turned pale, yet remained perfectly calm, while she said:
-
-“He has little to rob me of, Jack.”
-
-Up to the coach rode the chief, while he bent low in his saddle and
-said:
-
-“We have the pleasure of meeting, Miss Fallon.”
-
-“The pleasure is all yours, sir.”
-
-“And, Jack, you and I have met before,” resumed the chief, paying no
-attention to Lucille’s sarcastic reply to his salutation.
-
-“Yes, and some day we’ll meet once too often for your good, cap,”
-said Jack.
-
-“Well, what have you aboard to interest me, other than the fair lady
-on the box with you?”
-
-“Nothing, for I’m running light; but I was in hopes you was dead.”
-
-“Oh, no; I am still on deck, as you see.
-
-“But have you no dust from the mines on board?”
-
-“Not an ounce.”
-
-“No money?”
-
-“This ain’t after pay time, as you know, so no money goes East on
-this run.”
-
-“Well, I believe you, but I shall search your old hearse, all the
-same.”
-
-He called to his followers, and they completely surrounded the coach.
-Then he began the search personally.
-
-“What is in these boxes in the rear boot?”
-
-“Weapons sent to Colonel Buck from the fort sutler; he ordered them.”
-
-“They are treasure. Give me your hatchet.”
-
-The driver passed it down, and, knocking open the boxes, the chief
-said:
-
-“Good! repeating rifles and revolvers--just what I need; yes, and
-ammunition, too, with bowie knives and belts. Ah! here are a couple
-of fine saddles and bridles, too, and a roll of superb serapes. Why,
-Jack, I am in luck, especially as a decoy letter I wrote got Miss
-Fallon into my power, though I regret to see that her father is not
-along. Miss Fallon, the letter from your lawyer I forged. It has done
-its duty.”
-
-When the outlaw chief spoke of the letter Lucille’s face flushed, and
-her eyes brightened with indignation and anger. She knew that she
-was the victim of a plot, and quick as a flash she whipped out from
-her belt a small revolver and threw it forward, her finger upon the
-trigger.
-
-There was no tremor of the hand, the act was one of determined
-intention to kill the man, and she would have done so then and there,
-for he was caught wholly off his guard, had not Jack Jessop struck up
-her hand just as she pulled trigger.
-
-The bullet, as it was, cut through the corner of the chief’s sombrero.
-
-“A close call, that! Jack Jessop, you saved my life, so I’ll not kill
-you, as I intended to do; that act saved you.”
-
-“I didn’t do it for you, but to save her,” grunted Jack.
-
-“Oh, I know your intention, but the act was the same, for you saved
-me from death.
-
-“Miss Fallon, you are as quick as a flash as a drawer, and a ready
-hand with a revolver. You owe it to Jack Jessop that you do not
-suffer for your intended taking of my life, for my men would have
-been quickly revenged upon you. Give me that weapon, please.”
-
-Lucille sat, white, silent, and almost despairing. But she turned and
-handed the weapon to Jack Jessop, who in turn surrendered it with his
-own weapons to the chief.
-
-“Get off the box, Jack.”
-
-The man obeyed.
-
-“Now, Miss Fallon, do you also alight.”
-
-She also obeyed.
-
-“Jack, I shall put these irons on your ankles. You can walk with
-them, for the chain is a foot long, but slowly. You will have to walk
-to the next station, and you’ll hardly reach there before night. I
-need your horses, so will take them, and I have pack animals along,
-too, for the plunder.
-
-“Miss Fallon, I have a horse with sidesaddle for you, so you see
-I came prepared, even to good food for you, a canvas shelter and
-blankets.”
-
-“You intend to take me a prisoner?” said Lucille.
-
-“I certainly do, and hold you until I get the big ransom I shall
-demand.”
-
-“My poor, poor father.”
-
-“He is fortunate in not having come with you.”
-
-“Jack, there is no help for it, so I’ll make the best of it,” said
-Lucille, turning to the driver.
-
-“Tell my father what happened, and to arrange for the ransom, as he
-can do, provided it is not too large, for there is a limit, you know,
-and I am not of age yet, so funds cannot be readily gotten beyond
-a certain sum. Tell him not to delay, for I wish my freedom, and
-attempt no rescue, but pay the ransom. Good-by, Jack.”
-
-Lucille held out her hand.
-
-“You is the gamest leetle gal I ever seen,” said Jack Jessop, and the
-tears came into his eyes. Turning to the outlaw, he continued:
-
-“Some day there’ll come a settlement for your red deeds and your
-cruel treatment of this lady, and I’d show you no more mercy than I
-would a snake.”
-
-The chief laughed, snapped the irons on Jack’s ankles, then continued
-his search of the coach, taking several things of value.
-
-Then he called to his silent men to bring up the horses, and to strip
-the team of the harness.
-
-They quickly did so, and a horse was led up with a lady’s saddle.
-
-Lucille sprang to her seat without aid, making the remark in an
-indifferent tone:
-
-“It is lucky I wore my riding habit, fearing some accident.”
-
-The things from the coach, arms, and other articles, with the
-harness, cushions, and rubber coverings, were soon packed on the
-horses, the chief mounted, and, turning to the driver, said:
-
-“Good-by, Jack. I will not leave you unarmed, so here is your belt
-again. My compliments to Buffalo Bill, and tell him that some day
-I’ll get his scalp.”
-
-With a wave of the hand he rode off, leaving Jack Jessop gazing after
-them, his eyes full of tears at the fate of poor Lucille, whom he was
-powerless to aid.
-
-But Jack did not hesitate long, for he at once turned his steps down
-the trail toward Pioneer City, carrying the mails, which had not been
-disturbed, upon his back. He could not walk fast, ironed as he was,
-and it was night when he reached the relay station, utterly exhausted.
-
-But he quickly had the iron chain hammered in two by the stock
-tender, and, mounting a horse, the manacles still about his ankles,
-he rode on to Pioneer City and reported what had happened, starting
-out at once again with a harnessed team after his coach.
-
-The stock tender at the station he had sent off at full speed to the
-fort to report the affair to Colonel Carr.
-
-The stock tender reached the fort after midnight, and, half an hour
-after, a lieutenant with his troop and six of Buffalo Bill’s scouts
-had started for Monument Hill to pick up the trail of the outlaws at
-dawn, and follow it, Colonel Carr believing that he could thus aid
-Lieutenant Worth and his party who were pushing on to the river to
-head off the lawless band.
-
-Jack Jessop took his dismantled coach into Pioneer City with all
-haste, and then went to a blacksmith to get his manacles removed.
-
-He found the town all excitement over the affair, and learned from
-Colonel Buck, the stage agent there, that a stranger had come into
-Pioneer City and purchased a sidesaddle and a lot of provisions and
-other things, remaining but a short while and stating that he was
-from the Fort Advance settlement.
-
-“That man was the outlaw,” said Jack Jessop.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER VII.
-
- THE FLIGHT.
-
-
-The outlaw chief placed himself by the side of Lucille as they
-started away, and she said quickly:
-
-“There is no possible chance of my escape, so ride on ahead and I
-will follow you.”
-
-“You do not wish me by your side?”
-
-“I do not.”
-
-“I wish to talk to you.”
-
-“I do not care to converse with you.”
-
-“But I have something of importance to say.”
-
-“I do not care to hear it.”
-
-“But you must, and the trail admits of two riding abreast now, and
-will not later on, and I will not disturb you long.”
-
-“I have no power to enforce my wish.”
-
-“I shall ask the sum of just thirty thousand dollars for your ransom,
-and when that is paid you shall go free.”
-
-“You will not get it.”
-
-“Why?”
-
-“Well, though I have property of considerable value, neither my
-lawyer and guardian, nor myself, can get money on it until a certain
-time, and the cash that can be got is just that which is left over
-from the sum appropriated to pay certain fees, my schooling and
-living.”
-
-“And what does that amount to?”
-
-“About eighteen thousand dollars.”
-
-“Somehow I believe you, so I will take what I can get. Twenty
-thousand, then, shall be the price, for the balance can be raised.
-Doubtless your father has it, and when that is paid, you shall go
-free. I shall arrange all matters so as to place no difficulties in
-the way, and, meanwhile, you shall be treated with every respect, and
-given what comforts I can allow you.”
-
-There was something in the manner of the outlaw toward her that
-Lucille could not understand, and that was his marked respect.
-
-When it grew near sunset he ordered a halt, sought a secluded spot
-for his captive, had her canvas shelter put up, and placed before her
-a good supper, after which he left her, with the words:
-
-“I shall halt here for four hours, and then it shall be six more in
-the saddle, so get what rest you can.”
-
-Lucille enjoyed her supper, spread her blankets, and was soon fast
-asleep.
-
-A call awakened her, and, fifteen minutes after, they were again
-in the saddle, this time the chief riding ahead of her, his masked
-followers coming along behind her.
-
-“Why do they mask still? for they are all Indians, I have
-discovered,” she said to the chief.
-
-“You are not so sure of that.”
-
-“Oh, yes, I am,” was the girl’s confident reply. “I wasn’t born in
-the West, but I know an Indian when I see one.”
-
-Another long ride through the darkness of six hours, and the chief
-called a halt, two hours before dawn.
-
-Again Lucille was placed in a secluded spot, her shelter put up and
-she was made comfortable, the chief remarking:
-
-“We will not move for five hours this time, so you will have another
-rest, so make the best of it.”
-
-Again she slept soundly, and when she awoke the sun was shining
-brightly. She at once realized her position, and sighed.
-
-But she went to a rivulet near and made her toilet, then sat down on
-a rock and ate the breakfast which the chief had cooked.
-
-He had killed a deer, and gave her a nice steak, some bacon broiled
-on the coals, a crisp hoecake, and a cup of coffee in which there was
-some condensed milk and sugar he had brought from Pioneer City.
-
-She ate heartily, mounted her horse, and again took her place behind
-the chief, who remarked quietly:
-
-“As you can see through masks, Miss Fallon, I told my men to take
-them off.”
-
-“Yes, they are Indians, and a cruel-looking lot they are, though with
-hearts that are not as evil as their master’s, for their training has
-been to kill, torture, and rob an enemy, yours far different.”
-
-He bit his lip, but made no reply, and again rode to the front.
-
-After a short while he said:
-
-“Buffalo Bill and your father are up at the fords with Lieutenant
-Worth, hunting Indians, as you doubtless know. Jack Jessop got in
-during the night, and doubtless sent word of the holdup of the coach
-both to the fort and to Pioneer City, so that the troops, if sent at
-once on the trail, have now reached Monument Hill.”
-
-“On your trail?”
-
-“Yes, but a long distance behind, for we are over forty miles from
-the hill, and before night I shall cross the river into the Indian
-country, as I know of a secret trail over the mountain range you see
-ahead of us which will cut off half a day’s hard ride, and treat you
-to a view of some magnificent scenery as well.”
-
-“You are very thoughtful to treat me to grand scenery under such
-circumstances.”
-
-“Well, I wish to make your captivity as pleasant to you as possible;
-but I have to ride hard, as I will only feel safe when I get you
-across the river.”
-
-“And I shall be less safe.”
-
-“You will be all right, for I will take you up into the village of
-the old chief, Iron Eyes, and there is a good cabin there which no
-Indian will live in. It was built by a renegade white man who fled
-with his family to the Indians and was adopted into the tribe.
-The man, his wife and the children died off, and their cabin still
-remains there in good condition, furnished as they left it, for they
-brought all their furniture with them in their flight.”
-
-“I shall appreciate being separated from the Indians at least.”
-
-“Oh, yes, you will be free from them, for the tepees nearest the
-cabin are not occupied, but all used to store pelts, food, and the
-hundred and one things an Indian snakes in. It is, in fact, the
-store village, and the nearest living tepee to you is that of the
-young chief, Death Face, and you can trust him, for he is of a most
-chivalrous nature.
-
-“The other Indians will not go near you, I’ll see to that, so you
-will be alone; but that will not mean that you will have a chance
-to escape, as that would be impossible for a man to do, let alone a
-girl.”
-
-Lucille made no reply, and the chief did not again break the silence
-until they had climbed the mountain range by a most dangerous path.
-
-The outlaw halted as he neared the top of the range, having asked
-Lucille not to look behind her until he told her to do so, as he did
-not wish to spoil her view.
-
-She wheeled her horse and glanced behind her, and an exclamation of
-delight burst from her lips.
-
-Long she gazed in perfect rapture, and forgetful of herself, as she
-beheld miles of mountain, valley, and plain scenery.
-
-“That little grove there shall be your noonday camping place,
-directly upon the summit of the mountain, so that you can see in
-every direction,” said the chief. “Down on the other side, a few
-hundred yards, is a plateau, a valley in the mountaintop, with a
-stream running through it, and there we shall go on and halt, for
-there is good grass for the horses. When you get tired of the view
-come to where we are, and dinner will be ready.”
-
-Reaching the little grove of pines, Lucille again cried out in
-admiration, for before her now was a still grander view.
-
-Flowing through a vast valley, was a large river.
-
-“Do you see yonder mountains, miles below the river?”
-
-“Yes.”
-
-“It is there that the Indian village is, and that will be the end of
-our trail.
-
-“Just there, where you see a bald hill by the river, is where we will
-cross by a ford but very few know of, for none of my Indians know of
-it, and it is one no one could find, save by accident, as I did by
-seeing a herd of deer take to the water and swim across.
-
-“Something frightened them on the other side--a pack of wolves, I
-think--and they swam back again, landing at another point below. It
-showed me a crossing place, and I let several of my men into the
-secret and used to send couriers that way to and from my retreat to
-the Indian village. As the known fords are now guarded by troops, we
-will cross this way, if you are not too much alarmed.”
-
-“And if I am you will go to the regular ford?”
-
-“Oh, no; I am no fool, to run upon the soldiers.”
-
-“What will you do if I have not the nerve to go across?”
-
-“Simply go around by a ford that will give us two days’ hard travel.”
-
-“Never mind me, then; cross by the secret ford, for I can venture it
-if you can.”
-
-The outlaw then rode on, leading her horse, the Indians having gone
-to the camping place.
-
-Lucille was alone on the mountaintop, and gazed about her in rapt
-admiration.
-
-At last she said:
-
-“If I had my horse and a good start, I would risk finding my way back
-to the Overland Trail, for I watched all along closely, and my horse
-would retrace his tracks, I believe.
-
-“But, no, I must accept the situation as it is, and take things as
-they come.
-
-“The outlaw, from what he says, seems to think the fords are guarded
-by a large force, so I will not undeceive him.
-
-“Even now my father may be within a few miles of me, and, oh! if he
-only knew.”
-
-The girl weakened for a moment, but quickly rallied from her emotions
-and continued her gaze for quite a while. Then she strolled about the
-mountaintop, plucked a few wild flowers clinging among the rocks, and
-next started down to the camp with the remark:
-
-“Ah! I get the odors of boiling bacon and coffee, for the wind blows
-up from the camp. It makes me hungry, so I’ll go down to dinner.”
-
-Down she went, soon to come upon the trail, and she was glad to find
-dinner ready, and enjoyed it.
-
-Mounting again, the chief said:
-
-“We must ride hard now, for the river will have to be behind us when
-the sun sets. Are you very tired, Miss Fallon?”
-
-“Oh, no.”
-
-So on they went at a very slow pace for several miles in going down
-the mountain, and then when they struck good traveling, they pushed
-rapidly on, the chief not sparing the horses now.
-
-The sun was over an hour high when the river came into view.
-
-A halt was made to cool the horses off a little, then, riding down a
-steep ravine to the water, the chief said:
-
-“I’ll take your bridle rein here, Miss Fallon. Permit me to fold this
-rubber blanket around your feet and form, and you will not get in
-the least wet. Let your horse have full rein and do not be alarmed.”
-
-“I am not in the least alarmed,” was the reply, and she permitted the
-chief to fold the rubber blanket about her in such a way that she
-would not get wet when her horse was back deep in swimming.
-
-Then the chief rode in, she followed, her horse led, and the Indians
-came behind with the pack horses.
-
-The animals began to swim almost immediately, and the brave girl
-rather enjoyed the scene than dreaded it.
-
-After a long swim a sand bar was reached, they landed in safety, and,
-not to let the horses get cold, the chief pushed on for a couple of
-miles and went into camp, with the remark:
-
-“We are safe now, Miss Fallon, and you can rest through the night.”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER VIII.
-
- IN THE INDIAN VILLAGE.
-
-
-What the outlaw called safety was for himself and the Indians alone,
-and far from it for poor Lucille.
-
-He believed that the three fords were guarded still, that he might
-run upon a scouting party from the soldiers’ camps at any moment,
-and he did not feel at ease until he had crossed the river with his
-captive.
-
-It was bold in him to venture so near the upper ford, believing a
-party of soldiers to be there, yet he knew that the wild nature of
-the country through which the river flowed above would keep him from
-crossing for many a long mile, and, for Lucille’s sake alone, to his
-credit be it said, he wished to cross by the unknown ford, though,
-strictly speaking, it was not a ford, but a place where a horse or
-man might get over by swimming.
-
-Lucille had escaped getting wet in crossing, and, as before, was
-given a secluded camping place to herself.
-
-The chief made it most comfortable, as there was no hurry now, by
-cutting pine boughs and building a wikiup and placing the pine straw
-as a couch, with the cushions from the coach upon it.
-
-A little fire was built near, just to make it more homelike, the
-chief said, and an extra supper was prepared for all.
-
-Night fell, and soon after supper the tired girl, for she was tired,
-sank to sleep in a few minutes.
-
-She awoke once in the night, to hear an owl hooting in the trees not
-far away, and a coyote yelping a short distance from camp.
-
-But she banished all thought with an effort of her will, and went to
-sleep again, awakening only when the sun had risen.
-
-“I hope you rested well last night, Miss Fallon?”
-
-“I enjoyed a good night’s rest, thank you.”
-
-“A ride of a little over thirty miles, and you will be in your new
-home to-night.”
-
-“Home! Do not desecrate the name, for it will be a prison, not a home
-to me,” she said bitterly.
-
-“Breakfast is ready for you.”
-
-She ate it, her spirits returned, and once more she mounted for the
-ride.
-
-Toward noon they began to climb the range she had seen from far
-across the river, and soon after the chief halted for dinner.
-
-Then up the steep trail they climbed again, Lucille glancing back
-from time to time to behold the scenery, and, while the sun was yet
-two hours above the horizon, they came to a pass in the mountains,
-where she suddenly beheld an Indian sentinel standing in the trail
-ahead of them.
-
-“Where is the chief?” asked the outlaw in the Indian tongue, and
-which was as Hebrew to Lucille.
-
-The Indian sentinel pointed, and soon after there came toward them
-a horseman that at once riveted Lucille’s gaze. He was the Indian
-chief, Death Face, and he had just come down from the village to the
-pass, which his band of braves were guarding.
-
-The youthful warrior was resplendent in a new costume, from boots to
-war bonnet, for he had on a pair of handsome cavalry boots. Sitting
-his horse with conscious power, armed with the white man’s weapons of
-revolvers and bowie knife, his face hideously painted, and mounted
-upon an animal that was bedecked in barbaric splendor, Death Face
-struck Lucille as being the most remarkable being she had ever gazed
-upon.
-
-The chief fairly started as his eyes fell upon her, and the outlaw,
-after greeting him, said:
-
-“Death Face, I have been on a raid into the white man’s territory,
-and this lady is my captive, whom I shall sell back to her father for
-a large price.”
-
-To the utter amazement of Lucille, the young chief replied, in
-perfect English:
-
-“I do not believe in the theory of my people, chief, of making war
-upon women and children, and I am surprised that you, as a white man,
-should do so; but that is your affair, not mine. Only treat her well.”
-
-“That she will tell you I have done. I wish to place her in the
-renegade’s cabin in your camp.”
-
-“You can do so.”
-
-The outlaw and his captive were then riding on, when he halted and
-said:
-
-“Chief Death Face, those braves of yours whom I took with me I shall
-arm with repeating rifles and revolvers. I also have a pair of fine
-revolvers, a knife and a rifle for you, with a very handsome buckskin
-suit sent by an officer at the fort to a friend in the East, with
-slouch hat and all.
-
-“They will fit you, I am sure, and I wish you to accept them, as well
-as several fine Mexican serapes.”
-
-“Thank you, Captain Eagle, I will take them.”
-
-“You have done well, I see, on your raid?”
-
-“Oh, yes.”
-
-“Come to my quarters in the village to-night.”
-
-“I will.”
-
-“But have you any word of the soldiers?”
-
-“They are still on the other side, though I did not see them.”
-
-“I supposed they had gone, for we had seen no camp-fire smoke for
-three days.”
-
-“It may be a trick, so still be cautious and guard the fords,
-especially now that I have a captive here for whose rescue Colonel
-Carr would doubtless send his whole force.”
-
-With this the chief rode on, muttering to himself:
-
-“I must win that fellow with presents, for he will be the next chief
-after Iron Eyes, and he has as much influence now. Probably he has
-been educated in some school, for he speaks English like a paleface,
-and acts like one, too. There is some secret about him that I cannot
-fathom.”
-
-He had not ridden far before Lucille came up alongside of him. She
-saw now about her in a valley like cañon a camp of Indians.
-
-They were in full war paint, and gazed savagely at her as she rode
-by, yet were gloating in her capture.
-
-Once through the cañon, and the trail led down into a beautiful
-valley in which was the village of old Iron Eyes.
-
-Lucille uttered a cry as the view burst upon her, for, through the
-valley ran a mountain stream, upon both sides of which, for several
-miles, were the tepees of the Indians, the scattered village of the
-red men.
-
-The valley was dotted with thousands of ponies, and among the tepees
-were visible many women and children.
-
-Warriors were riding about, youths were mounted upon bareback ponies,
-others were playing games, children were bathing in the stream, and
-squaws were busy getting the evening meal.
-
-At the base of the hills on either side was heavy timber, and above
-the village towered the mountain ranges.
-
-“What a view for an artist!” cried Lucille.
-
-“Yes, it must strike you strangely, Miss Fallon.”
-
-“It does; but you did not answer my question?”
-
-“What was that?”
-
-“I asked you, after we came through the camp of braves, who that
-young chief was?”
-
-“He is called Death Face, and is the next chief in power to old Iron
-Eyes.”
-
-“He is very young?”
-
-“Not over twenty-two, I should say.”
-
-“And yet holds such power?”
-
-“He is a born fighter, a plotter, a soldier, and he has won his way
-up, young as he is.”
-
-“How is it that he speaks English so well?”
-
-“Only a few minutes ago he told me that he was taught by a renegade
-white man and his family.”
-
-“And also learned from him, I suppose, not to war against women and
-children. He could set you a good example, chief.”
-
-“I follow my own inclinations, Miss Fallon.”
-
-“So I have discovered. But in what part of this village am I to find
-refuge?”
-
-“Up at the head of the valley, in the cabin I spoke of.”
-
-“There must be a couple of thousand Indians here, at least.”
-
-“Double that number and more, for the village is five miles long,
-has some twelve hundred tepees, and can put out a force to defend it
-of two thousand warriors. Then there are several other contingent
-villages in these mountains that claim Iron Eyes as chief. It would
-be a sad day for any force of soldiers to invade these mountains,
-Miss Fallon, unless they came several thousand strong.”
-
-“That was just what I was thinking,” answered Lucille.
-
-As they rode into the village the squaws and children rushed toward
-them to see the newcomer.
-
-But a few words from the outlaw prevented any rudeness, for they held
-no sympathy for the fair-faced captive.
-
-Lucille paled at sight of them, but remained calm, and rode on by
-the side of the outlaw, whom she could not but now regard as her
-protector.
-
-Up through the village they rode, the girl’s fears gradually giving
-place to interest, until at the upper end of the valley, under the
-shelter of a heavily-wooded ridge, the mountaintop, there were
-visible a number of tepees apart from the others.
-
-“There is your camp, Miss Fallon. It is a deserted village--the
-supply tepees, as I told you. Yonder you see your cabin, apart from
-them, and there you will be safe. I shall have a half-breed squaw,
-who once lived at the fort as an officer’s servant, remain there with
-you and do your cooking.”
-
-“And be my guard also?”
-
-“In a measure, yes, for she will keep the Indians away from you, and
-you do not need any other guard here, as you could not escape over
-yonder ridge, unless you have wings.
-
-“The squaw speaks English and has cooked for me when I have been
-here, for my own tepee is in the village. The cabin is furnished, as
-I told you, after a rude fashion, and you have your own satchel with
-clothing, so you will not be uncomfortable.”
-
-As they passed a large tepee the outlaw called out to an Indian woman
-who stood there to approach them.
-
-She did so, and Lucille noticed that her face was lighter than those
-about her, and she looked neat in her attire.
-
-“Yellow Bird, I wish you to get your traps and come on up to the
-cabin. You are to look after this captive of mine while she is here,
-and take good care of her.”
-
-The woman had glanced at Lucille as she came up, but that was all,
-and she replied, in fair English:
-
-“Yellow Bird will do as the white chief bids her.”
-
-Then they rode on, and soon halted before the cabin, which was built
-of hewn logs, with boards roughly sawed out of hewn timber serving as
-roofing. There was a porch along the front, and it was certainly a
-very fine cabin to find in an Indian village.
-
-The chief took a key from a hiding place, which he appeared to know
-of, and unlocked the door.
-
-There were four rooms in the cabin, and Lucille saw that it was
-furnished, though rudely, for the renegade had brought his
-belongings with him when he had fled from his own people.
-
-“You will be at home here, Miss Fallon.”
-
-“Yes, at home!” repeated Lucille, with sarcasm, to add quickly:
-
-“But it is so much better than I expected, you have treated me so
-much differently than I anticipated, that I thank you.”
-
-The moment that she was left alone by the outlaw, and she saw him and
-his braves ride away, Lucille Fallon yielded to the prerogative of a
-woman, and, seating herself in the cabin, burst into tears.
-
-“At home! Ah! if this were to be my home, I would rather that the
-grave should be,” she cried bitterly.
-
-She had totally forgotten about the Indian woman until she heard the
-gently uttered words:
-
-“Don’t cry, paleface.”
-
-She started to her feet, for she was too proud to wish any one to see
-her weeping.
-
-Before her stood Yellow Bird, the half-breed Indian woman. She had
-tidied herself up, and had a bundle under her arms. Her face was a
-good one, not cruel, and she said again:
-
-“Don’t cry, Yellow Bird be good to you.”
-
-Lucille stepped forward and grasped the woman’s hand.
-
-“You are good, I can see that. You have lived among the palefaces,
-the outlaw told me?”
-
-“Yes, my mother was a paleface squaw, my father a great Indian chief.
-He died, and my mother went back to her people, taking me with her.
-She died, and I work hard for officer’s family at fort far away. I
-hear them say: ‘She only half-breed Injun; watch her.’ I feel mad,
-I feel bad, and run away back to my people. But some treat me good,
-one young squaw pretty, just like you, and I love her. I love you for
-her. Yellow Bird be good to you.”
-
-The tears came into the eyes of Lucille, and, stepping close up to
-the woman, she kissed her.
-
-It was under the impulse of her loneliness, her sorrow, her
-helplessness, and the kind words spoken to her.
-
-The squaw started as though she had been struck a blow, for it fairly
-frightened her, but she said quickly:
-
-“Oh, yes, Yellow Bird be heap good to little paleface.”
-
-Then she set about her work to clean up, just as she had done when
-living in the officer’s family. She got water from a spring near, and
-built a fire in the large hearth, so that the cabin soon no longer
-looked forlorn.
-
-The outlaw had left the stage cushions there, the stores he had
-bought in Pioneer City and Lucille’s satchel, and the young captive
-was soon quite comfortable, and she began to feel that she had cause
-to congratulate herself, after all, that matters were as they were.
-
-In Yellow Bird she believed she had found a friend. Yet Lucille was
-not one to gush, and she decided that there was a very narrow margin
-between deceit and sincerity in one’s appearance, so she wished to
-know whether the Indian woman was really true or false.
-
-As she watched the squaw preparing supper, she asked her about Death
-Face, the young chief.
-
-“He heap good young chief--heap like paleface. He be great chief some
-day, and maybe have peace with palefaces, for he don’t like to kill
-Little Paleface’s people, but big fighter in battle. Red people all
-love Death Face. Iron Eyes heap cruel man, kill and scalp paleface,
-hate them bad. Iron Eyes kill many.”
-
-Lucille glanced out of the open window and said half aloud:
-
-“Speak of the devil, and his imp appears. There comes Death Face now.”
-
-He rode up to the front of the cabin and was alone.
-
-Lucille walked out on the piazza and to her surprise he bowed
-courteously to her and then said:
-
-“I hope you are comfortable here!”
-
-“Comfortable, yes, far more so than I anticipated being, but unhappy,
-as you may know, for my people are not your people, my life not your
-life, we are raised in a different atmosphere and are foes.”
-
-The chieftain listened to her in deepest attention, gazing fixedly at
-her, and then said:
-
-“I like to hear you talk, for it brings back to me the voice of those
-I loved, those who are gone.”
-
-“Whom do you mean?”
-
-“I mean one whom I loved as a father, another who was a mother to
-me, and a sister and brother. They are all gone--dead; but I had not
-forgotten them, and you bring them back to me now, so I love to look
-at you, love to hear you talk.
-
-“Speak again, for your voice is as sweet as the murmur of the brook
-in summer, as sweet as the trilling of the birds, and your face as
-lovely as the mountain flowers that seem timid, just like you.”
-
-Lucille listened with rapt attention to the words of the strange
-young chief, for he spoke with a softness of tone, a respectful look,
-and with words that fell strangely from the lips of an Indian, and
-were in strong contrast to the hideously painted death face with
-which he had ornamented his countenance.
-
-As though he feared he should not talk to the captive longer, Death
-Face said:
-
-“I will go now, but I came to see if I could help you, if I could
-make you more comfortable.
-
-“This was my home once, and I am glad to have you here.
-
-“Do you see those graves under the ridge yonder?--they are buried
-there, those I loved, and I put white crosses above their graves, and
-cut their names on them with my knife.”
-
-“You can read, then?”
-
-“Oh, yes, and write. You will find books in the cabin to read. Don’t
-feel bad, for you shall not be harmed, for Death Face says so. I will
-come again.”
-
-He wheeled his horse and rode rapidly away, leaving Lucille wondering
-at her strange Indian acquaintance.
-
-Walking over to the graves under the ridge, Lucille saw that there
-were four of them, all marked by rude wooden crosses, but it was too
-dark to see the names, and she hastened back to the cabin, where
-Yellow Bird had her supper ready.
-
-It was a tempting repast, and eaten with real relish, Lucille talking
-the while to the squaw and asking her about the young chief, Death
-Face.
-
-Yellow Bird had little more to tell her than what she had already
-known, or would not tell her more. She did not say that all the
-maidens in the village were in love with the young chief, but that he
-seemed to care for none of them.
-
-The firelight was the only light they had in the cabin, and Lucille
-asked the woman to bring in wood enough to burn all night.
-
-This Yellow Bird did, and then the captive spread some bedding, put
-the serapes the chief had given her over them, and retired for the
-night, bolting the doors firmly.
-
-Yellow Bird spread her bed in front of the fire, and the two were
-soon fast asleep.
-
-When Lucille awoke the next morning she found Yellow Bird was getting
-breakfast, and the squaw told her that the young chief had been there
-early and left bear and other robes for her, dressed deerskins, and
-plenty of game and fish which he had shot and caught.
-
-The outlaw came after breakfast and asked her how she was, and then
-said:
-
-“There is a hammock in this house, Death Face told me, so I will
-swing it on the porch for you.”
-
-The hammock was found, swung, and then the outlaw said:
-
-“I have brought you pen, ink, and paper, Miss Fallon, and I wish you
-to write a letter to your father.
-
-“Tell him how you are treated by me, but make known that he must pay
-the sum of twenty thousand dollars for your ransom. The letter will
-be mailed to him at Pioneer City, and he shall send his answer by
-Jack Jessop, who will be met by a man whom I will instruct to be on
-hand. Your father must state in his letter if he will pay that ransom
-on the next run of the coach, and send it by Jack Jessop to be given
-to my representative. If my man is harmed, then I will not answer for
-your safety.
-
-“But, if he promises to send the money by Jessop, when he is ready to
-pay it, then you will be returned to him in safety, being given into
-Jack Jessop’s charge the third run of the coach after your father
-writes agreeing to my terms. Do you understand, Miss Fallon?”
-
-“Perfectly.”
-
-“I will write also, and you shall see my letter. Then I will see that
-the letters are mailed without delay in Pioneer City.”
-
-“It can be done none too soon to please me.”
-
-“So I thought.”
-
-“One minute, please?”
-
-“Yes.”
-
-“You said on the way here that you would tell me a secret some day
-that I am interested in.”
-
-“I believe I will tell you a secret,” said the man, thoughtfully, and
-he sat down upon the porch.
-
-Lucille sat in the hammock, using it for a swing, and the strangeness
-of her situation and surroundings could not but impress her.
-
-“I’ll tell you my secret, yes, and perhaps you will then understand
-that I seek revenge as well as gold from your father. By the way, do
-you think I resemble your father?”
-
-“In form, yes, and in face, also, save for the stamp of wickedness on
-your countenance.”
-
-“Well, he is innocent, I am evil. But we should be alike, for we are
-brothers.”
-
-Lucille sprang out, of the hammock and cried fiercely:
-
-“It is false!”
-
-“I tell you we are brothers, he being several years my senior,” said
-the outlaw. “My first love was a young and beautiful girl, and,
-though she loved me, he stole her from me.”
-
-“I do not believe you.”
-
-“Well, he married her, that is certain----”
-
-“My mother?”
-
-“Oh, no; your mother was his second wife.
-
-“He won my sweetheart from me, married her, and then went to Texas
-to live. I heard afterward that his wife died after two years of
-wedded life, but I did not know, did not care, and I was not aware of
-where he was, or what doing until during the Civil War. I was taken
-prisoner by the Confederates, when in my captor, the colonel of a
-regiment, I recognized my brother. He knew me at a glance, and he
-came to me and we had a long talk together.
-
-“He told me that he had not known of my love for the woman he
-married, that he had never been told by her or her parents about an
-engagement between her and myself, that I was away and he therefore
-could not hear it from my own lips, and hence he had asked her to
-be his wife. He was going to Texas to live, and the marriage was
-hastened and she went with him, and only when on her dying bed had
-she confessed to him that she had been engaged to me.
-
-“Then he had written me the truth; but his letter I never received,
-and I did not believe what he told me.”
-
-“Yet it was the truth.”
-
-“How do you know?”
-
-“I have his first wife’s written confession, in which she told all,
-and how her parents had told her not to speak of her love affair with
-you, as he was rich, you were not, having squandered much of your
-fortune in fast living. Her name was Dorothy Armand, and she left her
-confession with her jewelry and other things that my father placed in
-my mother’s keeping, and all of which she left to me.”
-
-“Yes, her name was Dorothy Armand, as you say; but she deceived me,
-and I would not believe her dying confession, or take my brother’s
-word, either, for they wronged me, and I never forgive a wrong.”
-
-“But my father never did you a wrong, whatever his wife did in
-deceiving him as to her engagement to you,” said Lucille warmly.
-
-“His name is Louis Fallon Lamar, and he was a colonel in the
-Confederate army, as I have said, and a Texan ranchero. He got me
-exchanged, I admit, and gave me money; but that did not atone for
-the past, and I hated him, for even in war he beat me, as he rose to
-be a colonel of cavalry, I only a captain of infantry.
-
-“He had married again, he told me, and had a daughter, but I was glad
-to feel that he was ruined by the war. What became of him then I
-never knew until I recognized him as a soldier in the United States
-army, and only a sergeant.
-
-“Then I remembered that I had heard that a Southerner of our name had
-killed a man in the East, and had fled to escape the gallows.
-
-“I wrote East, got the particulars, and found that it was my brother
-Louis. I have only hoped to capture him that I might send him back as
-a fugitive from justice to be hanged.”
-
-Lucille’s eyes flashed fire, and for a moment she did not speak. Then
-she said:
-
-“Let me ask you to look me in the eyes while I tell you what I know
-about what you have told me of my father.”
-
-“I am listening.”
-
-“My father did come out of the war ruined almost. He had married
-again, my mother being his second wife. He had felt keenly the
-unhappy circumstances of his first marriage, in fact, it cut him to
-the heart. He saved my mother’s father’s life at the risk of his
-own, was wounded by the shot intended for my grandfather, who took
-father to his home, where his daughter, my mother, nursed him through
-a long siege of suffering. My mother loved him, and he loved her, so
-they were married.
-
-“My father went North on business, accompanied a gentleman to his
-home one night with whom he had some business. Burglars broke into
-the house, and the host was shot down and robbed. Before he died he
-stated under oath that it was my father who had killed him, that they
-had a business deal on hand, that my father knew he had thousands of
-dollars in his home, and had come into his room at night and killed
-him.
-
-“My father had been in a distant wing of the house, had arisen at the
-noise of the struggle, had gone to the aid of his friend, to come
-face to face with you as you fled. You were dressed just as he was,
-you had killed your man, robbed him, and were flying. Stunned by the
-recognition, my father had been incapable of action, and, tottering
-to a seat, had remained there until arrested as the murderer.
-
-“Determined not to hang for your crime, and feeling that there was no
-hope for him, he sprang upon the constable who guarded him, choked
-him into unconsciousness, secured the keys of his manacles, freed
-himself, and fled. He wrote my mother that he was not guilty of the
-crime, but circumstantial evidence was against him, his insane flight
-added seeming proof, and she unfortunately believed that he had
-committed the deed, and wrote to him.
-
-“Thus a wide gulf was between them, and he became a homeless wanderer
-and fugitive. He went to dwell among the Indians, and, having been
-educated as a physician, he became a medicine man in the tribe,
-checked a smallpox epidemic in their midst, and became a great chief,
-honored and loved by them. Discovering gold in his wanderings, he hid
-it away and at last decided to make good use of it. So he left the
-Indian village, carrying his gold on pack horses, and, going to a
-settlement, shipped it home to my mother.
-
-“It was a fortune for us, and she gladly received it, for her income
-was not large, and long before she had repented of her belief in my
-father’s guilt, and tried in vain to find him.
-
-“One day, just one year ago, my mother received a letter from the
-judge of the court in the city where the murder was committed
-which had wrecked my father’s life. It told of the confession of a
-prisoner, who had died in prison, that my father was innocent of the
-crime, that it was his brother who had been the murderer--he, the
-prisoner, being his ally--and that he saw the recognition of his
-brother by my father, and the shock it gave him.
-
-“But the murderer had committed other crimes, forcing him to become
-a fugitive, and so he could not be found, nor could my father, who
-afterward, I learned, had entered the army on the border. My mother
-was dying then, and I had to cling to her. She died, and soon after I
-had my lawyer find out if Sergeant Louis Fallon was my father, and he
-did so.
-
-“Then I wrote him that I would come to him. You know the rest, and I
-know that you have wronged my father beyond all forgiveness. Yes, you
-are his crime-stained brother, Loyd Lamar.”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER IX.
-
- BUFFALO BILL’S BOLD VENTURE.
-
-
-The council of war which Lieutenant Walter Worth had said he would
-hold that night in the camp near the secret crossing of the river,
-where it was found that the outlaw had escaped across into the Indian
-country, continued until late at night, the young officer, Surgeon
-Denmead, the sergeant, and Buffalo Bill being the four present.
-
-Talking the matter over, in the light of all the facts with which
-they were acquainted, they were certain that Lucille had been
-captured by the outlaw leader.
-
-The letter which the outlaw had told the sergeant he would write to
-entrap her had been sent, and so there was no doubt but that he had
-been on hand to receive his prize.
-
-The Indians had told the sergeant the last night he had crossed the
-river that the outlaw had gone to Pioneer City by a secret ford.
-
-That trail had been found where it had left the river, and the trail
-where it had entered the river going back had also been discovered.
-
-This proved that the outlaw had secured his captive and hastened with
-her to the Indian camp.
-
-To rescue her, then, was the question, and Sergeant Fallon at once
-said:
-
-“There is but one thing for me to do, and that is to put on my
-disguise and go into the Indian village after her.”
-
-“Yes, sergeant, and I will go with you,” said Buffalo Bill firmly.
-
-“It would be madness for you to do so, Cody.”
-
-“Oh, no, sergeant, for I would go as an ally, not to keep you
-company. I would go on foot, not mounted.
-
-“We can cross the river, and while you go down to the ford, I will go
-over here.”
-
-“You can proceed by the regular trail, while I will take it afoot to
-the mountains, there make for the bald peak we can see, and there you
-can find me, as I will look for you.
-
-“Afoot, I can readily hide. I will leave no trail, and am afraid of
-no redskins trapping me, for I have been within hailing distance of
-their villages scores of times.”
-
-“Pardon me, lieutenant, but do you think Mr. Cody should make the
-venture?”
-
-“No, sergeant, I do not.”
-
-“Nor do I,” said the surgeon.
-
-“See here, that young woman is a captive, and I tell you there should
-be more than one to aid in her rescue.
-
-“I know Indians from ’way back, and I’ll guarantee to go to their
-village and return.
-
-“You, in your disguise, are all right, sergeant, and you may be able
-to help me escape with her, and come away yourself later.
-
-“We can pick out certain points in the mountains which we can
-discern, where we can meet, and I feel we can accomplish your
-daughter’s rescue; yes, and get hold of that outlaw by some means
-also, for I’ll not be happy until his chips are called in.
-
-“I go, too, sergeant.”
-
-“Well, Cody, I see you are determined, so I yield, for I have every
-confidence in your powers to give the redskins the slip, but what are
-we to do?”
-
-“Stay right here, lieutenant, until we bring Miss Lucille back, for
-we may need your support and need it bad.”
-
-“All right. I will do as you suggest; but you and the sergeant
-arrange your plans of action between you.”
-
-“We will, sir, to-morrow.”
-
-The next morning the scout and the sergeant went up on the range and
-picked out half a dozen objects on the distant mountains across the
-river, and agreed to make them points of rendezvous.
-
-Then the sergeant said:
-
-“Mr. Cody, I wish to confide in you.”
-
-“Well, sergeant.”
-
-“I have a brother who was a wild young fellow, and believed that
-I had treacherously cheated him out of his ladylove, when I knew
-nothing about his love for her, and she became my wife. She was not
-Lucille’s mother, she being the daughter of my second wife.
-
-“Now, my brother never forgave me, and some years after he committed
-a crime of which I was accused, and it made an outcast, a fugitive of
-me.
-
-“He married and came West, and the other night when I looked into the
-face of the man known as Eagle, the outlaw, I felt sure that he was
-my brother.
-
-“I have not seen my unfortunate brother for many years, but the face,
-as I saw it by the flickering camp fire’s light, the voice, impressed
-me that it was Loyd Lamar.
-
-“Now, if he is my brother, he knows that Lucille is my daughter,
-and that is a relief to my mind. If the outlaw is my brother, and I
-would almost take oath that he is, I have but one request of you, and
-that is to kill him, and not capture him to be taken to the fort and
-hanged.”
-
-“My dear sergeant, I had promised myself I would do that, on account
-of his wife, and I will be that more anxious to save him from the
-gallows now that he is suspected of being your brother,” was Buffalo
-Bill’s reply.
-
-That afternoon they started upon their perilous mission, Buffalo Bill
-crossing the river at the spot where the camp was and the sergeant
-riding down to the upper ford, to go over after dark and continue on
-by the trail to the mountains.
-
-But the sergeant in crossing came to grief, for there stood on the
-other bank as sentinel a young brave who was striving to win a name
-for himself.
-
-He saw in the moonlight a horse and rider crossing the ford; so,
-taking aim, the redskin fired, pulling trigger just as he discovered
-that it was not a paleface but an Indian.
-
-The sergeant felt a stinging pain in his shoulder, the blood began
-to flow; he, therefore, turned back, fearing that he was seriously
-wounded, and did not know why he had been fired on.
-
-Fortunately Surgeon Denmead was there, and at once went to work on
-him, remarking after a while:
-
-“I have got the ball, Worth, and, with care, the wound will not be
-fatal, though serious.”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER X.
-
- THE RESCUER REACHES THE GOAL.
-
-
-One afternoon, a week after Lucille’s coming to the Indian village
-as a captive, and while Lucille and the chief, Death Face, who had
-proved to be half white, were seated upon the little piazza looking
-at the sunset, the young man on the chair, the maiden in the hammock,
-there suddenly dashed around the corner of the cabin a tall form,
-brandishing a revolver in each hand. He had his revolver leveled full
-at the young man, as he called out sternly:
-
-“Up with your hands, renegade, or you die!”
-
-“Buffalo Bill!” cried Lucille, in suppressed tones, as though
-realizing, even in her surprise, the danger of speaking that name
-there. Then she quickly added:
-
-“For God’s sake do not kill him, for he is my friend.”
-
-Death Face sprang to his feet, yet made no move to draw a weapon, but
-stood gazing defiantly into the face of the scout, who, at the words
-of Lucille, lowered his weapons and said quickly:
-
-“Let me step into the cabin, for I may be seen here.”
-
-Quickly Lucille seized his hand and fairly dragged him into the
-cabin, while she said reproachfully:
-
-“Oh, why did you come here, for your life will be the forfeit?”
-
-“I came for you, Miss Lucille, but I did not expect to find you in a
-white man’s cabin, free and with company.”
-
-“I will explain all later, but now you must go into hiding, for if
-you were discovered----”
-
-“Not a redskin has seen me, I assure you. I have been four days
-coming from the river to this cabin, which I saw from the ridge
-above, as I did you also, and this young man, who I thought must be
-some renegade.
-
-“I crept up behind the cabin, having seen you seated on the piazza,
-and, dashing around, covered him; but you say he is your friend.”
-
-“You are safe here, Buffalo Bill, for I cannot but call you so, and
-you shall know the whole story. So sit down, for it is a long one,
-and there are secrets in it which you must not breathe to any one.”
-
-“You have my pledge not to betray anything, Miss Lucille,” said
-Buffalo Bill, and then he heard the story of her father’s strange
-life, her uncle’s, and her own.
-
-The scout listened with an interest that was intense, and when he had
-heard all, said in a low tone:
-
-“And I have a story to tell, too, Miss Lucille, and it is that you
-need no longer dread your wicked uncle, the outlaw. I crossed the
-river at the spot where you did, and that night camped not far away.
-The next morning the outlaw rode full upon me: we saw each other
-at the same time, but I was a little the quickest, and my bullet
-pierced his brain. I had crossed the river upon a small raft the
-soldiers had made for me, and so I staked his horse out, when I was
-sure that he was alone, and, putting the body on the raft, poled back
-to the other shore. There I found that your father, who was to have
-crossed at the ford, and go with me to rescue you, had returned,
-having been fired on by the Indian sentinel and slightly wounded.”
-
-“You mean it--slightly wounded?” cried Lucille.
-
-“I tell the truth, for Surgeon Denmead was in camp and extracted the
-bullet. I had a talk with your father and he was doing well, but did
-not wish me to risk coming. How glad I now am that I did, for I have
-found you, though I have not rescued you.”
-
-“And my outlaw uncle?”
-
-“Lieutenant Worth had his soldiers bury him, for the lieutenant is
-waiting on the river for your return. Just as I was leaving another
-force came up which had taken your trail from Monument Hill and
-followed it to the river, so both are there.
-
-“I recrossed the river then on the raft, waited until night, and,
-mounting the horse of the outlaw, made a flank movement to reach
-the camp, determined to play Captain Eagle, if I met a redskin, for
-we were not unlike in size and face, and I speak the Indian tongue
-fairly well, while the horse and the coat and hat I appropriated
-would help me out, I knew.
-
-“I did not care to risk it by day, so flew by night only, reached the
-ridge, reconnoitered, and here I am, Miss Lucille; and my advice is
-that we get out of this at once.”
-
-Lucille turned to Death Face, who said:
-
-“Yes, we will go. I will bring ponies, too, and we will go up the
-ridge trail, where Buffalo Bill’s horse is, and then, together, we
-will go down to the river. If we meet any bands, Death Face, the
-chief, passes unquestioned.”
-
-So it was decided, and, while the young man went to make his
-arrangements for leaving the Indian camp forever, Lucille and Yellow
-Bird prepared for their escape, Buffalo Bill keeping in hiding.
-
-Under the guidance of the young chief, the trail to the river was
-made in perfect safety, Buffalo Bill being taken for the outlaw,
-and Lucille and Yellow Bird for braves by the bands of Indians they
-passed.
-
-No one questioned Death Face, and on he rode with his escaping party,
-Lucille and Yellow Bird having their faces painted, and in their
-leggings, riding in masculine fashion, while the pack horses they had
-along were well loaded with things taken from the Manly cabin and the
-young chief’s tepee.
-
-Reaching the river before dawn, the Indians left them, and Lucille
-added to her costume her riding habit and felt better able to face
-the soldiers on the other side.
-
-They crossed on the raft, which made several trips, the horses
-swimming over; then, mounting, they rode on to the soldiers’ camp.
-
-Such a welcome as greeted them, when Buffalo Bill and the sergeant’s
-daughter were recognized, cannot be described, for the soldiers
-seemed to have gone wild.
-
-In the week that had passed since he was wounded the sergeant had
-much improved.
-
-The meeting between father and daughter was most affecting, while
-tears came into the brave man’s eyes as he grasped Buffalo Bill’s
-hand and said:
-
-“I owe all this to you, Cody, and Lucille tells me she has told you
-all.”
-
-Fearful of risking his daughter so near the redskins, the sergeant
-said he was able to travel. The march was, therefore, begun after
-the noon meal, the trail taken being the same one that Lucille had
-traveled with the outlaw.
-
-The command was three days getting back to the fort, but when they
-came in sight, and it was seen that Lucille had been rescued, again
-there was a wild scene of rejoicing.
-
-Then, too, the sergeant had more joy added to his cup of bliss, for
-the last coach through had brought him his commission, “for special
-and gallant services,” as a first lieutenant in the army of the
-United States.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XI.
-
- THE GUARD OF HONOR.
-
-
-After a month’s stay at the fort, under the plea of his wound
-unfitting him for service, for it was still troublesome, Lieutenant
-Fallon resigned his commission, feeling that he had been vindicated
-in having won it, unaided, and, with his daughter, went eastward, and
-thence to Texas, to his old ranch home.
-
-In a short time there was a wedding at the ranch, for thither had
-gone Lieutenant Walter Worth to claim his bride. Shortly after the
-lieutenant’s departure, Buffalo Bill set forth upon a new mission
-which promised a harvest of adventures.
-
-Having been appointed, for a special purpose, chief of scouts of the
-Tenth United States Cavalry, a regiment of black troopers, Cody rode
-off on one of his lone trails to reach the command at its frontier
-post.
-
-He loved the adventure and danger attending this new mission, yet
-sought it also for the benefit he could bring to those who dwelt upon
-the advance borderland, and depended upon just such men as himself to
-protect them from the redskins of the wild West.
-
-The noted scout had been ordered to Fort Aspen for his special duty,
-as the commandant, Major Armes, had made the request that he should
-be, on account of the threatened hostility of the Indians, and, also,
-as Buffalo Bill was the man who knew that country better than any
-other frontiersman.
-
-Major Armes also had been much troubled by the lawless bands of
-gold hunters who had sought to invade the Indian country, risking
-massacres, and keeping the redskins constantly worried over the
-determination of these palefaces to get a foothold in their hunting
-grounds and then force them farther toward the “Land of the Setting
-Sun.”
-
-Many bands of lawless invaders of the beautiful country had
-recklessly penetrated the mountain and valley recesses in search of
-the precious yellow metal, and they had thus avoided the chain of
-soldiers the government had put there to keep them out.
-
-One band after another had met its doom in the forbidden land, and
-been wiped out utterly by the Indians, who had left not one of them
-to tell the story of the massacre.
-
-They had taken their lives in their own hands, and, against all
-warnings and efforts of the soldiers, had broken through the military
-barrier and penetrated the Indian country, to meet there quick death.
-
-Even several emigrant trains, with women and children along, had
-foolishly ventured, and Buffalo Bill had reported that the groups of
-whitened bones he had found told the story of their fate.
-
-Though the soldiers were trying to protect their country from
-invasion, the hostile Sioux were as bitter toward them as toward
-those who sought to make homes there, and war, merciless and
-unending, had been declared.
-
-“If I had Buffalo Bill, as my chief of scouts, I believe he could,
-with his knowledge of the country, of these Indians, and his great
-skill as a frontiersman, head off these would-be settlers and bands
-of gold seekers from what they regard as a promised land, and this
-done, the Sioux would be more willing to make peace with the army,
-realizing that our desire was to protect them.”
-
-So wrote Major Armes, the commandant of Fort Aspen, to Colonel Carr,
-in seeking to have the valuable services of William F. Cody as chief
-of scouts.
-
-And the letter further said:
-
-“The Tenth Cavalry of colored troops also needs just such a man as
-Buffalo Bill to steady them and give them perfect confidence in the
-one who leads them upon deadly trails.
-
-“They one and all have perfect confidence in Buffalo Bill, believe
-that he bears a charmed life--as I also am inclined to believe--and
-they know that the Indians dread him, regard him with a certain
-superstitious fear, and his influence is very great along the whole
-border.
-
-“I, therefore, respectfully urge that he be sent to Fort Aspen, for a
-while at least, if only to bring confidence to the garrison.”
-
-The result of Major Armes’ letter was that the next courier through
-to Fort Aspen brought dispatches stating that Buffalo Bill should
-come very soon, and that, spoken to upon the subject, he had said
-that, instead of making up a scouting band of white scouts, he would
-pick colored soldiers to be his allies.
-
-In other words, he would have a company of black scouts from the
-Tenth Cavalry.
-
-Major Armes at once notified the garrison that Buffalo Bill was
-coming to Fort Aspen, and what his intention was regarding the band
-of black scouts.
-
-There was excitement at once in the garrison, and the colored
-troopers were delighted that the great borderman was going to show
-his confidence in them by taking his scouts from their regiment.
-
-“Now we’ll blow de Injuns off de farm.”
-
-“You better believe I speaks fer bein’ a nigger scout.”
-
-“Annudder nigger heah does say de same.”
-
-“Wonder if Massa Bill gwine ter brack hissef up so as ter look like
-us?”
-
-“Won’t dem red niggers git up an’ lead us brack scouts arter ’em?”
-
-“An’ I guesses dem palefaces as wants ter go inter de Promised Lan’
-will tarn back an’ settle somewhar else.”
-
-Such remarks and others of a like kind ran the rounds of the colored
-troopers, when they heard the good news that Buffalo Bill was
-coming, and better still that he intended to pick men from their
-regiment for his scouts.
-
-Major Armes was much pleased, and knowing about the time the scout
-was expected, he ordered a negro sergeant and twenty men to take the
-trail as a guard of honor and meet him a day’s ride from the fort.
-
-The sergeant and his picked men were as proud as peacocks at the
-duty and the envy of all the rest of the regiment, who had to remain
-behind.
-
-Had the colored troopers had their say, all would have gone to meet
-the scout and Fort Aspen would have been left without a garrison.
-
-And so the black escort set out upon the trail to meet the noted
-scout.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XII.
-
- CORRALLED BY INDIANS.
-
-
-The sergeant in command of the escort was Mobile Buck, and he was so
-enrolled. He was a fine soldier and a brave one, and had won his rank
-for his good qualities.
-
-Sergeant Mobile Buck was vary cautious, however, and he wisely
-decided that it would be better to have an advance guard of one man
-to take chances of an ambush, than to have his whole force in danger,
-so he kept a trooper well ahead.
-
-What that solitary trooper thought of his being selected for that
-post of honor will never be known, as his sacrifice saved the
-sergeant and his other men.
-
-It was when some thirty miles from the fort, and when nearing the
-time for going into camp, wild yells were heard half a mile ahead,
-and soon back came the colored trooper’s horse, riderless.
-
-This and the yells told the story, and the sergeant was quick to
-take advantage of a retreat to a little hill, rocky and wooded, he
-had found only a mile back. He ordered his corporal to retreat there
-and go into camp, against the advice of several of his men that the
-safest place to fall back on would be the fort, and in a hurry, too.
-
-But Sergeant Mobile Buck called to two of his men to remain with
-him, and he set out to discover the trouble ahead, how many Indians
-there were, and what he had better do under the circumstances.
-
-He soon discovered more than he cared to, for fully half a hundred
-Indians were in sight, with no telling how many more were hidden near
-by.
-
-Back he rode to the retreating place, fully convinced that the advice
-offered by a few, to fall back on the fort, was wise.
-
-But he discovered as he came in sight of the hill, that the corporal
-and his men were in trouble, for there were a number of Indians there
-also, advancing to the attack.
-
-“That cuts off retreat,” said Sergeant Buck, and he charged for the
-hill with his two companions.
-
-This charge checked the attack of the redskins and greatly pleased
-Corporal Black, who did not belie his name, as he was as black as
-charcoal.
-
-The corporal was only too anxious to be relieved of his command, and
-have the sergeant assume responsibility.
-
-“We are in for it and no mistake, corporal. How many Injuns have you
-seen?” said the sergeant, as he rode into the retreat.
-
-“Some says dere is hundreds of ’em, but I ain’t seen dat many yit,
-though I has seen more’n I wants ter,” was the reply.
-
-“There were about fifty that ambushed Buck, maybe more, and perhaps
-as many yonder, so we are cut off, I fear.”
-
-“Did dey kill po’ Brick?” asked the corporal.
-
-“I guess they did, for they are Injuns.”
-
-“An’ scallip him, too?”
-
-“I don’t know, for that wasn’t easy, as his hair was cut close.”
-
-“So hit was, but mine ain’t,” and the corporal felt of his hair,
-which he feared was long enough to get a grip on.
-
-The sergeant smiled, then took in the chances of defending the hill,
-being glad to see that the corporal had put the horses in as secure a
-place as could be found and posted his men in fighting positions.
-
-The corporal might be scared, but his military training stood him in
-need.
-
-“Grass, but no water here; yet we can hold ’em off for a while, for
-some man has got to slip out to-night and go back to the fort for
-help,” said the sergeant.
-
-All had been listening eagerly to his words; but each one looked away
-at this suggestion, fearing he would be the man picked out to go.
-
-“Maybe Massa Bill Cody come along and sabe us,” said the corporal.
-
-There was a cheer at this, and it showed just what the colored
-troopers thought of Buffalo Bill’s powers to help them.
-
-The sergeant seemed pleased, also, and he set to work to strengthen
-his position, place his men where they could do the most good and
-ordered them to throw up the earth about each one of them so as to
-protect them.
-
-They were only too anxious to do this, and worked like beavers.
-
-“There they come--steady, men, and wait until I order you to fire!”
-the sergeant said calmly.
-
-The Indians had now united their forces, and it was evident that they
-belonged to the same band, had been watching the troopers for some
-time, and had arranged to ambush them all: only the advance guard of
-poor Brick, sent ahead by the sergeant, had spoiled their plan, as
-they had fired on him with their arrows, believing that the others
-were close upon his heels.
-
-Having united their two bands, a hundred in number, all came with a
-rush upon the intrenched troopers, yelling like madmen, their ponies
-at full speed, and sending showers of arrows before them with an
-occasional shot from a rifle, where a brave was so unfortunate as to
-have firearms, then not common among the redskins.
-
-“We’ve got ter do ’em, men, or they’ll down us,” shouted the
-sergeant, and a moment after he cried:
-
-“Aim to kill--fire!”
-
-Some of the troopers may have fired at random; but more did not,
-and down went ponies and riders, while the repeating rifles of the
-soldiers keeping up their rattle, and deadly rattle it was, checked
-the onward rush of the redskins, for they wavered, turned, and fled
-for the shelter of the nearest timber.
-
-The colored troopers were jubilant with delight.
-
-Without a white officer they had beaten off the redskins, who were
-five to one against them, and killed or wounded a number of braves
-and ponies.
-
-Sergeant Mobile Buck was a hero of heroes, and he felt it, too.
-Whatever his men might feel about it, he, at least, was glad he had
-come. It gave the sergeant confidence, and it helped the men.
-
-One trooper had been killed, shot through the throat with an arrow,
-and three others slightly wounded.
-
-But the dead man was removed out of sight, and the wounds of the
-three men dressed, weapons reloaded, the position strengthened, and
-supper cooked and sent around, for night was at hand.
-
-“I doesn’t like dem dead red Injuns lyin’ out dere,” said a trooper,
-with an awe of the dead and darkness.
-
-“Never mind, we’ll have more of ’em soon,” said the sergeant.
-
-Then darkness came and the men waited, each man a sentinel, for there
-was no sleep for those black defenders of the hill that night.
-
-All was silent and darkness, suddenly broken by the words:
-
-“Who commands here?”
-
-The voice was clear and stern, and came from a point close at hand.
-Then a tall form arose from behind a group of rocks.
-
-“Massa Buf’ler Bill!”
-
-The cry came almost in a shout, and every man left his position and
-rushed to where the scout stood, for he it was, in truth, who had
-invaded the retreat of the corralled negro soldiers.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XIII.
-
- THE RIDE FOR HELP.
-
-
-The darkness hid the tears of joy in the eyes of the colored
-troopers, at the coming of Buffalo Bill.
-
-The scout had crept into the corral unseen, and he said sternly:
-
-“If I could get in here, redskins can--who is commander here?”
-
-“I am, sir, Sergeant Mobile Buck, and we were going to meet you,
-Chief Cody.”
-
-“I am glad to meet you, Sergeant Buck; but you have only colored
-troops?”
-
-“Yes, sir, from the Tenth Cavalry, and Major Armes told us we could
-come and meet you on the trail, and mighty glad we are to see you,
-sir.”
-
-“I saw your man ahead killed, but could not save him, for he rode
-right into an ambush I was watching, and his doing so saved me. Then
-I watched developments and saw you retreat here, so waited until dark
-to creep in, for there are more Indians coming and you are in a bad
-way.”
-
-“Oh, Lordy!”
-
-Buffalo Bill laughed.
-
-“You are not dead yet, boys,” he said, “and you made a good fight
-when they attacked you; but you will not be attacked again until
-morning, about dawn, and then by a force large enough to run you
-down.”
-
-“Jist you take us to de fort, Massa Bill, fer you kin do it, sah,”
-said one, and all held the same opinion.
-
-“No, you could never leave here, and I’ll have to sneak out; but my
-horse and pack animal are a mile away, on the trail to the fort, and
-I’ll go there for help, and it will take three or four troops to do
-it, too.
-
-“The fort is about twenty-five miles from here, and I’ll make it in
-three hours, for I’ll hide my pack animal soon as I can, and I will
-be back with help in four hours more.
-
-“That will get us here just in time, and you keep watch for all you
-are worth, strengthen your position all you can, have your rifles and
-revolvers ready, and you can fight them off, if they do attack, until
-we get here.”
-
-“Don’t yer think I better go wid yer, Massa Bill?” asked a trooper,
-who preferred to take his chances with Buffalo Bill alone to
-remaining with his score of comrades.
-
-“No, every man is wanted here.”
-
-“Dat’s so, an’ I wishes you was goin’ ter stay, too, sah,” and this
-remark voiced the idea of all.
-
-“Now, sergeant, send your men back to their posts, and let them know
-if they go to sleep some of them may wake up in the Indians’ happy
-hunting grounds.
-
-“Then Sergeant Buck go with me to the end of the timber, for I wish a
-word with you.”
-
-The troopers were sent again to their posts of duty, and the sergeant
-went with Buffalo Bill to a gully, by which he intended to retreat,
-for it was not guarded as horses could not go that way.
-
-“Sergeant, you have done well in your fight, and I appreciate your
-having come to meet me. It saved me. Tell your men I want each one of
-them in my band of scouts, so I have my eye upon them. You may have
-to fight again, but do it to the death as I’ll get help to you as
-soon as I can. Good night, and luck.”
-
-Buffalo Bill grasped the hand of the brave negro, who replied:
-
-“We’ll die game, sir, if we have to; but we depend on you, Massa
-Bill, for you’re the only man who can save us, and you will, sir, I
-know you will.”
-
-The deep voice quivered, and Buffalo Bill turned away, going rapidly
-down the gully to where he had left his horses.
-
-He passed within a dozen feet of an Indian outpost of several braves,
-heard them talking, and the smoke of their pipes reached him, while
-he saw a spark of fire.
-
-But he went on, reached his horses, mounted and rode off at a
-sweeping gallop toward the fort.
-
-At length he halted and muttered:
-
-“It is taking big chances, but I will do it. I can hide my pack horse
-there and it will cut off a dozen miles, if I do risk the lives of
-my horse and myself in making the leap, which is all of twenty feet.”
-
-He turned off the trail, just as the moon, on the wane, rose to light
-his way.
-
-A roar came to his ears, a roar of falling water, and he soon halted
-on the banks of a foaming stream.
-
-“My pack horse will be safe here,” said Cody, and he quickly
-unsaddled the animal.
-
-Then he stripped his own horse of his heavy Mexican saddle, laid with
-it his rifle and belt of arms, save one revolver, took off his boots,
-hunting coat, and broad-brimmed sombrero, and approached the steep
-banks of the river.
-
-It was a cliff, and all of twenty feet down to the water. A quarter
-of a mile below was a fall over which the stream wildly rushed, and
-across from him a hundred yards or more lay the other shore, the
-banks low and sandy.
-
-“It will save a dozen miles, Buckskin, and we can make it--we must!”
-he said, in his decided way, and he quickly made a bridle of his
-stake of rope, leaped across the bare back of his splendid horse,
-wheeled suddenly and rode rapidly toward the cliff.
-
-“Now, Buckskin, make the leap, and by it save the lives of my black
-troopers!” cried Buffalo Bill, as he urged his horse directly out
-upon the mad leap.
-
-Buckskin did not hesitate; he seemed to feel, with his master, that
-only by the leap from the dizzy height could he save the lives of
-human beings by cutting off a dozen miles in the trail and getting
-help from the fort to them before they would be wiped out by the
-Indians.
-
-The noble horse leaped far out from the cliff, hung in the air, it
-seemed, for one precious second, and then went down swiftly into the
-raging flood.
-
-He struck hard, sank from sight, though Buffalo Bill held his
-revolver far above his head to prevent its getting wet, for those
-were not the days of the present improved cartridges.
-
-Then the horse arose, and his rider guided him toward the other shore.
-
-It was a wild current, and they were swept rapidly down toward the
-falls; but the horse swam with vigor, and stripped of his saddle and
-trappings he was not hampered, Buffalo Bill helping him with all his
-power.
-
-At length, the shore was reached, the hoofs touched bottom, and
-Buffalo Bill dismounted to give the horse a rest.
-
-But only for a minute, for, remounting, he set off at a sweeping
-gallop for the fort, from that point not half a dozen miles.
-
-“I have saved all of an hour and a half, if not more. You did it
-splendidly, Buckskin,” said the scout, and coming back into the
-trail, he sent the horse flying along at full speed.
-
-Within half an hour the light of the fort came into view, and it was
-not yet midnight.
-
-“Ho, sentinel, let me in--I am Buffalo Bill, the scout--and sound the
-alarm, for help is needed at once, or Sergeant Mobile Buck and his
-men will all be wiped out!”
-
-This startling salute and alarm at once roused the garrison to
-action, and Buffalo Bill dashed to the headquarters of Major Armes,
-and reported his coming to that officer and asked for three troops of
-the Tenth Cavalry to go to the rescue.
-
-“God bless you, Cody, you shall have them, and within ten minutes,”
-cried Major Armes, and the order was given.
-
-Within half an hour, mounted upon a fresh horse, Buffalo Bill rode
-away from the fort at the head of over a hundred black cavalrymen, to
-the rescue of Sergeant Buck and his band.
-
-“I’ll set the pace, Captain Keyes, and those who cannot keep up can
-follow.
-
-“We must make it within three hours, sir,” said Buffalo Bill, and
-Captain Edward Keyes answered:
-
-“Go ahead, Cody, and we’ll be with you.”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XIV.
-
- THE BLACK TROOPERS AT BAY.
-
-
-As Buffalo Bill knew just how urgent the demand for haste might
-become, he set a pace that, though he knew many of the troopers
-might not be able to keep up, yet many would do so, and these could
-make the attack on the Indians, while the others would constantly be
-coming up as reënforcements.
-
-Major Armes had also promised to send a wagon with rations, a
-six-pounder gun, and a company of infantry, mounted, as a reserve, in
-case the Indians should be in still larger force than Buffalo Bill
-had supposed them to be.
-
-To the black troopers in the little hill retreat it was a sad sight
-to see Buffalo Bill leave them, though they knew that by his going
-alone was there a chance for their rescue.
-
-They knew their danger, and the warning the scout had given them,
-that “if he could get into their retreat an Indian could also do so,”
-had made them keep the closest watch, and not an instant did they
-close their eyes.
-
-“If I wakes up arter a nap, I wants it ter be in this world, not de
-next, so I doesn’t go ter sleep,” said a trooper, and he voiced the
-sentiments of all.
-
-To add to their wakefulness the corporal, in going his rounds, was
-seen to suddenly fall and lie motionless.
-
-The sergeant hastened to his side to find that an arrow had
-penetrated his eye--he was dead.
-
-Sergeant Mobile Buck dragged the body into hiding and wisely said
-nothing. He then went the rounds of the men himself, and very
-cautiously, for he knew that Indians were within arrow range and
-watching.
-
-Then the sergeant discovered how it was that the corporal had lost
-his life, for the moon was rising, and he had stood with its light
-behind him, his form in bold relief against its silvery face.
-
-“Be careful of showing yourselves with the moon behind you, for there
-are Indians watching for a chance to send an arrow at you,” said
-the sergeant, and he was cautious how he moved, for not only did he
-desire to escape what he had warned others of, but he thought also of
-the men, should he be killed or seriously wounded, and how readily
-they would get into a panic with no one to govern them.
-
-So the hours passed, the sergeant going on his rounds every half
-hour, and one time discovering a dark object out upon the open plain,
-and which he was sure was not there when last he passed that way.
-
-“Give me your gun, Benton,” he said to the sentinel nearest the dark
-object.
-
-The trooper obeyed, and the sergeant took a rest with the carbine
-over a rock, aimed well and pulled trigger.
-
-A wild yell, a form springing into the air, measuring a few feet, and
-a heavy fall followed.
-
-“You must keep better watch, Benton, for that redskin would have
-plugged you in half an hour more,” said the sergeant.
-
-Benton was thoroughly alarmed now, and said:
-
-“Yas, sah, you done sabe my life, an’ I ain’t gwine ter fergit it,
-nuther. You bet I’s keepin’ watch now, sergeant, I is.”
-
-The shot had startled the troopers, as it was answered by yells from
-the Indians across in the timber.
-
-But the sergeant continued his round, and to each man he told of
-Benton’s narrow escape, until several shots were fired at rocks
-fearing they might be large groups of Indians.
-
-That a random shot thus fired sounded a death-knell a choking war cry
-told.
-
-The sergeant had got the rifles of the corporal and of the other
-slain trooper, and kept them ready for use when the time came.
-
-But he continued his rounds through the night.
-
-Then he ordered all to be ready, for he felt sure an attack would be
-made.
-
-That Buffalo Bill had not got back was a cause of deepest anxiety,
-but the sergeant was brave and told his men that the scout with help
-was doubtless close at hand, only waiting for the Indians to attack
-the retreat, and this gave them hope.
-
-Soon a dark mass was visible, moving out from the distant timber. The
-Indians were advancing to the attack, and they were mounted.
-
-“Men, we’ll empty these extra guns at them first, for they’ll reach
-them, and then you fire only when I give the order,” cried the
-sergeant.
-
-The three guns rattled forth their seven shots each, and they must
-have hit hard, for the redskins wavered, yelled like demons, and came
-on with a rush.
-
-“Fire!”
-
-All the rifles opened fire, and the shots told, for ponies fell and
-riders dropped to the ground.
-
-But the rush was on, the Indians were in heavy force, hundreds
-against a score of black troopers, and the showers of arrows, the
-maddened yells and the roar of the charging ponies, struck terror to
-the hearts of the troopers.
-
-“Hold ’em, men, or all is lost,” shouted the sergeant, adding:
-
-“Revolvers now!”
-
-But as the rattle of revolvers began and the redskins were almost
-up to the retreat, above the wild yells of the redskins arose the
-piercing, thrilling notes of a bugle, followed by the ringing war cry
-of Buffalo Bill, and a stern command from Captain Keyes:
-
-“Ride them down, men!”
-
-The bugle notes broke upon the ears of the redskins just in time to
-deprive them of their prey, for, wheeling to one side of the retreat,
-they drove on at full speed, for they knew that United States cavalry
-was upon them and in large force.
-
-“After them, men!” shouted Buffalo Bill, and with Captain Keyes by
-his side, and nearly a hundred troopers following, they rode hot on
-the heels of the flying redskins.
-
-It was a complete surprise, of the kind that causes a stampede, and
-the Indians only sought to escape their pursuers until they reached a
-place where they could rally and ambush their foes.
-
-But Captain Keyes was too good a soldier to be caught in a trap, with
-tired-out horses and men, and he called a halt when his command drew
-near a heavily timbered hill.
-
-“Halt here, men, and let them think this is all the force, while
-Cody, you go back, meet the other men and flank yonder ridge with
-them, ordering a courier to go to the reserve and fetch them, with
-the gun, to your aid with all speed.”
-
-It was almost daylight now, and the tired men rested where they
-were in line of battle, while Buffalo Bill rode back, checking the
-troopers still coming up and ordering them to keep out of sight
-in the timber, while he went to the retreat of those who had been
-rescued in the nick of time.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XV.
-
- A VERY STRANGE FIND.
-
-
-“The goo’ Lor’ bress you, Massa Bill!” came a cry in chorus from a
-dozen men, as the scout approached the retreat.
-
-Sergeant Mobile Buck came out to meet Buffalo Bill, and wrung his
-hand hard, while he said:
-
-“You did it, sir--you saved us, and just in time, for my men were
-giving way.
-
-“I lost five killed, sir, and half a dozen wounded, though only two
-seriously.
-
-“It will do the men good, sir, this fight, and they’ll follow you,
-Mr. Cody, to the devil!”
-
-“And I want you and every man of them for my squadron of scouts,
-sergeant, as I will need yourself, a corporal, and twenty-four men.
-
-“Now look to your wounded and then bury your dead, for I’ll have
-breakfast sent to you from the main camp over in the timber yonder,
-where they are now cooking for Captain Keyes and his men, who will
-remain where they are until I can flank yonder hill, for we have as
-many more men in reserve and a gun.”
-
-“That’s good, sir, and Mr. Injun will get it bad, won’t he?” said the
-delighted sergeant, while Buffalo Bill rode through the retreat and
-called out:
-
-“You had it hot and deadly here, I see, boys, but you fought like
-wild cats, all of you, and I am proud of my black scouts, for I want
-you all.”
-
-A cheer answered the words of the scout, and he rode rapidly back
-into the timber, where the stragglers had come up with the pack
-animals, a camp had been formed, and breakfast was being prepared.
-
-Sending a white scout on his trail of the night before to bring his
-pack horse, saddle and bridle from where he had left them on the
-river bank, Buffalo Bill hastily had breakfast with a half a hundred
-troopers, and led them by a flank movement to get in the rear of the
-Indians on the ridge. He had long before sent a courier to tell the
-reserve force, the troopers with their gun, to branch off at a trail,
-which would head him off at a point where they could reach the rear
-of the redskins.
-
-All went just as he had hoped it would, the reserve met the command
-under Buffalo Bill, and by hard riding, were after the Indians,
-halted on the ridge and watching Captain Keyes in the valley in their
-front, feeling that he was afraid to attack them, were surprised by a
-shell bursting in their midst on the hill.
-
-It fairly dazed them with surprise and dread, and only when shell
-after shell began to crash among them, and Captain Keyes mounted his
-men for a rush on the ridge, did they break in a wild stampede.
-
-These, too, saw that they were between two fires, Captain Keyes
-and the force of Buffalo Bill with the gun, and there was but one
-way to escape, and that was to desert their ponies and take to the
-deep cañons leading into the mountains where a horse could not find
-footing.
-
-It was hard for an Indian to do, to leave his pony, but it was a
-question of life and death, and they fled on foot, thus making it a
-glorious victory for the palefaces.
-
-Sending a courier to have his pack animal and a fresh horse brought
-him, Buffalo Bill went on the trail of the redskins, to see if they
-continued their flight, or halted to try and make an effort to regain
-their horses when night came, and Captain Keyes came up with his men
-to go into camp with the entire force.
-
-It was nearly midnight when Buffalo Bill, on foot, returned to the
-camp.
-
-“They’ve got enough for the present, sir, and are all on the jump for
-their village; but I will go out mounted at dawn and alone, keeping
-on their trail for a day, at least, until sure what they will do,” he
-said to Captain Keyes.
-
-“And shall I camp here, Cody, or return to the fort?” asked the
-captain.
-
-“Better rest here until day after to-morrow, sir, and then return by
-slow march toward the fort, so I can overtake you, if they meet other
-bands and return, for there may be more of them.
-
-“If I see nothing suspicious, sir, please say to Major Armes that I
-will return to the fort within two or three days.”
-
-“All right, Cody, and I hear you are going to have a squadron of
-negro scouts?”
-
-“Yes, sir, for it will give the colored troops confidence, and I
-believe I can make good scouts of them, while the Indians are as
-scared of the black soldiers as the latter are of them--they don’t
-just understand their being black and call them ‘Heap Black Paleface
-Braves.’”
-
-“Not a bad name, either, if they will only prove braves; but the
-Indians are experts in giving names.
-
-“Now get what rest you can, for you need it, and I know of no man who
-could do what you have.”
-
-Ten minutes after Buffalo Bill was fast asleep; but at dawn he woke
-up, and his pack horse and a fresh riding animal having come up, he
-had breakfast, mounted, and rode away on his lone trail.
-
-That day every sign pointed to the fact that the Indians had been
-so badly beaten that though they had met a couple of bands of their
-comrades, they did not turn back, but went on to their villages
-together.
-
-It was toward evening of his second day’s trail, as he came to a good
-camping place, that Buffalo Bill decided to halt for the night, when
-he was startled by hearing a human voice calling to him, and the
-words spoken in a low tone.
-
-Out of a thicket staggered a tall, gaunt form, with black face,
-haggard, and showing deep lines of suffering, while his clothing was
-in rags, his feet wrapped in deerskins, a foxskin cap upon his head,
-a tattered blanket, and a rifle, revolver, and knife his weapons.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XVI.
-
- THE NEGRO MESSENGER.
-
-
-“Well, my poor fellow, who and what are you?” asked Buffalo Bill, as
-he dismounted and stood before the vagabond negro.
-
-“I’s mighty near starved ter death, an’ I’d died soon ef I hadn’t had
-you find me, boss,” was the answer. “I seen you comin’, and I lay low
-and was goin’ ter let you pass me by, sah, only I seen yer face, and
-know’d yer were a good man.
-
-“If you had been an Injun, sah, or one ob dem bad white men I seen in
-dis country, I’d ’a’ jist pulled my gun on yer and got yer horse an’
-rashuns ter eat, fer de Good Book do say dat preservin’ o’ one’s life
-am de bestest law o’ natur’, sah.”
-
-“So you would have chanced killing me?”
-
-“Yas, sah, and it w’u’d hev been a big chance, too, as I has got but
-one load in my gun an’ one in my revolver.”
-
-“Well, I am glad you didn’t take the chances; but I would have found
-you, anyhow, as I intended to camp right here for the night.”
-
-“Den I is sabed, sah, I is sabed, fer I gits somet’in to eat, an’
-sabin’ me, sah, means a heap, fer dere is lives dependin’ dis werry
-minit upon dis nigger.”
-
-“Where---- But you must be fed first, and then you can tell me. Sit
-there, and I’ll soon have a fire, and cook supper.”
-
-“Boss, I is mos’ so weak I has got ter let you do de work, an’ you
-see, sah, I is wounded, too.”
-
-“Poor fellow!” Buffalo Rill glanced at a bullet wound in the negro’s
-side.
-
-Hastily the scout set to work, pitched his camp in a secluded spot on
-the bank of a little stream, and, taking from his pack saddle a pair
-of extra blankets, he spread them on the ground and told the negro to
-lie down.
-
-He quickly gathered some wood, built a fire among some rocks, and,
-after staking out the horses, started to prepare a venison steak,
-bacon, hoecake, and coffee for supper.
-
-The negro would have eaten ravenously, so nearly starved was he, only
-the scout made him go slow, and did not give him half what he craved.
-
-“I’ll give you some more after a while; but now I’ll build a shelter
-for you, as I think you’ll have to rest here for a few days, at
-least.”
-
-The shelter was built and made comfortable, and then the scout cut
-off from the swollen, blistered, and bruised feet the deerskin
-covering that served as shoes, took a liniment from his pack, and,
-after having the man stand in the water for some time, put it upon
-them, after which he dressed the wound in his side, which, though
-painful, was not serious.
-
-“Who gave you this?”
-
-“A bad white man, sah, who pretended ter be my friend, but arter he
-heerd my story, he shot me, an’ he meant ter kill me, only I got one
-in on him, sah.
-
-“Then I heerd a man call out, an’ voices talking, so I lit out,
-thinkin’ they must be his frien’s, an’ I come rapid, sah, thinkin’ I
-c’u’d reach the fort afore I died.”
-
-Buffalo Bill was now convinced that the negro had a secret of
-importance to tell, so he gave him another steak, some hoecake, and a
-cup of coffee, and watched him eat it with the look of a half-starved
-animal.
-
-“I am mighty glad I met you, my man. What is your name?”
-
-“Black Bill, dey calls me, sah.”
-
-“All right, that is one bond between us, for my name is Bill. Did you
-ever hear of Buffalo Bill?”
-
-“Is I hear ob him, sah? Indeed I has, an’ dere ain’t nobody livin’
-dat ain’t.”
-
-“Well, I am Buffalo Bill.”
-
-The look on the negro’s face at this information fairly startled the
-scout.
-
-“You is de very man I’s lookin’ fer,” exclaimed the negro finally,
-after he had recovered from his surprise. “Yas, sah, I knows you is
-Massa Buf’ler Bill, I does, as he tole me jist how ye looked.”
-
-“Who did?”
-
-“De gemman who sent me ter find yer, sah.”
-
-“Who was it?”
-
-“Massa John Hill, sah.”
-
-“Ah! My old friend, John Hill?”
-
-“Dat’s him, sah.”
-
-“I thought he went East.”
-
-“He did went dere, sah, but he come back.”
-
-“Where is he?”
-
-“Whar de debble c’u’dn’t fin’ him, sah, fer he do be los’.”
-
-“Lost! Where?”
-
-“In de Big Horn country, sah, whar I left him an’ t’others. Dere’s a
-heap ob ’em, Massa Buf’ler Bill, men, wimmens, an’ chil’en.”
-
-“When did they go there?”
-
-“Months ago, sah. Yer see, sah, I ust ter b’long ter Doctor Miner, a
-gent from de Souf, who hed los’ his fortin by de war; but I didn’t
-leab him, sah, an’ we was comin’ West ter hunt gold, when we come
-across a outfit of folks as was also gold huntin’, fer Massa John
-Hill hed met ’em an’ tole ’em he know’d whar ter git it.
-
-“So, sah, we all comed along an’ he guided us inter de Big Horn
-country, an’ we go down inter a valley an’ make home dere.
-
-“But dere was bad men in dat outfit, and four ob ’em one night tuk
-blastin’ powder we fotch along an’ blow up rocks ter stop de only
-path down a cañon we hed leadin’ inter or out ob dat valley.
-
-“It were beautiful when we got dere, but dere were no way ob gittin’
-out, sah, fer it were all around wid mount’in cliffs, an’ mount’in
-sheep c’u’dn’t git out.
-
-“Yer see, all de gold we hed dug was done by day an’ left up in de
-cañon, de men goin’ home to de valley at night.
-
-“Dat’s why dem four bad men got dat powder an’ blow up dat cañon, an’
-we c’u’dn’t git out.”
-
-“Yet, you did.”
-
-“I has been a sailorman, sah, an’ I don’t git dizzy, an’ I said as
-how I’d climb dem cliffs, an’ I did, by buildin’ ladders wid poles I
-cut, choppin’ down a tree here an’ dere, an’ arter weeks of work I
-got out, an’ den I fetch up my weepin an’ some grub, an’ Massa John
-Hill he told me ter go ter Fort Fettermore an’ fine you, an’ tell you
-he sent fer yer ter come an’ save dere lives; but ter tell no one
-else but you, an’ when you come wid your scouts, you was ter bring
-ropes in plenty, so as ter git ’em out of dat lonesome valley.”
-
-“And those four men?”
-
-“Dey overdid it, sah, fer dey didn’t git a horse, mule, or waggin out
-ob de valley fust, an’ dey hed ter hoof it wid dere gold, or de gold
-we all hed got, an’ carry it, an’ I guesses it were mighty slow work.
-
-“I guesses, sah, dey set off de blow-up business afore dey was ready,
-fer all de pervisions were in de valley, sabe what was kept in de
-cabin on de cliffs fer de men’s dinner.”
-
-“How long have you been on the trail, Bill?”
-
-“’Bout a month, sah, fer I hed to reckon as how ter go, an’ got los’,
-so my grub gin out, my ammunition, too, an’ I has hed a terribul
-time, sah, so I had.”
-
-“You look it; but you met white men on the way?”
-
-“One, sah an’ heerd others. Dey was gold hunters, sah.”
-
-“Not the four men who left the valley?”
-
-“No, sah, dat one I seen wasn’t.”
-
-“This is a strange story you tell me, Black Bill, but I believe you.”
-
-“Praise de Lor’, sah, fer now you kin sabe ’em all.”
-
-“I will try,” said Buffalo Bill firmly.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XVII.
-
- TWO SHOTS.
-
-
-Black Bill would have talked all night had the scout allowed him to
-do so; but Cody checked him again, dressed his wound and feet, and
-gave him a little more to eat, after which he made him go to sleep.
-
-The scout looked to the comfort of his horses, and then, wrapping his
-blankets about him, lay down to rest.
-
-At dawn, Buffalo Bill arose, built a fire, cooked a substantial
-breakfast, having caught several fine fish from the stream, and then
-he awoke the negro, who was still sleeping soundly.
-
-Black Bill was then allowed to eat all he wished, and the scout gave
-him a change of his clothing to put on, and looked after his injuries.
-
-“Now, Black Bill, you are not fit even to ride, but you soon will
-be. This is a good camp for you, and you will be comfortable. I will
-leave you my pack horse, make you comfortable, give you plenty of
-food and ammunition for your weapons, and I’ll kill a deer before I
-go. Then you can fish and take it easy.”
-
-“Whar is you goin’, Massa Buf’ler Bill?”
-
-“To Fort Aspen, with all speed, for I shall get there a number of
-negro scouts I want with me, the ropes John Hill says we will need,
-pack horses well laden with provisions, and I’ll be back here in four
-days.”
-
-“Yas, sah.”
-
-“Now, I do not think you will see any Indians here, for they have
-skipped for their villages, and this camp is on no trail. If you
-should, you must mount my pack horse and get away, for I will leave
-my compass, and you must keep directly west.”
-
-“Yas, sah.”
-
-“It might be that the white men may be trailing you; but, if so, you
-must make your escape, and be on the watch for any danger.”
-
-“Yas, sah, I kin do pretty well ter take keer o’ myself.”
-
-“I don’t doubt it. In four days you will be well enough to ride, and
-we’ll start for that valley you have told me of, and get those people
-out of their trouble.”
-
-Half an hour after, Buffalo Bill, having made his black comrade
-thoroughly comfortable, mounted his horse and departed on his trail
-to the fort.
-
-Black Bill looked after him wistfully as long as he was in sight,
-but, looking back, the scout saw him wave a farewell, and muttered:
-
-“I am sorry to leave him, yet I must do so, as I can do nothing else,
-for he could not stand the ride to the fort and back, and lives
-depend on quick work, if I am not mistaken.”
-
-And the scout put his horse at a swift and steady pace.
-
-But he had not ridden many miles when suddenly he saw an Indian bound
-from the ground and spring to the shelter of a tree, his bow and
-arrows in hand.
-
-It was a long shot, and the scout had to fire quickly, and did so. It
-seemed as though there was a double report; but the redskin fell, and
-no others were visible.
-
-Cody knew that he had killed the Indian, and rode toward him,
-dismounted, and bent over the body, when suddenly a human form
-confronted him and a voice said:
-
-“Pard, I guesses I’ll take the scalp o’ this Injun, an’ as I holds
-ther drop on you, ye’d better be kinder discreetlike.”
-
-Buffalo Bill was certainly caught off his guard by the appearance of
-the stranger upon the scene where he least expected to see a human
-being, unless a stray Indian.
-
-Yet it was a white man, and certainly an odd-looking one. He was
-dressed in rudely tanned buckskin from head to foot, for he wore a
-cap of that material, ornamented with the tail of a fox for a tassel.
-He was a man of large size, muscular build, and looked hard as a pine
-knot, while his hair was long, unkempt, and iron-gray, and his beard
-short and grizzly, half hiding a face by no means prepossessing in
-the features that were visible.
-
-The stranger was armed with an old rifle, a muzzle-loader, a revolver
-of rather ancient manufacture, a couple of single-barrel pistols,
-and a large bowie knife, while at his back hung a long bow and two
-quivers of arrows.
-
-The eyes that gazed upon Buffalo Bill with a triumphant leer were
-vicious, small, and glittering with hate, that seemed their natural
-expression.
-
-He held his revolver upon Buffalo Bill to cover his heart, and seemed
-to feel that he was wholly master of the situation.
-
-“Well, who in thunder are you, you old sinner?” demanded Buffalo
-Bill, seemingly not in the slightest degree taken aback by the sudden
-appearance of one that seemed to be a foe.
-
-“I are ther Bad Man o’ ther Big Horn,” was the cool reply.
-
-“The what?” and Bill smiled.
-
-“Ther Bad Man o’ ther Big Horn.”
-
-“You don’t mean it?”
-
-“I do.”
-
-“Well, you do look as if you could get away with a big horn.”
-
-“Look a-hyur, stranger pard, is yer pokin’ fun at me?” angrily asked
-the man.
-
-“No, you are pokin’ that old gun at me,” was the cool response.
-
-“Who is you, anyhow?” asked the man, struck with the superb bearing
-and handsome, fearless face of the scout.
-
-“Sitting Bull,” answered Bill, most innocently.
-
-“Do yer take me fer a fool?”
-
-“Like as not you are one of the renegades said to belong to his
-tribe,” was the bold remark of the scout.
-
-“No, but I are friendly with ther Injuns.”
-
-“That means you dare not live among your own race, for you look as
-though you might have been a white man once.”
-
-The basilisk eyes of the stranger fairly blazed at this, and his brow
-grew dark with rage, while he answered quickly:
-
-“Ef I are, yer’ll never live ter tell thet yer seen me.”
-
-“I’ll stake that I do. Come, put up your money, or make no threats.”
-
-“Waal, you is a bold one, and I’d like ter know yer handle.”
-
-“The boys in camp call me Buffalo Bill.”
-
-Instantly the man’s face changed again, growing livid with passion,
-while he hissed forth:
-
-“You is Bill Cody, is you?”
-
-“When I am at home, that is my name,” was the reply, and Bill
-continued: “Now tell me your name, for the more I see of your face
-the more I feel we have met before.”
-
-“We have.”
-
-“What deviltry were you in when I saw you last, old man?”
-
-“I’ll tell yer jist what I were doing then: It were a long time ago,
-and you was a mere boy then, and you was guide fer a train I went ter
-rob one night, and----”
-
-“You are Ginger Sam, by Jove!” cried Buffalo Bill, recalling the
-man’s face, after nearly twenty years.
-
-“Yep.”
-
-“I remember you now, you miserable old sinner, and how you and your
-gang hired as teamsters to the train and intended to massacre all
-hands one night and get the booty.”
-
-“Thet’s so; but you overheard two o’ ther boys talkin’, and ther’
-were hangin’ done by ther train people, and I’d hev gone ther same
-way if I hadn’ lit out. Yer thwarted me then, Bill Cody, and I’ve
-heerd o’ yer doin’ big things o’ late on these hyur borders, an’ I
-intend ter cut yer days short.”
-
-“And I have heard how you played your old tricks of deviltry until
-you could not live in a border settlement, and here is where you came
-to hide your ugly head, was it?”
-
-“Yas, and it’s better than hangin’.”
-
-“You are a bad citizen, Ginger Sam,” said Bill Cody, with a light
-laugh, although the man still kept him covered with his revolver.
-
-“I’m a citizen thet shall take in Buf’ler Bill, fer ye’ve no business
-in these hyur parts, and, hevin’ comed hyur, I’ll see that yer
-remain, fer I’m ther Bad Man o’ ther Big Horn, I told yer.”
-
-“Do you see that dead Indian lying there?” asked Bill.
-
-“I do.”
-
-“Well, you had better spend your time burying him than in killing me,
-for it will be more profitable business.”
-
-The outlaw was astounded at the cool nerve displayed by Buffalo Bill
-in his danger, and could not understand his light, bantering tone. He
-meant to kill Cody, there was no doubt; but as a cat will play with a
-mouse to torture it, he wished to make Buffalo Bill suffer terror and
-despair, so he delayed firing the fatal shot, feeling that he had the
-scout wholly at his mercy.
-
-“I kilt that Injun.”
-
-“Why, I shot him myself!” said Buffalo Bill. “What a liar you are!”
-
-“I tell yer I was jist leavin’ ther timber when I seen thet Injun,
-hevin’ got sight o’ me, I s’pose. So I cracks away, an’ I seen
-him flop over an’ then lie still; but I lays close, fer I thought
-t’others mou’t be near, an’ then I seen you come out o’ thet timber
-from this p’int.
-
-“I flanked yer, and I’ve been lookin’ at yer, an’ now yer says you
-kilt ther red.”
-
-“And I tell you the truth, and I can prove it.”
-
-“How kin you?”
-
-“Where did you aim to hit him?”
-
-“In the heart.”
-
-“Well, look and see if there are two bullet wounds in his body, for I
-heard your shot, I remember now, and have no doubt but that you fired
-at him; but he was dying when you did so. Look for the two wounds.”
-
-The man stooped to do so, and, with the bound of a panther, Buffalo
-Bill was upon him.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XVIII.
-
- THE BAD MAN OF THE BIG HORN.
-
-
-Thrown off his guard by the manner of the scout and by his interest
-in searching for the second wound in the body of the Indian, Ginger
-Sam went right into the trap which was set for him, and did just what
-Buffalo Bill had been endeavoring he should do.
-
-Quick as lightning in his movements, Buffalo Bill had sprung forward
-and seized the hand that held the revolver, before the outlaw could
-come to an upright position, and at the same time he presented one of
-his own weapons full in the face of his foe, while he said, in the
-coolest manner possible:
-
-“If you wish to keep in good health, Ginger Sam, you’ll do as I tell
-you!”
-
-The outlaw was livid with rage, and seemed to feel that his last day
-on earth had come.
-
-“Do yer intend ter kill me?”
-
-“I do not know what I shall do with you in the end, but at present I
-intend to disarm you. Drop old Daniel Boone’s rifle you hold in your
-hand there.”
-
-“It mout break it.”
-
-“I guess not, for it’s too old a settler to be hurt by a little
-tumble. Drop it, I say!”
-
-“It mout go off an’ shoot yer from ther concussion.”
-
-“My revolver will go off and shoot you from the muzzle, if you don’t
-obey!”
-
-“Down she goes.”
-
-The outlaw dropped it in such a way, at the same time giving it a
-kick, that showed he would like to have it explode in the fall and
-kill his captor.
-
-But it did not, and, kicking it one side, Bill commanded:
-
-“Now, unbuckle your belt and let it fall!”
-
-“Now, thet would be dangerous.”
-
-“Do as I tell you, and be careful not to let your hand touch those
-blunderbusses you carry, or you won’t know what killed you.”
-
-The man uttered an oath, but obeyed, and the belt of arms fell to the
-ground.
-
-“Now step this way.”
-
-Bill drew him a few steps away from his rifle and belt, and then,
-with a sudden violent wrench of the wrist, tore the revolver from the
-outlaw’s hand, and pitched it over with the other weapons.
-
-“Now, Bad Man of the Big Horn, I was born tired, and don’t like work,
-so take your knife and set to work to build a house under this tree,”
-said Buffalo Bill.
-
-“A house?” asked the surprised man.
-
-“Yes.”
-
-“What kind of a house?”
-
-“One that will fit a dead man.”
-
-“Yer mean a grave?” asked the outlaw, in a tone of horror.
-
-“I do.”
-
-“Yer don’t mean ter kill me, and fust make me dig my own grave?”
-
-“No, you are not worth burying; but I wish to bury that Injun, there,
-and being lazy, as I told you, I want you to dig his grave.”
-
-The outlaw seemed to feel relieved in knowing that he was not the one
-to occupy the grave, and he at once set to work, and with his knife
-began to throw out the earth quite rapidly.
-
-Buffalo Bill sat near, coolly watching him, and keeping him covered
-with his revolver, and noticing the rapid work of the outlaw, he said:
-
-“I guess you were sexton for some graveyard, Ginger Sam, before you
-took to thieving?”
-
-“Thet are jist what I were, Bill Cody,” replied the man, stopping in
-his work.
-
-“And you took to robbing by night the people you buried by day, and
-got caught at it, I guess, so had to dig for the West?”
-
-“Waal, you hits things pretty squar’, Bill Cody, fer they did plant a
-leddy in my yard one day, thet were durned fool enough ter leave it
-in her will thet she were ter be buried in her di’mints an’ t’other
-jew’lry.
-
-“I know’d ther kin folks w’u’d dig her up some night, ef I didn’t, so
-I did, an’ them as was comin’ ter do it seen me, an’ I jist hed ter
-light out from them parts.”
-
-“Well, you look the ghoul you are: but go on with your work, for
-life’s too short to listen to your sins, old man!”
-
-The ex-sexton resumed his work, with a sigh, and soon had an opening
-which brought from the scout the remark:
-
-“No Injun could wish for more than that, Ginger Sam, and you are the
-boss gravedigger of the Big Horn, whatever your other sins may be.
-Now wrap that Injun in his blanket and lay him in it.”
-
-“Won’t yer scalp him?”
-
-“No. Come, delay no further, but bury that man, for I wish to be on
-my way,” said Buffalo Bill.
-
-“Whar goin’?”
-
-“You’ll know all in good time.”
-
-The man muttered an oath, but obeyed orders, and when the redskin had
-been buried, Buffalo Bill bound Ginger Sam securely with one end of
-his lariat, and forced the man to go on his way in the lead.
-
-After gaining a point where the trail led across a river, Buffalo
-Bill said:
-
-“Cross over, Ginger!”
-
-“What do yer want ter cross fer?” was the surly response.
-
-“I have my reasons, so wade in.”
-
-“No; I don’t keen ter git wet.”
-
-“Very well, take the back trail for the grave you dug; it will hold
-two,” said Bill indifferently.
-
-The outlaw shuddered, and replied quickly:
-
-“I’ll cross the river.”
-
-“Right are you, Sammy, my boy.”
-
-Into the water they went, and, once on the other shore, where a
-number of trails divided, Buffalo Bill selected the one that would
-lead him to the fort.
-
-“Thet trail only goes up into ther hills,” said the outlaw nervously.
-
-“It is into the hills I wish to go.”
-
-“Ther’ ain’t nothin’ up thar yer want.”
-
-“There’s where you are off your base, Ginger, for there is.”
-
-“What do yer want?”
-
-“I desire that you shall take the quickest trail to the fort.”
-
-“I’ll die fust,” was the savage reply.
-
-“You had better do as I ask, for I am not one to palaver.”
-
-“I’ll not go a step.”
-
-“Then I’ll lead you there,” was the quiet reply.
-
-The outlaw saw that Buffalo Bill was in earnest, and his thoughts
-flashed like lightning through his brain.
-
-His gaze falling upon the lariat end, held loosely in the hand of
-Buffalo Bill, his eyes suddenly gleamed with inborn resolve, and he
-said resignedly:
-
-“Waal, pard, as I don’t know thet I kin kick agin’ yer, I’ll do as
-you say.”
-
-“Right, Sammy! Now, move on!”
-
-The outlaw obeyed, taking the trail once more with nimble step.
-
-As it wound along the edge of a ravine, through the bed of which
-dashed a stream, the outlaw suddenly sprang over the precipice into
-the depths below.
-
-Buffalo Bill caught hard at the end of the lariat, as it tightened,
-but could not hold on, and the end slipped through his hand, and a
-plunge following told him that his captive had fallen into the waters
-below.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XIX.
-
- A DOUBLE ESCAPE.
-
-
-Hardly had the splash of the descending form reached Cody’s ears,
-when he was on foot and peering over the precipice. He saw that the
-water was swift-running and deep, and that the stream wound out of
-sight a few rods below by turning a rocky point. Instantly he decided
-upon his course, and cast aside his arms and outer clothing. At once
-he took the leap.
-
-It was thirty feet down to the water, but he struck feet foremost,
-and without injury.
-
-In the meantime, a perfect swimmer, Ginger Sam knew just what was
-before him, although his arms were bound behind his back.
-
-Keeping under water until he had rounded the point, which the current
-and his own efforts soon enabled him to do, he then rose to the
-surface and began to make for the shore.
-
-It was hard work, with only his feet to aid his efforts, and,
-retarded as he was by his clothing and the lariat, but he made it
-at last, and under the shelter of the overhanging hill had just sat
-down to rest, smiling grimly at his escape, when round the point shot
-Buffalo Bill, swimming with tremendous strokes.
-
-The hunted man uttered a cry of alarm, and, springing to his feet,
-darted away at great speed.
-
-But the scout had always been noted for his fleetness on foot, and he
-bounded along at a pace that overhauled the outlaw, who was hampered,
-too, by his bound arms and the dragging lariat.
-
-Seeing that Buffalo Bill was gaining upon him, he finally came to a
-halt, and sang out lustily:
-
-“Don’t shoot me!”
-
-“I have nothing to shoot you with, but I’ve a notion to drown you,”
-answered Bill Cody, as he laid no light hand upon the other’s
-shoulder.
-
-“Don’t do it, Bill, for ’twan’t no fault o’ mine. Yer see, my foot
-slipped when I turned round ter speak ter you, an’ when I found
-myself free, I concluded I’d try an’ stay so.”
-
-“As a scientific liar, Sam, you are ’way up; but, come, no funny
-business, but go!”
-
-There was nothing for the outlaw to do but to obey, and he did that
-promptly, taking a route that soon brought them to where the faithful
-horse was standing guard most patiently in the spot where his master
-had left him.
-
-“Now, I am due at the fort, for I have important work on hand and do
-not wish to be delayed, so I will tie you to a tree here until my
-return, or I’ll take you to your cabin, for I am sure you have a camp
-near. Which shall it be?”
-
-“I’d be eaten up by b’ar an’ sich ef yer tied me to a tree.”
-
-“So I fear, and that would keep you from being hanged, so where is
-your cabin?”
-
-“I got a den.”
-
-“Then lead to it, and quick.”
-
-The man saw that the scout was in earnest, so said:
-
-“We has got ter climb and leave yer boss here, so untie my han’s, fer
-we goes up thet cliff.”
-
-“I’ll do it, and if you attempt to run, look out for a shot.”
-
-“I’m inter it now, so I won’t kick.”
-
-Buffalo Bill then untied the man’s hands, told him to stand on the
-cliff until he hitched his horse, and, as he turned to do so, quick
-as a flash the man made the leap again.
-
-Buffalo Bill sprang to the cliff, but did not follow him.
-
-“I have not the time to lose, and I won’t shoot him when he comes
-into view,” he muttered.
-
-Soon the man appeared, smiling boldly, and apparently believing
-Buffalo Bill was in pursuit.
-
-But with his arms free, he felt the chances were that he could get
-away, as the scout was not armed.
-
-“I’ll not shoot you this time, though I could do so--we’ll meet
-again,” shouted the scout.
-
-But the outlaw had at once dove deep, when he saw the scout on the
-cliff, rifle in hand.
-
-Then Buffalo Bill mounted his horse, after hiding Ginger Sam’s
-weapons, and rode rapidly away, for already had he lost too much
-time. He pushed his horse hard, as he felt he could do so, with the
-animal to get rest at the fort, and, making but short halts, he kept
-on through the night, to strike at dawn the camp of Captain Keyes,
-who had taken up the trail for the fort, going by easy marches with
-his wounded soldiers and Indians.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XX.
-
- BLACK SCOUTS ON THE TRAIL.
-
-
-After a hearty breakfast, Buffalo Bill confided to Captain Keyes his
-experience, for he wished to keep the story of finding the negro,
-Black Bill, a secret from all save the commanding officer.
-
-“Now, captain, I wish to pick my men and go at once on the trail,
-for, from what that negro tells me, I fear those people are in a bad
-way.
-
-“I know they have no right in the Big Horn country, but they are
-there, in great danger, and there are women and children to be
-rescued.
-
-“Now, I have every confidence in Sergeant Mobile Buck, and I wish a
-corporal who is an equally good man for the work ahead.
-
-“Then I feel I can trust the men with Buck in his corral, and I wish
-twenty-six all told, so, if you will pick out the balance to make up
-the number, I know I will have just the band I can rely on.
-
-“Then, too, sir, I wish to take all the tools you may have along,
-every lariat, stake line, and rope in the outfit, plenty of
-provisions on pack animals, and the cannon powder, as I may need it
-for blasting, from what Black Bill tells me.
-
-“Now, Captain Keyes, if you will fit me out at once with the men and
-things I need, it will be a great favor, and we’ll be on the return
-trail within a couple of hours.”
-
-“I’ll do it, Cody, for what you tell me about these people interests
-me greatly.
-
-“I know just the men to send with you, and all we have in the outfit
-which you can use is at your disposal,” said Captain Keyes.
-
-Sergeant Buck was at once called, and Buffalo Bill told him he wished
-him, a corporal, and twenty-four men to take the trail with him,
-Captain Keyes adding:
-
-“Yes, and we are to pick the men, sergeant, for Chief Cody will only
-take colored soldiers, and they are to be his scouts.”
-
-“I’m mighty glad, sir, and I know we can get good men, sir,” was the
-answer.
-
-A corporal was first selected, and though he was the hue of ink,
-he rejoiced in the nickname of Milk White, being generally called
-“Corporal Milk.”
-
-With his aid, and he was a splendid soldier, strong as a giant, and
-an all-round good man, the twenty-four colored scouts were selected,
-the entire squad of Sergeant Buck’s original escort being taken
-along, save the wounded, for all wished to go with “Massa Buf’ler
-Bill.”
-
-The scout took along extra rifles for all, carried on the pack
-animals, every horse was picked for speed and endurance, a large
-supply of provisions was taken, with every rope and lariat in the
-command, and a big supply of ammunition and cannon powder.
-
-Within two hours, as Buffalo Bill had said, the band of black scouts
-mounted and rode away from the command, all wondering what the reason
-might be for the strange expedition.
-
-Buffalo Bill rode at the head, the sergeant following with fourteen
-men, and then came the corporal with his ten men as a guard to the
-pack animals and a reserve force.
-
-Buffalo Bill felt proud of his black scouts, and determined to
-push rapidly on to the lone camp of Black Bill, where a halt for a
-couple of days’ rest was to be made, and to enable the wounded and
-half-starved negro to recuperate.
-
-Buffalo Bill also intended to take this time to mount his own pack
-animal, which would be fresh, and try and strike the trail of Ginger
-Sam, who would not be expecting him back from the fort for some days.
-
-He had by no means given up hope of capturing that gallows bird.
-
-So Buffalo Bill pushed rapidly on with his scouts, and halted only
-when it was near sunset, for dinner and supper combined, and the men
-turned in for sleep until after midnight.
-
-Then a start was made, and early that afternoon the camp of Black
-Bill was reached.
-
-To the sergeant and corporal the scout had told of his coming upon
-the starving and wounded negro; but to the men the surprise was very
-great, upon coming across the lone camp.
-
-Black Bill greeted the chief of scouts with a shout, saying that he
-was getting well fast, and he knew he would be ready for the trail at
-once, if need be.
-
-“No, take a couple of days more, for I do not wish you to move until
-really able to do so.”
-
-The chief of scouts did not remain long in camp, but started, mounted
-on his pack animal, to go to the place where he had left Ginger Sam
-and try to pick up his trail. He was confident that the man had a
-cabin somewhere near there, as he had known the cliff trail so well,
-and by leaping from it into the stream he could make a landing and
-escape.
-
-The scout felt sure that Ginger Sam was in that country looking for
-gold, and doubtless allied with the Indians, while again he might
-have another comrade with him. He was determined to know and capture
-the outlaw if he could, to kill him if he had to do so.
-
-He reached the place where the man had landed from the stream, and,
-to one of his great scouting skill, he readily trailed the tracks of
-the large and heavy boots, soaked as they had been with water.
-
-It soon became a hard trail to follow, but after a mile it led into a
-cañon, and there the scout beheld a small, rude cabin.
-
-The door was closed, and the scout slipped up cautiously, to find it
-tied on the outside. It was empty, but it was evident that Ginger Sam
-had been there, for he had changed his wet boots for others.
-
-The ashes in the fireplace were cold, and Buffalo Bill seemed to
-grasp the situation, for he said:
-
-“He came here and left without weapons; he has gone, and where but to
-the Indian village to get more.
-
-“That will take him a week or longer, so I will visit him upon our
-return, for he doubtless has a gold find near here, so that keeps him
-alone in these wilds, for alone he certainly is.
-
-“He may have struck it rich, and so will I when I find him, as there
-are old scores to settle with that man.”
-
-Then, fastening the door as he found it and returning to where he had
-left his horse, for he had followed the trail on foot, Buffalo Bill
-started for the camp of his black scouts.
-
-The negro courier from the penned-up settlers of the valley had made
-himself solid with one and all of the black scouts, who did all they
-could to hasten the recovery of his strength. He had recuperated
-wonderfully, and was so anxious to start upon the trail of rescue
-that Buffalo Bill decided to make a start the next afternoon and
-travel by half-day trails until Black Bill was able to stand what the
-others could.
-
-So the next day the chief and his scouts started upon the trail of
-rescue.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXI.
-
- TO THE RESCUE.
-
-
-Feeling that he was on a trail of rescue, Black Bill rallied so fast
-that he began to scout on ahead, and one day as Buffalo Bill came
-near to where the negro lay full length upon the ground, he had
-reached the summit of a range and was gazing over at something he had
-discovered on the other side.
-
-Creeping up to the side of the negro, Buffalo Bill peered over
-cautiously, and he, too, lay low, and motioned to the coming scouts
-to come quietly and see the discovery that Black Bill had made.
-
-“Massa Bill, jist look a-yonder, sah, and see what I found,” said the
-negro.
-
-“You can have them, Black Bill, for I don’t want them,” answered
-Buffalo Bill, as he looked in the direction the negro pointed.
-
-The discovery was an Indian village. There it was in the valley, a
-hundred tepees, at least, and with a large herd of ponies feeding
-near. It did not look like a permanent village, and the experienced
-eye of Buffalo Bill now told him that it was not. It was an Indian
-village upon the march, and apparently halting there in the valley
-for rest and game for a few days.
-
-One by one, the black scouts came up and dropped down at full length
-by the side of their chief to peer over the range.
-
-They had expected some important discovery, but they saw more than
-they cared to see.
-
-Not a word was spoken other than a low ejaculation of surprise or a
-whistle at the startling discovery.
-
-Every eye was upon Cody, every ear waiting to catch his words. But
-he had taken his field glass from its case and was already surveying
-the river, the valley, the Indian village through it. What he was
-thinking his face did not reveal.
-
-“Ain’t yer goin’ ter skeer ’em, Massa Buf’ler Bill?” asked the guide.
-
-“You mean by playing ghosts, Bill?”
-
-“Yes, sah.”
-
-“There’s safety in numbers, and I don’t think they would scare so
-much as we would wish them to.”
-
-“Jist try it, sah.”
-
-“We will try it when a plan I have fails, when we have to do so.”
-
-“Yes, sah.”
-
-“Night is not very far off, none of the Indians will be coming up
-here at this hour, and we can follow down the range until we get
-opposite to where their ponies are.
-
-“From there we can see where the guards are, and how many if, indeed,
-they have any watching their ponies.
-
-“Then as soon as it is dark we can go down into the valley, mount
-some of the best ponies and stampede the whole herd.”
-
-The scouts all gave a chuckle of delight.
-
-“We can dash away with them, and keep pushing them along.
-
-“Of course, as you know, some of the braves will have ponies near
-their tepees, and will follow, but they won’t see us, and, if there
-are many of them, we can push on ahead of the herd, if the pace
-becomes too hot.
-
-“In this way we can get by these redskins without being seen.
-
-“The Indians will not know what stampeded their ponies, and we will
-leave them to find out the best way they can.”
-
-This plan of Buffalo Bill met with the approval of each man, though
-Black Bill seemed to regret not being able to get a chance to “skeer
-dem red Injuns silly,” as he expressed it.
-
-Down the range, out of sight of the Indian camp, went the scouts,
-until Buffalo Bill halted at a spot just above where the herd of
-ponies were feeding.
-
-Finding a hiding place, the chief swept the valley with his glass,
-and soon discovered that there were only a couple of youths in charge
-of the herd, and they were seated upon their ponies in the shadow of
-the trees along the river bank.
-
-“There are boys in charge, pards, but soon after night braves will
-come to relieve them, we may be sure, so we will be ready to move the
-moment the shadows deepen in the valley.
-
-“Three of you go to the farther end of the herd and mount, and we
-will go to the end near the village, so when you start they’ll follow
-under our driving.
-
-“You take the lead, corporal, and keep the ponies going at full speed
-when they get started.”
-
-The men understood the plan, and in half an hour it was dark.
-
-Of course, supper was not to be thought of then, and, while Corporal
-Milk led the way to the lower end of the herd, Buffalo Bill and those
-with him rounded up the ponies feeding nearest to the Indian village.
-
-Good ponies were caught without trouble, the scouts mounted, and,
-with their lariats for bridles, began to urge the herd forward.
-
-The men lay low on the backs of the ponies, so as not to be seen,
-and, as the corporal and those with him dashed off on the leaders,
-the other scouts pushing the herd upon them, the two startled Indian
-boys could just get out of the way as the stampeded animals went
-flying down the valley.
-
-What stampeded them those two boys could not tell, but their shrill
-cries gave the alarm, as well as did the thunder of hundreds of hoofs.
-
-There were braves in the village who had ponies near their tepees,
-and as soon as they could they dashed off in pursuit.
-
-But the stampeded ponies had over a mile the start before the
-warriors could get away, and that meant a long, hard chase unless the
-ponies stopped of their own free will.
-
-There were not over a score of braves who had ponies near by, and, as
-they came upon the two boys, the latter had a strange story to tell,
-of the whole herd raising their heads as one animal, uttering wild
-snorts, and going off as though possessed of evil spirits.
-
-On down the valley swept the herd, and, as mile after mile was gone
-over, the slow ponies and used-up ones began to lag behind.
-
-But Corporal Milk and his men led the way, and Buffalo Bill and those
-with him kept the pace a hot one, forcing the ponies that could run
-and endure the strain close on the heels of the leaders.
-
-Behind them they knew the warriors were coming with all the speed
-they could to try and head off the herd.
-
-But a stern chase is a long one always, especially when the leaders
-have a start of over a mile, and several hours thus passed before at
-last the shadowy outlines of the pursuers could be seen.
-
-“We must push to the lead now, pards, at all hazards.
-
-“We have to desert our ponies, and, fortunately, we have the timber
-along the river to hide us,” said Buffalo Bill.
-
-The ponies they rode then were pushed the harder, and they began to
-pass animal after animal. The center of the herd was reached, then
-they forged nearer and nearer to the front, the ponies they passed
-halting as they went by them, and thus checking the more rapid
-pursuit of the braves in chase.
-
-At last Buffalo Bill saw Corporal Milk’s tall form ahead, and the
-next moment the scouts were all bunched together.
-
-“Off to the right, here. All lie low on your own horses now, and no
-one speak aloud, for there are a score of braves pursuing,” said
-Buffalo Bill.
-
-The word was passed in a low tone from one to the other, the scouts
-wheeled to the right, the shadow of the timber along the river was
-reached, and each man slipped from the back of the animal he rode,
-pulled off the lariat bridle from his pony, and bounded into the
-shelter of the trees.
-
-Lashed with the lariats to urge them on, the group of ponies just
-deserted, though fagged out, ran on down the valley, and suddenly in
-chase swept half a dozen braves.
-
-“They had gained well on us, but they’ll soon head those ponies off
-and return up the valley,” said Buffalo Bill.
-
-“It was a successful stampede,” remarked the corporal.
-
-“Yes; now to push along for a few miles, as soon as those braves go
-back.”
-
-This the braves were not long in doing, going back at a canter and
-driving the ponies so recently deserted by riders before them, yet
-with no thought of the reason of the wild stampede.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXII.
-
- BLACK BILL’S LONE HAND.
-
-
-After going a couple of miles the black scouts returned to Sergeant
-Buck and his men, and they all pushed on once more, flanking the
-Indian village.
-
-They came to a small stream running down from the mountains, and this
-the chief followed up until it was seen to come out of a cañon.
-
-Here was a good camping place, so a fire was built in a crevice of
-the rocks, supper was gotten, and the scouts turned in for the night,
-well tired out after their hard day’s work.
-
-Up with the light, they were determined to press on before having
-breakfast, and fortunate for them it was, as they had not gone half
-a mile, and were just nearing the mouth of the cañon they had camped
-in, when Buffalo Bill, who was well in the advance, was seen to come
-to a sudden stop.
-
-The scouts halted, also. They saw their chief step cautiously back
-into a thicket, then move to the right and there stand gazing at what
-had attracted his attention and halted him so suddenly.
-
-After a moment he motioned them to approach.
-
-They did so, and, gaining a point of observation, beheld, not a
-quarter of a mile distant, a band of half a hundred Indians just
-going into camp. They had picketed their ponies, and were gathering
-wood with the intention of having breakfast there.
-
-“Those fellows are on a rapid march, and evidently belong to the
-village up the river, and are going home.
-
-“I judge they have come from across the Big Horn, and have struck the
-trail of their village and now have halted for rest and food.
-
-“Pards, we cannot get out of this cañon until they have passed on,
-for we can’t scale those cliffs, not being birds, and you know this
-stream tumbles over a precipice at the head of this trap.
-
-“Corporal, you remain here with me, and we’ll see what we can
-discover more about that band, while the rest of you return up the
-cañon and take it easy.”
-
-Buffalo Bill and Corporal Milk then remained in hiding, watching the
-redskins, while the remainder of the band returned up the cañon,
-which at its entrance was a quarter of a mile in width, but narrowed
-to a few feet at its end, and there the creek tumbled over a cliff
-into a waterfall.
-
-The Indians, the scouts saw, were some threescore in number, and
-their ponies stood with heads lowered as though they had been very
-hard ridden.
-
-Several fires had been built, and the smell of broiling venison
-floated up the cañon, while the redskins could be seen gathered about
-the fire, eating heartily.
-
-There was a thicket near that hid half of their camping place, but
-Buffalo Bill quickly ran his field glass over the band, and at last
-said:
-
-“Those redskins have been up to some deviltry, I am certain.
-
-“They have no plunder or scalps, but they have not been on a hunt, or
-they would have their game with them.
-
-“Then, too, there is so much game in this country they would not have
-to go after it.”
-
-“They’ve been on a war trail near some of the forts, sir, and look as
-though they had been worsted in a fight,” said the corporal.
-
-“Yes, that is about it. Doubtless they have been in the neighborhood
-of Fetterman, as they came up the right bank of the Big Horn.”
-
-“Do you observe any wounded among them, sir?”
-
-“Yes, now I am looking for wounded I see a number who appear to have
-been used rather severely in a fight. I see that they appear in
-no hurry now, having crossed the Big Horn and struck the trail of
-their village; but their arrival there will cause wailing instead of
-rejoicing---- Holy smoke! Look there!”
-
-Buffalo Bill pointed toward the other side of the cañon, where,
-quietly walking out upon the plain, was no less a personage than
-the giant negro, Black Bill. He had come out of the cañon, and was
-walking deliberately down toward the Indian camp, the latter not yet
-having discovered him.
-
-“Blast that darky! He will ruin us!” cried Corporal Milk, as he
-looked toward the spot where Buffalo Bill had pointed and discovered
-Black Bill going deliberately toward the Indian camp.
-
-“He will be killed if we don’t save him. Run, corporal, and call the
-boys!” cried Buffalo Bill.
-
-He was about to obey, when the sergeant came running up, and not far
-behind him were the other scouts.
-
-“Do you see that nigger, chief?”
-
-“Yes.”
-
-“He’s mad, or a traitor. He was there with us up the cañon, and said
-he could scare the reds to death. Then he got up and walked away, and
-soon after we discovered that he had gone toward the other side of
-the cañon. We followed, and you see what he has done!”
-
-“Yes; perhaps he has got us into a hole from which there is no
-escape. Stand ready, men, to see what the outcome will be.”
-
-The men were all ready for a fight or a race, as it might turn out
-for them.
-
-Every eye was upon the negro, who was now too far off to recall. He
-was walking calmly along, straight toward the Indian camp, and they,
-strange to say, had not yet discovered him.
-
-They were still broiling venison steak on the end of sticks and
-eating it in a way that showed their hunger by no means satiated.
-
-Feeling secure where they were, confident that they would not be
-pursued that far into their country, and not knowing that their
-village could not be over half a day’s journey ahead of them, they
-were taking matters coolly, to recover from the strain they had
-evidently been under for some time.
-
-Still the giant negro guide walked on, while the scouts could only
-stand ready for action, watch him, and wait for the finale. He
-appeared not in the least disturbed as he moved toward the Indian
-camp.
-
-But suddenly there was heard a wild, almost unearthly cry.
-
-It was of terror and ferocity commingled, and it was echoed by half a
-hundred throats, while it brought every brave to his feet.
-
-There was one glance of wild eyes toward the negro, gigantic in form,
-black as ink, and gliding rather than seeming to walk toward them,
-and with yells of fright they sprang for their ponies.
-
-There was not a moment of hesitation, and their cries told the story
-of their stampede and terror, for loud was heard in their own tongue:
-
-“The black spirit! The evil spirit of the Big Horn!”
-
-Leaping upon their ponies, here and there two braves upon the back of
-one horse, leaving their camp outfits, saddles and all, they started
-off as fast as they could mount.
-
-They could be seen lashing their ponies furiously, and looking back
-in terror, and were all soon spread out as they sped up the valley.
-
-Then Black Bill was seen by the amazed and watching scouts to start
-in a run after them.
-
-This added to their flight and terror, and the blows falling upon the
-worn-out ponies could be distinctly heard by the wondering scouts.
-
-The scouts could hardly restrain from a cheer, but Buffalo Bill said:
-
-“Remember, boys, we are scouts of silence on this trail.”
-
-Not an Indian was now visible, the last one having turned a bend in
-the valley that shut them out of sight.
-
-The negro, however, still kept on after them.
-
-Then he, too, turned the bend and disappeared.
-
-Still Buffalo Bill gave no order to move.
-
-For some time they waited, but Black Bill did not reappear.
-
-The Indian camp remained as they had left it.
-
-If there was a badly wounded redskin there he was not visible.
-
-The fires still burned, and several Indian ponies were grazing near,
-but no human being could be seen.
-
-At last an exclamation came from several of the scouts together.
-
-The guide was returning down the valley, but was yet a mile away.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXIII.
-
- BLACK BILL’S PRISONER.
-
-
-As Black Bill came on down the valley, the scouts wished to go out to
-meet him, to greet him with a cheer.
-
-But this Buffalo Bill would not allow.
-
-“We do not yet know who may have been left in the camp, pards.”
-
-Upon second thought, this was considered the wisest plan, and they
-kept in their place of concealment and waited.
-
-Down the valley in silence walked the guide, and at last reached
-the camp. He disappeared behind the little thicket of pines, then
-reappeared, and, walking to a grazing pony, slung his lariat.
-
-The animal was cleanly caught and led back to the thicket.
-
-Then some minutes passed away, and once more the negro reappeared.
-He was leading the pony, and upon the animal, supported by several
-saddles and blankets and tied there with lariats, was an Indian brave.
-
-That he was badly wounded the scouts could see at that distance. The
-head of the pony was checked up, so that he could not feed, and then
-he was led to the trail and started up the valley on the trail of the
-Indian village and the braves who had stampeded.
-
-Until the pony disappeared from sight around the bend the giant negro
-stood watching him. Then he turned back to the deserted camp and
-disappeared in the thicket.
-
-Still Buffalo Bill did not allow the scouts to show themselves.
-
-After another long wait, the negro reappeared, and, looking toward
-the cañon, he beckoned several times. “Now, pards, we’ll go.”
-
-With this, Buffalo Bill led the way, and they walked rapidly toward
-the Indian camp, Black Bill having returned to the thicket.
-
-When Buffalo Bill and his men reached the camp, they beheld a strange
-scene.
-
-The redskins had deserted everything. But that was not all, for they
-had left the badly wounded Indian Black Bill had sent off, and two
-dead comrades, the latter having evidently just died of their wounds.
-And they had left still more, for, lying in the pine thicket was a
-prisoner.
-
-It was a white man. He was securely bound, painfully so, and, as
-the scouts rode up, they saw Black Bill kneeling by his side and
-unfastening the thongs that were about his hands and feet, which were
-much swollen.
-
-A glad cry broke from the lips of Buffalo Bill as he advanced toward
-the prisoner.
-
-It was Don Miller, a gold hunter the scout knew well.
-
-“Ah, Miller, I am glad indeed to see you, and I have found it hard to
-believe you dead,” said the chief, “as I heard you were.”
-
-“Only half dead, Cody; but you have saved me.”
-
-“And glad we are to do so.”
-
-“All the rest were killed--I am the last of my band of hunters.”
-
-“Yes, and the man I would have risked much to save, for I have not
-forgotten what I owe you, Miller. Scouts, this is my friend, a
-gold-boomer captain, Don Miller.”
-
-The men pressed about him and grasped his swollen hands, which Black
-Bill had released.
-
-Turning to the negro guide, Buffalo Bill said:
-
-“Well, Bill, you have kept your word and frightened the redskins into
-fits, so I know now surely that there is virtue in what you have
-asserted about black spirits being a terror to the Indians of this
-Big Horn country.”
-
-“Yes, sah, dey runs like de debbil when dey sees a nigger. I done
-tell dis gemman here so. But, Massa Bill, we must git out of here
-right quick, for dem Injuns will come right back after dere prisoner
-in a short time.”
-
-This was decided upon at once, and preparations to start were begun.
-
-“Yer see, sah, we must not disturb de camp ’ceptin’ de gemman and de
-gold, and as I hab sent off dat wounded Injun he’ll tell ’em about me.
-
-“I didn’t open my mouth to him, was still as death, but jist took him
-up, put him on a pony, and tied him on all right. Then I started him
-off. He think I am de black evil speeret of de Big Horn, and when dey
-come back dey’ll find I has let de prisoner go, and what I hab done
-wid de gold dey won’t care.”
-
-“Black Bill, you have got a very level head. It is just what we will
-do. Come, boys! We must carry Mr. Miller and the gold, too.”
-
-“I’ll divide the gold, pards, for saving me as you did,” said Don
-Miller.
-
-“If you can find a man in my band who would touch a dollar’s worth
-of it for a service to you I wouldn’t have him with me five minutes
-after I knew it,” said Buffalo Bill, somewhat hotly, and the men
-joined heartily in their chief’s opinion.
-
-A quarter of an hour after their arrival in camp the scouts started
-off, with Buffalo Bill in the lead.
-
-The Indian camp was left just as it was found, with the exception of
-the gold and the rescued prisoner.
-
-The gold boomer’s horse and the ponies were left grazing near the
-dead redskins, where they had been placed by their comrades, and
-there was nothing to reveal that other than the supposed “evil
-spirit,” a black ghost, had been there.
-
-The superstitious dread of the Indians all knew would allow them to
-believe that the evil spirit had been angry with them for taking the
-paleface.
-
-The scouts turned toward the base of the mountains and went along the
-range.
-
-Mile after mile they held on until a stream was come to, flowing out
-of a cañon, a march of fully a dozen miles had been made, and in a
-secure spot Buffalo Bill encamped his men.
-
-Then the swollen limbs of the rescued prisoner were bathed, arnica
-put on them, and a good meal cooked for all to enjoy, for Buffalo
-Bill saw that a bend in the range would completely hide the smoke
-from the Indians up the valley.
-
-It was a good place, too, where the gold could be hidden, for Don
-Miller proudly said there was not a man in the party but whom he
-would trust with the secret.
-
-If the people of the valley were found, the retreat would be up the
-Big Horn to that point, at least, whether they were making for Fort
-Aspen or Fort Fetterman, and the gold could be taken up and carried
-along or a special expedition made for it.
-
-So the gold, in bright, glittering particles, from the size of a
-pinhead to an acorn, and nuggets as large as a hen’s egg, were packed
-more closely and hidden in a crevice in the cliff overhanging the
-cañon.
-
-The march was not resumed that day, for Buffalo Bill wished to see
-whether the Indians did follow, and, if so, that was a splendid place
-for a stand, if as “black spirits” the scouts could not frighten them
-off, and had consequently a fight on their hands.
-
-The next morning, as not an Indian had been seen, the party took up
-the march.
-
-Don Miller expressed himself as feeling much better, and said that he
-would be all right soon.
-
-On his account it was slow traveling, but Buffalo Bill felt that he
-owed his life to the gold-boomer captain, and could not do too much
-for him, and the men had the same feeling toward him for what he had
-done for their chief.
-
-Thus another day passed, and Buffalo Bill knew that they had got well
-up toward the Big Horn Mountains, and if the people of the valley
-lived they could not be so very far from where the camp then was.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXIV.
-
- THE LOST VALLEY.
-
-
-Still another day and another went by, and each night brought the
-scouts farther and farther into a most beautiful country, yet one
-that thus far had been most fatal to all palefaces venturing there,
-lured to risk life and untold hardships and suffering in search of
-the yellow dross that buys men so readily, body and soul.
-
-Buffalo Bill once owed his life to Don Miller when he was a scout,
-and liked the man; but he had given up scouting, and had gone to
-lawless gold hunting in the Big Horn, and the report had come that
-his whole party had been massacred; but Cody was only glad that his
-friend had escaped.
-
-Noon the next day brought them to a perfect garden spot in the Big
-Horn Mountains. The springs were as clear as crystal and as cold as
-ice, the trees grand, and the little valleys most inviting for a camp.
-
-Black Bill boldly asserted that the Indians would never come there,
-that they believed these mountains the abode of the evil spirits.
-
-Buffalo Bill knew, in spite of Miller’s protestations and nerve,
-that Don was not yet well, but good food, rest, and bathing in these
-springs would help him; so he decided to go regularly into camp
-there.
-
-They need have no dread of Indians there, and they had left no trail
-to be followed easily.
-
-They would halt there, for the men needed the rest, and he and Black
-Bill would take short searches to try and find the Lost Valley and
-its mysterious people.
-
-Several times in the last day the giant negro had halted and regarded
-his surroundings in a fixed way. He seemed to be trying to recall
-some feature in the landscape as though he had seen it before.
-
-It had been two months and more since he was there before, if he had
-passed that way in his wanderings, and then the trees were bright
-green, in midsummer.
-
-Now they were changing to autumn tints, and, as is well known, this
-changed the whole aspect of the country.
-
-The springs the negro had not seen, though there were people from the
-Lost Valley who had been there.
-
-“Black Bill has been near here before, I feel certain, Sergeant Buck,
-and our plan is to scout about the mountains until we strike some
-locality familiar to him.”
-
-“Yes, chief, that is just it, sir.”
-
-“We can all have a rest, and Miller is really not well yet.”
-
-“No, sir, and it is not any wonder, when you think them red devils
-had his hands tied behind him during all their retreat, and his legs
-so tightly bound that the flesh was cut into.”
-
-“Yes; but he will rally quickly here and soon will be well.
-
-“He is a brave and noble-hearted man, if he did break the law by
-invading this country as a gold boomer.”
-
-“He is all you say of him, chief, and the boys are very much attached
-to him, sir.
-
-“Then, too, sir, he’s another strong arm and brave heart, if we get
-into trouble, which I now believe we will not, as Black Bill seems to
-be a terror the redskins won’t face,” said Sergeant Buck.
-
-“But will you pick the camp?”
-
-“Yes.”
-
-The spot selected was all that could be wished.
-
-Wikiups were built as a shelter, for the cold nights were coming
-on, and the men made themselves most comfortable right near a large
-spring.
-
-Leaves furnished good mattresses to spread blankets upon, the
-provisions were plentiful, and very little use had been made of the
-ammunition, save to kill game.
-
-As there was no game near the spring, it was decided to send several
-scouts on a hunt the next day to get deer, and in the streams the
-fish were plentiful.
-
-The scouts had realized the virtue of being blacked up in that
-country, and Don Miller had transferred himself also, in appearance
-at least, to a negro.
-
-Without a guard, the scouts lay down to sleep, and nothing disturbed
-their slumbers.
-
-The next morning Corporal Milk took a party hunting up the valley
-with him, and Buffalo Bill and Black Bill began their real search for
-the Lost Valley.
-
-The hunters were gone all day, and when they returned to the camp at
-sunset they carried very heavy loads of game of various kinds.
-
-But the scouts who remained in the camp could give no reply as to
-what had become of Buffalo Bill and the negro.
-
-They had not put in an appearance, and it was certainly thought that
-they should have done so.
-
-“Was it any one else than the chief, I would be anxious,” said
-Sergeant Buck hopefully; but all could see that he was anxious, even
-though it was the chief.
-
-Buffalo Bill had said that they would be back before night. He had
-not returned. It had been his intention, they knew, to go out each
-day with the negro, and in a different direction, to try and come
-upon some scene Black Bill would recognize.
-
-If he did not do so from that camp, they would move to another, and
-in that time Don Miller would be as well as any of them, and they
-would see what discovery could be made.
-
-But here, the very first day of the search, the chief of the scouts
-and the giant negro did not return. What could it mean?
-
-Buffalo Bill was not the man to get lost anywhere. He could find
-his way in the darkness right through an unknown country. It was a
-talent with him--an instinct--and his men never feared for him, save
-from an ambush from an enemy, or treachery.
-
-There were several of the scouts who still doubted the black guide.
-They could not feel the faith in him which their chief did. In spite
-of the seeming honesty of the negro, they doubted him. He was an
-object of mystery to them--a man to dread.
-
-They could not believe that he had started alone to find aid, to look
-up Buffalo Bill, and yet could not find his way back to the point
-whence he had started. It looked strange to them. Now he had gone off
-alone with the chief of scouts, and they had not returned. This to
-some looked like treachery.
-
-The scouts awaited supper for some time, and then ate it, as the
-chief and the negro did not return.
-
-The meal was, however, not enjoyed by any one.
-
-Bedtime came, and yet what could be done? No one could go out at
-night to look for the missing chief and the negro.
-
-If nothing had happened, then Buffalo Bill would find the way to the
-camp in a mountain storm.
-
-All knew that the scout did not go without his blanket, a haversack
-of food, and was prepared to spend the night anywhere he might be
-overtaken.
-
-A search of the traps of the negro showed that he had gone also
-prepared for a stay, if necessary.
-
-At last the scouts decided to retire and put the best face on the
-nonreturn of the chief by saying that they had doubtless gone so far,
-made some discovery, and to carry out their intention had decided to
-camp where they were for the night, to be on the spot early in the
-morning, rather than return to camp.
-
-“We will start on the hunt, pards, if they are not here to
-breakfast,” said Sergeant Buck.
-
-Dawn came, but the chief and the negro had not returned.
-
-One of those who appeared to be most anxious about the chief was Don
-Miller. He wanted to go on the search.
-
-“We will all go, and divide in twos, and if we cannot find their
-trail we will go the way we think they must have gone.
-
-“You take care of the camp, Mr. Miller, and each one of us, as he
-gives up the search, will come in; only I do not wish any man to give
-up until he is certain that he cannot find the chief, and must get
-back here by night.
-
-“Yes, I want every man back here in camp by night.
-
-“You will see where we are located, and no man need get lost.
-
-“Come right back to camp if any discovery is made; and, I tell you,
-boys, we must find the chief.
-
-“If he has been treacherously dealt with, as I see some of you
-believe, then we know who did it, and we must find him.
-
-“Now, pards, let us be off!” said Sergeant Buck.
-
-Such was the sergeant’s speech to his comrades, and they all started
-on their search.
-
-And in the lone camp, Don Miller remained by himself, watching them
-as they disappeared on different trails, and musing to himself in a
-very determined way:
-
-“Buffalo Bill must be found, dead or alive; and, if dead, he shall be
-avenged!”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXV.
-
- UNSEEN FOES.
-
-
-When Buffalo Bill and the guide left the camp together, the chief
-went down the valley leading from the Big Horn Mountains, where the
-camp had been located, hoping to pass some scene that the negro would
-recall at sight.
-
-Could he do this, Buffalo Bill felt little doubt but that they could
-in that way find the Lost Valley, for the scout had perfect faith
-that the negro was sincere in all that he had said, and that it was
-not the creation of mind diseased.
-
-Brave as he was, good plainsman, also, it would be readily understood
-by Buffalo Bill how the negro failed to find a given locality when he
-had been guided thither by some one else, and had simply left there
-to endeavor to find his way to a place where he could get word of
-him, the chief of scouts, who was to be secretly urged to come to the
-rescue of people in distress.
-
-Why some one else--the guide of the party, for instance--had not been
-sent on this mission Buffalo Bill had been unable to find out from
-Black Bill.
-
-Starting out alone with Black Bill, and having arrived, as it were,
-almost upon the scene to which the negro had wished to bring him,
-Buffalo Bill thought that, perhaps, he would tell him more than he
-thus far had done, and to encourage him to do so he had said:
-
-“Well, you think we are near the Lost Valley?”
-
-“Sure, sah; very sartin.”
-
-“What do you tell by?”
-
-“Well, sah, dere is trees, and mountains, and valleys dat looks
-familiarlike, though I can’t jist place ’em; but I is sartin I has
-seen ’em before.”
-
-“Did you ever go far from the valley?”
-
-“Not very, sah; but I hunted ’round, maybe ten and a dozen miles
-away.”
-
-“Suppose you find some spot that you recall thoroughly, will you go
-right to the valley?”
-
-“Well, Massa Bill, I’ll go as near as I kin, and then let you decide
-what is ter be done.”
-
-“All right; keep your eyes open, and see if you can find any place
-you remember to have seen before.”
-
-“Yes, sah; I’m a-lookin’ hard, sah.”
-
-They went on together for some miles, and the valley they were
-following opened into a larger one.
-
-As they came out into the larger valley, the guide halted suddenly,
-rubbed his eyes, looked about him, and said earnestly:
-
-“Massa Buf’ler Bill, I knows whar I is.”
-
-“What do you recognize about this valley?”
-
-“If I is right, sah, you see dem cliffs ’way yonder?”
-
-“Yes.”
-
-“Dem is over de cañon where dey used ter git gold.”
-
-The negro started off in a way that told the scout that he was in
-earnest, that he had certainly got his bearings from some familiar
-scene before him. He kept up a rapid pace, Buffalo Bill keeping close
-by his side.
-
-The cliffs loomed up nearer and nearer, and at last the scout and the
-negro were almost under their shadow.
-
-“You see dat break yonder in de cliffs?”
-
-“Yes.”
-
-“It is a cañon, sah. It runs back from where you see de open place,
-and dere big springs yonder dat flow down the cañon, and dere whar
-dey found de gold.”
-
-The negro went forward alone, and began to climb up the steep rocks
-to the break in the cliff. Watching him, Buffalo Bill saw him peep
-cautiously over, as though he expected to see an enemy beyond.
-
-A moment he remained thus, and then came a distant report of a rifle
-that echoed and reëchoed among the cliffs, and Buffalo Bill saw the
-negro sink down upon his face as though dead.
-
-Buffalo Bill was fairly startled at what he beheld. He had not
-thought of danger there to himself or to the negro. The shot had come
-so unexpectedly that, for a moment, he did not know where to look for
-an enemy.
-
-It appeared to have ended the life of the guide, for he had fallen
-in a heap and lay motionless, like a dead man.
-
-But the scout was not one to hesitate long when action was needed,
-or to allow a crime to go unpunished when he could bring the
-perpetrators to book.
-
-Thoughts went like lightning through his mind. He thought of the
-people of Lost Valley that the negro had risked so much to rescue.
-Could they have killed their rescuer?
-
-How far was the Lost Valley from where he then was?
-
-Of course, it must be those from the valley who had fired on the
-black giant. But who they were he must know, and where they were, as
-well as why that murderous shot had been sent at a rescuer.
-
-Bounding forward while these thoughts were raging through his brain,
-the scout reached a large rock at the base of the cliff.
-
-As he did so, a man sprang in view through the break of the cliff,
-and within a few feet of the form of the negro. He was a large man,
-heavily bearded, long-haired, and he held a rifle in his hand.
-
-With a wave of his hand to some one unseen, he called out:
-
-“Come, Tom; for I told you I was right. It’s ther giant nigger of the
-valley.”
-
-Buffalo Bill heard the voice answer afar off, but did not catch what
-was said; yet he heard the reply of the man in full view of him, for
-he replied to the other:
-
-“Yes, dead as ther devil. I chipped him atween ther eyes. Come along.”
-
-The scout remained behind the bowlder. He could afford to wait; for
-he knew that another enemy was near, and would soon be in sight. The
-one in sight had fired on the negro, knowing who he was, and being
-anxious to kill him. He had spoken, too, of the valley; so he must
-know where that was.
-
-His words told Buffalo Bill that Black Bill was dead, and, in the
-very moment of his success in bringing him to the rescue of people
-who, if these two were a specimen of them, did not deserve rescue.
-
-“I think I’ve got the best of this,” muttered Buffalo Bill, and,
-slinging his rifle at his back, he drew a revolver in each hand.
-
-“Ho, Rocks, yer got him,” Buffalo Bill heard, for he dared not look
-toward the speaker for fear of being seen.
-
-“It’s ther nigger, ain’t it?” asked the man who had fired the shot.
-
-“Sure.”
-
-“How’d he get out?”
-
-“Who knows; fer I thought he’d given up tryin’ long ago.”
-
-“He didn’t, though, if he’s here.”
-
-“No, he didn’t; but there can’t be any more of ’em out.”
-
-“You bet ther ain’t, and they won’t be no more; so we’ve got it our
-way, sure.”
-
-“We has, ef our two pards come back all right.”
-
-“They’ll git here, fer gold will fetch ’em, you bet.”
-
-“Then we’ll be rich for our nat’ral lives.”
-
-“We will; and hev something ter leave after death.
-
-“We played to win, and we got ther game; only I don’t like this
-nigger gettin’ out.”
-
-“Me nuther.”
-
-“More might be gettin’ out now.”
-
-“Not ef they’re comin’ ther way he did; fer thar ain’t many men kin
-do it that I’m acquainted with.”
-
-“Nor me; but I wish our two pards would git back with the horses, for
-it’s after time some weeks, and provisions is running low.”
-
-“Yes, and gold won’t buy food in this country.”
-
-“No; all we has got won’t git us a meal if we was starving.”
-
-“That’s so; but suppose we keep a eye on ther valley, for if we see
-more of ’em gittin’ out, it means death ter us, if we don’t fust kill
-them.”
-
-“It does; but we’ll do ther killin’, as has just been done in this
-case of ther nigger; but let’s drag him down inter ther soft ground,
-go through his pockets, and see what he’s wuth to us outside of the
-killin’, and then he kin be left for coyotes ter chaw on, fer it’s
-too much like work ter plant him.”
-
-With this, the two men took hold of the negro, and their oaths
-revealed to Buffalo Bill that they were dragging him along down the
-steep hillside, and found it no easy task.
-
-Nearer and nearer they came, and the scout moved to the side of the
-rock nearest to which they must pass.
-
-A moment more and they came within ten feet of him, and would have
-come full upon him, when suddenly they were confronted by a tall
-form, and heard the words:
-
-“Hands up, both of you!”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXVI.
-
- FACE TO FACE WITH ENEMIES.
-
-
-The sudden appearance of the chief of the black scouts before them,
-appearing like an apparition to the two men, who had no thought of
-danger near, caused them to cry out in mingled terror and utter
-surprise.
-
-The form of the negro, which they were half bearing, half dragging
-along, was dropped with a suddenness that was by no mean showing a
-proper respect for the dead.
-
-The two men stood for an instant like statues, and before them
-towered the tall, athletic form of Buffalo Bill. He held a revolver
-in each hand, and was ten feet from them.
-
-“Hands up, I said!”
-
-The men had not heeded the first command, perhaps from utter
-helplessness, in their amazement. Now they did heed, and quickly.
-
-Buffalo Bill stepped forward toward the one nearest him, unbuckled
-his belt, thus disarming him of his knife and revolvers, and then
-drew the strap of his rifle over his head.
-
-“Now, your turn, sir!”
-
-The man did not move.
-
-“Step here, quick, or I’ll reach you with a bullet!”
-
-The scout saw that the men had discovered that they were two to one,
-and were plotting resistance. But the hint of reaching for him with
-a bullet brought the man quickly to within the length of the scout’s
-arm. He, too, was disarmed of his belt and weapons and his rifle.
-
-“Now, I wish to tie you, and if I see the first show of funny
-business, you will hand in your chips.”
-
-The men made no resistance, but they were glancing toward each other
-furtively, and certainly were plotting to escape.
-
-“Lie flat on your faces, both of you, and put your hands behind your
-backs!” came the order.
-
-“I’ll tie ’em, Massa Buf’ler Bill.”
-
-The words fairly startled the scout, with all his iron nerve. It was
-as though a dead man was speaking to him.
-
-The two men uttered a yell of fright, and, for a moment, seemed about
-to risk bullets in the face of superstitious fear.
-
-Had it been nighttime, the added dread that darkness brings to the
-superstitious would have sent them away on the jump.
-
-“Why, Black Bill, I thought that you were dead, and, thank Heaven, it
-is not so!” said Buffalo Bill earnestly.
-
-“No, massa; it was a close call, for dat bullet done cut my head, and
-I guess will kill me yet.
-
-“I is awful dizzy in my head like, but I kin tie dese gemmens, all
-right.”
-
-With this, the negro passed his hand across his head, took his lariat
-from over his shoulder, and began to tie the two men, Buffalo Bill
-keeping them covered with his revolver, and aiding in binding them
-securely.
-
-“The one lariat will do for them both, and keep them tied
-together--there, now we have them; but you cannot stand up?”
-
-“It don’t seem as though I could, sir,” said the black, who kept
-sitting on the ground.
-
-“I’ll see to your wound right off.”
-
-With this, the scout placed the weapons on the ground, wheeled the
-prisoners face to face, and bound them thus with his own lariat.
-
-“Now, Black Bill,” and he began to examine the wound.
-
-It was in the center of the forehead; but, having been fired upward,
-the bullet had glanced on the frontal bone, cut along under the scalp
-for several inches, and then made its way out, leaving a long gash,
-not serious, though the shock of the blow had felled the black and
-rendered him unconscious for some minutes.
-
-Bathing the wound with water from his canteen, and binding it up with
-a bandage moistened with arnica, the scout said:
-
-“You are all right now, and the dizzy feeling will soon wear off.”
-
-“It don’ hurt, sah; but it do feel like a mule hed kicked me.”
-
-“Rest is what you want, and we’ll go to the camp of these two men,
-for it cannot be far away.”
-
-The men had stood watching the every movement of the scout, and
-talking in whispers to each other.
-
-“We ain’t got no camp,” said one.
-
-“See here, men, you sought to kill this negro pard of mine, and that
-he escaped death is a marvel. I heard all that you said, and I know
-that you have a camp here, for you came from the camp of those who
-settled in this basin.”
-
-“That’s so, Massa Bill, fer I knows ’em both, one being named Tom
-Vail and t’other they calls Rocks. Dey had two pards, and we all
-thought dey got kilt de day of de ’arthquake. I knows ’em, sah; but
-why dey want ter kill me I doesn’t know, fer I never did ’em no harm,
-and den I thought dey was dead, and felt sorry for ’em, but dere must
-be two more of ’em, sah, so look out, Massa Bill.”
-
-“Yes, there are two more of them, though they are not here just now,
-but are due. I know a little about these fellows myself, for they
-gave themselves away when they thought they had killed you. Come,
-lead the way to your camp, or I’ll find a way to make you, and which
-you will not like.”
-
-The scout had unwound his lariat, so that they could walk side by
-side, and the two men saw that there was no nonsense to be put up
-with on their part, so one said:
-
-“We has a leetle camp down the valley, if yer wants ter go there.”
-
-“Lead the way. Black Bill, I’ll help you,” and, supporting the negro
-with his arm, Buffalo Bill followed on behind the two men, as they
-shuffled along down the valley, the weapons of each man being hung
-about their necks so that they would have to carry them.
-
-The two prisoners walked slowly, partly because their legs were tied
-so as to prevent rapid traveling, and also because they did not wish
-to go. They were livid with rage and fear, with hate and anxiety,
-for they did not know what would be their fate, while they saw their
-hopes dashed to earth in a second of time.
-
-Down the valley they went for a mile, perhaps, the walk seeming to
-benefit the negro, and, at last, they turned into a small cañon in
-which grew a grove of pines, and at the head of which was a spring.
-
-“De cañon whar de people hunt fer gold not far from here, Massa
-Bill,” said the negro, and then he added:
-
-“I jist guesses dat’s what dese men is here for, while t’others is in
-ther Lost Valley, for something had been de matter, sartin.”
-
-The camp now came into view, a stoutly built log cabin, with door and
-shutters of hewn timber, and a shed along the front.
-
-It was near the spring, was sheltered by the overhanging cliffs and
-the pines, and, winter or summer, was a safe and comfortable retreat.
-
-“De people built de cabin, Massa Bill; put it up fer dere provisions,
-which dey kept here, ter keep from going back to de valley, sah,
-every night, and dey only all went on Sundays.”
-
-“So you did find your camp, eh?” said Buffalo Bill to the two men,
-and he made them fast to a tree, back to back.
-
-Then he spread the negro’s blanket for him upon the pine straw, and
-said:
-
-“Now, you lie down there, while I reconnoiter this camp, which is a
-very snug affair, I see.”
-
-The two prisoners muttered oaths, the black lay down at full length,
-and Buffalo Bill threw open the door of the cabin and the shutters,
-which gave light within.
-
-It was a large cabin, and there were a number of bunks in it along
-the rear wall.
-
-There were shelves, too, with provisions, and a table, cooking
-utensils, weapons, and picks, shovels, axes, and hatchets.
-
-A haunch of venison hung under the shed outside, with bacon, hams,
-and dried fish, showing that the men were still well supplied with
-provisions.
-
-In a plot of ground back of the cabin there were potatoes, cabbages,
-and turnips growing, and places to store them away for the winter.
-
-“You fellows have had the best, I see, and I am going to know about
-you before I am done with you,” said Buffalo Bill.
-
-Then he added that he would cook dinner for all hands, and draw on
-the cabin’s larder for his supplies.
-
-A fire was smoldering outside of the cabin, and this was replenished,
-and soon a dinner of roast potatoes, bacon, venison, hoecake, and
-coffee was prepared.
-
-Black Bill was asleep; but woke at the scout’s call, saying that he
-felt much better, save for a headache.
-
-“It is well it is no worse. Now, see what a good dinner we have; or,
-I may say, supper, for it is getting late. I guess we’ll camp here
-to-night and return to our camp to-morrow; or I will go and bring the
-boys here, for you must keep quiet for a few days.”
-
-“What is you doing here in the Big Horn country, anyhow?” said Rocks,
-as Buffalo Bill untied the hands of the prisoners for them to eat
-their dinner.
-
-“That is just what I came here to ask you, and, as a government
-officer, I have the call.”
-
-“The nigger calls you Buffalo Bill.”
-
-“Yes.”
-
-“Is you him?”
-
-“Yes.”
-
-“I has heerd of yer,” said Rocks, watching the scout with interest.
-
-“So has I,” Tom Vail added.
-
-“You may hear of me before I leave this country of the Big Horn.”
-
-“Did ther nigger bring you here?”
-
-“About that.”
-
-“What for?”
-
-Buffalo Bill was willing to be questioned. He might find out what
-Black Bill had so far not made known to him. So he answered:
-
-“You know this country belongs to the Indians, and the government
-wishes to protect them in it, and will not send troops here, unless
-compelled to do so to punish murdering redskins.
-
-“You men, and others like you, are aware that the Big Horn is rich
-with gold finds, care nothing for the government’s pledges to the
-Indians, and invade the mountains and valleys as gold boomers.
-
-“This keeps the Indians restless, revengeful, and hostile, causing
-them to kill bands of whites where found, raid settlements away from
-their lands, and thus force the military to punish them severely for
-what you gold boomers have driven them to do.
-
-“You are, therefore, lawbreakers, and become murderers, for you kill
-the Indians, and they in turn kill the gold boomers and many innocent
-whites as well.
-
-“Now, I know that there is a settlement here, and, though they may
-have done no harm to the Indians, they are still lawbreakers, and
-must leave the country.”
-
-“You’ll have a lively time getting ther people of ther Lost Valley
-out of this country, Buffalo Bill.”
-
-“It may be; but they must go,” was the determined rejoinder of the
-chief of scouts.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXVII.
-
- A DISCOVERY.
-
-
-Buffalo Bill would have liked to have returned to his own camp that
-night, but he saw that Black Bill was still somewhat dazed by the
-wound in his head, and he did not just know how it would turn out.
-
-The scout had known similar wounds prove fatal when least expected,
-and if the negro was left to guard the two prisoners he might lapse
-into unconsciousness, and there be a possibility of the men getting
-free.
-
-Then, too, he knew what had been said by the two men of the pards
-they were expecting.
-
-They were overdue and might never come; and again, if they did happen
-to come that very night it would mean sure death to Black Bill,
-should he be left there alone.
-
-So the scout decided to remain, and, after the meal was over, he
-secured the prisoners, left the negro in charge, and started out on a
-search. He was not long in finding a trail leading into a wild cañon,
-through which flowed a stream, like a river in wet weather, but at
-other times dry.
-
-Going down this, the scout saw that he had struck the gold beds of
-the people of the Lost Valley.
-
-It was a case of placer mining, the wash from the mountains of the
-particles of gold, and yet the pick and shovel had been brought into
-use also in the bed of the cañon.
-
-“They have gotten considerable gold out of here, that is certain, and
-these men have been steadily at work, I see; but where are the people
-of the Lost Valley, for only these two murderous scamps seem to be
-anywhere about.”
-
-So musing, Buffalo Bill went on through the cañon, came out into
-a large valley, and, climbing to the top of a lofty cliff, looked
-about, glass in hand.
-
-It was nearly sunset; and the rays of light were cast far down the
-valley, and the eyes of the scout fell upon moving objects there.
-
-At once he turned his glass upon them.
-
-“They are horsemen!” he cried, “and they are coming this way.”
-
-A moment after he continued:
-
-“There are two of them, but they are leading five horses. By Jove! I
-believe they are the pards of these two murderers, just returning.
-How lucky I did not return to my camp!
-
-“Yes, they must be their two comrades; and, if these men are
-murderers, they can be no better that are coming.
-
-“They are all of half a dozen miles away, and it will be an hour and
-a half before they can reach the cabin, and darkness will be in
-soon. I’ll go and prepare for them.”
-
-The scout took another long look at the far-distant horsemen, then
-descended from the cliff, walked rapidly back through the gold cañon,
-and reached the cabin just as dusk fell.
-
-“Men, I am sorry to have to gag you and make you more secure, but I
-am determined to be upon the safe side. Are you well enough, Bill, to
-help me?”
-
-“Oh, yes, sah.”
-
-“Then get two sticks, put a piece of blanket over the head of each,
-and have it so you can tie it back of their heads.
-
-“I will tie these men in their bunks, when they have been gagged and
-they will give us no trouble or anxiety.”
-
-“It will kill us,” shouted Rocks.
-
-“Oh, no; you don’t die so easily.”
-
-The two men, bound as they were, sought to resist, but they soon
-found that they were as children in the hands of the scout, and they
-were placed in their bunks, made fast there, and the gags put in
-their mouths so that they could utter no sound.
-
-To test this the scout gave each one a severe pinch, to make them cry
-out, but a low groan was all that they could utter.
-
-“You see, I discovered some visitors coming, and who I am sure are
-the pards of these two men coming for them; so we wish no outcries
-of alarm, for I shall capture them also.”
-
-The two men could hear, if they could not talk, and they writhed and
-moaned at what they heard.
-
-“You, Black Bill, hide in the pines, rifle in hand, and be ready to
-drop those men if they attempt to run away.”
-
-“Yes, sah, I’ll do it.”
-
-“Hide a short distance off in the pines. Are you ready?”
-
-“Yes, sah.”
-
-“All right. I’ll wait in the cabin to welcome them.”
-
-The negro shouldered his rifle and walked to a place of hiding, with
-the scout by his side.
-
-Then Buffalo Bill returned to the cabin and closed the door, to wait
-the arrival of the visitors.
-
-That the chief of scouts had made no mistake in his surmise as to who
-the two horsemen were was proven by the sound of hoofs coming up the
-cañon.
-
-The guide saw by the moonlight two men, with five led horses, two
-carrying packs, pass by him. He heard one say:
-
-“I’ll be sartin afore I make a break, for we don’t know what has
-happened in ther three months we has been away.”
-
-“All right; I’ll wait here,” was the answer.
-
-The first speaker then rode on alone to the cabin and called out:
-
-“Ho, pards, kin yer give a couple of friends lodgin’ fer ther night?”
-
-The two prisoners writhed in agony of spirit, but Buffalo Bill,
-imitating the voice of Rocks, and having learned the names of the two
-men, called out:
-
-“Hooray! Is that you, Jim Sims and Alex Sands?”
-
-“It are. Any one with you?”
-
-“Yes; two pards is here. Wait until I open the door, and you bet we
-is glad ter see yer, fer Tom is laid up jist now and feelin’ mighty
-bad.”
-
-“Hoop-la! Come on, Alex!” cried Jim Sims in a joyful tone.
-
-“They are here, and all’s O.K., with the goose hanging high.”
-
-The tone was exultant, and Jim Sims leaped from his horse, stepped to
-the door, and was suddenly seized by the throat with a grip of iron,
-hurled to the dirt floor and heard the words:
-
-“Utter a sound of warning to your pard and you are a dead man!”
-
-The man was silent with fright, and, in an instant, the lariat of
-Buffalo Bill had been passed round and round his arms, pinioning them
-to his body, while his weapons had been removed.
-
-“Come in, Alex, and see poor Tom,” said Buffalo Bill, and the other
-man, having dismounted, stepped into the cabin, to be felled his full
-length by a stunning blow dealt him by Buffalo Bill full in the face.
-
-“Ho, Black Bill!” called out the scout, and the negro sprang into the
-cabin at the call, having followed the last man closely.
-
-The latter found himself bound before he recovered from the scout’s
-stunning blow full in the face, but he gasped:
-
-“Who is yer, cuss yer?”
-
-“A government officer on the track of gold boomers, four of whom we
-have just roped in, for there lie your pards Tom and Rocks, in as bad
-way as you are.”
-
-“Is this one all secure?”
-
-“You bet he is, Massa Buf’ler Bill.”
-
-“Buffalo Bill! That means we hang, Jim!” cried Alex Sands, in bitter
-tones.
-
-“So you are Buffalo Bill, is yer?” asked Jim Sims.
-
-“Yes; anything else I can do for you?” The scout naturally felt
-elated over his successful capture without firing a shot or having
-taken a life.
-
-“No, cuss yer, yer hev done too much.”
-
-“We’ll take the gags out of the fellows’ mouths now, as we have these
-two secure,” and, going over to the bunks, the two gags were removed,
-water was handed the men, and the four were at liberty to talk
-together, as soon as all four were secured in bunks for the night.
-
-Then Buffalo Bill and the negro went to care for the horses, and a
-good grass plot was found down the cañon, where the animals were
-staked out.
-
-The two packsaddles were well filled with supplies, and two of the
-other horses had bridles and saddles on them for the use of the men
-who were to ride them back to civilization when the gold boomers
-returned with their riches.
-
-From the conversation of the four, Buffalo Bill soon gleamed that
-the two had had a hard time of it going through on foot, but had
-reached Helena at last, and, after a long rest, had bought horses
-and supplies, and, watching their chance, had started back again
-for the Big Horn Basin for their pards, and cheered by the riches
-they would become possessors of and going to bring back with them to
-civilization.
-
-The firelight showed Buffalo Bill that the two men had hard faces,
-about on a par with his first two prisoners, and he knew that it
-would not do to leave them alone, bound as they were, with Black
-Bill, until the negro felt wholly himself again, and so he said:
-
-“Now, we will turn in, Black Bill, and get a good night’s rest, and
-to-morrow I’ll go after the boys and bring them over here, for this
-seems to be about the end of our trail.”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXVIII.
-
- A LIVING TOMB.
-
-
-When morning dawned, the scout and the giant black were on their feet.
-
-The latter said that he was all right, only his head was sore and
-felt twice as heavy as usual.
-
-The prisoners were taken out of the bunks in the cabin and tied to
-trees near the outside fire, where breakfast was put on by the negro,
-while the scout went to lead the horses to water and to change them
-to a fresh grazing ground.
-
-This was accomplished by the time the guide had breakfast done, and,
-as the chief came up, he found the prisoners talking earnestly with
-the black, who called out:
-
-“Massa Bill, what you think dese bad gemmens want me to do just now?”
-
-“Kill me, I suppose, and set them free.”
-
-“Lordy, Massa Bill, you read minds same as you does a book.”
-
-“It does not require much mind-reading to know that they offered you
-big money to turn against me.”
-
-“That’s just what they did do, sah; offer to give me half de gold dey
-have got ter set ’em free and let ’em kill you.”
-
-“They didn’t know you, Black Bill. But I don’t blame them, for
-killing is their trade, and they naturally wish to go free. Come,
-men, and we’ll have breakfast,” said the scout, with no show of
-resentment toward his prisoners.
-
-The meal over with, Buffalo Bill decided to start at once for the
-scout’s camp, leaving Black Bill to guard the four prisoners, who
-were greatly cast down at their failure to bribe the negro to allow
-them to go free, and which they could only do by putting the chief
-out of the way.
-
-They had, indeed, offered him half the gold that they had, and said
-he could accompany them on their way.
-
-That the guide would prove false to him Buffalo Bill did not for a
-moment believe, and he called him aside and said:
-
-“Last night I would not leave you alone, with those fellows, black
-pard, for I was not just sure how that head of yours would pan out
-after that wound, and feared they might best you. But now you are all
-right, and I will go to our camp after the boys.
-
-“You keep your eyes upon these men, for they are as tricky as snakes,
-and bound as they are, they are four, you one, and they may find some
-way of getting the best of you should you be off your guard for a
-moment.”
-
-So saying, he shouldered his rifle, and started off for the scout’s
-camp. He had not gone very far before he saw two men approaching. At
-a glance he recognized Sergeant Buck and a soldier.
-
-They saw him about the same time, and gave a shout of joy.
-
-“We are after you, chief, for, as you did not put in an appearance
-last night we got anxious about you.”
-
-“Where’s the black giant?” called out Sergeant Buck.
-
-“Safe, but by a miracle only, for he got a wound that was a very
-close call.”
-
-“Fell on the rocks, sir, I suppose?”
-
-“No, he was shot.”
-
-Then Buffalo Bill told of the discovery so far made, and the capture
-of the gold boomers, and learning that the scouts were scattered in
-search of him, he said:
-
-“You return, sergeant, and bring the outfit here, for I will have
-some one down the valley to meet you. If the boys do not come in
-until night, come to-morrow, and Ben will go with me now, and see if
-we cannot make further discoveries.”
-
-Sergeant Buck at once set off on the return trail, and Buffalo Bill
-and Ben went back down the valley.
-
-As the break in the cliff was reached Buffalo Bill led the way up the
-steep hillside, and the two continued on through the narrow pass.
-
-Buffalo Bill had an idea that he would make some discovery by going
-through that pass that severed the range.
-
-As they drew near the farther end, they could see through the opening
-that a large valley lay far below them, a thousand or more feet.
-
-The pass had narrowed to less than a hundred feet, and arose in solid
-walls of rock far above them.
-
-When within a short distance of the end, Buffalo Bill halted suddenly
-and cried:
-
-“See there, Ben!”
-
-“This end of the pass has been blasted out with powder.”
-
-“That is just what it was, Ben, and--we have found it--see? The Lost
-Valley lies before us!”
-
-The chief of scouts, since his meeting with the black giant, almost
-used up by starvation and wounds, had had his mind set on the
-penned-up settlers in the Lost Valley. He had given his pledge to the
-negro to answer the call upon him for aid, to go with him on what
-to other men would have seemed an aimless trail. He had pushed on
-against all dangers, all obstacles, and his intention was to triumph.
-
-There before him was the Lost Valley.
-
-It was no wonder that a triumphant smile hovered about the mouth of
-Buffalo Bill and his dark eyes glowed with joy. He had come to the
-end of the long and perilous trail.
-
-Where they stood, beneath their feet, and all around them, the rocks
-were blackened with powder. There had been a heavy blast there, as
-they could see. And that blast of powder had shattered the cliff, and
-hurled a small mountain of rock down into the valley far below.
-
-It had broken off the edge of the cliff right at the end of the pass
-most abruptly.
-
-Right beneath their feet the cliff broke off and went downward almost
-like an artificial wall for a thousand feet or more.
-
-The two scouts advanced to the edge and their eyes became riveted in
-wonder at what they beheld.
-
-Below them was a valley, or, rather, a basin, for it was surrounded
-on every side by towering cliffs. No break could be seen anywhere, no
-cañon pushing into the surrounding wall of rock.
-
-It was not a valley surrounded by mountain ranges, but a valley
-completely encircled by cliffs rising one thousand feet.
-
-But that was not all, for right in its center was a large lake, with
-wooded shores.
-
-Around the lake, in the timber, were scattered a score of cabins. A
-herd of cattle, horses, and mules were there, too. A group of wagons
-were in one place. Men, women, and children were also visible.
-
-The crowing of a rooster was heard down in the valley, and a flock of
-sheep was feeding right beneath the cliff on which the scouts were
-standing.
-
-For a long time Buffalo Bill gazed through his field glass at the
-strange sight, and then without a word handed it to Scout Ben.
-
-He, too, looked long and attentively, and when he removed the glasses
-from his eyes Buffalo Bill said:
-
-“How to get down there is the question.”
-
-“There must be some way, sah.”
-
-“I can discover no break anywhere in the walls. We must start those
-people out pretty soon, for it will be slow traveling with a wagon
-train, and we must not be caught on the way. Come, we will go after
-Black Bill.”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXIX.
-
- THE RESCUE.
-
-
-Black Bill, revolver in hand, lay on the pine straw, guarding his
-prisoners, who were tied to trees in front of him.
-
-Neither the negro nor his prisoners heard the scout approaching, but
-the latter heard Rocks saying:
-
-“See here, nigger, don’t you be fool enough to think all four of us
-is goin’ ter hang, and that one of us won’t git away, and that we
-will kill you sure as the sun shines if you don’t let us go.
-
-“That fool, Buffalo Bill, has gone off trustin’ you, and our horses
-ain’t far away, so we can all pack some provisions on, load up with
-gold, and be far away afore he comes back.
-
-“As you say you are all on foot, ther scouts kin never catch us, and
-you’ll git gold enough to last you all your days as a rich man.”
-
-“I’d ruther be a poor honest man than a rich one what had betrayed
-the gemman I owes my life to more than one time.
-
-“You gemmen is as bad as you kin be, and I’m onter your whole game
-now, though them in the valley don’t know it.
-
-“When dey does, your necks won’t be worth nothin’, I is a-thinkin’,
-gemmens.”
-
-“Good for you, black pard.”
-
-The negro sprang to his feet, and was face to face with Buffalo Bill
-and Ben. The four prisoners scowled and muttered curses.
-
-“Well, Black Bill, we have found your valley.”
-
-“Done found it, Massa Bill?”
-
-“Yes, we went through the break in the cliff where you so nearly lost
-your life yesterday.
-
-“I have sent to our camp after the boys; but it must have been a very
-hard and dangerous task, from what I have seen of the descent, to get
-that train down into that sunken valley, a very Devil’s Den I would
-call it.”
-
-“De pass led through and down de side of de cliff, sah. It were
-mighty dangerous fer wagons, sah, but all right for de people ter
-walk.
-
-“Saturday nights dey all went down in de valley ober Sunday.
-
-“One Saturday, Massa Bill, all went but four men--here dey is, right
-here now.
-
-“Dey had been working on de cliff road, blastin’ it out wid powder,
-for we brought our wagons along, with plenty of powder, sah.
-
-“Just at sunset dere came what we all thought was a ’arthquake or
-volcano, and de whole front of de cliff fell into de valley. Dere was
-rocks and fire and smoke go way up inter de air, and three people in
-de valley was kilt dead.
-
-“When dey all got deir senses de next day, Sunday, dey came to de
-conclusion dat de four men, dese very gemmens here, hab let de powder
-git on fire and blew up de cliff and dem, too.
-
-“But I now know dat dese gemmens blowed up dat cliff on purposse,
-sah, dat dey might git all de gold what was found in de cañon and
-keep it. But, Massa Bill, dem poor people in de valley was same as in
-jail, for dey couldn’t git out.”
-
-“These four men did prepare that powder mine to blow off the edge of
-that cliff and keep those people in the valley, which you call lost,
-and they were a lost people as well.”
-
-Standing on the very edge of the precipice, Buffalo Bill began to
-watch the cliffsides with his glass.
-
-“Try and make them see you, Bill,” said the scout.
-
-The negro fired his rifle, and gave a loud halloo.
-
-Many faces were upturned at once, women and children were seen
-running here and there, and a wild cheer arose as the negro was
-recognized.
-
-The scene was a startling one, for the people in the valley were wild
-with joy.
-
-Writing with a pencil upon several pages of his notebook, Buffalo
-Bill put them in his handkerchief, wrapped it around a large stone,
-and tossed it down into the valley. There was a wild rush for it at
-once.
-
-“I told them that we were here, planning to get them out of their
-valley.
-
-“That I had noticed that the winding trail along the face of the
-cliff had been blocked up where the rocks had fallen below, and also
-that it would readily be reached by lariats from here, and we would
-find a way to rescue them.”
-
-“You’ll do it, Massa Bill, and I kin see now, sah, dat a few lariats
-tied together will reach de old trail yonder.”
-
-“We can blast the rocks out that fell and choked up the trail, and we
-can bring that whole outfit out of that valley, though it may take us
-a week, perhaps longer, to do so.
-
-“I will write them what to do.”
-
-Another note was written and thrown down as before.
-
-Captain John Hill himself picked it up, and his voice reached those
-on the cliff:
-
-“God bless you, Buffalo Bill.”
-
-“If you will spare us some powder, we can blast this end clear.”
-
-“There is another pass farther along, which you can blast out down to
-the trail.”
-
-“Good!”
-
-“We will begin work to-morrow, for all my men will be here then,” was
-shouted back in the clear tones of Buffalo Bill, and a great cheer
-told him he had been heard, and hope filled every heart.
-
-Within one week the scouts slept in the valley, and the next morning
-all hands went to work repairing wagons, harness, and shoeing the
-horses and mules, while preparations were made by the women for
-leaving the place, which had so long been to them a living tomb.
-
-Just two weeks after the arrival of the scouts, the march was begun.
-
-One wagon at a time was taken up the ledge trail; the women and
-children followed, then the extra horses, and next the cattle, sheep,
-and all that could be carried along.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXX.
-
- OUT OF DEVIL’S DEN.
-
-
-The march from the Devil’s Den, as Buffalo Bill called the sunken
-valley, was a long one and slow, with wagons, stock and all on the
-move, for chasms had to be bridged. Ten miles a day was a fair rate
-of travel at first.
-
-Buffalo Bill led the way by the spot where Don Miller’s gold had been
-buried, and this was recovered.
-
-In fairly good time Fort Aspen was reached.
-
-When nearing the fort, Buffalo Bill appointed Don Miller as guide to
-the wagon train, and, with his black scouts, he started on a secret
-expedition.
-
-The chief of scouts had a certain object in view, and he wished each
-one of his men to share the honor with him, if the expedition proved
-to be the success he hoped it would.
-
-Of course, Black Bill also went along, for he had become the very
-shadow of Buffalo Bill, and was the hero of the whole band of black
-scouts.
-
-The object of Buffalo Bill was to capture Ginger Sam, whom he felt
-sure he would find at his cabin in winter quarters.
-
-At night the cabin was reached and quietly surrounded, and at
-daylight, when the cabin door was opened by Ginger Sam, he looked
-squarely into the muzzle of Buffalo Bill’s revolver.
-
-Up went his hands and he said:
-
-“Waal, you wins ther game.”
-
-“I will, when I play my last card, Ginger Sam.”
-
-“What are that?”
-
-“A rope,” was the significant reply.
-
-“You don’t intend ter hang me?”
-
-“Yes, with four more of your kind I found in the Big Horn and whom
-Major Armes will make short work of, as he will you, and that will
-about clear this country of such cattle as you. I knew you were bad
-as they make ’em, but I have a friend who knows you to be a renegade
-and the secret instigator of half the Indian deviltry done here. I
-refer to Don Miller, whom the Indians captured, and understanding
-Sioux well, he asked about you, as he thought you might get them not
-to kill him, for once he had saved your life. But get your traps
-ready, for after breakfast we start for the fort.”
-
-The next afternoon Buffalo Bill, his black scouts, and his prisoner
-reached Fort Aspen, and the welcome the garrison gave them, and also
-the rescued settlers, for they had arrived the day before, was enough
-to repay the men all the hardships they had endured.
-
-“Another one to hang, Cody?”
-
-“Well, he’s a little late, for the other four were hanged this
-morning; but it is never too late to do a good act, and there has
-been a price on that man’s head for a long time.
-
-“Yes, the four wretches who proved such traitors to the settlers, I
-had tried at once, and they were quickly sentenced, and to-morrow
-this man’s life shall end, for white outlaws must expect no mercy
-here.
-
-“But, Cody, let me thank you for your splendid services in behalf of
-Fort Aspen and its garrison, and believe me, a full report of what
-you have done shall go to headquarters without delay.”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXXI.
-
- ANOTHER STRANGE STORY.
-
-
-About a week later, Cody returned to Fort Advance one night from
-a lone expedition, just as all the garrison were looking upon him
-as dead, believing that he had at last met the doom so many had
-predicted he would, and wondering why he had not long before done so.
-
-“Corporal of the guard! Cody is returning,” repeated the sentinel, as
-he recognized a horseman coming at a lope over the plain.
-
-And such a cheer as went up at the words of the sentinel was seldom
-heard, for that Buffalo Bill had discounted all predictions and again
-proved his title to “bearing a charmed life,” was a joy to one and
-all in the fort.
-
-He looked worn and haggard, and his horse was gaunt and weary, as
-they passed in through the stockade; but the greeting was a grand one.
-
-Even Colonel Carr had begun to regard the scout as dead, for many
-anxious days had passed since he had left the post on his recent
-mission.
-
-Straight to headquarters he rode, dismounted, turned his horse loose
-to go to the stable, and was met by Colonel Carr on the piazza, so
-glad was that officer to welcome the great scout back again.
-
-“Come in, Cody, and I feel as though I was welcoming you back almost
-from the grave.”
-
-“Not so bad as that, colonel, though I have been on a long trail, and
-a strange one, sir.”
-
-“I do not doubt it--you show it in your face, and I was sorry that I
-allowed you to go on the search.”
-
-“And I am glad that I went, sir, for I found the secret valley, and
-I discovered enough to know that the inhabitants need looking after.
-But I have a new plan to submit to you, sir. I’ve found a mystery
-that must be uncovered.”
-
-“Well, tell me about your trip.”
-
-“I went on the trail, after leaving Fort Aspen, which a Mexican who
-died there told me to take, and it led me into a country seldom
-traveled, down in the land of an old deserted fort, Rosal.
-
-“I struck the Rosal range and found there a large lake in a most
-beautiful valley, situated by itself, for all approaches to it are
-desert lands, beyond which no one would suspect to find a garden spot
-of beauty.”
-
-“Yes, I have heard only indirectly of such a country there, but not
-that it was settled.”
-
-“Well, it is settled, as you shall hear:
-
-“The valley is beautiful, fertile, the surroundings well timbered,
-grass abundant, and there is a large, deep lake of clear and icy
-water.
-
-“I was surprised, I can tell you, sir, when I saw it, and yet my
-suspicions were only beginning with the first view from the range
-summit.
-
-“But first, sir, two days ago I ran upon an adventure and a strange
-one.
-
-“As I began to enter the unknown and beautiful lake land, I came
-unexpectedly upon what had been once the home, doubtless, of some old
-Spanish or Mexican don; but it was in ruins, almost, and seemed to
-have been long deserted.
-
-“Halting to gaze at it, I was startled to hear voices, the first I
-had heard for days, and in English.
-
-“There was a shot, a cry in a woman’s voice, oaths in Mexican, and I
-knew that some one was in trouble, so I rode to the rescue.
-
-“It didn’t last long, for I saw a man in Mexican uniform lying on the
-ground, a young girl near him, their horses close by, and they had
-been held up by several outlaws.
-
-“One I dropped, the others skipped, and I found I had rescued a
-Mexican officer and the young girl, who, while on a ride had been
-attacked by road agents, who had not expected help near.
-
-“A glancing shot on the head had stunned the officer, knocking him
-from his saddle.
-
-“As the men dashed off and escaped me, for I didn’t press them close,
-I admit, there being more than I wanted, one called out: ‘I’ll
-remember you for this, Buffalo Bill.’”
-
-“This showed that he knew you.”
-
-“Yes, sir.”
-
-“But go on with your strange story.”
-
-“In a few words, sir, the officer had revived, and from the young
-girl I learned that she lived some distance away, and the outlaws had
-sought to force from her some secret, what I did not know, and, as I
-felt that the villains believed I had help near, and finding out that
-I had not would return, I urged a quick movement to a place of safety.
-
-“The girl and the officer quickly mounted, the latter still half
-dazed from his wound, and I told them I would remain behind to check
-pursuit and then follow upon their trail.
-
-“I did remain for a while, then left, but I stuck to the trail I had
-been traveling, thinking that they might think there was a crowd if I
-followed the girl and the officer.
-
-“As I rode along I suddenly spied a glittering object on the ground,
-and picking it up I was surprised to find that it was a bracelet
-studded with gems. I will show it to you later, for I have it.
-
-“Feeling sure that the lady had dropped it, I retraced my steps and
-picked up their trail, only to lose it, and I am certain that they
-covered up their tracks to throw me off the track.
-
-“Search as I might, I could not pick up the trail of the officer and
-the girl, so I gave it up at last and went on to the valley, to halt
-at a fine ranch I came upon and there ask hospitality.
-
-“But to tell you first of this strange valley and its people.
-
-“The settlement numbers a thousand people, is an adobe village, and
-the dwellers there are Mexicans, with a mixture of Americans and
-Indians.
-
-“From Silver Lake’s settlement the ranches branch out in the valley,
-and there are some fine haciendas among them, the rancheros being
-rich in cattle and horses, and a mixture of Americans and Mexicans of
-the better class.”
-
-“You surprise me, Cody, and interest me greatly,” said Colonel Carr.
-
-“I was greatly surprised and interested myself, sir, during the two
-days and nights I was in the valley.
-
-“All seems peaceful there, too, and yet upon that valley rests
-a cruel curse, for it is under a ban of outlawry that is most
-mysterious, and the more terrible because the actors are unseen,
-unknown, and therefore secret foes.
-
-“Upon this strange community hangs my mission of duty that I ask to
-go upon.”
-
-“Well?”
-
-“I was struck with the beauty of the valley, the apparent wealth
-of the rancheros, and where I stopped was the home of an American,
-who was half Mexican, for he had had a Texan for his father, who
-had married a lady of Mexico. He received me with the greatest
-hospitality, and we became so friendly that he told me that night, as
-we sat together, of the ban upon the fair valley.
-
-“I questioned him closely, for I wished to know all that I could
-discover, and he made known, though with considerable dread at doing
-so, that the curse upon the community was from the deeds of a secret
-foe or rather foes. Who that foe was no one could tell, and yet he
-was most in evidence at every ranch in the valley, upon which he
-levied tribute or blood money, I may say, and got it.”
-
-“But how did he do this?”
-
-“By a placard stuck on the gate of a ranch house, or hacienda,
-demanding a certain sum to be placed in a designated spot on a day or
-night named, under the penalty, if refused, of a death in the family.”
-
-“This must be looked to, Cody.”
-
-“That is just what I am after, colonel.”
-
-“But why do not the rancheros have the nerve to put this unseen
-robber to the test?”
-
-“They have, sir, and to their bitter cost.”
-
-“He has carried out his threats, then?”
-
-“He has, sir, promptly and without mercy, and that is why they no
-longer refuse the demands upon them.”
-
-“I can hardly wonder at it, when an unseen foe strikes at those they
-love.”
-
-“He does more, sir, for he has taken from each home a hostage,
-keeping them comfortably, as they are allowed to write home, but
-holding them against refusal of his demands, and threatens to thus
-keep them until he gains the purpose for which he is striving, a
-certain amount of money, I take it, sir.”
-
-“There is no doubt of it, and it is a novel way of gaining his ends;
-but still I believe he can be checkmated.”
-
-“I feel confident of it, sir, and for that reason I wish your
-permission to go to that valley and solve that mystery, hunt down
-that unseen and unknown foe.
-
-“You know that Scout Texas Jack brought with him a dozen Texans as
-scouts, and they are all saddle sharps, superb lassoists, dead shots,
-speak Spanish more or less fluently, and are utterly fearless.”
-
-“They are all that you say, Cody.”
-
-“Now, colonel, I wish to take Texas Jack and his Texans and go to
-that valley and take possession of a deserted hacienda I saw there
-and turn ranchero, buying cattle and horses, and establishing myself
-there for the one purpose of discovering the daring leader who thus
-threatens, robs, and persecutes these people, and I am sure, sir,
-that I can unearth a mystery that will fully compensate for our
-time.”
-
-“Cody, you can go, and take the men you ask for. You have been there,
-understand the situation, and know what you are doing, so I leave all
-to you.”
-
-“Now, colonel, as the owner of this bracelet dodged me, beyond all
-doubt, I have it to return to her and will do so. Here it is, sir.”
-
-“Why, it is worth a small fortune, Cody,” said the colonel, gazing
-earnestly at the handsome bracelet.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXXII.
-
- UNDER A CURSE.
-
-
-Buffalo Bill went on to tell how hard he had tried to find the owner
-of the bracelet, and what he considered proof that she and the
-wounded Mexican officer had covered up their tracks.
-
-“I gave that deserted ranch a close call, sir,” resumed the scout,
-“for I was interested in it, and it was really a grand old ruin,
-avoided, as I found out later, by all, and feared, for it is known as
-the Haunted Hacienda, and the believers in ghosts all are sure that
-it is the haunt of evil spirits.
-
-“I took it all in and made up my mind that it would be valuable for
-me to haunt when I returned to the valley with the force I was going
-to ask you to let me have, and which you have kindly given me.
-
-“I rode on up the valley to the settlement of Silver Lake City
-without meeting a soul.
-
-“That city, as they call it, is beautifully situated, and is composed
-of adobe houses, the people seeming to have very little to do. Some
-mine in the mountains, others of the men are cowboys on the ranches
-down the valley, there are several stores, saloons, and a blacksmith
-shop or two, with an old mission chapel and a priest. There is a
-halfway inn there, and if the landlord is not a villain, then his
-looks belie him.
-
-“I told him I was looking for a ranch, and he told me there was none
-for sale.
-
-“I asked him about the deserted hacienda, and he said that no one
-would live there, as it was haunted by evil spirits, and he either
-believed it, or could lie with as straight a face as I ever saw.
-
-“He said the place belonged to some one in Mexico, who had inherited
-it; that every one who had last lived there had died overnight, from
-what cause no one knew, for there were no signs of violence upon
-them, but all were found dead in the morning, as also every horse,
-cow, sheep, and dog in the walled-in place.”
-
-“This is a remarkable story, Cody.”
-
-“Yes, but he told it as the truth, and there stands the deserted
-hacienda, with the graves, thirty-three in number, in one corner of
-the grounds.
-
-“I asked the landlord as much as I dared, to try and find out who the
-maiden and the Mexican officer were. From what I could learn from
-him, if the one I rescued was the one he had in mind, the young lady
-is known as Suelo, the Recluse. She is the daughter of a Mexican
-nobleman, I heard, but lives alone at her hacienda, which is a fine
-one, with only her servants and a score of Mexican cattlemen, and all
-appear to worship her.
-
-“But no one in the valley knows much about her, the landlord said,
-and who the Mexican officer was he did not know.
-
-“I did not tell him I had rescued them, but merely said I had met
-them, and her beauty and his fine looks and uniform impressed me.
-
-“I called upon the priest, but he was absent, and so I determined to
-bring the bracelet on with me, and when I go back I shall look up the
-owner, and then, sir, I shall take the deserted hacienda as my ranch.”
-
-“Well, Cody, you are the best judge of just what to do; but I assure
-you I will not only be anxious about you, but will watch the result
-with great interest. If you need aid I will give you letters to the
-nearest posts, so you will be able to call on them for what men you
-may wish.”
-
-“Thank you, sir. My idea was to stop at the government corrals on
-my way down--for you know they send the cattle southward to feed in
-winter--and borrow a lot of steers and horses to drive to my ranch
-and care for, thus carrying out the idea that I had gone to the
-valley to settle and make it my home.
-
-“I shall tell the priest that I will pay rent when the owner demands
-it, and thus keep my taking possession of the deserted ranch from
-appearing a lawless act.”
-
-“It would be a good idea. Come to me when you are ready to start,
-and I will give you all letters necessary to have you carry out your
-plans,” said the commandant, and Buffalo Bill departed, to prepare
-for his latest mission.
-
-All the garrison at the fort wondered what was going on when they saw
-Buffalo Bill ride away from the post at the head of fourteen of the
-best scouts, most daring Indian fighters, and wildest riders on the
-frontier.
-
-Men and horses had been picked for a purpose, it could be plainly
-seen. They had extra animals along, and half a dozen pack mules, well
-loaded with a camp outfit, provisions, and ammunition.
-
-Those that saw them waiting for the start beheld Texas Jack, the
-noted ranger scout from the Lone Star State, and next in rank to
-Buffalo Bill at the post.
-
-“Where are you going, Jack?” asked an officer of cavalry, passing the
-squad of wild riders.
-
-“Don’t know, sir. Got orders to get ready for a long trail, and am
-prepared for a fight, foot race, or siege, sir.”
-
-“I have not heard of any news that causes Colonel Carr to send out
-Cody and his picked saddle sharps,” continued the officer.
-
-“Nor have I, sir.”
-
-“Have none of the men an idea?”
-
-“Not one, sir, and we are waiting for Cody, now, for he has gone to
-the colonel for last orders.”
-
-As Texas Jack spoke, Buffalo Bill appeared, coming from the
-colonel’s quarters. He was splendidly mounted and armed.
-
-“Which way, Cody?” asked the major of the post.
-
-“Southward on a scout, major,” was Buffalo Bill’s reply, and,
-saluting, he rode to the head of the line, and gave the order to
-march.
-
-The scouts obeyed, following in two files, Texas Jack at the head of
-one, Winfield leading the other, while two men brought up the rear,
-to keep the pack-mules closed up.
-
-That the band of wild riders were curious about their going, was
-certain; but not a hint came from their chief, and not a man dared to
-question him.
-
-The start had been made after dinner, and after a ride of twenty-five
-miles a halt was made for the night.
-
-The next day forty miles were placed behind them, and the scouts knew
-that the chief had started upon a long journey.
-
-So it went on for day after day, from forty to fifty miles being
-made, the cattle being well cared for, with long noonday halts, until
-the chief of scouts bore toward the right, into a land that was
-unknown to his followers.
-
-“We will leave Santa Fe well to our left,” said Texas Jack to
-Winfield one day.
-
-“Yes, but why does not the chief give us a hint of where we are
-going?”
-
-“He will, in good time.”
-
-“Oh, yes; but it is an important trail, I feel sure, and connected
-with his trip southward which he has just returned from.”
-
-“No doubt it is; but the government cattle corrals must be in this
-course.”
-
-“Yes, and I believe we are going after cattle; but to-morrow will
-tell, as the corrals and grazing grounds are on the headwaters of the
-San Juan, and that is the way we are pointed now, and we must reach
-there before two more camps.”
-
-The same style of conversation and guesswork the other scouts
-indulged in, and still the chief said nothing as to their
-destination, and all decided that it was to the corrals to drive back
-cattle.
-
-But that night, when they went into camp, Buffalo Bill said, after
-all had had supper:
-
-“Pards, I have had nothing to say as to our mission, as there was
-little to tell you. But, as we strike the government corrals at noon
-to-morrow, I wish to say that we are to get there a large herd of
-cattle, and a band of a hundred or more horses.”
-
-“Yes, we supposed that was what we were going for, chief,” said Texas
-Jack.
-
-Buffalo Bill smiled, and replied:
-
-“Colonel Carr thought it best for me not to tell you my purpose until
-we neared the corrals, and then, if any of you wished to back out,
-you could remain there, and I could find other men in your places;
-but I think I picked those men who will stand by me.”
-
-“Just try us!” cried Texas Jack, and the other men all cried out in
-the same vein.
-
-“Now, though we are going to get cattle and horses, we drive them
-south instead of north, and I tell you plainly that we are going to
-a pleasant valley where I am to turn ranchero, and you are to be my
-cattlemen.
-
-“That I do this for other motives than posing as a ranchero, you may
-all be certain, and that there will be hot work ahead of us I feel
-very confident.
-
-“Does any man wish to remain at the corrals?”
-
-The response to this question of Buffalo Bill was so earnest that he
-knew he had nothing to fear from any one of his riders.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXXIII.
-
- THE HACIENDA.
-
-
-After an uneventful journey, Buffalo Bill rode up to the little inn
-where he had before halted, and was greeted by the same Mexican
-landlord, whom he had not particularly fancied.
-
-Speaking English well, the landlord recognized the handsome scout,
-and said in a way that was meant to be hospitable, but which was full
-of curiosity:
-
-“Ah, señor, you again come this way--is your stay to be short, as
-before?”
-
-“On the contrary, Señor Riel, I am here to stay.”
-
-“Ah, señor! you like the Silver Lake Valley, then?”
-
-“Very much.”
-
-“You are a gambler, perhaps, señor, or you have no business?”
-
-“Oh, no, I am a ranchero, and have come to settle down the valley,
-near the lake.”
-
-“You amaze me, señor, for there is no ranch to sell there.”
-
-“There is one unoccupied, and may be for sale. I shall take
-possession of it, herd my cattle in the surrounding country, and,
-when the owner appears, will pay him what is just. Now, tell me,
-Señor Riel, if the padre is at home---- Oh, I see him there now,” and
-Buffalo Bill walked rapidly away to where a small, dark-faced man
-was standing, dressed as a Mexican priest.
-
-“The Padre Juan, I believe?” he asked politely.
-
-“Yes, my son, but I know you not.”
-
-“No; I am an American, and once passing through this valley, decided
-to find a home here. I called upon you, but you were away from home,
-and I have just arrived to settle here.”
-
-“How can I serve you, señor?”
-
-“I have some miles away my cattle and horses, and my destination is
-the old deserted hacienda down the valley on the lake. I would ask
-you if you can place me in communication with the owner?”
-
-“I cannot, my son, for the one who fell heir to that truly accursed
-place is a stranger, and was never here. It is a blot upon the
-valley, and will be a home of ill omen should you dwell there, which
-Heaven forbid.”
-
-“I thank you, padre, but my men and cattle are near, and to-morrow
-night I will take possession of the ill-omened place, as you call it,
-with the pledge to you to pay what is right for its use. As we are
-all men, we need but little household furniture, and that I can buy
-at your stores here in Silver Lake City.”
-
-“But, my son, let me tell you that this whole valley is under a
-curse, and if you remain here, especially within that dreary hacienda
-with its record of death, you but become another upon whom suffering
-must fall.”
-
-“I will take all chances, padre, and as the deserted hacienda is to
-be my home, let me say that I will be happy to entertain you there
-whenever you pass that way.”
-
-“Thank you, señor, thank you, but only in case duty called me would I
-cross the threshold of that house, for it is haunted by the crudest
-of memories, if not worse. I wish you well, señor, but I have warned
-you--it was my duty.”
-
-Returning to the landlord of the little adobe tavern, Buffalo Bill
-told him that he wished to make some purchases, and to get a wagon to
-take them to the deserted hacienda.
-
-“You will go there, then, señor?”
-
-“Oh, yes.”
-
-“You do not heed the warnings, then?”
-
-“I am not superstitious, and so warnings of imaginary evils have no
-dread for me; but, if warned of a real danger, I heed, as I flatter
-myself that I am no fool.”
-
-The landlord shook his head; and then said he would furnish the means
-of transportation for what the señor cared to purchase, and he would
-take him to the best places at which to buy them.
-
-The purchases were soon made, loaded in a wagon, and started upon the
-way for the hacienda, the scout, after having dinner at the tavern,
-starting on after the men, for they were already well on their way
-to the new home of Buffalo Bill in the mysterious valley.
-
-The wagon was soon overtaken, and afterward the herd, and Buffalo
-Bill said:
-
-“We now camp, pards, and to-morrow early we go into our home.”
-
-The night halt was made, an early start followed the next morning,
-and before noon the cattle were halted upon the rich meadowland on
-either side the lake, several scouts left to guard them, while the
-rest rode on after their chief, who had gone on ahead to the hacienda.
-
-“If that is not an owl’s roost I’m mistaken,” said one.
-
-“It may be an outlaws’ retreat.”
-
-“The place may be haunted.”
-
-Some laughed, some did not, others looked grave, and said nothing.
-The superstitions of a few had been aroused.
-
-But into the walled-in plaza rode the scouts, followed by the wagon,
-and there stood Buffalo Bill, but his left sleeve was stained with
-blood, his face had a bruise upon it, and he had the appearance of
-one who had been in a terrible struggle.
-
-“Boys,” he said calmly, “make yourselves at home, for I am master
-here.”
-
-Telling Texas Jack where to halt the cattle and horses, to have a
-guard of several men over them, and then come on with the others and
-the wagon and animals.
-
-The chief of scouts had cantered on alone to the hacienda.
-
-As he approached it, he saw that all appeared there as he had left it
-a month before.
-
-To him it looked as though no one had visited the place, and he saw
-not even a skulking coyote. This put him on his guard, for he knew
-that when he had visited the place first many coyotes had run out.
-Now, having found none about, he at once concluded that some one
-had been there within the last few minutes. So he was on his guard.
-Leaving his horse in the grounds, he entered the hacienda.
-
-It was a large structure, one story in height, built of adobe, and in
-the center was a square towerlike structure, with a top that looked
-very much as though the whole space within the walls, several acres
-in area, could be swept by even revolvers in the hands of persons
-stationed there on the tower roof. In the rear was a lofty cliff. It
-commanded, too, a wide range with rifles, and that it was intended
-for a stronghold there was no doubt in the scout’s mind.
-
-There were about thirty rooms in the building, some furnished with
-chairs and bedsteads, but of all else the place had been swept clean.
-
-Selecting the rooms that were to be their quarters, and being glad
-to see that the place within the walls would readily hold all their
-horses and cattle in an emergency when the entrance was repaired,
-Buffalo Bill was passing out through a long and dimly lighted
-corridor, when he beheld before him what appeared to be two diamonds
-glittering in the half darkness.
-
-But he was not deceived, he had seen just such balls of fire often
-before in his eventful life, and he was as quick as a flash in
-dropping his hand upon a weapon in his belt.
-
-It was his knife, and he had just time to draw it and raise the
-point, when, with a savage growl there sprang upon him a huge
-mountain lion.
-
-The weight of the animal hurled Buffalo Bill backward, and he fell
-against the rough wall with considerable force, bruising his face
-badly, while he also felt the teeth of the mad animal buried in his
-arm.
-
-But he had got his knife on guard, and the long, sharp blade had cut
-into the heart of the lion, the force of the spring driving it to the
-hilt.
-
-Half dazed by the fall against the wall and the blow of the huge body
-against him, Buffalo Bill yet recognized that he must cut, and once
-more he drove his knife deep into the shaggy hide.
-
-But to his joy he recognized that there was no need of his doing
-more, for the animal upon him was a dead weight, the first knife
-thrust had entered his heart, and the teeth that had been driven into
-the scout’s arm had not been closed upon it, for the mountain lion
-had sprung to a quick and sudden death, the keen blade catching, by
-an accident, just in the right spot to kill.
-
-Throwing off the weight, Buffalo Bill arose to his feet.
-
-Was it from the concussion that he had received that made strange
-figures appear before his eyes, or did he really behold a ghostly
-form, clad in white, at the end of the long, dark corridor, one arm
-pointing straight outward, the other down at the ground.
-
-“I’ll tackle you, too, for ghosts are more to my liking than mountain
-lions,” said Buffalo Bill grimly, and he rubbed his eyes to see that
-they were not deceiving him, and, drawing his revolver now he rushed
-forward to grapple with this new foe.
-
-But then, as he felt that it was no vision of the brain, but in
-reality a ghostly looking form, not fifty feet from him, he halted
-and called out in a voice that echoed through the corridor:
-
-“Hands up, there, or I’ll fire and kill you!”
-
-But the order was not obeyed, the form still standing mute and
-motionless, and pointing as before.
-
-Instantly came a red flash from the scout’s revolver, and a sharp
-report rang through the hacienda.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXXIV.
-
- HAUNTED.
-
-
-Buffalo Bill at once moved rapidly toward the spot where he had seen
-the white form. Twice he fired his revolver as he approached to light
-up the scene. But he saw nothing.
-
-The rear of the corridor had no egress, only a window some eight feet
-from the floor. Upon either side were doors, full a dozen feet from
-the end of the corridor, but one of these was closed too securely to
-open, and the other was the one he had entered the long hall from and
-led into the rooms he had selected for himself and comrades to dwell
-in.
-
-Not a particle of superstition had the scout, but here was a mystery
-he could not solve.
-
-How had the mountain lion got into that corridor? He had not entered
-by the door, for that was closed and locked on the other side. He
-could not have come through the window, even had he been able to leap
-that high, for it was closed. The other door was locked or bound on
-the other side, but to have come through that way it could only have
-been done with the aid of a human being. All the doors, save the one
-the scout had entered by, were closed. How, then, could the mountain
-lion have got into the corridor without human help, and who was the
-white-robed form at whom he fired?
-
-Lighting match after match, Buffalo Bill looked about him. He could
-discover nothing to show how the lion and the white form had entered.
-
-There lay the lion dead. The spectral visitant was gone. And yet he
-had aimed to kill, and Cody knew that he was not one to miss.
-
-Going out of the door through which he had entered, the scout closed
-it behind him, and, leaving the building, walked out into the bright
-sunlight.
-
-His sleeve was wet with blood, and he was feeling weak and a little
-shaky.
-
-But just as he was going to the brook to bathe his wounds, Texas
-Jack, Winfield, and eight of the men came at a canter into the plaza.
-
-They saw that there had been a death struggle, and he did not keep
-them waiting long to know what it was.
-
-“I have had a fight with a mountain lion I found in the hacienda,
-Jack, and killed him, fortunately, before he did me much harm. Get my
-medicine case from my saddle, and you, Stevens, see just how badly he
-bit my arm, for you are the surgeon of the outfit.”
-
-“Yes, chief,” answered Stevens, who had gone to Texas to practice
-medicine, but had devoted himself to scouting instead.
-
-The chief’s wounds were soon shown, and the marks of the teeth of the
-animal were seen below and above.
-
-“It is not nearly as bad as I would expect from the teeth of a
-mountain lion,” said Stevens, whom his comrades called “Doc.”
-
-“He must have been small,” said Winfield.
-
-“No, he was large enough. I have him in the hacienda; but that is not
-all I found, boys.”
-
-“I see that your face is bruised and head cut,” Doc Stevens said.
-“What was it, chief?”
-
-“A ghost.”
-
-Some of the men looked startled at this announcement, while others
-laughed.
-
-“Well, boys, I saw a human form, clad in white, and, as it did not
-obey my order to hands up, I fired. But I could find nothing when I
-looked for the dead body.”
-
-The words of the chief created an impression, for all knew that he
-was not in a joking humor.
-
-“The truth is, pards,” Cody went on to say, “we are not wanted in
-this valley, and I will tell you why. I had no idea that there was
-such a settlement as this in this valley, and I wish to know if you
-had ever heard of it?”
-
-“I have been through here, before, ten years ago, and it surprised
-me then, chief, but I have met no one else who knew that there was a
-settlement here. Then its people were Mexicans, Indians, negroes, and
-a few Americans.”
-
-The one who spoke was Lone Star Sam, a handsome, dashing fellow,
-reserved, courteous, whom his comrades regarded as a man with a past
-that had left its impress upon him, for he never spoke of it.
-
-“What did you find out about it, Sam?”
-
-“Very little, sir.”
-
-“What brought you here?”
-
-“I was in search of one I was anxious to find, and, hearing of this
-settlement from a Mexican officer, I came here to see if my man was
-here.”
-
-“Was he?”
-
-“He was not.”
-
-“Did you stay long at that time?”
-
-“About a month, chief.”
-
-Then Buffalo Bill told his story, and let the scouts understand what
-discovery he had made, and what Señor Otega, the ranchero down the
-valley, had made known to him, though he did not say where he had got
-the information.
-
-“Now, boys, we are here to find out where these secret outlaws are.
-They are doubtless leagued for gold alone, but revenge may play a
-part in their actions also. That they have a retreat is assured by
-their keeping their captives as hostages. Where this retreat is we
-must find out. Who they are we must know, and when we have set our
-trap we must spring it in a way that will leave escape for none. A
-dozen there may be, perhaps more, to work so well and successfully.
-
-“The landlord--Riel is his name--I do not trust, so beware of him;
-yes, and every one else, even the Padre Juan in Silver Lake, as he,
-too, may be a wolf in the garb of a sheep, though I think not. Trust
-no one, but keep your eyes and ears open, and be prepared at any time
-to fight for your lives.
-
-“I am, remember, an American ranchero, and you are my cattlemen. We
-are here to stay, you can tell the inquisitive, and secretly we are
-here to ferret out the mysteries of this valley.
-
-“The curse that rests upon it is a mystery, the secret band of
-robbers and kidnapers is another, my having met that Mexican officer
-and maiden is a third, while the masked man and his four unmasked
-followers is a fourth mystery. Then there is this deserted and
-haunted hacienda, and let me warn you that it has begun its underhand
-work already, for human hands led that mountain lion in where I found
-him, and the white-robed form I fired at was no apparition, and you
-are all too sensible to believe that such a thing could be.
-
-“Now come up and see our quarters, and get the packs off the mules
-and unload the wagon, for I wish to get lanterns, and, first of all,
-make a thorough search of the old place. Where are the two wagon
-drivers?”
-
-“Back with the men I left with the herd, for nothing would induce
-them to come any nearer to this hacienda, so one of the boys brought
-the wagon on, and when it is unloaded, will drive it back and let
-them skip, for they wish to be well on their way before night
-overtakes them, and swear they would not have come a step had the
-landlord told them where they were to take their load.”
-
-Buffalo Bill laughed at the fears of the two Mexicans who had come
-with the wagon, and Texas Jack went on to say:
-
-“And, chief, those two fellows vowed that there was not a man in the
-valley you could get to come to this hacienda, day or night.”
-
-“All right. We don’t want any to come. But we are men, and here we
-remain until I accomplish what I came for.”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXXV.
-
- THE SEARCH OF THE RUIN.
-
-
-The corridor of the hacienda was first entered through the wing the
-chief of scouts had selected for occupation, and it was seen that
-all, save the door through which he had made his entrance and exit,
-was securely fastened.
-
-Whoever it had been the chief had fired at, could only have entered
-by that single door, as far as could be seen.
-
-The rear window was opened then, and showed that it had been closed
-for a long time. So did the wide front doors, which filled almost the
-other end of the corridor. But the other doors, save that one through
-which Buffalo Bill had entered, showed plainly that they had not been
-opened for a long while.
-
-That door the chief himself had opened from within the wing, and
-yet the lion had been found in the corridor, as also had the white
-apparition, whatever it was.
-
-“Well, if a mountain lion could get in here, a ghost ought to. The
-lion was certainly not a specter brute, as I have proof,” said the
-chief, with a grim smile. “We will now look over the rest of the
-building.”
-
-And they did so, going into each wing, the chapel, and the basement
-in the solid rock beneath it, the second story, and up to the tower.
-
-This done, and finding nothing more than that it had been the haunt
-of owls and bats, the party blew out their lanterns and returned to
-the wing where their comrades had been hard at work.
-
-With water from the stream, and brooms, they had cleaned up the rooms
-well, a fire had been built in the large open chimney, the tables got
-out, chairs set around, the cooking utensils put in the fireplace,
-the bedding placed in the sleeping rooms, and in little more than
-three hours the hacienda, in that wing at least, presented a very
-comfortable appearance.
-
-Then the wagon was returned to the two waiting Mexicans, and the
-broken-down plaza entrance was repaired, as it was decided best, for
-a few nights at least, to drive the horses and cattle into the walled
-grounds about the hacienda, so that they would begin to understand
-that it was home.
-
-Just before sunset the stock was driven up, and the gateway having
-been finished, so as to make it strong again, it was closed for the
-night, and the scouts went to get supper.
-
-Two guards were appointed for the night, one in the hacienda, one at
-the entrance to the grounds, and Buffalo Bill selected men whom he
-knew were not of a superstitious turn of mind, remarking to Texas
-Jack:
-
-“If we put on a man who was looking for ghosts, this is the very
-place to find them, and he would be alarming us constantly with
-challenges of apparitions, so I just put on men who have no fear of
-the dead.”
-
-“You are right, for though there is not a man in the band who would
-not fight big odds if he knew he was facing men, several of the
-boys would skip at the sight of anything in this ruin they did not
-understand. I am sorry that you told them the ghost story.”
-
-“No, it was best, for if this hacienda is the haunt of outlaws as I
-believe it has been, it will be by springing the supernatural upon
-us, that they will endeavor to frighten us away.”
-
-“Yes, that is so, and from that standpoint it was best; but the
-cleverness of that apparition act shows that they have some means of
-getting in and out that we are not on to yet, chief.”
-
-“Well, it won’t be long before we are, if the men are not stampeded
-by a supposed ghost,” was Buffalo Bill’s answer.
-
-In the band of brave men congregated in the hacienda that night,
-about half of them had a superstitious dread of the old deserted
-mission ranch.
-
-Buffalo Bill saw just how these men felt, and he read the faces of
-those who had no dread. So he said, as all were seated in the ranch
-waiting to retire:
-
-“Remember, pards, I believe that efforts will be made to drive us out
-of here to-night. Not by direct force, for, with our numbers, they
-will not attempt any attack.
-
-“But this hacienda is very old. Strange deeds have been done here,
-crimes committed, and most mysterious happenings have occurred.
-
-“Now, there is no such thing, as all of you know, as spooks and
-ghosts, for the dead never come back to earth in spirit form. But,
-relying upon the fears of many that believe in spooks, wicked men
-play the ghost act to frighten all away from this place for a purpose
-of their own.
-
-“My idea is that this place has been the abode of outlaws, and
-our coming here thwarts their game to keep hidden. As they dare
-not attack us openly, they will play the specter game and try and
-stampede us.
-
-“But that will not go with you, and as an extra precaution to-night
-I will keep four men on duty instead of two. Two of you can be
-together: a couple in the hacienda, the others about the grounds.
-
-“But, remember, neither of the guards must move into the domains of
-the others, for my orders are to shoot everything on two legs you see
-prowling about, be it ghost or man.
-
-“Now, Jack, you go on duty with three men until midnight, and I will
-relieve you then with three more.”
-
-This plain talk quieted the foolish dread of those who had been
-feeling anxious as to what might happen, and Texas Jack went on duty
-with three men whom he called to follow him, being careful to select
-two of the three whom he knew had an uncanny fear of the place.
-
-One of them he left on guard at the hacienda with a comrade who had
-no fear of ghosts, and the other he took out in the grounds with him,
-though showing no sign that he suspected either.
-
-The horses were huddled together in one corner of the walled-in
-plaza, and the cattle were in another, all quiet and apparently
-wondering why they were penned up.
-
-As the guards left the hacienda the others turned in for the night,
-and were soon fast asleep, Buffalo Bill setting the good example by
-dropping off instantly into a deep slumber.
-
-Soon after the guards had gone on duty, the horses began to grow
-uneasy, just why Texas Jack could not understand. As they still
-continued their restlessness, he told the man who was with him to
-stand guard at the gateway while he went among the restive animals.
-
-But the man preferred to go with him, and he said no more.
-
-The two quieted the horses, to find that the cattle also were getting
-restive, and, cowboy fashion, Texas Jack began to sing to them, for,
-as he muttered to himself:
-
-“If they stampeded they may break out, and about half the nags will
-go with them.”
-
-The cattle also became quieted under the weird chanting of the Texan,
-and then the horses once more became restive.
-
-“Say, Pinto Paul, you stay about the horses while I soothe the
-split-hoofs with the melody of my voice, which can lull them to
-rest,” said the Texan, in a light vein.
-
-“Jack, give me an order to tackle the mate of that mountain lion the
-chief killed, or to brace up against a couple of outlaws, and I’ll do
-it, but don’t expect me to play a lone hand, for I don’t intend to do
-it.”
-
-“You are surely not scared, Paul?”
-
-“I tell you that this is no place for living men when the dead are
-prowling about.”
-
-Texas Jack saw that Pinto Paul was in deadly earnest, and he said no
-more, merely remarking:
-
-“Well, Paul, if you think I am a foil to the ghosts we’ll stay
-together, and we’ll keep by the gate, so as to head the cattle if
-they make a break for it, and I’ll keep up my song.”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXXVI.
-
- THE FIRST NIGHT.
-
-
-The plaintive song of the Texan did have a soothing effect upon both
-cattle and horses.
-
-Thus the time passed away out in the grounds, while in the hacienda
-when all became quiet it seems that the spooks began to get in their
-work also.
-
-The first the guards heard was a low moan which sounded like a man in
-suffering, but just where it came from the two guards could not tell.
-
-The superstitious one of the two was for rousing the men at once, but
-his comrade said:
-
-“What for? We see no one, and it is merely a trick to frighten us,
-for the chief is right; this is an outlaws’ haunt.”
-
-When there joined in with the moaning the sound of a woman weeping,
-Mustang Frank began to show real fright, but Lone Star Sam calmed
-him, and the two listened to the strange sounds. As though a man’s
-moaning and woman’s weeping were not enough, there joined as a treble
-the sound of a child crying like one in pain.
-
-“Let’s arouse the chief.”
-
-“No, Frank, it is nearly midnight, and he’ll be on hand then.
-Besides, we cannot shoot, mind. This place is haunted by men whose
-interest it is to frighten us away; but we won’t scare a little bit,
-Frank.”
-
-“Speak for yourself, pard, for I’m about scared silly this blessed
-minute.”
-
-Lone Star laughed.
-
-“Listen!” he said. “I thought we would have more of it, for hear that
-dog join in the quartet, only I don’t like the music--ah! here comes
-the chief.”
-
-Buffalo Bill just then came out into the corridor.
-
-“Well, pards, we are having a serenade, I hear. But it is time for
-you to turn in, just twelve, and I’ll watch here, while Haskell
-stands by the outer door; but remain on duty until I return from
-seeing Texas Jack.”
-
-“Do you mean any one can sleep, chief, with this going on?”
-
-“Yes, Frank. We were not born in the woods to be scared by an owl,”
-was the answer, and Buffalo Bill left the corridor and met Winfield,
-and the other two men who were to go on guard.
-
-They were Haskell and Broncho Rawlings, and both of them were very
-nervous, for they had heard the weird sounds echoing through the
-hacienda.
-
-“Winfield, you and the others come with me to where Texas Jack and
-Pinto Paul are on duty, and we will see if they have been disturbed
-by these outlaws playing ghosts.”
-
-On they walked and found Texas Jack having as much trouble to soothe
-Pinto Paul as he had to keep the cattle quiet.
-
-“Anything wrong, Jack?”
-
-“The cattle and horses are very restless, and Paul thinks ghosts are
-about, but we have seen nothing, though we have heard the howling of
-a dog and hooting of an owl.”
-
-“Well, Jack, I will relieve you and Pinto Paul, and Broncho Rawlings
-will stand guard over the cattle while I take the gate. You,
-Winfield, return to the hacienda and relieve Sam, taking Haskell with
-you.”
-
-This was done, Broncho Rawlings taking his stand among the cattle,
-and at once beginning to sing as Texas Jack and Pinto Paul had done,
-for they were, indeed, restless.
-
-Winfield and Haskell returned to the hacienda, accompanied by Texas
-Jack and Pinto Paul, who muttered:
-
-“I suppose it will be out of the frying pan into the fire in the old
-ghost nest.”
-
-The men were all awake now, yet not up. But Texas Jack showed no
-dread, simply remarking that a ghost would be made of those in
-reality who were playing the spook act, and he turned in.
-
-Pinto Paul, meanwhile, stirred up the fire for light, not heat, and
-sat by it, merely remarking:
-
-“Now, I’m not sleepy a little bit, pards.”
-
-Winfield meanwhile had placed Haskell on guard at the outer door of
-the hacienda, while he went in to relieve Lone Star Sam and Frank.
-
-These came into the large sleeping room, and while Lone Star calmly
-went to bed, Mustang Frank joined Pinto Paul at the fire, remarking:
-
-“I’m with you, pard, for I always was scared of a danger I couldn’t
-see.”
-
-“Me, too.”
-
-“This old rookery is a graveyard from ’way back, and, you bet, ghosts
-are on the prowl this night, for they’ve invited no company, and
-don’t keep a hotel for men in the flesh, such as we are. Just listen
-to that music, will you?”
-
-Weird sounds rang through the hacienda.
-
-When Buffalo Bill had gone into the corridor he had intended to
-relieve Lone Star and Mustang Frank. But when he visited the spot
-where Texas Jack was on guard he thought that the entrance to the
-ranch was the best place for him, after he had heard the Texan’s
-report. He knew if the cattle and horses were restless some one was
-causing them to be so by prowling about among them, and in some way
-exciting them.
-
-If that “some one” could only stampede the whole lot, causing them to
-break through the gateway, then he and his scouts would be in a bad
-way indeed.
-
-It was true that the gateway had been repaired, but not as well as
-was intended, for timber would have to be cut and hauled there to
-make it secure, and a rush of steers would break down the barrier
-that was there.
-
-That any other demonstration would be made in the hacienda than the
-weird sounds already heard, Buffalo Bill did not believe, so he
-decided that he would keep his stand at the gate and let Rawlings
-guard the cattle, singing to them to quiet them.
-
-The moment the others had walked away, Buffalo Bill had quickly
-crouched down in the shadow of the wall, just at the entrance. He
-heard no sound save the impatient tramping of the horses, the singing
-of Broncho Rawlings, and an anxious lowing of a frightened steer.
-
-An hour passed, and he saw that the horses were becoming more
-restless.
-
-A moment after his keen eyes detected a white object running along
-the wall. It came from the corner where the horses were.
-
-Keeping his position, Buffalo Bill watched the white object as he
-could distinctly see it.
-
-The song of Broncho Rawlings was still kept up, and the cattle, too,
-became restive in spite of the lulling notes of the melody.
-
-“Broncho soothes them, but if I attempted to sing to them I’d
-stampede the whole outfit, yes, scouts and all,” said Buffalo Bill,
-with a full realization that music was not one of his accomplishments.
-
-The chief of scouts was upon the opposite side, crouching in the
-shadow of the massive adobe column on either side of the entrance.
-
-The white figure came straight toward him, and had Pinto Paul been
-where Buffalo Bill was, he would have stampeded with alacrity.
-
-The white figure did not seem to be able to see well, for the scout
-had not been discovered yet.
-
-Halting at the entrance, not twenty feet from Buffalo Bill, the
-“ghost” showed what its intention was. It intended to break down the
-barrier, and thus leave an open way for the cattle to stampede.
-
-But the entrance had been better closed than the midnight prowler in
-white thought, as it had some difficulty in its attempt.
-
-Just then there came from the hacienda, rising far above the singing
-of Broncho Rawlings and all other sounds, wild and piercing shrieks.
-
-The ghost seemed determined to break down the barrier as he heard the
-sound, but was suddenly startled by the stern command:
-
-“Hands up, there, or I’ll fire!”
-
-A cry broke from the white-robed form, and, with a bound, he was off,
-when sharp, loud, and deadly came the report of a revolver.
-
-Just as Buffalo Bill pulled the trigger it seemed as though the white
-form fell heavily, and then Buffalo Bill’s voice was heard:
-
-“Turn out, all, to quiet the cattle.”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXXVII.
-
- A DEAD GHOST.
-
-
-Out of the hacienda came Texas Jack and the others, while, springing
-before the entrance, Buffalo Bill called out soothingly to the
-cattle, the other scouts doing the same as they came out.
-
-There was a moment of suspense, but then the herd calmed down, as all
-the scouts, thoroughly trained cattlemen, began to sing to them.
-
-Then Texas Jack went to the aid of Buffalo Bill, calling out as he
-advanced:
-
-“Winfield stands guard with several men in the hacienda, and I came
-to see who fired that shot, chief.”
-
-“I did. There is a dead ghost lying yonder, and I hope it will end
-this fool dread of spooks,” was Buffalo Bill’s reply.
-
-Seeing that the cattle were being quieted by the scouts, Texas Jack
-walked toward the white object lying thirty feet away, at the foot of
-the high wall.
-
-“Well, Jack, it’s a flesh ghost, isn’t it?” called out Buffalo Bill,
-as he saw his pard bend over it.
-
-“It is, sir, and I’ll call several of the men to guard the gate while
-we carry it up to the hacienda to have a look at it.”
-
-“Do so.”
-
-Several men at once came at the call, among them Pinto Paul.
-
-“There’s the ghost, Pinto Paul; at least, he is more ghost now than
-he was a short while ago,” said Texas Jack.
-
-“What is it?” he asked, in an awed way.
-
-“A dead man, now, who was playing ghost a while since. He did not
-know that I was on duty at the gate there, for he heard Broncho
-Rawlings singing, and supposed he was alone on watch.
-
-“As the ghost was trying to take down the barrier, to let the cattle
-out, I held him up, but, as he did not heed, I fired on him. I did
-not fire to kill, but to wing him, but just as I pulled trigger he
-fell into a hole I remember is there, and caught the bullet in a
-vital spot. But it shows that spirits can be killed, Pinto.”
-
-The scout made no reply, for he was beginning to see that if the
-hacienda was haunted it must be by flesh and blood of ghostly forms.
-
-“I’ll give you a hand, Jack,” said Buffalo Bill.
-
-But the Texan dragged the white form out of the gully into which he
-had fallen, and shouldered it without an effort.
-
-As he moved off toward the hacienda Buffalo Bill joined him, calling
-out to the scouts to keep the cattle quiet, while he went to
-investigate the ghost in the glare of the light.
-
-Arriving at the hacienda, Texas Jack deposited his load before the
-fire, and lighted a couple of lanterns, while Buffalo Bill walked to
-the corridor where Winfield was on guard.
-
-“Well, Winfield, how goes it?”
-
-“All quiet, now, sir; but that shrieking was a bloodcurdler, even to
-me, and I feared it would stampede some of the boys along with the
-cattle.”
-
-“No, we headed them off. But keep your ears open for the slightest
-sounds, now, though I do not believe we will have any more
-disturbances. The ghost is laid, I think.”
-
-So saying, Buffalo Bill returned to the large room.
-
-The fire had been brightened up, and, with the light of several
-lanterns, the room was very light.
-
-Texas Jack had laid the form upon the floor before the fire, and,
-with a couple of the men who had come in, was standing looking at it.
-It was clad in a white garment, made to resemble a shroud, and the
-head was also wrapped around, though two holes had been made for the
-eyes to peer through. On each side, near the belt, there were two
-slits, through which the arms could be thrust.
-
-The white covering was taken from the form by Buffalo Bill and Texas
-Jack, and a dark, foreign face was exposed.
-
-“It is a Mexican,” said Texas Jack.
-
-“Yes, and he came to kill, if need be.”
-
-Buffalo Bill pointed to the belt of arms the man wore. He was attired
-half in Mexican, half in frontier garb, and his face was an evil
-one. Also, about his waist was a buckskin belt that contained several
-hundred dollars in gold.
-
-“Well, Jack, we need not report the killing of this man, at least
-just yet. We will wait and see if we hear of it, and, if so, the man
-who makes it known we will spot. I trust, now, the boys will not fear
-ghosts any more.”
-
-“I hope not, chief.”
-
-“Send each one of them here to have a look for himself, and they will
-know that I was right when I said an effort would be made to scare us
-away from here.
-
-“As we did not scare, they will try some other plan to get rid of us;
-but, one thing is certain, that these men have some way of entering
-and leaving the hacienda we do not know of, but must find out.
-
-“You see there is not a sound now, for they know that one of their
-spirits has come to grief.”
-
-Texas Jack went out after the men, and they all took a look at the
-“ghost,” made their comments, saw where the bullet of the chief had
-struck him in the head, and then the body was put in a vacant room, a
-guard placed in the grounds, at the gate, and the rest of the scouts
-returned to their blankets, Pinto Paul remarking:
-
-“Well, I take no more stock in ghosts, though I don’t just love this
-old owl’s nest.”
-
-The night passed away without much sleep for a few of the scouts.
-There was not another sound heard in the hacienda, and the horses
-and cattle quieted down. This proved to the men that they had been
-frightened by the white-robed form going about among them.
-
-The body of the dead Mexican was buried in the walled inclosure,
-while Winfield prepared breakfast and put things to rights.
-
-After the meal was over, he and six of the scouts took the cattle to
-graze, while Texas Jack and the others started upon a thorough search
-of the old mission ranch. They were anxious to find out just where
-their disturbers of the night before had hidden, or, if concealed in
-the place, how they had got into it, and made their exit.
-
-Having posted men here and there on the watch, one in the tower,
-one upstairs, one in the grounds, and seen the others start in the
-search, Buffalo Bill put on his best rig and rode away, his men
-wondering where, and why he had dressed up. He rode his best horse,
-carried a rifle slung to his saddle, and seemed prepared to meet
-friend or foe.
-
-That he carried no provisions along, after saying that he would not
-return until night, was also a surprise to the scouts, who knew that
-their chief was not one to miss a meal except on compulsion.
-
-Down the valley rode the scout, and, following the lake shore its
-length, he turned, after going half a score miles, in a trail leading
-to the left toward the mountain range on the eastward.
-
-Up among the foothills he saw a fine hacienda which he knew was the
-place where he had spent the night in passing through the valley a
-month before.
-
-Toward this he wended his way, for he wished to talk with Señor Otega.
-
-The señor it was who had told him of the secret band of robbers in
-the valley, of the curse that rested upon the people, and this had
-influenced him in coming there to solve the mystery, to hunt down the
-outlaws.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXXVIII.
-
- ON SECRET WORK.
-
-
-Buffalo Bill did not care to trust even Señor Otega with any secrets,
-for he knew not who he could place confidence in; but, having now
-come to the valley, being on the spot, he might find out from the
-señor some information that might be of value to him.
-
-He wished to see just who the maiden he had rescued was, who the band
-of outlaws might be, when Señor Otego had said that not one of the
-secret foes of the people in the valley had ever been seen.
-
-Then who was the officer in the Mexican uniform, and why was he in
-the valley thus attired, why the victim of these men?
-
-It was to get at the bottom facts, as well as he could, that Buffalo
-Bill had started upon his visit to Señor Otega.
-
-As he neared the ranch he saw the cattle and horses feeding near, the
-cowboys, five in number, guarding them and gazing curiously at him,
-and to these he nodded as he rode near, and said pleasantly:
-
-“Good morning, pards.”
-
-They returned his salute in silence, and were evidently surprised at
-seeing a stranger.
-
-Going on up to the hacienda he saw Señor Otega just about to mount
-his horse, but discovering him, he turned toward him, and said:
-
-“Why, señor, you in our valley again? You are welcome, I assure you.”
-
-Buffalo Bill responded to the questions, and then said:
-
-“But my coming prevents you from going on a ride, I fear?”
-
-“No, for I can go another time, as there is no great hurry. I was
-merely intending to ride over to see the stranger who had taken
-possession of the old mission ranch and urge that he give up such a
-thought, for I deem it my duty to advise him.”
-
-“Thanks, señor. Do you know who he is?”
-
-“An American of wealth, I believe, who came here with his people,
-cattle, horses, and all.”
-
-“Permit me to say, señor, that I am the one. I took possession
-yesterday.”
-
-“You surprise me.”
-
-“And it is a surprise to me that you should know it so soon.”
-
-“I learned it last night, from my men. But, señor, I am the more
-distressed, now, as I learn you are the man, for I like you, and to
-go to that terrible place is but to go to your doom.”
-
-“Not so bad as that, I hope, Señor Otega. The fact is, I fell in love
-with your beautiful valley, and, anxious to find a home, I decided to
-settle here, and the old hacienda was the only place I could get. So
-I came here from the northward, bringing my cattle, horses, outfit,
-and cowboys with me, and I assure you we shall be most comfortable.
-You see, I took an early opportunity to call upon you.”
-
-But Señor Otega seemed to be lost in thought, and said, in an
-absent-minded way:
-
-“Come in, come in! Why did you come to this valley, señor?”
-
-“To settle here, at least for a while.”
-
-“You have your people with you?”
-
-“Yes, all of them, and real men, too.”
-
-“I am glad. But why did you seek a home beneath that doomed roof?”
-
-“Do you remember telling me the curse that rested upon this valley?
-You told me that your daughter had been taken from you by an unseen
-foe.”
-
-“Yes.”
-
-“Has she been restored to you?”
-
-“Alas, no! She is still a prisoner. Only yesterday I paid the tax of
-one thousand pesos put upon me.”
-
-“It is an outrage.”
-
-“It is the seventh I have paid, señor, and I believe there are to be
-five more, if not still more, before she is returned to us.”
-
-“And other families pay this same tax?”
-
-“Yes, señor.”
-
-“It is infamous.”
-
-“But they do not all pay the same sum, señor, for the taxgatherer
-knows well the circumstances of each of his victims, and collects
-accordingly. He does not put upon any one a sum that cannot be paid,
-for when I pay a thousand, a poor man pays a hundred, and one pays
-five thousand pesos, señor.”
-
-“Who is that?”
-
-“A young girl, the Señorita Suelo Sada, known as The Fair Hermit.”
-
-“Ah! who did you say she was?”
-
-“One left a large fortune by a kinsman, who owned the ranch where
-she lives, and she came here to dwell, but receives no visitors, has
-no friendships, and lives such a life of utter seclusion we call her
-here in the valley the hermitess, the beautiful recluse, and other
-such names.”
-
-“Who of her family are with her?”
-
-“Not one.”
-
-“Does she dwell all alone?”
-
-“All alone, señor, save her servants and cattlemen, of whom there are
-quite a number, but they, too, hold themselves aloof from all others,
-and the stockmen are known as the hermit cowboys.”
-
-“Then how can these secret taxgatherers, as we may call them, make a
-demand upon the Señorita Sada for so large a sum, as they cannot have
-any of her loved ones, señor?”
-
-“Ah, but they have. She is betrothed to a Mexican officer, I hear,
-and he came here on a visit to her, was seized on his way home, and
-is now held a prisoner by these men whom no one knows. I learn the
-demand is made upon her regularly for five thousand pesos, and she
-pays it.”
-
-“Is the officer a man of any prominence?”
-
-“He is a captain of lanceros, señor, in the Mexican army.”
-
-“It is strange that his government has taken no steps to release him.”
-
-“There is a threat to put him to death if such an attempt is made.”
-
-Buffalo Bill did not tell about his rescue of the fair hermit and the
-officer.
-
-“Do you know his name, señor?”
-
-“It is said to be Del Sol.”
-
-“You know the padre in Silver Lake City.”
-
-“Oh, yes, Padre Juan.”
-
-“Can he do nothing to help you?”
-
-“He is under a ban also--a threat--if he does.”
-
-“And the landlord of the inn? The Señor Riel?”
-
-“Señor Cody, I do not like that man, I do not trust him, though he,
-too, is under the ban, as his son, an only child, is a prisoner.
-Still, I have a dread of him.”
-
-“Well, Señor Otega, the secret foe can only capture me or one of my
-men, to get a ransom, and we’ll watch that they do not.
-
-“I did not come here to pay ransom to robbers; but I came here to
-settle, and I like our home, haunted though it may be.
-
-“I told you that I intended to help you, and I am here to do so; but,
-remember, not a word of that to any one, for it might thwart my plan.”
-
-“I will be silent, señor, for something tells me you are here for
-good, to be relied on. I was going over to the old mission ranch to
-warn whoever had settled there to leave, for I did not know it was
-you. Are you sure that nothing disturbed you last night?”
-
-“We heard sounds, the cattle were restless, but no harm befell us,
-señor, and we’ll take chances, for that is what we are here for.”
-
-“How many men have you, señor.”
-
-“I thought it best to bring at least half a dozen,” was Buffalo
-Bill’s evasive reply, for he did not wish his force to be known, even
-to Señor Otega. He had not allowed the two Mexicans who drove the
-wagon from Silver Lake City to see more than six men beside himself,
-keeping the others off beyond the cattle.
-
-“It will be best to have just double the number they think I have,”
-was the chief of scouts’ way of thinking.
-
-Buffalo Bill remained to dinner at the hospitable ranch, and the
-señora, a sad-faced, lovely woman, gave him a warm greeting, for she
-had been pleased with his frank and genial manner upon his last visit
-to their home.
-
-Late in the afternoon the scout started upon his return, the señor
-accompanying him a few miles on the trail.
-
-Learning that he had just moved in, the Señora Otega insisted that
-she be allowed to add to his comfort, and when he was ready to go
-he found a pack horse ready for him to carry along, and it had been
-loaded with grapes, vegetables, preserves, and a large quantity of
-choice provisions, which the good lady insisted that he must accept
-from her.
-
-“Just turn the pack horse loose to-night, and he will come home and
-give you no further trouble,” said the señor.
-
-The scout was touched by the señora’s kindness, and as he rode away
-with her husband, he said:
-
-“You told your wife, then, that I was here to help you?”
-
-“Not a word, señor; but I told her when you left a month ago that
-you were Buffalo Bill, the great military scout, and had promised to
-be our friend; and, with a woman’s quick intuition where her love
-is interested, she feels sure that you have come to save our poor
-daughter.”
-
-“Yes, I saw that she was trying to read me, and I appreciate her kind
-gifts to make me comfortable. We will enjoy her bounty greatly.”
-
-As they reached the lake shore the sun was touching the horizon, and
-the señor halted.
-
-“I will turn back here, Señor Cody, for my wife will be anxious. You
-see, we have lately received quite a handsome legacy, and if it were
-known, then our secret foes would capture me or my wife and demand a
-much larger ransom.”
-
-“Then return home at once, and I regret that you came thus far with
-me.”
-
-“You have the most dangerous trail to travel, Señor Cody, and a long
-ten miles.”
-
-“I am used to dangerous trails, señor, but if I thought danger might
-beset you I would return with you.”
-
-“Not unless you remain all night, señor.”
-
-“I could not do that. The ghosts in the old hacienda might put my men
-to flight.”
-
-The sun had now sunk behind the western range of mountains, and the
-lake valley was already darkening under the fall of night.
-
-“That man is all right, for he told me of a legacy lately received.
-I came here prepared to doubt every one, but I’ll set him down as a
-square man,” muttered Buffalo Bill, as he rode along the lake shore,
-under the shelter of the fringe of timber, beneath which led the
-trail up the valley.
-
-Señor Otega had turned his horse toward home, and set out at a rapid
-canter.
-
-Reaching a belt of timber, the animal was walking along at his ease,
-the night having set in, when, without a warning, there settled over
-the señor’s head a coil of rope, and he found his arms pinioned to
-his side, while he heard the words in Spanish:
-
-“Resist, Señor Otega, and you are a dead man. I have men here to
-master you.”
-
-Señor Otega thought first of his wife, and he groaned in agony of
-spirit.
-
-“What does this outrage upon me mean, for you call me by name, and
-hence know me?”
-
-“It means that you are a prisoner, and the Señora Otega will be taxed
-to keep you alive,” was the reply.
-
-Señor Otega now, to his chagrin, saw that he had been lassoed by
-one man, and he had seized his bridle rein and stood by him, with a
-revolver leveled at his head.
-
-But there came a flash, a report, and the kidnaper sank in his tracks
-by the side of the señor’s horse.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXXIX.
-
- THE SCOUT’S RETURN.
-
-
-At first thought Señor Otega had believed that he had been the one
-shot at, and as his horse set a good example of flight, he determined
-to encourage him in it, believing there were other outlaws about.
-
-But ere the horse had made half a dozen bounds, a voice called out:
-
-“Ho, señor, I fired that shot!”
-
-Señor Otega recognized the voice at once. It had a ring in it that
-once heard could not be forgotten. So he wheeled his horse, and rode
-back to find the one who had rescued him standing by the side of the
-fallen outlaw.
-
-“Señor Cody!”
-
-“Yes; I had a dread that your coming with me as far as you did might
-get you into trouble, so I turned back to dog your steps, unseen by
-you, and see you enter your ranch in safety.”
-
-“How glad am I that you did, señor!”
-
-“I was not very far behind you, nearer you than I thought, for you
-must have slackened your speed, and I distinctly heard the voice of
-your captor.
-
-“I instantly sprang from my saddle, and, advancing on foot, realized
-that you had been captured, and I saw one man, but took the chances
-of there being more.
-
-“As he was an outlaw, I thought it best to put him out of the way.”
-
-“God bless you,” was all the ranchero could at first say.
-
-But he soon conquered his emotion and told just what his captor had
-said to him.
-
-Buffalo Bill listened attentively, and then said abruptly:
-
-“This man was sent to kidnap you?”
-
-“Yes.”
-
-“Is he alone?”
-
-“Yes.”
-
-“His being there shows that he saw you leave your home, was watching
-your return, shadowing you in fact.”
-
-“No doubt of it, señor.”
-
-“Well, I wish you to be guided by me in this matter.”
-
-“I will.”
-
-“Say nothing, even to your wife, of this attack on you to-night. I
-mean that no one must know of this attack on you, señor.”
-
-“But why, Señor Cody?”
-
-“This man was sent to do this work. If he does not return to report,
-they will not know what has become of him, for I shall strap his body
-upon his horse, which must be near, take the animal to the lake,
-lead him in, and thence along the shore in the water to a spot near
-my ranch.
-
-“I will search the body for any telling articles there may be on it,
-and will hide away his saddle and bridle.”
-
-“But the horse, señor?”
-
-“I will give him into the keeping of my men for a day, and after they
-have branded him and disguised him, his own master, if alive, would
-not know him, and one of them will ride him, so he will not go back
-to his home, at least, not just now.”
-
-“You know what you are about, Señor Cody?”
-
-“I hope so. Now we will find that horse, mount his master on him, and
-I’ll lead him back through the timber, not in the trail.”
-
-“And your horse, señor?”
-
-“Is trained, señor, and will keep always in the trail as I start him
-until we reach the lake shore, and there I will mount him.”
-
-“What will this dead man’s comrades think?”
-
-“In my opinion they will track him, find his trail leading here, then
-back to the lake, where they will lose it.
-
-“They will see that your horse was halted here, remained for some
-time, and the tracks will reveal that two men were here, their
-comrade and you. They will take my footprints for yours, so you must
-not dismount.
-
-“But when I have removed the body, you must move your horse about
-all over the spot, to mark out all traces of where it lay, for the
-ground is soft, I notice, beneath my feet. Then you go on homeward,
-and continue to gallop until you get there.”
-
-“But that will not explain that dead man’s absence?”
-
-“Yes, for they will believe that, being alone, when he captured you,
-why you simply bribed him to let you go.”
-
-Going into the timber, Buffalo Bill was not long in finding the horse
-of the outlaw, and the body of the dead kidnaper was tied across the
-saddle with his own lariat, and then the animal and that of Señor
-Otega were moved all about, until every trace of where the man had
-fallen had been destroyed.
-
-Bidding the señor good night, and promising to pay him another visit
-in good time, Buffalo Bill walked back to his own horse and the pack
-animal, turned toward the old ranch, threw the rein of the other over
-the saddle horn, and started them off at a walk.
-
-Then he returned to the kidnaper’s horse, and led him through the
-timber, and then back over the two miles to the lake shore. There he
-overtook his horse and the pack animal, and they were taken into the
-lake, but at different points.
-
-Along the beach, ankle deep in the lake, they continued their way,
-over the miles that lay between the point where they had entered the
-water and the old Mission Ranch.
-
-At last the scout left the lake at a place where his trail led direct
-to the hacienda. He saw the glimmer of a light there, and he knew
-that it must be at the gate, and placed as a beacon to guide him
-home. Not a horse or a steer did he see, and he felt that they had
-all been driven into the grounds again for safety.
-
-As he neared the gate, the cheery voice of Texas Jack called out:
-
-“Is that you, chief?”
-
-“Yes, Jack.”
-
-“We were getting anxious about you, and not one of the men has
-retired.”
-
-“What, more ghosts?”
-
-“Not the shadow of one, but the men wished to remain up to see if you
-came in all right.”
-
-“Oh, yes, I am all right. But I have a pack animal loaded with good
-things, for I have been off on a visit, and, Jack, I have another
-horse here, with his dead master upon him.
-
-“Now, walls have ears, they say, and for fear the old hacienda may
-have some secret closets where foes are watching, I do not wish the
-men to breathe a word of this dead man.
-
-“First, he must be searched, then buried to-night in the grave with
-the other one, and his horse must be disguised.”
-
-“I understand, chief.”
-
-“In the morning drive the cattle and horses over my trail to the
-lake.”
-
-“Yes, chief.”
-
-Feeling that he could leave all to Texas Jack, Buffalo Bill
-dismounted and entered the walled-in grounds, discovering that the
-men had during the day made a barrier that nothing could break
-through. Then he went on to the hacienda, for he was both tired and
-hungry.
-
-The men welcomed their chief in a way that showed how glad they were
-to see him back, and that they felt a most warm regard for him.
-
-But he said nothing of his adventure other than to tell them to go
-out and see Texas Jack.
-
-Buffalo Bill had no desire to say anything in the hacienda that other
-ears than those his words were intended for should hear. He was very
-suspicious about the old structure, for, though it seemed one could
-discover if there were secret closets about it, he very well knew
-that such had not been found out, and they were certainly there.
-
-This was proven by the mountain lion in the corridor, the sounds of
-moaning and weeping, and the howling of a dog the night before. Those
-sounds could only have been made by persons in concealment.
-
-The scouts had discussed the matter among themselves when out of
-the place, and off from it, for the chief had warned them about
-talking when in the hacienda, and, where they could understand that
-men could have uttered the moans and other sounds, they could not
-comprehend just how the weeping of a woman and the voice of a child
-could have been heard.
-
-“Pards, those ghosts must enter here by way of the cliff up yonder,
-so to-night we’ll put a strong guard there to head them off,” said
-Buffalo Bill.
-
-And so it was planned for the next night.
-
-Going out to Texas Jack, they saw the dead body, and it was quietly
-buried; then they took the horse in hand, and soon had him cleverly
-metamorphosed.
-
-The saddle and bridle were taken into the hacienda and hidden, and
-all were told that they must utter not a word within the house that
-they did not wish to be known as there might be eavesdroppers whom
-they did not wish to know their plans.
-
-This all attended to, Texas Jack went up to the hacienda to report,
-and that also he had what had been taken from the dead man put away
-for inspection on the morrow.
-
-There was a guard of four men that night, two in the hacienda, two in
-the grounds.
-
-Soon after midnight Buffalo Bill was awakened by low groans. Where
-they came from he could not tell. He arose in the darkness, and tried
-to trace the sound to its source. But in vain.
-
-Lone Star was on guard in the corridor, but he, too, knew not whence
-they came.
-
-Then followed the sound of weeping in a woman’s voice, as upon the
-night before.
-
-“Go, Sam, and see if there is any disturbance among the cattle. I
-will keep watch until you return,” said Buffalo Bill.
-
-Lone Star left, and the chief took his stand just in the middle of
-the corridor, and listened attentively.
-
-As he listened, there was heard the wailing of a child, as though in
-pain. And the moans, the weeping, and the wailing continued.
-
-“It all comes from the center of this hacienda, either from overhead
-or from underneath, which I cannot tell,” mused the scout.
-
-Suddenly there rang out the wild, piercing shriek of the night before.
-
-For a moment Buffalo Bill was startled, so close to him did it seem.
-
-The men were all awakened by it, and upon their feet in an instant.
-
-There was an alarm sounded, but just then Lone Star Sam returned, and
-reported the horses and cattle quiet.
-
-“Yes, and the same game must be played here to quiet these ghosts,”
-said Buffalo Bill.
-
-Lone Star had heard the shriek, for it had even reached the men on
-guard at the gate. He said every scout was up and ready for business.
-
-“This must not be,” said Buffalo Bill. “They must pay no attention
-to any sounds they hear, and then we will master the situation.”
-
-This order was given secretly to each one of the men, and they
-returned to their beds, though some did not care to sleep, as that
-unearthly shriek still echoed in their ears.
-
-The morning dawned, and then Buffalo Bill gave orders to each man
-to retire the next night early, and to pay no attention to moans,
-groans, weeping, wailing or shrieks.
-
-“We will disappoint them, pards. And more, only one man need stand
-guard to-night in the hacienda, and one at the gate.
-
-“If there is cause for alarm, a pistol shot will be the signal to
-bring up to the spot where we are needed, but remember, nothing less
-than seeing a ghost to-night counts, for hearing them is nothing.”
-
-These orders were given away from the hacienda, where no one could
-hear, if concealed within the walls.
-
-The men to guard the cattle left early with the herd and the horses,
-and the trail of Buffalo Bill’s horse and the led animals was blotted
-out to the lake.
-
-One of the men even rode the horse of the dead kidnaper out on duty.
-
-His heavy tail had been thinned out more than half, as also had his
-bushy mane, while two brands had been put upon him that looked old.
-This was done by folding a cloth, saturating it in water, placing
-it upon the side of the animal, and then holding the red-hot brand
-against it until the hair was scalded off, but the flesh not burned.
-
-This gave it an old look, and the horse certainly would not be known
-by the man who had owned him.
-
-Just at midnight a low moaning was heard. As the wind had come up,
-and was whistling about the old hacienda, it made the moaning seem
-more dismal than ever. Then deep groans were heard.
-
-A few scouts moved uneasily at this, but no one rose, no one spoke.
-
-The weeping of a woman followed, without causing any disturbance
-among the sleepers, if any one was really asleep. Next was heard the
-plaintive wailing of a child.
-
-Still no one stirred. A few minutes after there was a perfect chorus
-of these melancholy sounds, and still the scouts lay quiet.
-
-Suddenly, without warning, the same unearthly, terrible shriek which
-had before brought all the scouts to their feet echoed through the
-old hacienda.
-
-To say that some of the scouts started would be but the truth. But
-all had their orders from Buffalo Bill, and not a man moved. The
-shriek had caused hardly any more disturbance than had the moans,
-weeping, and wailing.
-
-But, as though angry at having remained unnoticed, the shrieker sent
-forth peal after peal, until Buffalo Bill called out:
-
-“Oh, quit that racket, ghost, and go back to your grave; for we can’t
-help you.”
-
-The scouts laughed, and in a moment the sounds ceased altogether.
-
-Nothing more disturbed the night’s rest, and the morning dawned with
-the secret sleuths the victors.
-
-Buffalo Bill rose early, and while breakfast was being got ready he
-went out and scaled the cliff.
-
-“Pards, to-night some of us will camp out upon that cliff,” he said
-upon his return.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XL.
-
- THE SHOT ON THE CLIFF.
-
-
-The secret sleuths all seemed particularly pleased with their chief
-and themselves, when they felt that they had not been turned out of
-their beds by the carrying on of the “ghosts” during the night.
-
-Those who had been most superstitious took heart also, and began to
-feel that the “dead folks” were not so much to be dreaded, after all.
-
-The guard at the entrance had reported that the cattle had shown no
-restlessness, and he had neither seen nor heard anything to alarm
-him, save the wild shrieks up at the hacienda.
-
-Buffalo Bill had picked out four men to accompany him to the cliff,
-when night came, to remain there on watch.
-
-A guard was also to be stationed in the tower, one at the gate and
-another at the entrance of the living wing.
-
-In case of an alarm five more scouts were to hasten over the wall,
-and, led by Lone Star, who knew the way, go to the help of those upon
-the cliff.
-
-Buffalo Bill had selected to accompany him Texas Jack, Kit Kingdon,
-Rio Grande Dick, and Blue Jacket Bob, all of them splendid fellows in
-a close fight.
-
-And all were to take their rifles along.
-
-They were to carry their blankets as well, so that all could sleep
-except one who watched.
-
-Quietly they slipped out of the gate, after dark, and, Buffalo Bill
-leading the way, they went around the wall to the cliff and began the
-steep climb by the aid of the trees.
-
-It was no easy task by day, and doubly dangerous in the darkness.
-
-But the climb was made in safety, and when the plateau was reached
-the five men formed a line, and, spreading their blankets upon the
-ground, lay down to watch.
-
-Buffalo Bill had taken the center position, and he told his men that
-they could go to sleep, as he would remain on guard and call them if
-he had any grounds for alarm.
-
-The men were thus stretched right across the plateau from one
-cliffside to another, and about a hundred yards apart, just over the
-ranch.
-
-But though each man spread his blanket, he did not go to sleep.
-
-All were too anxious to make some discovery that would enable them to
-entrap the outlaws.
-
-If there was an alarm, they were to rally toward their chief, and if
-their foes proved too numerous they were to give a signal for help
-from the hacienda, and then retreat toward the cliff overlooking it.
-
-Midnight came and passed without any sound, and then Texas Jack, who
-held the end position on the right, beheld a form in white coming
-from the cliff that looked down from the range over the plateau, and
-which rose several feet above it. He was instantly on the alert, and
-expecting that the one he saw was not alone, he dared not yet give
-the alarm.
-
-Nearer and nearer drew the form in white, gliding quickly along,
-until suddenly Texas Jack called out sharply:
-
-“Halt! Hands up!”
-
-There was a startled cry, a quick shot at random toward Texas Jack,
-and the white form was off like a deer toward the cliff.
-
-Seeing that he must get away, Texas Jack raised his rifle and fired
-as the shadowy form was disappearing in the darkness.
-
-Instantly all was excitement on the plateau, the scouts rallying
-quickly toward Texas Jack, who had darted forward in pursuit, calling
-to his comrades to follow.
-
-Buffalo Bill was the first to reach his side, and he was bending over
-a man lying upon the ground and groaning with pain.
-
-“Stay and see what you can get out of him, Jack. Blue Jacket, run to
-the cliff and give the alarm for Lone Star Sam and his party to come
-in. Dick, light those lanterns and have them ready, but under cover,
-and then all of you follow me.”
-
-With these orders Buffalo Bill moved rapidly on toward the cliff, and
-as quickly as possible his men followed, two of them with lanterns.
-
-Buffalo Bill reached the cliff of the range rising above the spur,
-and as the others came they stretched out along its base.
-
-Blue Jacket Bob called out to say that Lone Star Sam and the others
-were coming, and in a quarter of an hour they were on hand, and half
-a dozen lanterns were following like fireflies along the wall of rock
-which towered above the plateau.
-
-But not another soul was seen, nothing was found, and the whole cliff
-seemed to be nowhere scalable.
-
-But the scouts kept up their search until the dawn, determined to see
-then if there was any discovery that could be made.
-
-Stevens, the surgeon, had been called to the wounded man, and as
-Buffalo Bill went to where he lay, just as day broke, he found
-the scout doctor seated by his side, Texas Jack having left the
-unfortunate fellow to his care.
-
-“Well, doc, how is he?”
-
-“Perfectly conscious, sir, but he will utter no word.”
-
-“His pallid face shows that death is not far off.”
-
-“Yes, sir; I have told him that he must die, that he can live but
-an hour or more, and that I could do nothing for him, though I have
-tried. But the wound is mortal.” Stevens showed where the bullet had
-torn its way.
-
-Buffalo Bill knelt by the side of the dying man, who was beyond doubt
-an American, for his hair was light in hue, and his eyes dark blue.
-He was dressed in buckskin leggings, a blue woolen shirt, moccasins,
-and a slouch hat, but, in strange contrast, about him was wrapped a
-large white robe, intended to be white, though much soiled. He had
-had on a belt of arms, but it had been removed by Texas Jack to make
-him more comfortable.
-
-The man’s blue eyes rested upon Buffalo Bill with a strange
-expression in them.
-
-“My poor fellow, I am sorry I can do nothing for you,” said Buffalo
-Bill kindly.
-
-The man shook his head.
-
-“Can you not talk?”
-
-“Yes.” The word was distinctly uttered.
-
-“Will you not tell me if I can serve you in some way?”
-
-Again the wounded man shook his head.
-
-“Why were you playing ghost, for you thus brought your death upon
-yourself?”
-
-No reply.
-
-“Have you no kindred, no friends to whom you wish to send a last
-word?”
-
-“I will leave no word.”
-
-“But would it not be best?”
-
-“No.”
-
-“If you wish your friends to know of your death, upon my word I will
-not tell them what you are.”
-
-“Let me die in silence.”
-
-“Doc, can you not give him something to relieve his sufferings?”
-
-“He refused it--he will soon be beyond suffering.”
-
-Just then Texas Jack approached, and as he did so Buffalo Bill said:
-
-“Texas Jack, the poor fellow is dying, but will utter no word to
-commit himself or betray his comrades.”
-
-The blue eyes of the dying man rested upon the face of Texas Jack in
-an earnest way:
-
-“Jack Omohundro, I know you. We were boys together in far-away
-Virginia. And your hand has ended my career. So be it, for I might
-have met a worse death---- Ah! I see that you know me now, but do not
-betray me here, nor to the people at home, who believe me dead years
-ago. Give me your hand, Jack.”
-
-Into the bright eyes of the Texan, who had witnessed many a death
-scene, came tears that rolled down his bronzed cheeks, as he grasped
-the hand, while he said softly:
-
-“Yes, Ned, I know you, my boyhood friend. We never dreamed of this in
-those old days. I will not betray you.”
-
-The Texan’s form quivered with emotion, and a smile swept over the
-face of the dying man.
-
-Buffalo Bill’s fine face grew stern as death, but it was to force
-back the flood of feeling that rushed upon him, and Doc Stevens
-hastily drew his sleeve across his eyes.
-
-“Jack, I will atone all I can for my evil past, I will tell you that
-which will let me die easy in mind, for it will save many from sorrow
-and suffering, yes, and some lives, too--listen to me while I can
-talk.”
-
-The scouts walked away, but the dying man recalled Buffalo Bill, who
-had removed his broad sombrero, as Texas Jack’s fell from his bowed
-head.
-
-Bold, fearless, reckless fellows that they were, the scouts all saw
-that their chief was respecting a death scene, even though it was an
-outlaw that was dying. They beheld the attitude of their lieutenant,
-Texas Jack, saw that his hand clasped that of the dying man, and they
-bared their heads in compassion, for they knew that there was some
-link that bound the two together.
-
-Later came the last words of the dying man:
-
-“Jack, old friend, good-by.”
-
-All heard the words, saw the smile, and then beheld the ashen hue
-deepen on the face of the dying man, as the end came.
-
-Texas Jack folded the hands upon the breast, and wrapped the white
-shroudlike robe about the form.
-
-“He was my boyhood friend, pards, and as he asked me to keep his
-secret it will die with me,” said the Texan. And to his dying day
-Texas Jack never made known the identity of the outlaw.
-
-After the body of the dead outlaw had been decently buried down in
-the ranch graveyard, Texas Jack motioned to the chief of scouts, and
-the two walked apart together.
-
-“You heard his strange story?”
-
-“Yes, Jack.”
-
-“And who the leader of these secret foes is?”
-
-“Yes, he is known as El Diabolo, the Cowboy King, is feared by
-everybody, and is the chief of cowboys on the ranch of the girl
-hermit.”
-
-“And you will act upon the information he gave us, Bill?”
-
-“Of course, but not too hastily, as I wish to make a clean sweep of
-all the guilty ones, and have none of the innocent suffer.”
-
-“You are wise in that; but if you could trust your friend, Señor
-Otega, he might help greatly.”
-
-“Yes, but I’ll know just who to trust before I make a move. I shall
-make a visit to Silver Lake City and see how matters are there,
-for I wish to see the priest, and also have a talk with Riel, the
-innkeeper. In fact, I expect to go on a still hunt and be much away,
-so you take full control here, and at the right time we will act and
-make no mistake.”
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XLI.
-
- THE FIGHT IN THE SLEUTHS’ CAMP.
-
-
-Several days passed away, and Buffalo Bill was absent from the camp,
-for, acting under his orders, Texas Jack had encamped his men outside
-of the hacienda and away from its immediate surroundings.
-
-The chief of scouts was what the men called “playing a little game,”
-in this, for it could give those who haunted the hacienda the idea
-that the scout sleuths were afraid to stay there any longer.
-
-The truth was that Buffalo Bill was on a still hunt of detective
-work, and each one of his men was aiding him all in his power.
-
-The scout had not been gone a day from the camp before visitors began
-to drop in there, a thing that had never happened while they were at
-the hacienda.
-
-Just how it happened Texas Jack and his men did not know, or if they
-did they kept it to themselves; but trouble came, and at night, when
-the scouts were away from the camp.
-
-Blue Jacket Bob and Rio Grande Dick were the two men left in camp,
-and following the arrival of three strangers came a fatal fight.
-
-To the surprise of Blue Jacket Bob, two of the cowboy visitors were
-from the ranch of Señor Otega, and the other was from the hacienda
-of the fair hermit, and known to belong to the band who served the
-cowboy king, the Señorita Suelo’s chief of cowboys.
-
-Perhaps they had expected to find only one guard at the cowboy camp
-and rob it; but the two men they found there had proven more than a
-match for them.
-
-When Buffalo Bill returned to camp he found Texas Jack and the men,
-save two, off on scouting duty; but of those two one was dead, Rio
-Grande Dick, and Blue Jack Bob was wounded.
-
-With Buffalo Bill came Señor Otega.
-
-Doc Stevens had joined his chief back on the trail, fortunately as it
-proved, and as the three rode into camp there stood Blue Jacket Bob
-in the moonlight, and he called out:
-
-“Doc, I have a wound in my arm for you to dress, and it needs it, for
-I could not go to look you up, being all alone in camp.”
-
-“Why, where is Rio Grande Dick?”
-
-“I am sorry to say, sir, that he is dead.”
-
-“Dead! How was it, Bob?”
-
-But Buffalo Bill could see that Blue Jacket Bob was suffering, and he
-insisted that he should not make a report until his wound had been
-tended.
-
-This was now done by Doc Stevens, who said:
-
-“It is not dangerous, but he has lost considerable blood. Here is the
-bullet--give him a drink, please.”
-
-The bullet had been extracted from the shoulder, a drink of brandy
-was given the wounded man, and as soon as he was made comfortable he
-said:
-
-“There lies poor Dick over there, chief.”
-
-“How was it, Bob?”
-
-“You see that man lying yonder?”
-
-“Yes.”
-
-“He was one of the cowboy king’s men.”
-
-“Yes, I remember him, and next in authority to him,” said Señor Otega.
-
-“I guess he was; there is his horse hitched where he left him. He
-came to our camp with two men. One said to us that they had brought
-a friend of theirs over who wanted to know us, and he had some fine
-liquor and cigars, and wished us to join him. I said that we did not
-drink, but would smoke with them, and asked them to be seated.
-
-“We all sat down here, and were talking when he called out suddenly:
-‘Now!’
-
-“The three men, with that, at once drew their revolvers and turned
-them on us.
-
-“But, though we were taken by surprise, we are quick on the draw, and
-our revolvers were going off with theirs, and for a second or so it
-was lively here.
-
-“We all sprang to cover of the timber, of course, and so we had it.
-
-“I don’t think it lasted half a minute, and then I found I was the
-only one standing up, and I was wounded.
-
-“I walked over to where those three traitors lay, but they were dead.
-I then went to poor Dick. He was gasping, but murmured something
-about a plot to kill us. Then he grasped my hand, and the poor boy
-was gone.”
-
-As he spoke, Bob brushed tears from his eyes, and there were others
-who felt the drops trickle down their bronzed cheeks as they thought
-of their dead comrade.
-
-The scouts had listened with rapt attention to Blue Jacket Bob’s
-story, and Buffalo Bill said:
-
-“Bob, you have done nobly, old fellow, and there is proof lying
-before us of your plucky fight against odds. Now, señor, what is your
-opinion of the treachery of your men to-night?”
-
-“They came to rob this camp, señor, and failed, though they had one
-of the fair hermit’s cattlemen as an ally.”
-
-“What a pity that they all got killed, that we cannot entrap one
-alive, or wound and capture one!”
-
-“It is, indeed, a pity, Señor Cody. But you recall that I told you
-the secret foes had spies on every ranch, or were suspected of
-having?”
-
-“Yes, Señor Otega.”
-
-“Well, these two were the spies, doubtless, on my ranch.”
-
-“I see.”
-
-“And the other man was a comrade of theirs, and hence a spy on the
-ranch of the fair hermit.”
-
-“I guess you are right.”
-
-“Now, what is to be done with these bodies, for poor Dick we will
-take with us for burial at the ranch?”
-
-“It would be best if you ride over with me and report the affair to
-the alcalde.”
-
-“Who is he?”
-
-“The landlord, the Señor Riel.”
-
-“All right,” and to Texas Jack, who just rode up:
-
-“Jack, you and three others be within call if I need you, for I may
-have to shoot the alcalde,” said Buffalo Bill, to the surprise of
-Señor Otega, who cried:
-
-“Oh, señor!”
-
-“If ever there was a scamp, Señor Otega, that landlord is one, and I
-shall stand no nonsense with him.”
-
-“All right, sir, and you’ll find us within call,” said Jack.
-
-With this, Buffalo Bill and the Señor Otega mounted their horses and
-rode away from the camp. Texas Jack, Lone Star Sam, and Mustang Frank
-following soon after.
-
-The landlord was found in the Fandango Hall, at Silver Lake City, but
-he was called into his office by Señor Otega, who said at once:
-
-“Señor Alcalde, we have an unfortunate affair to report to you.”
-
-“The Señor Cody I suppose has killed some one?”
-
-The look the man got from the scout made him wince, but the words
-were calmly uttered:
-
-“You must not jump at conclusions, sir, or I might be tempted to
-punish impertinence. I am here to report to you that two of our men
-were left to guard camp, while the rest were away. We returned to
-find that one of our men had been killed, the other wounded, and the
-three men who had gone there to rob the camp were lying dead, having
-been shot by our comrade, Blue Jacket Bob.”
-
-“This is bad, very bad.”
-
-“The three men were those whom we had reason to believe friends, for
-two were Señor Otega’s cowboys, and the other was a cattleman of the
-band of the cowboy king, and he it was who arranged the robbery,
-which ended in the loss of their lives.”
-
-“This is bad, very bad. I must demand the man who did this killing,
-and while the Señor Otega goes to fetch him I will hold you as
-hostage, Señor Cody.”
-
-“You shall neither take Blue Jacket Bob, nor will you keep me here. I
-have reported the facts, and it is a pretty state of affairs when we
-cannot protect our camp and our lives. If you wish a trial, name the
-day and we will be here.”
-
-“And I will guarantee on bond, Señor Alcalde, for the appearance of
-the accused man,” said Señor Otega.
-
-“I must have a guarantee from them also.”
-
-Buffalo Bill laughed and replied:
-
-“You doubt my word, and I have reason to doubt you, and, in fact, do.
-No, I’ll pledge my word, and remember, the Señor Otega here shall
-give no bond for us, and we will be here on the day you set for
-trial.”
-
-“I wish a guarantee.”
-
-“See here, Landlord Riel, you shall have one. With your own people
-you would consider this justifiable killing of three robbers and
-murderers. We are here in this valley as are others, and you shall
-not make us an exception.”
-
-“But I must punish murder,” said the landlord, all in a tremor.
-
-“There was no murder, save the killing of my poor comrade by those
-men who were murderers and robbers. Blue Jacket Bob acted in
-self-defense, and I’ll tell you to your face, if you dare to attempt
-to hold me a prisoner, or arrest my comrade, I’ll make known to these
-people the confession of one of those three men, and a dying man does
-not lie.
-
-“I alone know that confession, Landlord Alcalde, or whatever you
-choose to call yourself, and I will make it known, and leave it for
-you to prove that dying lips lied.
-
-“Do you grasp my meaning as I intend you shall, Señor Riel?”
-
-Señor Otega stood amazed at the bold words of Buffalo Bill. He knew
-perfectly well that there had been no dying confession; he was
-surprised and startled at the daring shown by the scout, and flinging
-into the face of a man whom every one in the valley feared, a charge
-of guilt, as it were. He glared at the alcalde, expecting a terrible
-outbreak.
-
-Instead, he saw that his face was livid, that his lips were drawn
-back from his white teeth like a snarling dog, and that they were
-clicking together with a nervous chill.
-
-“Señor Otega retire a moment, please, for I wish to ask our friend
-here of this man’s confession.”
-
-The voice of the alcalde was hardly audible.
-
-A glance at Buffalo Bill, and the Señor Otega saw a sign for him to
-go.
-
-“I will soon join you, señor, as the alcalde will not detain me
-long,” said the scout pleasantly.
-
-When the door closed behind Otega, the alcalde said in a low tone:
-
-“Who made this confession you speak of?”
-
-“I do not know the name of the man of the cowboy king’s band,” was
-the evasive reply.
-
-“Ah! it was he?”
-
-“Shall I tell you that the confession appeared like that of a man who
-sought to destroy you, alcalde; but where there is smoke you will
-always find fire, and were I to speak there are plenty to listen,
-though I myself might not believe that you can be guilty.
-
-“Suppose we square this matter by your giving me a discharge for my
-comrade; in other words, that he acted in self-defense, and you bury
-the three bodies at your expense.”
-
-“Yes, yes, señor, that will do, for I have no desire to prosecute
-you or your comrades. You are strangers in our valley, and I will
-give you the paper asked, and in return your lips are sealed about
-the confession of that dying man. As you said, it was the malignant
-confession on the eve of death, to ruin me, for we had had some
-trouble several times, and there is not a word of truth in it.”
-
-“I did not tell you what he had said.”
-
-“No, no.” The alcalde looked most anxious.
-
-“Just write out the paper for my pard, please--his name is Robert
-Mead, nicknamed Blue Jacket Bob.”
-
-“I see.” The alcalde hastily filled in a discharge and handed it to
-the scout, saying as he did so: “Now, there is no charge, you know.”
-
-“Thanks, señor.”
-
-“Now, what did that wicked man have to say about me?”
-
-“Well, I heard enough to know you were in some way allied to these
-secret foes of the valley, and kept by fear of death of making known
-all that you are aware of.”
-
-“Nonsense, señor, utter nonsense! Still, it is best not to let it be
-known that I had such a charge against me, and you are not to speak
-of it, you know.”
-
-“Not one word I ever heard from that dying man against you, señor,
-shall ever pass my lips, at least as long as you don’t forget.”
-
-“Then that will be all right. I will call in the Señor Otega, and you
-are to have a glass of wine with me.”
-
-“Thanks, but I do not often drink; the Señor Otega never does, and
-you must excuse us. But you will send over after the bodies, for we
-shall leave camp to-night.”
-
-“Yes, I will return with you, with two of my men, and take them in
-charge.”
-
-Señor Otega was again surprised when the alcalde and the scout came
-out together, and as Texas Jack saw them approaching he and his
-comrades hastened back to camp.
-
-The alcalde had two men and a wagon to follow him, and the bodies of
-the three robbers were taken back into the settlement, where there
-was already plenty more work for the landlord in his magisterial
-capacity, there having been a riot in the Fandango Hall, and half a
-score of men lay around dead, while many more were wounded.
-
-“Those three dead from our camp will fit in with the ones slain at
-the fandango,” said Señor Otega, as he rode with Buffalo Bill as they
-started on their homeward trail just before dawn.
-
-“Oh, yes, the alcalde will fix things up all right, and I have Blue
-Jacket Bob’s acquittal paper here,” replied Buffalo Bill.
-
-“And, señor, how did you manage it?”
-
-“Easy enough.”
-
-“Well, you played the boldest game I ever saw, and you are the first
-one who ever frightened Alcalde Riel, I assure you. Why, not one of
-those men made a confession.”
-
-“No, but if he thought they did, and he was guilty, it was just as
-well as though they had.”
-
-“Yes, just as well.” Señor Otega was lost in admiration at the bold
-deed of Buffalo Bill in bringing the alcalde to terms.
-
-Back to his ranch went Señor Otega, while Buffalo Bill and his
-men returned on the trail that would take them by the way of the
-temporary camp where poor Rio Grande Dick had lost his life.
-
-The chief of scouts found that his orders to get ready to return to
-the haunted hacienda had been carried out, and all were in readiness
-for the move.
-
-Rio Grande Dick had been given decent burial, and the men felt that
-their chief had been doing some splendid secret-service work during
-his short absence from them.
-
-“Pards, I have found out enough to convince the most skeptical of
-you, that is the most ardent believer in ghosts, that every spook
-we will have to deal with can be brought down with a bullet,” said
-Buffalo Bill.
-
-“I have gleaned certain information that fastens the crimes in this
-valley upon a man, yes, men whom no one suspects; but what we do now
-will bring the guilty to the end of their rope.
-
-“Though you did not know it, there was one of our band left alone and
-in hiding in the haunted hacienda, and what he discovered proved that
-we are on the right track.”
-
-Though Buffalo Bill did not even hint as much, the men were sure that
-their chief had been that lone watcher in the ruins of the fatal
-ranch.
-
-Continuing in his easy way, Buffalo Bill said:
-
-“Now, men, we return to that old spook nest next, and we stay there
-until we lay the ghosts, mark my words.
-
-“All I ask is for each man to give me his full support, and we’ll
-soon strike the end of our trail.”
-
-The answer was a cheer, and the march was taken up for the fatal
-ranch.
-
-If there was one of the scouts who longer felt dread of the ruin,
-that is, a superstitious dread, he did not show it.
-
-The place was again occupied, and after a talk with the men, before
-they reached the hacienda, it was agreed by one and all that not a
-word should be uttered there that would in any way give their plans
-away.
-
-That night a move would be made by Buffalo Bill which should lay the
-foundation for the laying of the spooks, and all were on the eager
-watch for what was to come.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XLII.
-
- A STARTLING VISIT.
-
-
-Night came and Buffalo Bill was on guard at the gate with Winfield.
-
-The cattle and horses had not been driven in, as the scouts had
-returned home, and there were enough for four for night duty and
-four for day duty, with the others to look to the duties about the
-hacienda, and be ready for any service they might be called upon to
-do.
-
-As Buffalo Bill had signified his intention of going on an expedition
-the next day, he carried his blankets down to the entrance to sleep
-there, and have Texas Jack call him.
-
-Jack awoke the chief just at dawn, asking:
-
-“Now, what does it mean, chief?”
-
-“I am going to make a call--in fact, a couple of them, for I shall
-dine with Señor Otega, and from there go on to the hacienda of the
-fair hermit.”
-
-“Do you mean it, chief?”
-
-“Certainly.”
-
-“Don’t go there.”
-
-“Is it the fair hermit you distrust, or her cowboys?”
-
-“It is the king of the cowboys I have no faith in, and his men will
-do as he tells them, as my dying friend said.”
-
-“I do not doubt that.”
-
-“He is bitter over our coming here, as all of them are, and he will
-seek to do you harm in some way, I am sure.”
-
-“My dear Jack, that is just why I want you and the boys along.”
-
-“Ah!”
-
-“You are to follow my trail, you know, and, stopping at the Otega
-ranch later in the afternoon, some time after my departure from
-there, he will give you a couple of men to accompany you, guiding you
-to the hacienda of the fair hermit.
-
-“You can then go as near as you dare, meet me upon my departure, and
-on the return, instead of having one man to waylay, as they will
-expect, they will find half a dozen, and I will not fall into the
-trap.”
-
-“I see.”
-
-“I do not know that they would kill me, I rather think they would
-not; but just now I wish to take no chances--wish to keep out of
-trouble--as I am playing a little secret game myself, which you will
-all be let into as soon as I make a discovery or two I hope to.
-
-“Now, follow in a couple of hours, and when you reach the Otega ranch
-go there alone, leaving the men in hiding.”
-
-With this Buffalo Bill rode along the trail, now well known to him,
-leading to the home of Señor Otega. He was watchful as he rode
-along, as he deemed it necessary that he should be.
-
-It was within half an hour of dinner time when he reached the Otega
-ranch, and he was received by the señor and his lovely wife most
-cordially.
-
-“You are going to be our guest for several days, I hope?”
-
-“Thank you, no, for I must go on my way this afternoon.”
-
-“I am sorry; but we will soon have dinner.”
-
-Señora Otega left the room to see to it, when the señor remarked:
-
-“Now, which way, señor, for I am sorry to see you alone on a trail?”
-
-“I have company, sir, but they are not visible.”
-
-“Good!”
-
-“My friend, Texas Jack, will be here this afternoon, and will you
-give him a couple of men whom you feel that you can really trust as
-guides?”
-
-“I can give him a dozen men, Señor Cody, but candidly, and with shame
-I say it, I know of but one man on my ranch whom I would fully trust.
-The fact is, I do not know in whom to place confidence. They may be
-all faithful, and yet one may not be so, and that one might be the
-person I select for you.”
-
-“That is very true.”
-
-“But one man I am sure of, Palma, my cowboy chief, and he will go
-with you where you please.”
-
-“Thanks, señor, he will do, and if you will allow him to go with
-Texas Jack I will feel obliged.”
-
-“But you, señor?”
-
-“I am going to make a visit, señor, to the hacienda of the fair
-recluse.”
-
-“Oh, señor!”
-
-“Yes, and I wish you to give me full directions for reaching there.”
-
-“I will, yet---- I do not wish to see you go there.”
-
-“Why not?”
-
-“The cowboy king.”
-
-“Is not the Señorita Suelo a protection upon her own ranch?”
-
-“Yes, but----”
-
-“Well?”
-
-“She will not see you.”
-
-“I will make the trial at least.”
-
-“But why go there?”
-
-“I have a special desire to see her.”
-
-“In your mysterious but seemingly sure way you are working for an
-end, señor, and I say Heaven speed you.”
-
-“When I come back from my visit to the hacienda of the Señorita
-Suelo, I will get your cowboy chief to come to the Mission Ranch for
-a visit of several days, and he will guide us around to the other
-side of that range, for up there is the retreat of the secret foes.”
-
-“I believe you are right. But I also will go, for you, a stranger,
-must not run all the risk in working for us here in this valley, who
-have suffered at the hands of the secret foes. I will accompany you,
-señor, and you may need my aid, as well as that of Palma.”
-
-“I shall be only too happy to have you go, señor, for I shall go
-there for work, deadly work.”
-
-Buffalo Bill rode away from the home of Señor Otega half an hour
-after he had enjoyed one of the señora’s most substantial dinners.
-
-The ranchero was sorry to see him go, yet he was beginning to feel
-that all the scout understood he would accomplish. He had given him
-full directions for reaching the hacienda of the fair recluse.
-
-It was situated down the valley from him, at the foot of the lake,
-and just half a score of miles from the Otega ranch.
-
-As he drew near it, after a brisk ride, Buffalo Bill was glad to
-discover that there were innumerable hiding places for Texas Jack
-and his men, and their approach could not be seen by any one in the
-hacienda.
-
-Some of the cowboys herding cattle gazed at the scout with interest
-as he rode along, but he seemed neither to avoid nor care to meet
-them.
-
-One, however, rode in such a way as to cross his trail, and he said,
-as he drew near:
-
-“Going to the hacienda, señor?”
-
-“Yes.”
-
-“The cowboy king is not there.”
-
-“I wish to see the Señorita Suelo.”
-
-“She receives no strangers, señor.”
-
-“I shall at least try to see her.”
-
-“It will be useless.”
-
-“Has she not cattle and horses for sale?”
-
-“Yes, señor, but the cowboy chief attends to that.”
-
-“In his absence who does?”
-
-“You will have to come again, señor.”
-
-“I will ride on, however, and request to see the señorita.”
-
-“It will only be refused.”
-
-“Very well, I can then turn back. But when will the cowboy king
-return?”
-
-“To-night, señor.”
-
-Thanking the man, Buffalo Bill rode on, and soon approached the heavy
-gate of the hacienda.
-
-A man stood within, looking through a small window, and said,
-somewhat rudely:
-
-“The señorita entertains no strangers beneath her roof.”
-
-“I have not asked it, my man. But you will go and say to the señorita
-that the Señor Cody desires to see her for a few minutes.”
-
-“I’ll go, señor, but she will not see you.”
-
-He returned within ten minutes and said:
-
-“The señorita regrets to decline to see the señor, and that she is
-not able to offer him hospitality beneath her roof.”
-
-Buffalo Bill smiled, and, taking from his pocket a notebook, he tore
-out a leaf and wrote upon it:
-
-“‘If taken from the wrist the charm is broken.’ The Señor Cody begs
-to restore the charm.”
-
-“Hand this to the señorita, my man.”
-
-A silver dollar slipped into the hand prevented any reply, as the man
-had upon his lips a refusal to bear the message. But he walked off,
-and Buffalo Bill waited with no show of anxiety as to the result.
-
-This time the gatekeeper was gone for a much longer time than before,
-and when he returned there was a puzzled look upon his face, as he
-said:
-
-“I’ll allow you to enter, señor, for the señorita will see you?”
-
-“I felt that she would see me,” was the quiet reply of Buffalo Bill.
-
-“She has done so, but----”
-
-“But what?” asked Buffalo Bill, looking the evidently greatly
-surprised gatekeeper straight in the eye.
-
-“The señor is doubtless an old friend of the señorita?”
-
-This was ventured as though the man was cautiously feeling his way.
-
-“I may and may not be a friend.”
-
-The man halted at this and said:
-
-“Well, I am very sure of one thing, señor.”
-
-“It matters nothing to me what you think; do as you were told to
-do--lead me to the presence of the señorita.”
-
-The man had a dogged look and manner. He appeared as though he meant
-not to obey the bidding; but there was that in the look of the scout
-which commanded obedience.
-
-And so he moved on once more.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XLIII.
-
- THE FAIR HERMIT.
-
-
-“Visitors are not allowed here, and, were the cowboy king at home,
-he would not have admitted you,” said the man to Cody, as though
-determined to make another effort to talk.
-
-“My visit is to the Señorita Suelo, not to her servant, the cowboy
-chief,” was the stern reply.
-
-The gateman winced, for the cowboy king evidently was all powerful in
-that hacienda.
-
-The gateman did not lead the visitor into the hacienda, but, halting
-at the flower-garden gate, said:
-
-“The señor will find the señorita in yonder arbor.”
-
-“She does not intend to have any eavesdroppers, that is certain,”
-muttered the scout to himself.
-
-A short walk brought him to the arbor, a perfect bower of beauty amid
-the flowers that were upon all sides.
-
-The señorita arose from a hammock, a book in her hand, as the caller
-approached.
-
-“Señor, be seated,” she said, and she appeared embarrassed.
-
-“Señorita, I have no right, perhaps, to intrude myself upon you,
-knowing the unwritten law of your house that no stranger must enter,
-but I have done so to return to you a trinket that belongs to
-you--one I picked up upon the scene when last we met.”
-
-As Buffalo Bill spoke, he held out the bracelet he had found upon the
-spot where he had rescued the Mexican officer and the maiden from the
-outlaws.
-
-The face of the fair Mexican flushed and paled in turn, and, stepping
-forward, she said earnestly:
-
-“Señor, can you ever forgive me for my treatment of you that day,
-leaving you, as we did, after your saving the señor captain from
-certain death, and rescuing me from the power of cruel foes?
-
-“Yes, the bracelet must have been torn from my wrist unnoticed by my
-captors in the struggle.
-
-“You read what is written within it, señor, so the charm is broken.
-I will never wear it again; no, never! For what is there graven has
-come true--the charm is broken.”
-
-She turned her head, and for a moment was silent, when Buffalo Bill
-spoke:
-
-“I am sorry you no longer have faith in the charm; but I am glad to
-have returned it to you.”
-
-“Señor, I am glad you have done so, for it has given me the chance to
-meet you to tell you how I appreciate all you did that day. Why we
-left you so unceremoniously I cannot tell, for my lips are sealed.”
-
-“And who were those foes of yours, señorita?”
-
-“I do not know.”
-
-“And the señor captain--did he recover from the cruel treatment they
-gave him?”
-
-“Yes, señor.”
-
-“Señorita, I have a request to make.”
-
-“I will grant it.”
-
-“The favor I would ask is that when I come again to see you, you will
-see me.”
-
-“I have promised; but you must not come when the cowboy king is here,
-señor.”
-
-Buffalo Bill’s face did not change a muscle at this remarkable
-request of the fair recluse.
-
-The girl looked at him somewhat anxiously, while he answered
-graciously:
-
-“It shall be as you wish, señorita. I will now bid you adios and
-thank you for having received me.”
-
-“Then thanks are due to you, señor, and I wish you would tell me if
-in any way I can serve you.”
-
-“By allowing me to call again, as you have promised, if I deem it
-best to come.”
-
-“You have my promise.”
-
-“And may I again ask if you have any idea of who the men were who
-attacked you that day?”
-
-“I have not.”
-
-“Were they not the secret foes?”
-
-“No, señor.”
-
-“I did not know but that they might be,” said Buffalo Bill, in a
-peculiar way.
-
-“No, señor, they were not of that band. Their masked leader was a
-foe to--to--the señor captain, and to me. I know; but, just who he
-is I am not aware. He wanted gold, and revenge, as well, it seemed,
-but he thwarted his purpose as far as getting money was concerned,
-for, but for your coming, as you so bravely did, he would have killed
-the señor captain, and from me he would have obtained nothing. The
-outlaws were strangers in the valley, señor, save their chief, and
-just who he was I do not know, as I have stated.”
-
-“Perhaps when I call again, señorita, I may be able to inform you as
-to his identity.”
-
-“Ah! can you?”
-
-“I may,” was the cautious reply, and, declining the offer of
-refreshments, the scout took his leave, the señorita offering her
-hand as she bade him farewell.
-
-“Señor, this valley is full of dangerous characters, and one knows
-not whom to trust. You are going alone upon a dangerous trail, and I
-warn you that you may be halted and held up, as they say here. This
-will protect you from robbery, perhaps from death. Wear it!” and she
-took from the silk scarf about her neck a pin of unique design and
-fastened it upon the lapel of Buffalo Bill’s jacket.
-
-“Señorita, I will keep it as a souvenir of you; it will doubtless be
-a charm to protect me. I thank you.”
-
-Again bidding the beautiful girl good-by, Buffalo Bill left the
-garden, crossed the plaza to where his horse awaited him, and rode
-toward the gate.
-
-There stood the keeper, who now saluted him with marked respect,
-again saying:
-
-“You are the first stranger, señor, who ever gained entrance to this
-hacienda.”
-
-As Buffalo Bill rode along he was not forgetful of being in great
-danger, and he was surprised when he did not see the ranch cowboys
-he had seen when he was on his way to visit the fair hermit. He
-was riding quietly along when he saw a horseman approaching, a
-splendid-looking man, well mounted, and with silver-mounted Mexican
-saddle and bridle.
-
-Buffalo Bill knew him at once from what he had heard of the cowboy
-king.
-
-Both saluted and halted, the cowboy king saying:
-
-“Off your trail, señor?”
-
-“No, for I have been to the hacienda.”
-
-“And why?”
-
-“That I consider none of your business.”
-
-“I shall make it my affair, Señor Cody, and you are covered by my
-men,” responded the cowboy king.
-
-It was true, for four men were peering over a rock with rifles
-leveled at the scout, who said:
-
-“So it seems; but do you not respect this badge?” and he pointed to
-the pin Suelo had given him.
-
-“Not this time, for you are too dangerous a man to be at large. I
-know you, Buffalo Bill.”
-
-“And I know you, now, for you were a deserter from the army, and
-later became a finished cutthroat; but I thought you were dead,
-Dallas Mowbray.”
-
-“No, I left the northern country several years ago, as it became
-too hot for me, and came back to the Southwest, for I am really a
-Mexican, you know, and was once an officer of the Mexican army, but
-was exiled for certain acts. You see, I don’t mind telling you, as I
-regard you as good as dead.”
-
-“Thanks; but while there is life, there is hope.”
-
-“So I have found out; but I’ll fix you now--ho, men, come here!”
-
-The four men came, their rifles still loaded; but as they neared the
-scout there were several shots heard--then one.
-
-The first came from some thick timber close at hand, and the four men
-with rifles dropped dead.
-
-The single shot was from Buffalo Bill’s revolver, who was quick to
-take advantage of the volley in his favor. He had sent a bullet
-through the heart of the cowboy king.
-
-The next moment Texas Jack, four of his pards, with Señor Otega and
-his cowboy chief, Palma, came into view.
-
-“You were just in time, Jack, and I thank you all.
-
-“Find the horses of those four men, strap the bodies in the saddles,
-and we’ll take them to our ranch to-night, and to-morrow there will
-be two visits for us to make, and in full force, for I can see the
-beginning of the end of our trail.”
-
-“As I also can, chief,” answered Texas Jack.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XLIV.
-
- REVEALED.
-
-
-Again did Buffalo Bill pay a visit to the hacienda of the fair
-hermit. It was the day following his meeting with the cowboy king.
-
-Again he was received, and in the garden, as before, while the
-señorita said:
-
-“You have come sooner than I expected, señor; but it is well, as the
-cowboy king is not here.”
-
-“Why do you fear that man?”
-
-“Ah! I cannot tell.”
-
-“What is he to you?”
-
-“Do not ask me.”
-
-“Do you love him?”
-
-“No!”
-
-“I am glad, for I can tell you that you need no longer fear him.”
-
-“What do you mean?” she gasped.
-
-“Señorita, I have read your secret, for that man was the Mexican
-officer I saved with you from those men that day nearly two months
-ago.”
-
-“You recognize him, then?”
-
-“Yes, and as a vile cutthroat who joined our army, robbed the
-paymaster, deserted, and became a fugitive and an outlaw, at last,
-as we believed, being killed, but, instead, coming here. Did you not
-know him as all that was bad?”
-
-“Señor, I was deceived by him, for I believed him an officer of the
-Mexican army. I was left this place, and he urged me to marry him
-secretly, and I did so, then coming here to live, and obeying him
-blindly. At times he came here, I believing he was on duty when he
-was away.
-
-“It was when he was here that you rescued us, and from men I now
-think were not outlaws, but those who suspected him of certain deeds
-and determined to kill him. Perhaps they were my own cowboys, who
-sought to kill him, not wishing a master over them.
-
-“Of late, I have had reason to doubt him, and I meant to know the
-truth, even if he killed me, as he has often threatened to do.”
-
-“Have no fear now, for he is dead.”
-
-“No, no, it cannot be, for he bears a charmed life.”
-
-“It has ended--the charm is broken, as was the case when you lost
-your bracelet.”
-
-“Which he gave to me; but do you know that he is dead?”
-
-“I killed him, Señorita Suelo Sada,” calmly said Buffalo Bill.
-
-“You?”
-
-“Yes, I made you a widow, I am glad to say, for that man was the
-leader of the secret foes of this valley, the one who has put the
-curse upon it which all have dreaded.”
-
-“God bless you, señor, for those words. You have freed me from worse
-than death. But only lately did I suspect that he was really bad at
-heart, and the words I got came to me by a secret letter, and I was
-told to closely watch his movements and I would discover the truth.
-
-“My servants here are innocent, all in the hacienda, but I believe
-all the cowboys are guilty, and were members of his band.”
-
-“I know that they were; but let me tell you that they are all
-prisoners now, for I led my men to their retreat last night, on the
-cliffs, back of my ranch, and through a secret entrance into the old
-hacienda, surprised their hidden camp.
-
-“They had there a score of prisoners, men, women, and children, held
-for ransom, and I learned the story from dying lips, and enough more
-to enable us, under Señor Otega and his chief of cowboys, to find the
-secret entrance to the cliffs.
-
-“We set free all who were there, killed the five guards over them,
-and to-day rounded up and captured your cowboys, seven in number, who
-shared the ransoms paid with their chief.
-
-“You were not guilty, I know, Señorita Suelo Moro, for such is your
-name as Dallas Moro’s wife; but you will be so thought by many in
-this valley, and my advice is that you at once leave here and seek a
-home elsewhere, where no cloud hangs over your life, and Señor Otega
-will see to your property here.”
-
-“Señor Cody, again I say, ‘God bless you,’ and from my heart I thank
-you more than words can tell. I have an ample fortune of my own,
-independent of this accursed ranch, where I have known only sorrow;
-but what I have done he forced me to do. To Señor Otega I leave this
-ranch, cattle and all, for him to dispose of, and pay back to those
-who have paid ransom, every dollar they have been cheated out of.
-
-“Señor, with my few faithful servants I will leave here at sunset,
-and into your hands will I give the paper by which Señor Otega can
-act for me.”
-
-From his heart Buffalo Bill pitied the beautiful and unhappy
-woman, and he was glad, a few hours after, to see her and her few
-faithful servants depart from the hacienda forever, while Señor
-Otega willingly accepted the duty, to carry out the mission she had
-intrusted to him, through Cody.
-
-As quickly as Buffalo Bill and his secret sleuths had entered the
-mysterious valley, they departed from it, carrying with them their
-horses and cattle, and their prisoners also, to deliver over to the
-commandant of the fort nearest the scene, who held control of that
-part of the country.
-
-Among the prisoners was Riel, the innkeeper, who, next to the
-cowboy king, was the guilty one in the many crimes committed in the
-beautiful valley.
-
-It is needless to say that quick punishment was visited upon all the
-prisoners, and Buffalo Bill and his sleuths of the saddle gained
-great praise for their splendid services rendered, and Colonel Carr
-sent a special report to headquarters about the great chief of
-scouts’ brilliant achievement.
-
-As to the beautiful valley, it is as peaceful to-day as a Quaker
-village, and the fair hermit of the hacienda is forgotten, for she
-was never heard of again by those who dwelt in the Silver Lake
-settlement, while the haunted ranch remains but a ruin, surrounded by
-its graves.
-
-
- THE END.
-
- No. 104 of the BUFFALO BILL BORDER STORIES, entitled “Buffalo
- Bill’s Barricade,” is a rattling good story of Indian warfare among
- the red men themselves, helped out by the great scout, who as
- usual, is on the side of those who are fighting for the right.
-
-
-
-
- A REQUEST
-
-
-Conditions due to the war have made it very difficult for us to keep
-in print all of the books listed in our catalogues. We still have
-about fifteen hundred different titles that we are in a position to
-supply. These represent the best books in our line. We could not
-afford, in the circumstances, to reprint any of the less popular
-works.
-
-We aim to keep in stock the works of such authors as Bertha Clay,
-Charles Garvice, May Agnes Fleming, Nicholas Carter, Mary J. Holmes,
-Mrs. Harriet Lewis, Horatio Alger, and the other famous authors who
-are represented in our line by ten or more titles. Therefore, if your
-dealer cannot supply you with exactly the book you want, you are
-almost sure to find in his stock another title by the same author,
-which you have not read.
-
-It short, we are asking you to take what your dealer can supply,
-rather than to insist upon just what you want. You won’t lose
-anything by such substitution, because the books by the authors named
-are very uniform in quality.
-
-In ordering Street & Smith novels by mail, it is advisable to make a
-choice of at least two titles for each book wanted, so as to give us
-an opportunity to substitute for titles that are now out of print.
-
- STREET & SMITH CORPORATION,
-
- 79-89 Seventh Avenue, New York City.
-
-
-
-
- Transcriber’s Notes
-
- The Table of Contents at the beginning of the book was created by
- the transcriber.
-
- Inconsistencies in hyphenation such as “gold-boomer”/“gold boomer”
- have been maintained.
-
- Minor punctuation and spelling errors have been silently corrected
- and, except for those changes noted below, all misspellings in the
- text, especially in dialogue, and inconsistent or archaic usage,
- have been retained.
-
- Page 2: “A Congress of the Rough-riders of the World” changed to “A
- Congress of the Rough Riders of the World”.
-
- Page 238: “Lighting match after mach” changed to “Lighting match
- after match”.
-
-*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK BUFFALO BILL'S BIG SURPRISE ***
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the
-United States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for an eBook, except by following
-the terms of the trademark license, including paying royalties for use
-of the Project Gutenberg trademark. If you do not charge anything for
-copies of this eBook, complying with the trademark license is very
-easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose such as creation
-of derivative works, reports, performances and research. Project
-Gutenberg eBooks may be modified and printed and given away--you may
-do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks not protected
-by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the trademark
-license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country other than the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you will have to check the laws of the country where
- you are located before using this eBook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that:
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the manager of
-the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the Foundation as set
-forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non-profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's business office is located at 809 North 1500 West,
-Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up
-to date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site
-and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without
-widespread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine-readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
diff --git a/old/64262-0.zip b/old/64262-0.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index 159a42c..0000000
--- a/old/64262-0.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/64262-h.zip b/old/64262-h.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index 2115742..0000000
--- a/old/64262-h.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/64262-h/64262-h.htm b/old/64262-h/64262-h.htm
deleted file mode 100644
index 859a4af..0000000
--- a/old/64262-h/64262-h.htm
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,12591 +0,0 @@
-<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
- "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
-<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en">
- <head>
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=utf-8" />
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Style-Type" content="text/css" />
- <title>
- Buffalo Bill’s Big Surprise, by Colonel Prentiss Ingraham&mdash;A Project Gutenberg eBook
- </title>
- <link rel="coverpage" href="images/cover.jpg" />
- <style type="text/css">
-
-body {
- margin-left: 10%;
- margin-right: 10%;
-}
-
- h1,h2 {
- text-align: center; /* all headings centered */
- clear: both;
- margin-top: 1.5em;
- margin-bottom: 1em;
- word-spacing: 0.2em;
- letter-spacing: 0.1em;
- line-height: 1em;
- font-weight: normal;
-}
-
-h1 {font-size: 180%; line-height: 2em;}
-h2 {font-size: 120%; line-height: 1.4em;}
-
-p {
- margin-top: .51em;
- text-align: justify;
- margin-bottom: .49em;
- text-indent: 1em;
-}
-
-.p1 {margin-top: 1em;}
-.p2 {margin-top: 2em;}
-.p4 {margin-top: 4em;}
-.p6 {margin-top: 6em;}
-
-.pb2 {margin-bottom: 2em;}
-.pb4 {margin-bottom: 4em;}
-
-.p10pc {margin-top: 10%;}
-.pg-brk {page-break-before: always;}
-
-div.chapter {page-break-before: always;}
-h2.nobreak {page-break-before: avoid;}
-
-.pfs180 {font-size: 180%; text-align: center; text-indent: 0em; word-spacing: 0.3em;}
-.pfs135 {font-size: 135%; text-align: center; text-indent: 0em; word-spacing: 0.3em;}
-.pfs120 {font-size: 120%; text-align: center; text-indent: 0em; word-spacing: 0.3em;}
-.pfs100 {font-size: 100%; text-align: center; text-indent: 0em; word-spacing: 0.3em;}
-.pfs90 {font-size: 90%; text-align: center; text-indent: 0em; word-spacing: 0.3em;}
-.pfs80 {font-size: 80%; text-align: center; text-indent: 0em; word-spacing: 0.3em;}
-
-.fs50 {font-size: 50%; font-style: normal;}
-.fs70 {font-size: 70%; font-style: normal;}
-.fs80 {font-size: 80%; font-style: normal;}
-.fs90 {font-size: 90%; font-style: normal;}
-
-.bold {font-weight: bold;}
-
-
-/* for horizontal lines */
-hr {
- width: 33%;
- margin-top: 1.5em;
- margin-bottom: 1em;
- margin-left: 33.5%;
- margin-right: 33.5%;
- clear: both;
-}
-
-hr.chap {width: 65%; margin-left: 17.5%; margin-right: 17.5%;}
-hr.r10 {width: 10%; margin-left: 45%; margin-right: 45%;}
-
-@media handheld {
-hr.chap {width: 0%; display: none;}
-}
-
-
-/* for inserting info from TN changes */
-.corr {
- text-decoration: none;
- border-bottom: thin dotted gray;
-}
-
-@media handheld {
- .corr {
- text-decoration: none;
- border-bottom: none;
- }
-}
-
-
-/* for tables */
-table {
- margin-left: auto;
- margin-right: auto;}
-
-table.autotable { border-collapse: collapse; }
-table.autotable td {}
-
-.tdl {text-align: left; padding-left: 1.5em; text-indent: -1em;}
-.tdr {text-align: right;}
-
-
-/* for spacing */
-.pad5 {padding-left: 5em;}
-
-
-.pagenum { /* uncomment the next line for invisible page numbers */
- /* visibility: hidden; */
- position: absolute;
- color: #A9A9A9;
- left: 92%;
- font-size: smaller;
- text-align: right;
- font-style: normal;
- font-weight: normal;
- font-variant: normal;
- text-indent: .5em;
-}
-
-
-/* blockquote (/# #/) */
-.blockquot { margin: 1.5em 15% 1.5em 15%; }
-
-.blockquotx { margin: 1.5em 5% 1.5em 5%; }
-
-
-/* general placement and presentation */
-.bbox {margin: 5% 10% 5% 10%;
- padding: .5em;
- border: double thick;}
-
-.center {text-align: center; margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto;}
-
-.smcap {font-variant: small-caps;}
-
-
-/* Images */
-
-img {
- border: none;
- max-width: 100%;
- height: auto;
-}
-
-img.w100 {width: 100%;}
-
-
-.figcenter {
- margin: auto;
- text-align: center;
- page-break-inside: avoid;
- max-width: 100%;
-}
-
-
-/* Transcriber's notes */
-.transnote {background-color: #E6E6FA;
- color: black;
- font-size:smaller;
- padding:0.5em;
- margin-bottom:5em;
- font-family:sans-serif, serif; }
-
-.transnote p {text-indent: 0em;}
-
-
-/* Illustration classes */
-.illowe4_375 {width: 4.375em;}
-.illowe4_6875 {width: 4.6875em;}
-.illowp51 {width: 51%;} @media handheld { .illowp51 {width: 100%;} }
-
- </style>
- </head>
-
-<body>
-
-<div style='text-align:center; font-size:1.2em; font-weight:bold'>The Project Gutenberg eBook of Buffalo Bill's Big Surprise, by Colonel Prentiss Ingraham</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
-most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms
-of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online
-at <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>. If you
-are not located in the United States, you will have to check the laws of the
-country where you are located before using this eBook.
-</div>
-
-<table style='margin-left:0; border-collapse:collapse'>
- <tr><td>Title:</td><td>Buffalo Bill's Big Surprise</td></tr>
- <tr><td></td><td>The Biggest Stampede on Record</td></tr>
-</table>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:1em; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em'>Author: Colonel Prentiss Ingraham</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>Release Date: January 11, 2021 [eBook #64262]</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>Language: English</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>Character set encoding: UTF-8</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em'>Produced by: David Edwards, Susan Carr and the Online Distributed Proofreading Team at https://www.pgdp.net</div>
-
-<div style='margin-top:2em; margin-bottom:4em'>*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK BUFFALO BILL'S BIG SURPRISE ***</div>
-
-<div class="figcenter illowp51" id="cover" style="max-width: 59.75em;">
- <img class="w100" src="images/cover.jpg" alt="" />
-</div>
-
-<hr class="chap p6 pg-brk" />
-
-<h1>Buffalo Bill’s Big Surprise<br />
-<span class="fs50">OR</span>,<br />
-<span class="fs80">The Biggest Stampede on Record</span></h1>
-
-<p class="pfs80 p6">BY</p>
-
-<p class="pfs135">Colonel Prentiss Ingraham</p>
-
-<p class="pfs90">Author of the celebrated “Buffalo Bill” stories published in the<br />
-<span class="smcap">Border Stories</span>. For other titles see catalogue.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter illowe4_375" id="colophon">
- <img class="w100 p4" src="images/colophon.jpg" alt="Colophon" />
-</div>
-
-<p class="pfs120 p4">STREET &amp; SMITH CORPORATION</p>
-<p class="pfs90">PUBLISHERS</p>
-<p class="pfs120">79-89 Seventh Avenue, New York</p>
-
-<hr class="chap p10pc" />
-
-<div class="bbox pg-brk">
-
-<p class="p2 pfs100">Copyright, 1914</p>
-<p class="pfs100">By STREET &amp; SMITH</p>
-<hr class="r10" />
-<p class="pfs100 pb2">Buffalo Bill’s Big Surprise</p>
-</div>
-
-<p class="pfs90">All rights reserved, including that of translation into foreign<br />
-languages, including the Scandinavian.</p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CONTENTS">CONTENTS</h2>
-</div>
-
-<table class="autotable fs90" width="95%" summary="">
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr"></td>
-<td class="tdl"></td>
-<td class="tdr fs80">PAGE</td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr"></td>
-<td class="tdl">IN APPRECIATION OF WILLIAM F. CODY</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_1">1</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">I.</td>
-<td class="tdl">BAD NEWS.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_5">5</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">II.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE OUTLAWS’ ALLY</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_11">11</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">III.</td>
-<td class="tdl">PLOTTING WITH A FOE.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_15">15</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">IV.</td>
-<td class="tdl">BURSTING SHELLS.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_22">22</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">V.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE RETURN.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_31">31</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">VI.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE FORGED LETTER.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_48">48</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">VII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE FLIGHT.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_56">56</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">VIII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">IN THE INDIAN VILLAGE.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_65">65</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">IX.</td>
-<td class="tdl">BUFFALO BILL’S BOLD VENTURE.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_86">86</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">X.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE RESCUER REACHES THE GOAL.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_91">91</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XI.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE GUARD OF HONOR.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_96">96</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">CORRALLED BY INDIANS.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_101">101</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XIII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE RIDE FOR HELP.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_107">107</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XIV.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE BLACK TROOPERS AT BAY.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_113">113</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XV.</td>
-<td class="tdl">A VERY STRANGE FIND.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_118">118</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XVI.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE NEGRO MESSENGER.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_123">123</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XVII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">TWO SHOTS.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_129">129</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XVIII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE BAD MAN OF THE BIG HORN.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_137">137</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XIX.</td>
-<td class="tdl">A DOUBLE ESCAPE.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_143">143</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XX.</td>
-<td class="tdl">BLACK SCOUTS ON THE TRAIL.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_147">147</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXI.</td>
-<td class="tdl">TO THE RESCUE.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_152">152</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">BLACK BILL’S LONE HAND.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_159">159</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXIII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">BLACK BILL’S PRISONER.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_165">165</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXIV.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE LOST VALLEY.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_171">171</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXV.</td>
-<td class="tdl">UNSEEN FOES.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_178">178</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXVI.</td>
-<td class="tdl">FACE TO FACE WITH ENEMIES.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_185">185</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXVII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">A DISCOVERY.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_194">194</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXVIII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">A LIVING TOMB.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_201">201</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXIX.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE RESCUE.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_207">207</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXX.</td>
-<td class="tdl">OUT OF DEVIL’S DEN.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_212">212</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXXI.</td>
-<td class="tdl">ANOTHER STRANGE STORY.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_215">215</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXXII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">UNDER A CURSE.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_223">223</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXXIII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE HACIENDA.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_230">230</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXXIV.</td>
-<td class="tdl">HAUNTED.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_237">237</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXXV.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE SEARCH OF THE RUIN.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_243">243</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXXVI.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE FIRST NIGHT.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_249">249</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXXVII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">A DEAD GHOST.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_255">255</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXXVIII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">ON SECRET WORK.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_261">261</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XXXIX.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE SCOUT’S RETURN.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_270">270</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XL.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE SHOT ON THE CLIFF.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_281">281</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XLI.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE FIGHT IN THE SLEUTHS’ CAMP.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_289">289</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XLII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">A STARTLING VISIT.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_302">302</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XLIII.</td>
-<td class="tdl">THE FAIR HERMIT.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_310">310</a> </td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
-<td class="tdr">XLIV.</td>
-<td class="tdl">REVEALED.</td>
-<td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_316">316</a> </td>
-</tr>
-</table>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_1"></a>[Pg 1]</span></p>
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="IN_APPRECIATION_OF_WILLIAM_F_CODY">IN APPRECIATION OF WILLIAM F. CODY<br />
-<span class="fs70">(BUFFALO BILL).</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>It is now some generations since Josh Billings, Ned
-Buntline, and Colonel Prentiss Ingraham, intimate friends
-of Colonel William F. Cody, used to forgather in the
-office of Francis S. Smith, then proprietor of the <cite>New
-York Weekly</cite>. It was a dingy little office on Rose Street,
-New York, but the breath of the great outdoors stirred
-there when these old-timers got together. As a result of
-these conversations, Colonel Ingraham and Ned Buntline
-began to write of the adventures of Buffalo Bill
-for Street &amp; Smith.</p>
-
-<p>Colonel Cody was born in Scott County, Iowa, February
-26, 1846. Before he had reached his teens, his
-father, Isaac Cody, with his mother and two sisters,
-migrated to Kansas, which at that time was little more
-than a wilderness.</p>
-
-<p>When the elder Cody was killed shortly afterward in
-the Kansas “Border War,” young Bill assumed the difficult
-rôle of family breadwinner. During 1860, and until
-the outbreak of the Civil War, Cody lived the arduous
-life of a pony-express rider. Cody volunteered his services
-as government scout and guide and served throughout
-the Civil War with Generals McNeil and A. J.
-Smith. He was a distinguished member of the Seventh
-Kansas Cavalry.</p>
-
-<p>During the Civil War, while riding through the streets
-of St. Louis, Cody rescued a frightened schoolgirl from
-a band of annoyers. In true romantic style, Cody and
-Louisa Federci, the girl, were married March 6, 1866.</p>
-
-<p>In 1867 Cody was employed to furnish a specified
-amount of buffalo meat to the construction men at work
-on the Kansas Pacific Railroad. It was in this period
-that he received the sobriquet “Buffalo Bill.”</p>
-
-<p>In 1868 and for four years thereafter Colonel Cody<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_2"></a>[2]</span>
-served as scout and guide in campaigns against the Sioux
-and Cheyenne Indians. It was General Sheridan who
-conferred on Cody the honor of chief of scouts of the
-command.</p>
-
-<p>After completing a period of service in the Nebraska
-legislature, Cody joined the Fifth Cavalry in 1876, and
-was again appointed chief of scouts.</p>
-
-<p>Colonel Cody’s fame had reached the East long before,
-and a great many New Yorkers went out to see
-him and join in his buffalo hunts, including such men
-as August Belmont, James Gordon Bennett, Anson
-Stager, and J. G. Heckscher. In entertaining these
-visitors at Fort McPherson, Cody was accustomed to
-arrange wild-West exhibitions. In return his friends
-invited him to visit New York. It was upon seeing his
-first play in the metropolis that Cody conceived the idea
-of going into the show business.</p>
-
-<p>Assisted by Ned Buntline, novelist, and Colonel Ingraham,
-he started his “Wild West” show, which later
-developed and expanded into “<ins class="corr" id="tn2" title="Transcriber’s Note—“A Congress of the Rough-riders of the World” changed to “A Congress of the Rough Riders of the World”.">A Congress of the Rough Riders of the World</ins>,”
-first presented at Omaha, Nebraska. In time it became a familiar
-yearly entertainment in the great cities of this country and Europe.
-Many famous personages attended the performances, and became his warm
-friends, including Mr. Gladstone, the Marquis of Lorne, King Edward,
-Queen Victoria, and the Prince of Wales, now King of England.</p>
-
-<p>At the outbreak of the Sioux, in 1890 and 1891,
-Colonel Cody served at the head of the Nebraska National
-Guard. In 1895 Cody took up the development
-of Wyoming Valley by introducing irrigation. Not long
-afterward he became judge advocate general of the
-Wyoming National Guard.</p>
-
-<p>Colonel Cody (Buffalo Bill) died in Denver, Colorado,
-on January 10, 1917. His legacy to a grateful world was
-a large share in the development of the West, and a
-multitude of achievements in horsemanship, marksmanship,
-and endurance that will live for ages. His life
-will continue to be a leading example of the manliness,
-courage, and devotion to duty that belonged to a picturesque
-phase of American life now passed, like the great
-patriot whose career it typified, into the Great Beyond.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_5"></a>[5]</span></p>
-
-<p class="pfs180">BUFFALO BILL’S BIG SURPRISE.</p>
-
-<hr class="r10" />
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_I">CHAPTER I.<br />
-<span class="fs70">BAD NEWS.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-<p>It was at Fort Advance, one of the smaller frontier
-posts on the Indian border, just about the hour of sunset.
-Buffalo Bill and Colonel Carr, the commandant
-of the fort, were chatting together when suddenly Buffalo
-Bill raised his hands and pointed across the plains.</p>
-
-<p>A horseman could be seen in the distance, and he
-was approaching at a furious gallop.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill scanned the figure for a moment in
-silence.</p>
-
-<p>“It is Hugh Hardin, the oldest of my scouts,” he
-said, “and I am willing to bet a few cigars that he
-brings news of a fresh Indian uprising.”</p>
-
-<p>It was, indeed, Hugh Hardin, and a moment later
-he had pulled up his steed before Buffalo Bill and
-Colonel Carr, and, after saluting his superior officers,
-was making his report.</p>
-
-<p>It was to the effect that the Indians to the number of
-several thousands were on the warpath, under command
-of Death Face and several other of their chiefs.</p>
-
-<p>“I scouted near their camp,” said Hugh Hardin,
-“and I know that there is at least one white man in<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_6"></a>[6]</span>
-their number. I saw him. He is Eagle, a well-known
-outlaw. He was formerly chief of the band
-known as the Renegade Red Riders, which you broke
-up, Buffalo Bill, not long ago.”</p>
-
-<p>“What! Eagle, the outlaw chief!” exclaimed the
-colonel. “I thought you killed him, Cody?”</p>
-
-<p>“I followed him and drove him off a precipice into
-Rapid River&mdash;man and horse,” said Cody; “but it
-looks as if he had escaped by swimming, and joined the
-redskins, now that his own band is wiped out. Are
-you sure that he is with the Indians?”</p>
-
-<p>“Perfectly,” said Hugh Hardin.</p>
-
-<p>“That man must be captured at all hazards,” said
-the colonel. “I shall immediately order out a troop
-of cavalry, as well as a battery of infantry, and send
-them on to oppose the Indians.”</p>
-
-<p>An hour later the detachment of cavalry and artillery,
-under command of Lieutenant Worth, one of
-the most popular young officers in the post, was starting
-for Rapid River.</p>
-
-<p>Two other commands of artillery and cavalry were
-dispatched immediately afterward.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill headed the column, of course, and when,
-early the next day, after a hard night ride, they were
-within a few miles of the river, he advised the lieutenant
-to call a halt.</p>
-
-<p>“I will go forward myself on a scout,” he said, “before<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_7"></a>[7]</span>
-the Indians discover that there is a body of soldiers
-in the vicinity.”</p>
-
-<p>“I suggest that you take one of the men in my troop,
-Sergeant Fallon, as an assistant. He has lived with
-the Indians for years, and can disguise himself perfectly
-as one, and speak the language well. Besides,
-they say that he has powerful friends among the Sioux
-chiefs. He can enter the camp in disguise, perhaps.”</p>
-
-<p>Sergeant Fallon, a tall, lean, dark-faced man, stepped
-forward at the command of Lieutenant Worth, and,
-after a few words with Buffalo Bill, went off to disguise
-himself as an Indian, a complete disguise having
-been brought along with the artillery equipments by
-command of Lieutenant Worth.</p>
-
-<p>“He is a mysterious man, evidently well educated,”
-said the lieutenant to Buffalo Bill, “and no one knows
-why he entered the army, as he is reputed to be very
-wealthy. He has good cause to wish to be revenged
-on Eagle, the outlaw chief. Eagle captured his daughter,
-Lucille Fallon, when she was on her way West, to
-hold her for ransom, and it was you yourself who
-rescued her when you wiped out Eagle’s band.”</p>
-
-<p>“I remember the occasion,” said the great scout;
-“but here comes the man, and he looks like an Indian,
-indeed.”</p>
-
-<p>Sergeant Fallon’s disguise was perfect, and an hour
-later the scout and he set out.</p>
-
-<p>When they reached Rapid River, Fallon decided to<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_8"></a>[8]</span>
-swim his horse across and enter the Indian camp disguised
-as he was, and Buffalo Bill, knowing from what
-he had seen and heard of the man that he could thoroughly
-trust him, allowed him to do so.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill accompanied him as far as the river,
-and watched him across. He lost his form after he
-had got halfway across, but waited until he was sure
-that Fallon had reached the other side and found the
-Indian guards.</p>
-
-<p>Hearing no outcry or shot, he muttered:</p>
-
-<p>“I guess he’s all right, but his danger is great.</p>
-
-<p>“The man grows upon me more and more, and I am
-sure that he has once held a high position and been in
-command of men.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, if he gets back in safety, I will use my influence
-to get him the commission he richly deserves.”</p>
-
-<p>So saying, the scout gazed in silence for a while
-over the weird, wild scene, lit up by the moonlight into
-picturesque beauty, and then, turning his horse, rode
-back to his camp for the night.</p>
-
-<p>The sergeant, meanwhile, had crossed the river, been
-met by the guards, and then rode to the camp beyond
-the ridge.</p>
-
-<p>To his surprise, he found there over a hundred Indian
-braves, and about a camp fire built out of sight
-up in a niche of the cliff stood several forms, upon
-whom his eyes were at once riveted.</p>
-
-<p>Fighting Bird, an old Sioux chief, was there, and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_9"></a>[9]</span>
-near him stood the young chief, Death Face, while,
-seated upon a rock near, was a splendid type of a redskin
-leader, a man of almost herculean proportions,
-robed in gorgeous costume of tanned doeskin heavily
-embroidered with wampum, and wearing a war bonnet
-of barbaric splendor. His face was bold, rugged,
-crafty, intelligent, and merciless.</p>
-
-<p>That countenance was furrowed with age, silver
-threads streaked his raven locks, but he was still the
-mighty leader of his people, the grand old fighter, plotter,
-good general, merciless foe of the palefaces, Iron
-Eyes, the head chief of his tribe.</p>
-
-<p>By his side stood a fourth person.</p>
-
-<p>It was one of elegant form, handsome face, dark
-and sinister, fine though it was. He was dressed in a
-black fatigue suit of army style, wore buttons of ten-dollar
-gold pieces, diamond studs and sleeve buttons in
-his negligee silk shirt, a massive watch chain, and a
-large, brilliant ruby upon the little finger of his left
-hand, his right being covered with a red glove.</p>
-
-<p>This man had a cigar between his lips, stood like one
-waiting to be photographed, one booted foot resting
-upon a rock before him, and his elbow leaning upon his
-knee as a rest.</p>
-
-<p>His spurs were of gold, his belt of arms showed
-that they were ornamented with the same precious
-metal, and, altogether, he was a most picturesque and
-striking figure, a man to stand in awe of.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_10"></a>[10]</span></p>
-
-<p>As the sergeant approached, old Iron Eyes arose
-and greeted him, greeted him as he would one for
-whom he held both reverence and affection.</p>
-
-<p>“Iron Eyes is surprised at meeting his paleface
-brother, the great medicine chief, White Wolf. The
-Iron Eyes has with him another great chief of the
-paleface race, the Eagle, his brother and ally, and here
-is my son, the mighty young chief who will some day
-wear the war bonnet of old Iron Eyes.</p>
-
-<p>“It gladdens my heart to again see my brother, the
-White Wolf. He is welcome, and he has proven my
-friend.”</p>
-
-<p>Such was the welcome and the introduction of the
-sergeant to those assembled about the camp fire in the
-little ravine among the cliffs.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_11"></a>[11]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_II">CHAPTER II.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE OUTLAWS’ ALLY.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Sergeant Fallon was perfectly calm under the ordeal
-he was passing through. He greeted the old chief
-most reverently and kindly, offered his hand to the
-outlaw, for he wished to feel his grip and remember it,
-and saluted the young son of Iron Eyes courteously,
-while he did not by any means ignore Fighting Bird.</p>
-
-<p>But he lost no time in at once saying:</p>
-
-<p>“I am here unexpectedly to-night, for I wish to tell
-the great chief that his foes are not sure that he has
-warriors camped here, and they intend to send out
-scouts on foot to cross the river and find out. By
-drawing your braves far back, putting out your camp
-fires, and not one being seen, the scouts will come over
-and find no braves here.</p>
-
-<p>“They will report this to their chiefs, and then when
-another night the force attempts to cross, the warriors
-of Iron Eyes will be here to ambush them.”</p>
-
-<p>The words of the disguised sergeant were listened
-to in silence, but with great interest, and old Iron Eyes
-said:</p>
-
-<p>“The Chief White Wolf speaks with wisdom, and
-my warriors shall at once draw back to cover.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, it will be the very thing to do, for if the soldiers
-believe that you have withdrawn your guards<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_12"></a>[12]</span>
-from the fords, they will cross, hoping to surprise you,
-and dash upon an ambush and be beaten back right
-here, as they should be.”</p>
-
-<p>“I would send couriers to the other bands, also,
-chief,” the outlaw joined in, “to have them also fall
-back for the night. Would you not, White Wolf?”</p>
-
-<p>“It would be just what I should do, sir,” answered
-the sergeant.</p>
-
-<p>Orders were at once given to put out the camp fires,
-get the ponies and camp outfit, and retreat over the
-range half a mile back.</p>
-
-<p>The sergeant went along and rode with Iron Eyes,
-the two talking together like old friends.</p>
-
-<p>When they had come to a halt, the outlaw stepped
-up to the sergeant and asked:</p>
-
-<p>“What force is on the other side, sir?”</p>
-
-<p>“There are three commands, sir; two of considerable
-strength, the other not so large.”</p>
-
-<p>“Have they any guns?”</p>
-
-<p>“All three commands have artillery, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“And infantry?”</p>
-
-<p>“Mounted infantry, with cavalry and guns.”</p>
-
-<p>“Then Carr is in earnest?” said the outlaw.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir, he seems determined.”</p>
-
-<p>“There are three men there whom I hate. I will
-give a reward to get their scalps.”</p>
-
-<p>“Who are they, sir?”</p>
-
-<p>“One is Lieutenant Worth, who has been a persistent<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_13"></a>[13]</span>
-foe of my band of Red Riders; one is Buffalo Bill, and
-the other is Sergeant Fallon.”</p>
-
-<p>“I know them all, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“They have both been strong allies to wipe me out,
-and here I am a fugitive to-day with no men left, and
-must begin life anew to gain both gold and revenge.
-But I am not dead yet, and I will have both.”</p>
-
-<p>“You are right, Captain Eagle,” said the sergeant.</p>
-
-<p>“May I ask your name, my friend?”</p>
-
-<p>“My name is Louis, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“What position do you hold under Colonel Carr?”</p>
-
-<p>“I am in the ordnance department, but hold only an
-inferior position.”</p>
-
-<p>“You have once dwelt among the Indians?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, as a fugitive from my own people, I became
-a renegade and was a medicine chief. When I could
-do so I returned to my people, unknown, however, to
-work like you, for gold and revenge. Some day I will
-have both.”</p>
-
-<p>“See here, you are just the man that can aid me, and
-in doing so help yourself.”</p>
-
-<p>“I am willing, if there is any money in it.”</p>
-
-<p>“There is, and big money, too, for you.”</p>
-
-<p>“I am your man, Captain Eagle,” was the earnest
-reply.</p>
-
-<p>The outlaw was evidently greatly excited through
-some thought that had crossed his mind. He paced
-to and fro for a minute, his hands clasped behind his<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_14"></a>[14]</span>
-back, his whole bearing that of one who was moved by
-strong emotion.</p>
-
-<p>Again turning to the sergeant, he said, and in a perfectly
-calm tone:</p>
-
-<p>“You dwell at Fort Advance, of course?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“Do you know Sergeant Fallon well?”</p>
-
-<p>“He is my most intimate friend, and I occupy his
-quarters.”</p>
-
-<p>“Good! Have you any love for him?”</p>
-
-<p>“I have for him, sir, the deepest hatred, as he has
-been my worst enemy, and at times I have been tempted
-to take his life.”</p>
-
-<p>“Then you are the very man I want for an ally&mdash;what
-do you say?”</p>
-
-<p>“I will serve you, sir, as I can serve myself in doing
-so.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_15"></a>[15]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_III">CHAPTER III.<br />
-<span class="fs70">PLOTTING WITH A FOE.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>The outlaw leader seemed pleased with the idea of
-his ally’s hatred for Sergeant Fallon, and said, when
-he was told that he would serve him:</p>
-
-<p>“Well, you will have to go slow, and there is much
-to be done.”</p>
-
-<p>“I am ready.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll tell you just what my plan is, and see what
-you think of it.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll frankly tell you what I think.”</p>
-
-<p>“I believe you, for the chief speaks of you in the
-highest terms, in fact loves you as a brother, and the
-only thing I had against you was that, after being a
-renegade, you went back to your people.”</p>
-
-<p>“It was, as I said before, for a purpose.”</p>
-
-<p>“Ah, yes; but now to my plot with you.”</p>
-
-<p>“I am all attention.”</p>
-
-<p>“You, of course, know the sergeant’s daughter?”</p>
-
-<p>“I do.”</p>
-
-<p>“She is an heiress, you know?”</p>
-
-<p>“I have heard so; in fact, I know that it is the case,
-from the sergeant.”</p>
-
-<p>“I had her a captive, with others, but Buffalo Bill
-guided Lieutenant Worth, Sergeant Fallon, and others
-to my retreat and rescued the prisoners, destroying my<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_16"></a>[16]</span>
-band and making me fly as a fugitive for shelter with
-my good friend, Iron Eyes.”</p>
-
-<p>“I see.”</p>
-
-<p>“Now, I wish to get possession of Lucille Fallon, the
-sergeant’s daughter.”</p>
-
-<p>“Ah!”</p>
-
-<p>“And that is what I wish you to aid me in.”</p>
-
-<p>“I can do it if any man can.”</p>
-
-<p>“My plan is for you to notify me, by a letter left at
-a certain spot on the Overland trail, which I will describe
-to you, when I can get possession of her. She
-can be called to Pioneer City through an excuse of
-some kind to meet a lawyer there who will not come
-farther on, and I will hold up the coach and capture
-her.”</p>
-
-<p>“But your men are all dead or prisoners?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, but I am organizing another band out of new
-material, men who will serve my purpose even better
-than the others did.”</p>
-
-<p>“You wish to capture the girl and get a big ransom
-for her?”</p>
-
-<p>“That is just it, and Sergeant Fallon with her.”</p>
-
-<p>“You wish both?”</p>
-
-<p>“I do, the one for revenge, the other for gold.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, I believe I can arrange it.”</p>
-
-<p>“You must understand the whole situation, the name
-of the girl’s lawyer in New York, something of the
-facts of the case of her inheritance, and just what to<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_17"></a>[17]</span>
-do. Now, when she was my captive, I looked over her
-papers, and I have the name and address of the lawyer,
-in fact, one of his letters, and I can forge his
-writing perfectly.</p>
-
-<p>“I will write the letter to her, mail it from Pioneer
-City, telling her that, writing as the lawyer, I cannot
-come any farther, as I am suffering with an attack of
-rheumatism, and that she and her father must come to
-me, the lawyer, mind you, by return coach. I will then
-lie in wait on the trail and capture them.”</p>
-
-<p>“A good idea.”</p>
-
-<p>“There is another thing: You must see to it that
-the girl’s jewels and money are taken along, though
-she must not know this. Smuggle them on the coach
-in some way, for you can get possession of them, intimate
-as you are at the sergeant’s home, and I will
-share with you.”</p>
-
-<p>“Thank you. I know where the money and jewels
-are kept, and I can get them, and will see that they
-go through with the sergeant and his daughter, never
-fear.”</p>
-
-<p>“Is Jack Jessop, the star driver, driving now?”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“It will be his last trip, for I’ll bury him on Monument
-Hill. He is too plucky a man to be in the Overland
-coach-driving business, and so he goes under.”</p>
-
-<p>“It is just as well, I guess, though I rather like
-Jack.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_18"></a>[18]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Well, now, we’ll go over the whole matter again, and just as soon
-as you return to the fort notify me by letter what you think can be
-done, or if you can think of any better plan. The place to leave the
-letter is under the end of the third board of the Cañon River bridge,
-where it projects over the land, as I suppose it must, though I have
-not seen the new structure. At any rate, look well for a spot there,
-and I’ll find it, for I’ll take to the trail soon with my new band.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll prepare the way for you, Captain Eagle, never fear,” was the
-answer of the sergeant, and then the two went all over the same
-ground again, the outlaw asking many questions about the fort and its
-people, and coming to what he considered was a thorough understanding
-with the man whom he little dreamed to be his foe.</p>
-
-<p>This conversation being ended, the sergeant held a powwow with his
-old friend Iron Eyes, the outlaw, Death Face, and Fighting Bird being
-present.</p>
-
-<p>It being then a couple of hours after midnight, Sergeant Fallon
-suggested that he would make a visit to the ford to see if the enemy
-had sent their scouts across, and send back word by a couple of
-warriors who would accompany him, as he would then be compelled to go
-on back to the command where he was expected to serve as the Indians’
-spy.</p>
-
-<p>Two young braves were, therefore, called to accompany him, and Iron
-Eyes said that he had increased the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_19"></a>[19]</span>
-force of guards at each ford by fifty men, while several hundred
-more braves under Death Face would camp at the first mountain pass
-on the trail, where they could give battle to the soldiers, and be
-reënforced readily from the village.</p>
-
-<p>Iron Eyes himself would return to his village, and Captain Eagle was
-to remain at the ford, being at liberty to go where he pleased.</p>
-
-<p>Assured by these facts, and accompanied by the two braves, the
-sergeant set out upon his return.</p>
-
-<p>He left the braves on the ridge, advanced alone to the river, and
-discovering, by the sign agreed upon between them, that Buffalo Bill
-had been there, he went back and told the warriors to return and
-report to Iron Eyes that a scout from the soldiers had been across
-the river, so that they could come back into their camp again.</p>
-
-<p>Then he rode into the river to cross.</p>
-
-<p>The sergeant was greeted by Buffalo Bill as he rode out of the water,
-the two friends clasping hands warmly.</p>
-
-<p>“I am glad, indeed, to see you again, sergeant, for I was becoming
-very nervous about you.”</p>
-
-<p>“I was delayed, as I did not dare appear anxious to get back.”</p>
-
-<p>“I found Iron Eyes, Death Face, and the outlaw in camp when I went
-over, and a number of warriors, as well, so I decided to get them
-well out of the way<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_20"></a>[20]</span>
-at once, and would not delay for the time agreed upon.</p>
-
-<p>“I found, upon my return to the ford, that you had
-been there and crossed. I gave the chief a great ghost
-story about the soldiers, and I had an hour’s chat with
-the outlaw,” and Fallon related all his conversation
-with the outlaw.</p>
-
-<p>“When he holds up the coach he will not only find
-Sergeant Fallon in it, but Buffalo Bill, Lieutenant
-Worth, and a few good scouts and soldiers, with others
-following on behind, and a few more to head off the
-outlaws, so that we will catch the whole outfit,” said
-the sergeant.</p>
-
-<p>“The very thing to be done, sergeant; but who has
-the outlaw chief for a band?”</p>
-
-<p>“That is the question, Cody.”</p>
-
-<p>“Doubtless redskins?”</p>
-
-<p>“I had that idea at first, but he spoke of going to
-Pioneer City, where he had friends, and I believe he
-will get men there, and more than he had before, from
-what he gave out in the way of hints.”</p>
-
-<p>“Then, to be sure, we will have to be well provided
-with men, say one on the box with Jack Jessop, who
-is also to be counted when it’s a scrimmage, and a
-dozen can pack away in the coach. Then a few scouts
-and soldiers on the trail behind the coach, some more
-of my men ahead and we’ll rope in the entire outfit, as
-you suggest.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_21"></a>[21]</span></p>
-
-<p>“We’ll do it, and arrange with the lieutenant, but
-keep it as secret as the grave. When the letter comes
-we will then be ready to go out on the first coach, and
-the man who rides on the box with Jack Jessop can
-wear a hat and clothes to appear to be my daughter, for
-she rode all the way through on the box, you know.
-But here we are at camp.”</p>
-
-<p>Day had dawned, and the camp was astir, though the
-men were not building any fires, but were preparing to
-eat a cold breakfast.</p>
-
-<p>Having washed off his paint and changed his clothes,
-the sergeant and Buffalo Bill went directly to the quarters
-of the lieutenant.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_22"></a>[22]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_IV">CHAPTER IV.<br />
-<span class="fs70">BURSTING SHELLS.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Before nightfall the two reserve commands had
-reached the fords, to which they had been guided by
-the scout sent to each of them.</p>
-
-<p>They found them good camping places, water, wood,
-and grass in plenty, and which could be readily defended
-if need be.</p>
-
-<p>There were a dozen fires built by those sent on
-ahead, and the officers in command were delighted to
-learn that there was a chance for a brush with the Indians,
-for, being ordered to the front, they believed
-there would be.</p>
-
-<p>It was just before sunset that Lieutenant Worth,
-Buffalo Bill, and Sergeant Fallon rode into the camp
-at the upper ford, and were welcomed by the officers
-and men.</p>
-
-<p>“Percy, how is your gun placed?” asked Lieutenant
-Worth of the officer in charge.</p>
-
-<p>“It commands the ford and the other shore, though
-it is not in position to be seen.”</p>
-
-<p>“All right, run it into position as soon as Buffalo
-Bill shows you, just to toss a shell or two, for he has
-been devoting the past day to studying the Indian
-camps at two of the fords,” said the lieutenant, with a
-smile, while the scout remarked:</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_23"></a>[23]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Say night, rather, lieutenant, for I’ve been resting
-by daylight.”</p>
-
-<p>Going to a point which commanded a view of the
-other shore, Buffalo Bill ran his glass over it and
-said:</p>
-
-<p>“Sergeant, when I reconnoitered, the camp was in
-those willows.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, that is it; and the ponies are corralled over
-beyond them.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll see if I can put a shell there,” and the officer
-in charge of the guns sighted one himself, a sergeant
-training the other.</p>
-
-<p>“Fire!”</p>
-
-<p>The six and twelve-pounders flashed together, and
-shells went shrieking across the river.</p>
-
-<p>One burst directly in the willows, the other beyond,
-where the sergeant had said the horses were.</p>
-
-<p>There was a neighing of horses, several ponies
-dashed into view, and it was certain that the shells had
-been a startling surprise to the redskins in camp.</p>
-
-<p>“Percy, I wish one of your guns sent at once down
-to my camp, and with full speed, for I shall drop a
-shell or two into the camp across the river from me,
-and then push on down to the other camp, and have
-them give the reds a surprise, though we do not know
-just where they are located at the lower ford, and
-must guess at it.</p>
-
-<p>“Toss a few more shells over there, and then limber<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_24"></a>[24]</span>
-up and get the gun away, whichever one you care to
-send.”</p>
-
-<p>Half a dozen more shells were sent flying into the
-Indian camp, and then the gun was sent down to the
-camp of Lieutenant Worth, who, after supper with his
-officer comrades there, rode away with Buffalo Bill, the
-sergeant, and the three men sent there in the morning
-to build fires, back to his camp.</p>
-
-<p>He found it no easy task to overtake the gun, the
-crew being anxious to reach their position and throw in
-a few shells before word could be sent down from the
-upper ford, though the firing would naturally be heard
-there, the sound traveling by the river.</p>
-
-<p>The gun was dragged to the ridge, and the sergeant
-pointed out just where the camp and corral of
-ponies were.</p>
-
-<p>“Aim it yourself, sergeant,” ordered Lieutenant
-Worth.</p>
-
-<p>The sergeant did so, and the shell was seen to burst
-right behind the ledge.</p>
-
-<p>Wild yells followed, and, with the firing of a second
-shell into the corral of ponies, it also struck home, for
-horses neighed wildly in fright.</p>
-
-<p>“Give them a few more shells, sergeant, and then
-the gun can go to camp, while we hold on down to
-the lower ford.”</p>
-
-<p>This was done, the gun retreated to camp, and Lieutenant<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_25"></a>[25]</span>
-Worth, Buffalo Bill, and Sergeant Fallon followed
-on down the river trail to the lower ford.</p>
-
-<p>It was some fifteen miles distant, and over a rough
-trail; but they reached the camp soon after midnight,
-and found the officer in command and his men all under
-arms and ready for the fray, for they had heard the
-firing from the middle ford and expected to be called
-upon to move at any time.</p>
-
-<p>“It is no alarm, Benedict, at least to us, though it is
-for the Indians.</p>
-
-<p>“I took a fancy to let the redskins know we were
-across here in very heavy force, as Sergeant Fallon had
-so reported to them, and got Percy to open on them,
-and, borrowing one of his guns, I did the same, and
-now I wish you to stir them up.”</p>
-
-<p>“With great pleasure, Lieutenant Worth,” answered
-Lieutenant Benedict, who was in command.</p>
-
-<p>“Have you any idea of just where their camp and
-corral is?”</p>
-
-<p>“I reconnoitered with my glass just before sunset
-and think I found their camp, and behind it is a
-meadow where I saw a pony astray.”</p>
-
-<p>“We’ll chance it.”</p>
-
-<p>Accordingly, the guns were placed in position, the
-spots pointed out to the gunners, and first one, then
-another roar came, the shells went shrieking on their
-errands, and bursting just where it was intended they
-should.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_26"></a>[26]</span></p>
-
-<p>Again startled yells answered, and then half a dozen
-more shells went crashing into the timber on the other
-side.</p>
-
-<p>“Give them a couple of shots just at dawn, Benedict,
-and the other camps will do the same to show them
-that we have guns at each ford.</p>
-
-<p>“We will camp at the fords for a couple of days yet,
-and then return by easy marches to the fort, for I do
-not believe a redskin will venture across the river for
-a long while to come. Eh, Cody?”</p>
-
-<p>“I do not think so, either, sir, unless Eagle, the outlaw,
-puts them up to some act of deviltry,” was the
-scout’s answer, and, after a snack, the lieutenant and
-his two companions returned to their own camp.</p>
-
-<p>The stay of the commands at the fords was continued
-for three days longer, and every morning and
-evening what the troops called the “sunrise and sunset
-guns” were fired across the river at the Indian camps,
-the guns being loaded with shell.</p>
-
-<p>Since the first night of the firing not an Indian had
-been seen or heard. They were either gone or in hiding
-farther off.</p>
-
-<p>Sergeant Fallon volunteered to go across and discover,
-making the site of the three fords in the night
-along the trail upon the other side, but Lieutenant
-Worth said that he did not care to have him take any
-more chances.</p>
-
-<p>Then the sergeant said it would be well for him to<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_27"></a>[27]</span>
-cross just where he had before, and let the Indians feel
-that he was still trying to serve them, also giving them
-another ghost story about the troops intending to remain
-for some time.</p>
-
-<p>Thus urged, the lieutenant yielded, and, rigging out
-in his Indian costume once more, Sergeant Fallon rode
-slowly away from the fort after supper one night.</p>
-
-<p>Lieutenant Worth and Buffalo Bill accompanied him
-to the river, and then waited.</p>
-
-<p>It was bright moonlight, and the other shore could
-be plainly seen, the officer and the scout watching the
-sergeant all the way across and until he disappeared in
-the shadows of the other side.</p>
-
-<p>They waited two hours before they saw him come
-again into sight. He rode into the river, came across,
-and joined them back in the shadows on the ridge.</p>
-
-<p>“Have they gone, sergeant?” asked the officer.</p>
-
-<p>“No, sir, they are there, only camped well back, and
-with half a dozen braves on guard at a time, while their
-force now numbers a couple of hundred men at each
-ford.”</p>
-
-<p>“Give me the location of their camp, and we will
-toss a shell over there in the morning.”</p>
-
-<p>“Pardon me, lieutenant,” said Buffalo Bill, “but that
-would compromise the sergeant, as they would understand
-that through him only the location could have
-been found out.”</p>
-
-<p>“You are right, Cody, and it would not do.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_28"></a>[28]</span></p>
-
-<p>“You could hardly reach there as it is, sir, for they
-are well protected; but, as Cody says, it might bring
-suspicion upon me, and I was received in a most
-friendly manner.”</p>
-
-<p>“Was Iron Eyes there?”</p>
-
-<p>“No, sir; he is back at the village, and Death Face
-commands five hundred warriors at the pass where
-they would hope to check your advance, with the
-braves who would retreat from the fords, and others
-who would come from the camp.</p>
-
-<p>“They have planned well, indeed, sir, and are in
-dread of your advance, for they think you have two-thirds
-of the force from the fort. Fighting Bird is in
-command at the ford here, and he is a plucky, able
-chief. The shots did some damage at each ford, for
-half a dozen warriors were killed opposite to us, two at
-the upper camp, and one at the lower, while a score
-were wounded, as the shells dropped right into their
-midst. Then, too, they lost a number of ponies by
-the shelling.”</p>
-
-<p>“We did do some service then, at random.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir, and they will be most cautious about recrossing
-the river for some time to come.”</p>
-
-<p>“I hope they will not allow us to rust in camp.”</p>
-
-<p>“No danger of that, lieutenant, for they are Indians,
-and they will break out in a new spot when they
-think you have forced them to lie quiet,” remarked
-Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_29"></a>[29]</span></p>
-
-<p>“There is one thing I did not like, lieutenant.”</p>
-
-<p>“What is that, sergeant?”</p>
-
-<p>“The outlaw chief has left the camps.”</p>
-
-<p>“Indeed?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“When did he leave?”</p>
-
-<p>“The day after my visit, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“Where did he go?”</p>
-
-<p>“I was told by Fighting Bird that the outlaw seemed
-sorry to have trusted me, after I left, and told Iron
-Eyes so. Iron Eyes and Death Face laughed at him,
-and he said that he had made a mistake, but would
-rectify it, and soon after he left the camp. I asked
-where he had gone, but Fighting Bird said he did not
-know; but he thought to the village of the palefaces,
-meaning Pioneer City.”</p>
-
-<p>“But he would not dare to cross the fords?”</p>
-
-<p>“It seems, sir, that he knows of another ford up the
-river to which no trail leads, but where there is really
-a good crossing, and he went there. He wished to
-lead a band of warriors around that way to attack the
-upper camp, but the Indians were too much afraid of
-the big guns to listen to it.”</p>
-
-<p>“It’s well for us they were; but would he dare go to
-Pioneer City, where he must be known?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, lieutenant, for you know he always wore a
-mask as an outlaw, and no one saw his face.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_30"></a>[30]</span></p>
-
-<p>“His face is not known in Pioneer City, and I never
-saw it that I know of,” the scout remarked.</p>
-
-<p>“But is he masked now?”</p>
-
-<p>“No, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“Then you saw his face?”</p>
-
-<p>“I did, sir, and I would know it again if I met his
-ghost in Hades,” was the sergeant’s emphatic response,
-for a moment did he break out from his accustomed
-quiet mien.</p>
-
-<p>“Describe him, sergeant, please.”</p>
-
-<p>“A man six feet in height, sir, herculean in strength,
-and with a dark, intellectual face, cynical, stern, and
-very handsome, but for its look of cruelty. He has a
-long dark mustache, and his hair hangs upon his shoulders.
-He is a very striking-looking man, sir, and
-worthy of a better calling, to judge by his appearance.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, I hope to have a close look at him some
-day; but what do you think he went to Pioneer City
-for?”</p>
-
-<p>“I told you, sir, of his intended letter to my daughter,
-and as it seems he grew suspicious of me, my idea
-is that he has gone there to plot to get her into his
-power at once.”</p>
-
-<p>“By the Lord Harry! but you may be right, sergeant.
-We will break camp at daylight and push for
-the fort. Come, I’ll send couriers to the other camps
-to move, also,” and the three returned at a gallop to
-the camp.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_31"></a>[31]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_V">CHAPTER V.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE RETURN.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>When the three forces got under way they marched
-at a speed according to the distance they had to travel,
-that all might make the same camp the first night on the
-way.</p>
-
-<p>The command from the lower ford made twenty
-miles, and, camping early, they were joined in the
-afternoon by the party under Lieutenant Worth.</p>
-
-<p>At dark the third command, under Lieutenant
-Percy, came in, and Walter Worth surveyed his little
-army with pride at being the superior officer.</p>
-
-<p>When they pulled out from camp early the next
-morning, seeing that the news that the outlaw had gone
-to Pioneer City made Sergeant Fallon anxious, he said
-to him:</p>
-
-<p>“Sergeant, you and Buffalo Bill can push on ahead
-to the fort, for the command cannot get in to-night
-without crowding the horses very hard and riding late,
-and there is no necessity for either.”</p>
-
-<p>The face of the sergeant brightened at the order of
-the lieutenant, and he said:</p>
-
-<p>“Thank you, sir; I shall be most happy to go on
-ahead.”</p>
-
-<p>“Say to Colonel Carr I will arrive with the command
-to-morrow, not caring to push the cattle.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_32"></a>[32]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>The sergeant at once reported to Buffalo Bill what
-the lieutenant had said, and the two started off at a
-pace more than double that at which the troops were
-traveling, retarded as they were by the guns, a couple
-of ambulances, and some pack mules.</p>
-
-<p>The sun was yet above the horizon when the sentinel
-on the watchtower reported the coming of two
-horsemen by the trail leading to the Indian country.</p>
-
-<p>The coming of the scout and Sergeant Fallon was
-soon reported to the colonel.</p>
-
-<p>Their stories were told, the sergeant telling his first,
-and both were listened to with the greatest attention by
-the colonel, who then said:</p>
-
-<p>“Sergeant, your daring and gallant conduct shall
-be reported, with a strong recommendation, added to
-others already sent to Washington, for your promotion
-to a lieutenancy.”</p>
-
-<p>“I thank you, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“It will be a well-won appointment, sergeant, but, as
-you request it, it will be best to say as little as possible
-about your going into the Indian lines, as it might
-reach the ears of the outlaw, who you say left the
-camps after your first visit, presumably going to Pioneer
-City.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“Then he will be up to more deviltry, I fear; but,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_33"></a>[33]</span>
-sergeant, your daughter is not here, you know, or had
-you heard of her departure?”</p>
-
-<p>“My daughter not here, sir?” Sergeant Fallon’s
-face turned to the hue of death.</p>
-
-<p>“Don’t be alarmed, man, for she only went by Jack
-Jessop’s coach this morning to Pioneer City to see
-her lawyer, who wrote to her that he was laid up there
-with rheumatism, and wished both of you to come on
-there.</p>
-
-<p>“As she did not know you would return, she went
-alone; but what ails you, sergeant?”</p>
-
-<p>“Colonel Carr, that letter was a trick of the outlaw
-chief to get my child into his clutches again!” gasped
-the sergeant.</p>
-
-<p>The words of the sergeant fairly startled the colonel,
-and he looked anxiously toward the scout and
-said:</p>
-
-<p>“Cody, the sergeant is too deeply moved to speak.</p>
-
-<p>“Tell me yourself what this means?”</p>
-
-<p>“It means, colonel,” answered Buffalo Bill, “that
-while in the Indian lines Sergeant Fallon had a long
-talk with Eagle, the outlaw leader, and became his ally
-in an intended capture of himself, the sergeant, and
-Miss Fallon. A compact was entered into between
-them, as I understood it from Sergeant Fallon, that he
-should inveigle himself and Miss Fallon to take the
-coach to Pioneer City, and he would hold it up and
-capture them.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_34"></a>[34]</span></p>
-
-<p>“The outlaw had seen Miss Fallon’s papers and
-letters, when she was his captive, copied the address of
-her lawyer, and secreted a letter of his so as to forge
-his writing and signature.</p>
-
-<p>“A letter to her was to be written from Pioneer
-City, pretending to come from the lawyer and saying,
-as he was laid up and unable to come to the fort, she
-must come to him on a most important legal matter
-that he would explain.”</p>
-
-<p>“I see it all, and she has fallen into the trap, for it
-was to Pioneer City that the outlaw went to carry out
-his infernal plot. Sergeant, you have my deepest sympathy,
-and we will do all we can to rescue your daughter,
-I assure you.”</p>
-
-<p>“I feel that, sir; but she is now in that man’s power,
-and&mdash;&mdash;”</p>
-
-<p>“Colonel Carr, may I offer a suggestion?” said Buffalo
-Bill suddenly.</p>
-
-<p>“Out with it, Cody.”</p>
-
-<p>“The outlaw crossed the river at a point beyond
-the upper ford, the Indians told the sergeant, at a secret
-ford known to him alone.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, I believe he carried Indians along with him,
-so a trail will be left, and if he has captured Miss Lucille
-he will most surely take her to the village of
-old Iron Eyes, for nowhere else could he carry her in
-safety.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, Cody.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_35"></a>[35]</span></p>
-
-<p>“If he held up the coach to-day it was on the other
-side of Cañon River bridge, and it is as far for him to
-ride from there to his secret crossing of the river as it
-is for us to go down from here, and by hard riding we
-could get there first, sir; begging your pardon, if we
-could start at once, push through and meet Lieutenant
-Worth, we could&mdash;&mdash;”</p>
-
-<p>“Cody, you have hit the nail on the head, and you
-and the sergeant shall start within half an hour on
-your ride.</p>
-
-<p>“You, sergeant, can ride my best charger, Spur, for
-he needs exercise, and Lieutenant Worth will go back
-with you and take what men he deems necessary, leaving
-the command to Lieutenant Percy to bring on.
-Say to Lieutenant Worth, sergeant, that such is my
-wish.</p>
-
-<p>“Let him pick his horses, and you should reach him
-in time to-night to get a short rest there for yours, and
-be away all together at dawn.”</p>
-
-<p>“We will, sir; and I thank you deeply for your great
-kindness. We will start within half an hour, sir, but
-I dislike to force Scout Cody and others on such a hard
-ride,” said Sergeant Fallon earnestly.</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, don’t mind me, sergeant, for I’ve had more
-rest of late than I wanted,” said Buffalo Bill dryly.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, now be off, and remember, sergeant, you are
-to ride my horse, Spur.”</p>
-
-<p>“Thank you, sir.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_36"></a>[36]</span></p>
-
-<p>With wishes for their success, the colonel saw them
-depart hastily for their respective quarters.</p>
-
-<p>The long ride they had had was forgotten by both
-men, for what did they care for fatigue when it was
-to save Lucille from the power of the hated outlaw
-chief?</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill hastened to his quarters to change his
-clothing, and order two of his best horses brought out,
-for the scout was noted for the splendid animals he
-always had ready for use.</p>
-
-<p>One of them he intended to ride, the other to be
-used as a pack animal, and he ordered a good supply of
-provision put in the pack saddle, and within an hour
-after leaving the colonel’s quarters he was ready for
-the trail. He had his supper, and just at dark rode
-up to the sergeant’s quarters.</p>
-
-<p>“Time, sergeant, time!” he called.</p>
-
-<p>The colonel’s magnificent roan, Spur, was there,
-with the sergeant’s saddle and bridle on, and there was
-a place in the pack saddle for what the soldier wished
-to carry along.</p>
-
-<p>These were stowed away, and the two friends rode
-out of the fort side by side, the pack horse traveling
-behind.</p>
-
-<p>The traps of the horsemen had been so divided up
-that the saddle horses had only the weight of the riders,
-the pack animal carrying the balance.</p>
-
-<p>They were gazed upon as they rode away back on<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_37"></a>[37]</span>
-the trail they had come, the soldiers wondering at
-their going so soon after their return.</p>
-
-<p>As they left the gate, the scout urged his horse
-into a slow canter, the sergeant’s and the pack horse
-settling down to the same steady pace.</p>
-
-<p>Thus they went on their way through the darkness,
-leaving mile after mile behind them.</p>
-
-<p>“We will reach the camp by midnight, sergeant, and
-that will give our horses and ourselves a good rest until
-dawn, and allow Lieutenant Worth ample time to
-select his men.”</p>
-
-<p>“What number do you think he will take, Cody?”</p>
-
-<p>“I should say six of my men and as many soldiers,
-and this, with the lieutenant and ourselves, will give us
-fifteen.”</p>
-
-<p>“Enough, if Lieutenant Worth picks the men.”</p>
-
-<p>“Which he will do, and yet a few more would not
-be amiss.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, suggest it, for he is most reasonable.”</p>
-
-<p>“He is, indeed, and one of the bravest and most
-brilliant young officers I ever knew.”</p>
-
-<p>“You are right there, and he is making his way
-well to the front.”</p>
-
-<p>Seeing that they were not distressing their horses,
-the two kept them at a still more rapid pace, and it
-was just before midnight that they dashed up to the
-camp.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_38"></a>[38]</span></p>
-
-<p>Lieutenant Worth was at once aroused and the situation
-explained to him, and before the sergeant could
-deliver the colonel’s message he cried:</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll take a score of men and go back with you, for
-that villain must be run down. You know your men
-best, Cody, so pick out from the three commands together
-here ten of your best scouts, and let them take
-the finest horses, whether their own or not. You,
-Sergeant Fallon, pick a corporal and ten troopers, and
-see that they get the very best mounts. The quartermaster
-shall at once get supplies for a couple of weeks’
-stay, for we must go well prepared, and&mdash;&mdash;”</p>
-
-<p>“I go, too, Lieutenant Worth, for I shall be needed,”
-cried Surgeon Denmead, who was present at the interview.</p>
-
-<p>“Ah, Denmead, always the right man in the right
-place, and I am glad you spoke, for I will be glad to
-have you along.”</p>
-
-<p>“Now, prepare all, for we must be in the saddle
-within the hour.”</p>
-
-<p>There was no use saying wait until dawn, for the
-dashing young cavalry officer said:</p>
-
-<p>“We will go ten miles on our way and then camp,
-for I’ll feel then as though we had started. If your
-horses are blown, Cody, you can take others.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll ride another, sir, as will Sergeant Fallon, and
-take an extra pack horse, too, so the three we pushed
-to the camp here can run loose and thus rest.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_39"></a>[39]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Yes, and I’ve ordered half a dozen extras driven
-along loose in case of breakdowns, for there must be
-no delay on this ride.”</p>
-
-<p>The party who were to make the ride then had
-supper, and in just one hour after the arrival of Buffalo
-Bill and the sergeant in camp, the party, twenty-five
-all told and thirty-five horses, rode off on their
-expedition to rescue Lucille Fallon.</p>
-
-<p>“Set the pace, Cody, and don’t make it too slow,”
-said Lieutenant Worth, and Buffalo Bill rode to the
-front, the sergeant with him.</p>
-
-<p>Behind rode Lieutenant Worth and Surgeon Denmead,
-then the corporal and his troopers, the pack
-horses and extras following, and the scouts bringing
-up the rear in two detachments, under Will Palmer
-and Hugh Hardin respectively.</p>
-
-<p>When ten miles had been passed over, Buffalo Bill
-began to look for a camping place, when Lieutenant
-Worth called out:</p>
-
-<p>“The horses are all right, Cody, so give them another
-hour of it, and we’ll reach a good halting place.”</p>
-
-<p>Another hour was given them, and the scout led the
-command to a fine camp where water, grass, and wood
-were plentiful.</p>
-
-<p>They quickly staked out the animals, one scout was
-put on duty, with orders to call a relief after one hour,
-and he to do likewise, until four hours had passed,
-when breakfast would be eaten and the ride resumed.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_40"></a>[40]</span></p>
-
-<p>The men threw themselves down upon their blankets
-and were soon fast asleep.</p>
-
-<p>Feeling that all was being done that was possible
-for the rescue of his daughter, Sergeant Fallon, knowing
-his need of rest, followed Buffalo Bill’s example,
-and dropped off into a deep slumber.</p>
-
-<p>Two soldiers and two scouts were awakened by
-the sentinel to get breakfast, and the others were allowed
-to sleep on until it was ready.</p>
-
-<p>The meal disposed of, the horses were saddled, and,
-mounting, away they started on another mad ride.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill was leading the command as guide and
-scout, and constantly by his side kept Sergeant Fallon,
-while Lieutenant Worth and Doctor Denmead were
-not far in the rear.</p>
-
-<p>The halt was made at noon, but not for two hours,
-as a consultation and look at the horses showed that
-they were not yet used up, save two, that were left
-behind.</p>
-
-<p>“They will get a rest when we reach the river to-night,
-so push them for all they are worth, Bill,” said
-the lieutenant.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir; and we must reach the river while it is
-daylight to find that trail, and so wait there, for he may
-come up in the night and go across,” answered Buffalo
-Bill.</p>
-
-<p>The halt was, therefore, made at noon for an hour<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_41"></a>[41]</span>
-only, and yet the horses were stripped and rubbed down
-while they fed.</p>
-
-<p>Then the party mounted again and pushed on, the
-scout setting even a faster pace than before. He was
-determined to strike the river above the upper ford, and
-from there up look for the trail coming out where the
-outlaw crossed. To do this, hard riding must be
-made.</p>
-
-<p>Another horse dropped out during the afternoon,
-and a second soon after. They were left by the trail
-side.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill glanced back to see if he was pushing
-too hard, but the lieutenant waved him on, and the
-sergeant’s face brightened, as he said, in a low tone:</p>
-
-<p>“God bless that noble young man.”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, he’s got the nerve to push to the end,” answered
-Buffalo Bill, and as he spoke, Lieutenant Worth
-called out:</p>
-
-<p>“Your horses can stand the strain, Bill, so you and
-the sergeant push on ahead, and I’ll send what men
-after you I can pick out with the best animals. The
-rest of us can follow, but you go on and try and pick
-up the trail.”</p>
-
-<p>The splendid animals ridden by Buffalo Bill and the
-sergeant were yet capable of hard work, as was also
-the one ridden by Lieutenant Worth, but he felt that
-he had better remain with the men.</p>
-
-<p>So he picked out several of the scouts whose horses<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_42"></a>[42]</span>
-seemed less distressed, and told them to push on with
-their chief.</p>
-
-<p>So on went Buffalo Bill, the sergeant and four
-scouts following, the rest bringing up the rear at a
-slower pace.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill looked back and saw that they were
-dropping the command fast enough for the good
-of the animals, and so held at the reserved pace he
-had set.</p>
-
-<p>On, on they went, halting at a brook for a few
-swallows of water, again a few mouthfuls of grass,
-and then on once more.</p>
-
-<p>The river at last came in sight as they descended
-a ridge.</p>
-
-<p>They had crossed the trail leading back from the
-upper ford half an hour before.</p>
-
-<p>Riding down from the ridge, they reached the river
-just three miles above the ford. Here they halted
-for a moment, two of the scouts’ horses having failed
-them.</p>
-
-<p>The animals were all panting like hounds, and the
-riders relieved them of their weight, and began to go
-on foot along the river bank, the scout remarking:</p>
-
-<p>“There is certainly no crossing between us and the
-ford, for I have ridden this far above it several times.</p>
-
-<p>“It is above that the secret crossing is, and the outlaw
-would hardly have risked it had it been nearer to
-where the soldiers’ camp was.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_43"></a>[43]</span></p>
-
-<p>“So I think,” the sergeant remarked.</p>
-
-<p>So on they went, the scout and sergeant walking
-rapidly and viewing every foot of ground, while the
-scouts followed behind leading their horses.</p>
-
-<p>Thus a mile had been gone over, and the face of the
-sergeant grew anxious, for he saw that the sun was
-drawing near the horizon.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill’s face was placid, for he never relieved
-his thoughts, no matter what was his distress of mind.</p>
-
-<p>On they went, limbering up their legs from long
-riding by rapid walking.</p>
-
-<p>At last they came to a rise, when the scout halted.
-He saw that there were two ridges running to the river,
-a deep ravine between them.</p>
-
-<p>Across the river he saw that there was a sand bar,
-and a point of sand stretched out into the stream, the
-swift flow being on the side where they stood.</p>
-
-<p>The channel here looked narrow, too, and, examining
-the water, it appeared to be more shallow than
-above and below.</p>
-
-<p>“Sergeant, I think here is the crossing.”</p>
-
-<p>“The same thought was mine, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“Of course, they would have to swim their horses
-for several hundred yards, but by riding out upon that
-sand bar which is well above, they would land, forced
-down by the current, about at this ravine&mdash;in fact, if
-they were swept by, would not land at all.”</p>
-
-<p>“If they crossed from this side, sir?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_44"></a>[44]</span></p>
-
-<p>“They would have to ride in yonder above at that
-break in the bank, and that would bring them on the
-sand-bar point. I will go there and see if they could
-get down to the river, while you look down in the
-ravine for their trail,” and the scout started on his way,
-to suddenly call out to the sergeant, who was climbing
-down the ravine:</p>
-
-<p>“Here is the trail coming out, and there were a
-score of them.”</p>
-
-<p>The sergeant, at the call of Buffalo Bill, hastened to
-where he stood. He was passing around the descent
-to the river between the two ridges, and had found a
-trail.</p>
-
-<p>Reaching the spot, the trail was there, made by all
-of two dozen horses, they decided after an examination.</p>
-
-<p>“It goes straight down the ravine to the river, and
-was, as you said, the landing when they rode in from
-the bar.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sergeant.</p>
-
-<p>“We will leave the boys here and go on to that
-break up yonder, for there is where I feel sure they
-must cross, and, if my memory serves me right, there
-is no other for many a long mile above.”</p>
-
-<p>Calling to the scouts to halt there where they were,
-Buffalo Bill and the sergeant pushed rapidly on to the
-break in the bank, nearly a mile above.</p>
-
-<p>They reached it just as the sun touched the horizon,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_45"></a>[45]</span>
-and a glance showed that it was a ravine like the one
-below, narrow, rocky, and steep.</p>
-
-<p>But from that point a descent into the river could
-rapidly be made, and as the stream had a bend there,
-a swim would carry them across for a landing on the
-sand bar below.</p>
-
-<p>Going around to the head of the ravine, Buffalo
-Bill and the sergeant came to a halt, as though they had
-been shot at.</p>
-
-<p>“Too late!” said Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>“They have crossed,” said the sergeant, and his face
-was white.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, not two hours ago, from the looks of the
-trail.</p>
-
-<p>“That man knows the secret pass through Skeleton
-Range, or he could never have reached here in this
-time, for that cuts off all of thirty miles in coming
-from the Overland Trail to the upper ford.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, I have followed the regular trail, long ago, but
-knew of no secret pass.”</p>
-
-<p>“There is one, however, as an old trapper once led
-me through it. The outlaw must have known it, to
-have reached here before us, riding as we have, for,
-remember, it is just twenty-four hours since we left
-the fort, and we have come a little over a hundred
-miles.”</p>
-
-<p>“Very true; we have done our duty, but in vain, for<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_46"></a>[46]</span>
-my daughter is still in that man’s power, and has been
-carried on to the Indian camp in the mountains.”</p>
-
-<p>“I fear so.”</p>
-
-<p>“What can we do now?”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll tell you.</p>
-
-<p>“We came here on foot, so have left no trail. We
-will go to the lower ravine and join the boys, then
-draw off for a camp, for horses and men must rest.”</p>
-
-<p>“True.”</p>
-
-<p>“We passed a spot some distance back that will make
-a splendid camp, back from the river, and where the
-fires cannot be seen by the Indians, who must still be
-guarding the fords.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“Now to see if this trail was made by the same party,
-for I took notice of peculiarities I can readily discover,
-as there were two shod horses, and large animals,
-the others being ponies.”</p>
-
-<p>“That means the outlaw’s two horses and the ponies
-of the Indian allies.”</p>
-
-<p>“Just that,” and the two began to examine the trail.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, here are the tracks of the two iron-shod horses,
-Mr. Cody.”</p>
-
-<p>“There are more shod horses&mdash;six more, sergeant&mdash;and
-that means&mdash;&mdash;”</p>
-
-<p>“The six horses of the stagecoach,” quickly interrupted
-the sergeant.</p>
-
-<p>“Just that.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_47"></a>[47]</span></p>
-
-<p>“That tells the story, then, for the other tracks
-agree. It is growing dark, so let us hurry back and
-make a camp for the tired men.”</p>
-
-<p>They walked rapidly back down the river bank,
-joined the two scouts awaiting them, and told the sad
-story to them that they were too late!</p>
-
-<p>Mounting their horses, they rode back in the gathering
-twilight for a mile, when they met the other two
-scouts, who had dropped back on account of their
-horses.</p>
-
-<p>They had halted just where the scout intended to
-make the night camp, and, seeing that the place was
-thoroughly sheltered, they began to build fires.</p>
-
-<p>Just as the fires began to burn well, the command
-came in sight, and the tired horses gained courage and
-hastened on.</p>
-
-<p>They were soon all there, the stragglers dropping in
-one by one, and a sadness fell upon all as they heard
-the ill-omened words: “Too late!”</p>
-
-<p>Lieutenant Worth listened, with stern face and flashing
-eyes.</p>
-
-<p>Then he said:</p>
-
-<p>“Our first duty is to care for our worn-out cattle.</p>
-
-<p>“Then we will have supper, and, afterward, hold a
-council of war, Bill, and decide what must be done, for
-Miss Fallon shall be rescued; yes, and that villain,
-Lamar, must be hanged.</p>
-
-<p>“Those two duties must and shall be done!”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_48"></a>[48]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_VI">CHAPTER VI.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE FORGED LETTER.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Lucille Fallon was surprised when she received a
-letter by mail, posted at Pioneer City, and addressed in
-the well-known hand of her lawyer.</p>
-
-<p>It was short, and merely told her that certain legal
-technicalities having arisen that required her signature,
-and her father’s, to papers he held, he had decided to
-come himself and get them, and had reached Pioneer
-City, where, on account of an attack of rheumatism, he
-was compelled to halt and ask the sergeant and herself
-to come to him.</p>
-
-<p>Lucille expressed her surprise that any business had
-been so important as to bring the lawyer out to the wild
-West, but she concluded to go, and regretted the absence
-of her father.</p>
-
-<p>Perhaps she could do without him, and, if not, she
-would urge the lawyer to return with her to the fort,
-where he would be well cared for.</p>
-
-<p>There were no other passengers, and with a small
-satchel as her only baggage, she mounted to the box
-with Jack Jessop and rolled away from the fort. She
-enjoyed the bright morning and beautiful scenery immensely,
-and Jack was glad to entertain his fair companion.</p>
-
-<p>The bridge was crossed over the river, and then
-began the pull up a long hill.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_49"></a>[49]</span></p>
-
-<p>Suddenly, as though by magic, a score of forms
-arose, it appeared from the ground.</p>
-
-<p>They came from behind trees and rocks, and they
-came like so many apparitions.</p>
-
-<p>They were all dressed in buckskin, wore slouch hats
-and masks, while they carried rifles in their hands and
-were armed with a belt of weapons as well.</p>
-
-<p>They were all on foot, save one.</p>
-
-<p>That one was mounted on a fine horse, and came
-out from behind a group of rocks. He sat his horse
-splendidly, wore a belt of arms, but carried no rifle. A
-broad sombrero sheltered his head, his hair fell upon
-his shoulders, and he was dressed in a black suit with
-gold-coin buttons. His face was masked completely,
-and his hands were covered with red gauntlet gloves.
-There was no mistaking the man, for it was Captain
-Eagle, chief of the Red Hand Riders.</p>
-
-<p>“That imp of Satan, ther chief o’ ther Red Hands,
-by all that’s holy!” growled Jack Jessop.</p>
-
-<p>Lucille turned pale, yet remained perfectly calm,
-while she said:</p>
-
-<p>“He has little to rob me of, Jack.”</p>
-
-<p>Up to the coach rode the chief, while he bent low
-in his saddle and said:</p>
-
-<p>“We have the pleasure of meeting, Miss Fallon.”</p>
-
-<p>“The pleasure is all yours, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“And, Jack, you and I have met before,” resumed<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_50"></a>[50]</span>
-the chief, paying no attention to Lucille’s sarcastic
-reply to his salutation.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, and some day we’ll meet once too often for
-your good, cap,” said Jack.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, what have you aboard to interest me, other
-than the fair lady on the box with you?”</p>
-
-<p>“Nothing, for I’m running light; but I was in hopes
-you was dead.”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, no; I am still on deck, as you see.</p>
-
-<p>“But have you no dust from the mines on board?”</p>
-
-<p>“Not an ounce.”</p>
-
-<p>“No money?”</p>
-
-<p>“This ain’t after pay time, as you know, so no money
-goes East on this run.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, I believe you, but I shall search your old
-hearse, all the same.”</p>
-
-<p>He called to his followers, and they completely surrounded
-the coach. Then he began the search personally.</p>
-
-<p>“What is in these boxes in the rear boot?”</p>
-
-<p>“Weapons sent to Colonel Buck from the fort sutler;
-he ordered them.”</p>
-
-<p>“They are treasure. Give me your hatchet.”</p>
-
-<p>The driver passed it down, and, knocking open the
-boxes, the chief said:</p>
-
-<p>“Good! repeating rifles and revolvers&mdash;just what I
-need; yes, and ammunition, too, with bowie knives
-and belts. Ah! here are a couple of fine saddles and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_51"></a>[51]</span>
-bridles, too, and a roll of superb serapes. Why, Jack,
-I am in luck, especially as a decoy letter I wrote got
-Miss Fallon into my power, though I regret to see that
-her father is not along. Miss Fallon, the letter from
-your lawyer I forged. It has done its duty.”</p>
-
-<p>When the outlaw chief spoke of the letter Lucille’s
-face flushed, and her eyes brightened with indignation
-and anger. She knew that she was the victim of a
-plot, and quick as a flash she whipped out from her
-belt a small revolver and threw it forward, her finger
-upon the trigger.</p>
-
-<p>There was no tremor of the hand, the act was one
-of determined intention to kill the man, and she would
-have done so then and there, for he was caught wholly
-off his guard, had not Jack Jessop struck up her hand
-just as she pulled trigger.</p>
-
-<p>The bullet, as it was, cut through the corner of the
-chief’s sombrero.</p>
-
-<p>“A close call, that! Jack Jessop, you saved my life,
-so I’ll not kill you, as I intended to do; that act saved
-you.”</p>
-
-<p>“I didn’t do it for you, but to save her,” grunted
-Jack.</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, I know your intention, but the act was the
-same, for you saved me from death.</p>
-
-<p>“Miss Fallon, you are as quick as a flash as a
-drawer, and a ready hand with a revolver. You owe
-it to Jack Jessop that you do not suffer for your intended<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_52"></a>[52]</span>
-taking of my life, for my men would have been
-quickly revenged upon you. Give me that weapon,
-please.”</p>
-
-<p>Lucille sat, white, silent, and almost despairing. But
-she turned and handed the weapon to Jack Jessop, who
-in turn surrendered it with his own weapons to the
-chief.</p>
-
-<p>“Get off the box, Jack.”</p>
-
-<p>The man obeyed.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, Miss Fallon, do you also alight.”</p>
-
-<p>She also obeyed.</p>
-
-<p>“Jack, I shall put these irons on your ankles. You
-can walk with them, for the chain is a foot long, but
-slowly. You will have to walk to the next station,
-and you’ll hardly reach there before night. I need
-your horses, so will take them, and I have pack animals
-along, too, for the plunder.</p>
-
-<p>“Miss Fallon, I have a horse with sidesaddle for
-you, so you see I came prepared, even to good food
-for you, a canvas shelter and blankets.”</p>
-
-<p>“You intend to take me a prisoner?” said Lucille.</p>
-
-<p>“I certainly do, and hold you until I get the big
-ransom I shall demand.”</p>
-
-<p>“My poor, poor father.”</p>
-
-<p>“He is fortunate in not having come with you.”</p>
-
-<p>“Jack, there is no help for it, so I’ll make the best
-of it,” said Lucille, turning to the driver.</p>
-
-<p>“Tell my father what happened, and to arrange for<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_53"></a>[53]</span>
-the ransom, as he can do, provided it is not too large,
-for there is a limit, you know, and I am not of age
-yet, so funds cannot be readily gotten beyond a certain
-sum. Tell him not to delay, for I wish my freedom,
-and attempt no rescue, but pay the ransom.
-Good-by, Jack.”</p>
-
-<p>Lucille held out her hand.</p>
-
-<p>“You is the gamest leetle gal I ever seen,” said Jack
-Jessop, and the tears came into his eyes. Turning to
-the outlaw, he continued:</p>
-
-<p>“Some day there’ll come a settlement for your red
-deeds and your cruel treatment of this lady, and I’d
-show you no more mercy than I would a snake.”</p>
-
-<p>The chief laughed, snapped the irons on Jack’s
-ankles, then continued his search of the coach, taking
-several things of value.</p>
-
-<p>Then he called to his silent men to bring up the
-horses, and to strip the team of the harness.</p>
-
-<p>They quickly did so, and a horse was led up with a
-lady’s saddle.</p>
-
-<p>Lucille sprang to her seat without aid, making the
-remark in an indifferent tone:</p>
-
-<p>“It is lucky I wore my riding habit, fearing some
-accident.”</p>
-
-<p>The things from the coach, arms, and other articles,
-with the harness, cushions, and rubber coverings, were
-soon packed on the horses, the chief mounted, and,
-turning to the driver, said:</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_54"></a>[54]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Good-by, Jack. I will not leave you unarmed, so
-here is your belt again. My compliments to Buffalo
-Bill, and tell him that some day I’ll get his scalp.”</p>
-
-<p>With a wave of the hand he rode off, leaving Jack
-Jessop gazing after them, his eyes full of tears at the
-fate of poor Lucille, whom he was powerless to aid.</p>
-
-<p>But Jack did not hesitate long, for he at once turned
-his steps down the trail toward Pioneer City, carrying
-the mails, which had not been disturbed, upon his
-back. He could not walk fast, ironed as he was, and
-it was night when he reached the relay station, utterly
-exhausted.</p>
-
-<p>But he quickly had the iron chain hammered in
-two by the stock tender, and, mounting a horse, the
-manacles still about his ankles, he rode on to Pioneer
-City and reported what had happened, starting out
-at once again with a harnessed team after his coach.</p>
-
-<p>The stock tender at the station he had sent off at
-full speed to the fort to report the affair to Colonel
-Carr.</p>
-
-<p>The stock tender reached the fort after midnight,
-and, half an hour after, a lieutenant with his troop and
-six of Buffalo Bill’s scouts had started for Monument
-Hill to pick up the trail of the outlaws at dawn, and
-follow it, Colonel Carr believing that he could thus
-aid Lieutenant Worth and his party who were pushing
-on to the river to head off the lawless band.</p>
-
-<p>Jack Jessop took his dismantled coach into Pioneer<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_55"></a>[55]</span>
-City with all haste, and then went to a blacksmith to
-get his manacles removed.</p>
-
-<p>He found the town all excitement over the affair,
-and learned from Colonel Buck, the stage agent there,
-that a stranger had come into Pioneer City and purchased
-a sidesaddle and a lot of provisions and other
-things, remaining but a short while and stating that
-he was from the Fort Advance settlement.</p>
-
-<p>“That man was the outlaw,” said Jack Jessop.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_56"></a>[56]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_VII">CHAPTER VII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE FLIGHT.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>The outlaw chief placed himself by the side of Lucille
-as they started away, and she said quickly:</p>
-
-<p>“There is no possible chance of my escape, so ride
-on ahead and I will follow you.”</p>
-
-<p>“You do not wish me by your side?”</p>
-
-<p>“I do not.”</p>
-
-<p>“I wish to talk to you.”</p>
-
-<p>“I do not care to converse with you.”</p>
-
-<p>“But I have something of importance to say.”</p>
-
-<p>“I do not care to hear it.”</p>
-
-<p>“But you must, and the trail admits of two riding
-abreast now, and will not later on, and I will not disturb
-you long.”</p>
-
-<p>“I have no power to enforce my wish.”</p>
-
-<p>“I shall ask the sum of just thirty thousand dollars
-for your ransom, and when that is paid you shall go
-free.”</p>
-
-<p>“You will not get it.”</p>
-
-<p>“Why?”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, though I have property of considerable value,
-neither my lawyer and guardian, nor myself, can get
-money on it until a certain time, and the cash that
-can be got is just that which is left over from the sum
-appropriated to pay certain fees, my schooling and
-living.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_57"></a>[57]</span></p>
-
-<p>“And what does that amount to?”</p>
-
-<p>“About eighteen thousand dollars.”</p>
-
-<p>“Somehow I believe you, so I will take what I can
-get. Twenty thousand, then, shall be the price, for
-the balance can be raised. Doubtless your father has
-it, and when that is paid, you shall go free. I shall
-arrange all matters so as to place no difficulties in the
-way, and, meanwhile, you shall be treated with every
-respect, and given what comforts I can allow you.”</p>
-
-<p>There was something in the manner of the outlaw
-toward her that Lucille could not understand, and that
-was his marked respect.</p>
-
-<p>When it grew near sunset he ordered a halt, sought
-a secluded spot for his captive, had her canvas shelter
-put up, and placed before her a good supper, after
-which he left her, with the words:</p>
-
-<p>“I shall halt here for four hours, and then it shall
-be six more in the saddle, so get what rest you can.”</p>
-
-<p>Lucille enjoyed her supper, spread her blankets, and
-was soon fast asleep.</p>
-
-<p>A call awakened her, and, fifteen minutes after, they
-were again in the saddle, this time the chief riding
-ahead of her, his masked followers coming along behind
-her.</p>
-
-<p>“Why do they mask still? for they are all Indians,
-I have discovered,” she said to the chief.</p>
-
-<p>“You are not so sure of that.”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, yes, I am,” was the girl’s confident reply. “I<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_58"></a>[58]</span>
-wasn’t born in the West, but I know an Indian when
-I see one.”</p>
-
-<p>Another long ride through the darkness of six hours,
-and the chief called a halt, two hours before dawn.</p>
-
-<p>Again Lucille was placed in a secluded spot, her shelter
-put up and she was made comfortable, the chief remarking:</p>
-
-<p>“We will not move for five hours this time, so you
-will have another rest, so make the best of it.”</p>
-
-<p>Again she slept soundly, and when she awoke the
-sun was shining brightly. She at once realized her
-position, and sighed.</p>
-
-<p>But she went to a rivulet near and made her toilet,
-then sat down on a rock and ate the breakfast which
-the chief had cooked.</p>
-
-<p>He had killed a deer, and gave her a nice steak,
-some bacon broiled on the coals, a crisp hoecake, and
-a cup of coffee in which there was some condensed
-milk and sugar he had brought from Pioneer City.</p>
-
-<p>She ate heartily, mounted her horse, and again took
-her place behind the chief, who remarked quietly:</p>
-
-<p>“As you can see through masks, Miss Fallon, I told
-my men to take them off.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, they are Indians, and a cruel-looking lot they
-are, though with hearts that are not as evil as their
-master’s, for their training has been to kill, torture,
-and rob an enemy, yours far different.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_59"></a>[59]</span></p>
-
-<p>He bit his lip, but made no reply, and again rode
-to the front.</p>
-
-<p>After a short while he said:</p>
-
-<p>“Buffalo Bill and your father are up at the fords
-with Lieutenant Worth, hunting Indians, as you doubtless
-know. Jack Jessop got in during the night, and
-doubtless sent word of the holdup of the coach both to
-the fort and to Pioneer City, so that the troops, if
-sent at once on the trail, have now reached Monument
-Hill.”</p>
-
-<p>“On your trail?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, but a long distance behind, for we are over
-forty miles from the hill, and before night I shall
-cross the river into the Indian country, as I know of
-a secret trail over the mountain range you see ahead
-of us which will cut off half a day’s hard ride, and
-treat you to a view of some magnificent scenery as
-well.”</p>
-
-<p>“You are very thoughtful to treat me to grand
-scenery under such circumstances.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, I wish to make your captivity as pleasant
-to you as possible; but I have to ride hard, as I will
-only feel safe when I get you across the river.”</p>
-
-<p>“And I shall be less safe.”</p>
-
-<p>“You will be all right, for I will take you up into
-the village of the old chief, Iron Eyes, and there is a
-good cabin there which no Indian will live in. It
-was built by a renegade white man who fled with his<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_60"></a>[60]</span>
-family to the Indians and was adopted into the tribe.
-The man, his wife and the children died off, and their
-cabin still remains there in good condition, furnished
-as they left it, for they brought all their furniture with
-them in their flight.”</p>
-
-<p>“I shall appreciate being separated from the Indians
-at least.”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, yes, you will be free from them, for the
-tepees nearest the cabin are not occupied, but all used
-to store pelts, food, and the hundred and one things
-an Indian snakes in. It is, in fact, the store village,
-and the nearest living tepee to you is that of the young
-chief, Death Face, and you can trust him, for he is of
-a most chivalrous nature.</p>
-
-<p>“The other Indians will not go near you, I’ll see to
-that, so you will be alone; but that will not mean that
-you will have a chance to escape, as that would be impossible
-for a man to do, let alone a girl.”</p>
-
-<p>Lucille made no reply, and the chief did not again
-break the silence until they had climbed the mountain
-range by a most dangerous path.</p>
-
-<p>The outlaw halted as he neared the top of the range,
-having asked Lucille not to look behind her until
-he told her to do so, as he did not wish to spoil her
-view.</p>
-
-<p>She wheeled her horse and glanced behind her,
-and an exclamation of delight burst from her lips.</p>
-
-<p>Long she gazed in perfect rapture, and forgetful of<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_61"></a>[61]</span>
-herself, as she beheld miles of mountain, valley, and
-plain scenery.</p>
-
-<p>“That little grove there shall be your noonday
-camping place, directly upon the summit of the mountain,
-so that you can see in every direction,” said the
-chief. “Down on the other side, a few hundred yards,
-is a plateau, a valley in the mountaintop, with a stream
-running through it, and there we shall go on and
-halt, for there is good grass for the horses. When
-you get tired of the view come to where we are, and
-dinner will be ready.”</p>
-
-<p>Reaching the little grove of pines, Lucille again cried
-out in admiration, for before her now was a still
-grander view.</p>
-
-<p>Flowing through a vast valley, was a large river.</p>
-
-<p>“Do you see yonder mountains, miles below the
-river?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“It is there that the Indian village is, and that will
-be the end of our trail.</p>
-
-<p>“Just there, where you see a bald hill by the river,
-is where we will cross by a ford but very few know
-of, for none of my Indians know of it, and it is one
-no one could find, save by accident, as I did by seeing
-a herd of deer take to the water and swim across.</p>
-
-<p>“Something frightened them on the other side&mdash;a
-pack of wolves, I think&mdash;and they swam back again,
-landing at another point below. It showed me a crossing<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_62"></a>[62]</span>
-place, and I let several of my men into the secret
-and used to send couriers that way to and from my
-retreat to the Indian village. As the known fords are
-now guarded by troops, we will cross this way, if you
-are not too much alarmed.”</p>
-
-<p>“And if I am you will go to the regular ford?”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, no; I am no fool, to run upon the soldiers.”</p>
-
-<p>“What will you do if I have not the nerve to go
-across?”</p>
-
-<p>“Simply go around by a ford that will give us two
-days’ hard travel.”</p>
-
-<p>“Never mind me, then; cross by the secret ford,
-for I can venture it if you can.”</p>
-
-<p>The outlaw then rode on, leading her horse, the
-Indians having gone to the camping place.</p>
-
-<p>Lucille was alone on the mountaintop, and gazed
-about her in rapt admiration.</p>
-
-<p>At last she said:</p>
-
-<p>“If I had my horse and a good start, I would risk
-finding my way back to the Overland Trail, for I
-watched all along closely, and my horse would retrace
-his tracks, I believe.</p>
-
-<p>“But, no, I must accept the situation as it is, and
-take things as they come.</p>
-
-<p>“The outlaw, from what he says, seems to think
-the fords are guarded by a large force, so I will not
-undeceive him.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_63"></a>[63]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Even now my father may be within a few miles of
-me, and, oh! if he only knew.”</p>
-
-<p>The girl weakened for a moment, but quickly rallied
-from her emotions and continued her gaze for quite a
-while. Then she strolled about the mountaintop,
-plucked a few wild flowers clinging among the rocks,
-and next started down to the camp with the remark:</p>
-
-<p>“Ah! I get the odors of boiling bacon and coffee,
-for the wind blows up from the camp. It makes me
-hungry, so I’ll go down to dinner.”</p>
-
-<p>Down she went, soon to come upon the trail, and
-she was glad to find dinner ready, and enjoyed it.</p>
-
-<p>Mounting again, the chief said:</p>
-
-<p>“We must ride hard now, for the river will have
-to be behind us when the sun sets. Are you very
-tired, Miss Fallon?”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, no.”</p>
-
-<p>So on they went at a very slow pace for several
-miles in going down the mountain, and then when
-they struck good traveling, they pushed rapidly on,
-the chief not sparing the horses now.</p>
-
-<p>The sun was over an hour high when the river
-came into view.</p>
-
-<p>A halt was made to cool the horses off a little, then,
-riding down a steep ravine to the water, the chief said:</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll take your bridle rein here, Miss Fallon. Permit
-me to fold this rubber blanket around your feet<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_64"></a>[64]</span>
-and form, and you will not get in the least wet. Let
-your horse have full rein and do not be alarmed.”</p>
-
-<p>“I am not in the least alarmed,” was the reply, and
-she permitted the chief to fold the rubber blanket about
-her in such a way that she would not get wet when her
-horse was back deep in swimming.</p>
-
-<p>Then the chief rode in, she followed, her horse led,
-and the Indians came behind with the pack horses.</p>
-
-<p>The animals began to swim almost immediately,
-and the brave girl rather enjoyed the scene than
-dreaded it.</p>
-
-<p>After a long swim a sand bar was reached, they
-landed in safety, and, not to let the horses get cold,
-the chief pushed on for a couple of miles and went
-into camp, with the remark:</p>
-
-<p>“We are safe now, Miss Fallon, and you can rest
-through the night.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_65"></a>[65]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_VIII">CHAPTER VIII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">IN THE INDIAN VILLAGE.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>What the outlaw called safety was for himself and
-the Indians alone, and far from it for poor Lucille.</p>
-
-<p>He believed that the three fords were guarded still,
-that he might run upon a scouting party from the soldiers’
-camps at any moment, and he did not feel at
-ease until he had crossed the river with his captive.</p>
-
-<p>It was bold in him to venture so near the upper
-ford, believing a party of soldiers to be there, yet he
-knew that the wild nature of the country through
-which the river flowed above would keep him from
-crossing for many a long mile, and, for Lucille’s sake
-alone, to his credit be it said, he wished to cross by
-the unknown ford, though, strictly speaking, it was
-not a ford, but a place where a horse or man might
-get over by swimming.</p>
-
-<p>Lucille had escaped getting wet in crossing, and,
-as before, was given a secluded camping place to herself.</p>
-
-<p>The chief made it most comfortable, as there was
-no hurry now, by cutting pine boughs and building
-a wikiup and placing the pine straw as a couch, with
-the cushions from the coach upon it.</p>
-
-<p>A little fire was built near, just to make it more
-homelike, the chief said, and an extra supper was prepared
-for all.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_66"></a>[66]</span></p>
-
-<p>Night fell, and soon after supper the tired girl, for
-she was tired, sank to sleep in a few minutes.</p>
-
-<p>She awoke once in the night, to hear an owl hooting
-in the trees not far away, and a coyote yelping a
-short distance from camp.</p>
-
-<p>But she banished all thought with an effort of her
-will, and went to sleep again, awakening only when the
-sun had risen.</p>
-
-<p>“I hope you rested well last night, Miss Fallon?”</p>
-
-<p>“I enjoyed a good night’s rest, thank you.”</p>
-
-<p>“A ride of a little over thirty miles, and you will be
-in your new home to-night.”</p>
-
-<p>“Home! Do not desecrate the name, for it will be
-a prison, not a home to me,” she said bitterly.</p>
-
-<p>“Breakfast is ready for you.”</p>
-
-<p>She ate it, her spirits returned, and once more she
-mounted for the ride.</p>
-
-<p>Toward noon they began to climb the range she
-had seen from far across the river, and soon after
-the chief halted for dinner.</p>
-
-<p>Then up the steep trail they climbed again, Lucille
-glancing back from time to time to behold the scenery,
-and, while the sun was yet two hours above the
-horizon, they came to a pass in the mountains, where
-she suddenly beheld an Indian sentinel standing in
-the trail ahead of them.</p>
-
-<p>“Where is the chief?” asked the outlaw in the Indian
-tongue, and which was as Hebrew to Lucille.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_67"></a>[67]</span></p>
-
-<p>The Indian sentinel pointed, and soon after there
-came toward them a horseman that at once riveted
-Lucille’s gaze. He was the Indian chief, Death Face,
-and he had just come down from the village to the
-pass, which his band of braves were guarding.</p>
-
-<p>The youthful warrior was resplendent in a new costume,
-from boots to war bonnet, for he had on a pair
-of handsome cavalry boots. Sitting his horse with
-conscious power, armed with the white man’s weapons
-of revolvers and bowie knife, his face hideously
-painted, and mounted upon an animal that was bedecked
-in barbaric splendor, Death Face struck Lucille
-as being the most remarkable being she had ever gazed
-upon.</p>
-
-<p>The chief fairly started as his eyes fell upon her,
-and the outlaw, after greeting him, said:</p>
-
-<p>“Death Face, I have been on a raid into the white
-man’s territory, and this lady is my captive, whom
-I shall sell back to her father for a large price.”</p>
-
-<p>To the utter amazement of Lucille, the young chief
-replied, in perfect English:</p>
-
-<p>“I do not believe in the theory of my people, chief,
-of making war upon women and children, and I am
-surprised that you, as a white man, should do so; but
-that is your affair, not mine. Only treat her well.”</p>
-
-<p>“That she will tell you I have done. I wish to place
-her in the renegade’s cabin in your camp.”</p>
-
-<p>“You can do so.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_68"></a>[68]</span></p>
-
-<p>The outlaw and his captive were then riding on,
-when he halted and said:</p>
-
-<p>“Chief Death Face, those braves of yours whom I
-took with me I shall arm with repeating rifles and revolvers.
-I also have a pair of fine revolvers, a knife
-and a rifle for you, with a very handsome buckskin suit
-sent by an officer at the fort to a friend in the East,
-with slouch hat and all.</p>
-
-<p>“They will fit you, I am sure, and I wish you to accept
-them, as well as several fine Mexican serapes.”</p>
-
-<p>“Thank you, Captain Eagle, I will take them.”</p>
-
-<p>“You have done well, I see, on your raid?”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“Come to my quarters in the village to-night.”</p>
-
-<p>“I will.”</p>
-
-<p>“But have you any word of the soldiers?”</p>
-
-<p>“They are still on the other side, though I did not
-see them.”</p>
-
-<p>“I supposed they had gone, for we had seen no
-camp-fire smoke for three days.”</p>
-
-<p>“It may be a trick, so still be cautious and guard
-the fords, especially now that I have a captive here
-for whose rescue Colonel Carr would doubtless send
-his whole force.”</p>
-
-<p>With this the chief rode on, muttering to himself:</p>
-
-<p>“I must win that fellow with presents, for he will
-be the next chief after Iron Eyes, and he has as much
-influence now. Probably he has been educated in some<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_69"></a>[69]</span>
-school, for he speaks English like a paleface, and acts
-like one, too. There is some secret about him that I
-cannot fathom.”</p>
-
-<p>He had not ridden far before Lucille came up alongside
-of him. She saw now about her in a valley like
-cañon a camp of Indians.</p>
-
-<p>They were in full war paint, and gazed savagely at
-her as she rode by, yet were gloating in her capture.</p>
-
-<p>Once through the cañon, and the trail led down into
-a beautiful valley in which was the village of old Iron
-Eyes.</p>
-
-<p>Lucille uttered a cry as the view burst upon her,
-for, through the valley ran a mountain stream, upon
-both sides of which, for several miles, were the tepees
-of the Indians, the scattered village of the red men.</p>
-
-<p>The valley was dotted with thousands of ponies,
-and among the tepees were visible many women and
-children.</p>
-
-<p>Warriors were riding about, youths were mounted
-upon bareback ponies, others were playing games, children
-were bathing in the stream, and squaws were busy
-getting the evening meal.</p>
-
-<p>At the base of the hills on either side was heavy
-timber, and above the village towered the mountain
-ranges.</p>
-
-<p>“What a view for an artist!” cried Lucille.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, it must strike you strangely, Miss Fallon.”</p>
-
-<p>“It does; but you did not answer my question?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_70"></a>[70]</span></p>
-
-<p>“What was that?”</p>
-
-<p>“I asked you, after we came through the camp of
-braves, who that young chief was?”</p>
-
-<p>“He is called Death Face, and is the next chief in
-power to old Iron Eyes.”</p>
-
-<p>“He is very young?”</p>
-
-<p>“Not over twenty-two, I should say.”</p>
-
-<p>“And yet holds such power?”</p>
-
-<p>“He is a born fighter, a plotter, a soldier, and he has
-won his way up, young as he is.”</p>
-
-<p>“How is it that he speaks English so well?”</p>
-
-<p>“Only a few minutes ago he told me that he was
-taught by a renegade white man and his family.”</p>
-
-<p>“And also learned from him, I suppose, not to war
-against women and children. He could set you a good
-example, chief.”</p>
-
-<p>“I follow my own inclinations, Miss Fallon.”</p>
-
-<p>“So I have discovered. But in what part of this
-village am I to find refuge?”</p>
-
-<p>“Up at the head of the valley, in the cabin I spoke
-of.”</p>
-
-<p>“There must be a couple of thousand Indians here,
-at least.”</p>
-
-<p>“Double that number and more, for the village is
-five miles long, has some twelve hundred tepees, and
-can put out a force to defend it of two thousand warriors.
-Then there are several other contingent villages
-in these mountains that claim Iron Eyes as chief. It<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_71"></a>[71]</span>
-would be a sad day for any force of soldiers to invade
-these mountains, Miss Fallon, unless they came several
-thousand strong.”</p>
-
-<p>“That was just what I was thinking,” answered Lucille.</p>
-
-<p>As they rode into the village the squaws and children
-rushed toward them to see the newcomer.</p>
-
-<p>But a few words from the outlaw prevented any
-rudeness, for they held no sympathy for the fair-faced
-captive.</p>
-
-<p>Lucille paled at sight of them, but remained calm,
-and rode on by the side of the outlaw, whom she
-could not but now regard as her protector.</p>
-
-<p>Up through the village they rode, the girl’s fears
-gradually giving place to interest, until at the upper
-end of the valley, under the shelter of a heavily-wooded
-ridge, the mountaintop, there were visible a
-number of tepees apart from the others.</p>
-
-<p>“There is your camp, Miss Fallon. It is a deserted
-village&mdash;the supply tepees, as I told you. Yonder you
-see your cabin, apart from them, and there you will be
-safe. I shall have a half-breed squaw, who once lived
-at the fort as an officer’s servant, remain there with
-you and do your cooking.”</p>
-
-<p>“And be my guard also?”</p>
-
-<p>“In a measure, yes, for she will keep the Indians
-away from you, and you do not need any other guard<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_72"></a>[72]</span>
-here, as you could not escape over yonder ridge, unless
-you have wings.</p>
-
-<p>“The squaw speaks English and has cooked for me
-when I have been here, for my own tepee is in the
-village. The cabin is furnished, as I told you, after
-a rude fashion, and you have your own satchel with
-clothing, so you will not be uncomfortable.”</p>
-
-<p>As they passed a large tepee the outlaw called out to
-an Indian woman who stood there to approach them.</p>
-
-<p>She did so, and Lucille noticed that her face was
-lighter than those about her, and she looked neat in
-her attire.</p>
-
-<p>“Yellow Bird, I wish you to get your traps and
-come on up to the cabin. You are to look after this
-captive of mine while she is here, and take good
-care of her.”</p>
-
-<p>The woman had glanced at Lucille as she came up,
-but that was all, and she replied, in fair English:</p>
-
-<p>“Yellow Bird will do as the white chief bids her.”</p>
-
-<p>Then they rode on, and soon halted before the cabin,
-which was built of hewn logs, with boards roughly
-sawed out of hewn timber serving as roofing. There
-was a porch along the front, and it was certainly a
-very fine cabin to find in an Indian village.</p>
-
-<p>The chief took a key from a hiding place, which
-he appeared to know of, and unlocked the door.</p>
-
-<p>There were four rooms in the cabin, and Lucille saw
-that it was furnished, though rudely, for the renegade<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_73"></a>[73]</span>
-had brought his belongings with him when he
-had fled from his own people.</p>
-
-<p>“You will be at home here, Miss Fallon.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, at home!” repeated Lucille, with sarcasm, to
-add quickly:</p>
-
-<p>“But it is so much better than I expected, you
-have treated me so much differently than I anticipated,
-that I thank you.”</p>
-
-<p>The moment that she was left alone by the outlaw,
-and she saw him and his braves ride away, Lucille
-Fallon yielded to the prerogative of a woman, and,
-seating herself in the cabin, burst into tears.</p>
-
-<p>“At home! Ah! if this were to be my home, I would
-rather that the grave should be,” she cried bitterly.</p>
-
-<p>She had totally forgotten about the Indian woman
-until she heard the gently uttered words:</p>
-
-<p>“Don’t cry, paleface.”</p>
-
-<p>She started to her feet, for she was too proud to
-wish any one to see her weeping.</p>
-
-<p>Before her stood Yellow Bird, the half-breed Indian
-woman. She had tidied herself up, and had a
-bundle under her arms. Her face was a good one, not
-cruel, and she said again:</p>
-
-<p>“Don’t cry, Yellow Bird be good to you.”</p>
-
-<p>Lucille stepped forward and grasped the woman’s
-hand.</p>
-
-<p>“You are good, I can see that. You have lived
-among the palefaces, the outlaw told me?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_74"></a>[74]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Yes, my mother was a paleface squaw, my father
-a great Indian chief. He died, and my mother went
-back to her people, taking me with her. She died,
-and I work hard for officer’s family at fort far away.
-I hear them say: ‘She only half-breed Injun; watch
-her.’ I feel mad, I feel bad, and run away back to my
-people. But some treat me good, one young squaw
-pretty, just like you, and I love her. I love you for
-her. Yellow Bird be good to you.”</p>
-
-<p>The tears came into the eyes of Lucille, and, stepping
-close up to the woman, she kissed her.</p>
-
-<p>It was under the impulse of her loneliness, her sorrow,
-her helplessness, and the kind words spoken to
-her.</p>
-
-<p>The squaw started as though she had been struck a
-blow, for it fairly frightened her, but she said quickly:</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, yes, Yellow Bird be heap good to little paleface.”</p>
-
-<p>Then she set about her work to clean up, just as she
-had done when living in the officer’s family. She got
-water from a spring near, and built a fire in the large
-hearth, so that the cabin soon no longer looked forlorn.</p>
-
-<p>The outlaw had left the stage cushions there, the
-stores he had bought in Pioneer City and Lucille’s
-satchel, and the young captive was soon quite comfortable,
-and she began to feel that she had cause to<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_75"></a>[75]</span>
-congratulate herself, after all, that matters were as
-they were.</p>
-
-<p>In Yellow Bird she believed she had found a
-friend. Yet Lucille was not one to gush, and she decided
-that there was a very narrow margin between
-deceit and sincerity in one’s appearance, so she
-wished to know whether the Indian woman was really
-true or false.</p>
-
-<p>As she watched the squaw preparing supper, she
-asked her about Death Face, the young chief.</p>
-
-<p>“He heap good young chief&mdash;heap like paleface.
-He be great chief some day, and maybe have peace
-with palefaces, for he don’t like to kill Little Paleface’s
-people, but big fighter in battle. Red people all love
-Death Face. Iron Eyes heap cruel man, kill and scalp
-paleface, hate them bad. Iron Eyes kill many.”</p>
-
-<p>Lucille glanced out of the open window and said
-half aloud:</p>
-
-<p>“Speak of the devil, and his imp appears. There
-comes Death Face now.”</p>
-
-<p>He rode up to the front of the cabin and was
-alone.</p>
-
-<p>Lucille walked out on the piazza and to her surprise
-he bowed courteously to her and then said:</p>
-
-<p>“I hope you are comfortable here!”</p>
-
-<p>“Comfortable, yes, far more so than I anticipated
-being, but unhappy, as you may know, for my people<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_76"></a>[76]</span>
-are not your people, my life not your life, we are
-raised in a different atmosphere and are foes.”</p>
-
-<p>The chieftain listened to her in deepest attention,
-gazing fixedly at her, and then said:</p>
-
-<p>“I like to hear you talk, for it brings back to me
-the voice of those I loved, those who are gone.”</p>
-
-<p>“Whom do you mean?”</p>
-
-<p>“I mean one whom I loved as a father, another
-who was a mother to me, and a sister and brother.
-They are all gone&mdash;dead; but I had not forgotten
-them, and you bring them back to me now, so I love to
-look at you, love to hear you talk.</p>
-
-<p>“Speak again, for your voice is as sweet as the
-murmur of the brook in summer, as sweet as the
-trilling of the birds, and your face as lovely as the
-mountain flowers that seem timid, just like you.”</p>
-
-<p>Lucille listened with rapt attention to the words of
-the strange young chief, for he spoke with a softness
-of tone, a respectful look, and with words that fell
-strangely from the lips of an Indian, and were in
-strong contrast to the hideously painted death face
-with which he had ornamented his countenance.</p>
-
-<p>As though he feared he should not talk to the captive
-longer, Death Face said:</p>
-
-<p>“I will go now, but I came to see if I could help
-you, if I could make you more comfortable.</p>
-
-<p>“This was my home once, and I am glad to have
-you here.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_77"></a>[77]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Do you see those graves under the ridge yonder?&mdash;they
-are buried there, those I loved, and I put white
-crosses above their graves, and cut their names on
-them with my knife.”</p>
-
-<p>“You can read, then?”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, yes, and write. You will find books in the
-cabin to read. Don’t feel bad, for you shall not be
-harmed, for Death Face says so. I will come again.”</p>
-
-<p>He wheeled his horse and rode rapidly away, leaving
-Lucille wondering at her strange Indian acquaintance.</p>
-
-<p>Walking over to the graves under the ridge, Lucille
-saw that there were four of them, all marked by rude
-wooden crosses, but it was too dark to see the names,
-and she hastened back to the cabin, where Yellow Bird
-had her supper ready.</p>
-
-<p>It was a tempting repast, and eaten with real relish,
-Lucille talking the while to the squaw and asking her
-about the young chief, Death Face.</p>
-
-<p>Yellow Bird had little more to tell her than what she
-had already known, or would not tell her more. She
-did not say that all the maidens in the village were in
-love with the young chief, but that he seemed to care
-for none of them.</p>
-
-<p>The firelight was the only light they had in the
-cabin, and Lucille asked the woman to bring in wood
-enough to burn all night.</p>
-
-<p>This Yellow Bird did, and then the captive spread<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_78"></a>[78]</span>
-some bedding, put the serapes the chief had given her
-over them, and retired for the night, bolting the doors
-firmly.</p>
-
-<p>Yellow Bird spread her bed in front of the fire, and
-the two were soon fast asleep.</p>
-
-<p>When Lucille awoke the next morning she found
-Yellow Bird was getting breakfast, and the squaw told
-her that the young chief had been there early and
-left bear and other robes for her, dressed deerskins,
-and plenty of game and fish which he had shot and
-caught.</p>
-
-<p>The outlaw came after breakfast and asked her
-how she was, and then said:</p>
-
-<p>“There is a hammock in this house, Death Face
-told me, so I will swing it on the porch for you.”</p>
-
-<p>The hammock was found, swung, and then the outlaw
-said:</p>
-
-<p>“I have brought you pen, ink, and paper, Miss Fallon,
-and I wish you to write a letter to your father.</p>
-
-<p>“Tell him how you are treated by me, but make
-known that he must pay the sum of twenty thousand
-dollars for your ransom. The letter will be mailed
-to him at Pioneer City, and he shall send his answer
-by Jack Jessop, who will be met by a man whom I
-will instruct to be on hand. Your father must state
-in his letter if he will pay that ransom on the next
-run of the coach, and send it by Jack Jessop to be given<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_79"></a>[79]</span>
-to my representative. If my man is harmed, then I
-will not answer for your safety.</p>
-
-<p>“But, if he promises to send the money by Jessop,
-when he is ready to pay it, then you will be returned
-to him in safety, being given into Jack Jessop’s charge
-the third run of the coach after your father writes
-agreeing to my terms. Do you understand, Miss Fallon?”</p>
-
-<p>“Perfectly.”</p>
-
-<p>“I will write also, and you shall see my letter. Then
-I will see that the letters are mailed without delay in
-Pioneer City.”</p>
-
-<p>“It can be done none too soon to please me.”</p>
-
-<p>“So I thought.”</p>
-
-<p>“One minute, please?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“You said on the way here that you would tell me
-a secret some day that I am interested in.”</p>
-
-<p>“I believe I will tell you a secret,” said the man,
-thoughtfully, and he sat down upon the porch.</p>
-
-<p>Lucille sat in the hammock, using it for a swing,
-and the strangeness of her situation and surroundings
-could not but impress her.</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll tell you my secret, yes, and perhaps you will
-then understand that I seek revenge as well as gold
-from your father. By the way, do you think I resemble
-your father?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_80"></a>[80]</span></p>
-
-<p>“In form, yes, and in face, also, save for the stamp
-of wickedness on your countenance.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, he is innocent, I am evil. But we should be
-alike, for we are brothers.”</p>
-
-<p>Lucille sprang out, of the hammock and cried
-fiercely:</p>
-
-<p>“It is false!”</p>
-
-<p>“I tell you we are brothers, he being several years
-my senior,” said the outlaw. “My first love was a
-young and beautiful girl, and, though she loved me, he
-stole her from me.”</p>
-
-<p>“I do not believe you.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, he married her, that is certain&mdash;&mdash;”</p>
-
-<p>“My mother?”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, no; your mother was his second wife.</p>
-
-<p>“He won my sweetheart from me, married her, and
-then went to Texas to live. I heard afterward that
-his wife died after two years of wedded life, but I
-did not know, did not care, and I was not aware of
-where he was, or what doing until during the Civil
-War. I was taken prisoner by the Confederates, when
-in my captor, the colonel of a regiment, I recognized
-my brother. He knew me at a glance, and he came to
-me and we had a long talk together.</p>
-
-<p>“He told me that he had not known of my love
-for the woman he married, that he had never been
-told by her or her parents about an engagement between
-her and myself, that I was away and he therefore<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_81"></a>[81]</span>
-could not hear it from my own lips, and hence he
-had asked her to be his wife. He was going to Texas
-to live, and the marriage was hastened and she went
-with him, and only when on her dying bed had she confessed
-to him that she had been engaged to me.</p>
-
-<p>“Then he had written me the truth; but his letter
-I never received, and I did not believe what he told
-me.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yet it was the truth.”</p>
-
-<p>“How do you know?”</p>
-
-<p>“I have his first wife’s written confession, in which
-she told all, and how her parents had told her not to
-speak of her love affair with you, as he was rich, you
-were not, having squandered much of your fortune in
-fast living. Her name was Dorothy Armand, and she
-left her confession with her jewelry and other things
-that my father placed in my mother’s keeping, and all
-of which she left to me.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, her name was Dorothy Armand, as you say;
-but she deceived me, and I would not believe her dying
-confession, or take my brother’s word, either, for
-they wronged me, and I never forgive a wrong.”</p>
-
-<p>“But my father never did you a wrong, whatever his
-wife did in deceiving him as to her engagement to
-you,” said Lucille warmly.</p>
-
-<p>“His name is Louis Fallon Lamar, and he was a
-colonel in the Confederate army, as I have said, and
-a Texan ranchero. He got me exchanged, I admit, and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_82"></a>[82]</span>
-gave me money; but that did not atone for the past,
-and I hated him, for even in war he beat me, as he
-rose to be a colonel of cavalry, I only a captain of infantry.</p>
-
-<p>“He had married again, he told me, and had a
-daughter, but I was glad to feel that he was ruined
-by the war. What became of him then I never knew
-until I recognized him as a soldier in the United States
-army, and only a sergeant.</p>
-
-<p>“Then I remembered that I had heard that a Southerner
-of our name had killed a man in the East, and
-had fled to escape the gallows.</p>
-
-<p>“I wrote East, got the particulars, and found that
-it was my brother Louis. I have only hoped to capture
-him that I might send him back as a fugitive from
-justice to be hanged.”</p>
-
-<p>Lucille’s eyes flashed fire, and for a moment she
-did not speak. Then she said:</p>
-
-<p>“Let me ask you to look me in the eyes while I tell
-you what I know about what you have told me of
-my father.”</p>
-
-<p>“I am listening.”</p>
-
-<p>“My father did come out of the war ruined almost.
-He had married again, my mother being his second
-wife. He had felt keenly the unhappy circumstances
-of his first marriage, in fact, it cut him to the heart.
-He saved my mother’s father’s life at the risk of his<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_83"></a>[83]</span>
-own, was wounded by the shot intended for my grandfather,
-who took father to his home, where his daughter,
-my mother, nursed him through a long siege of
-suffering. My mother loved him, and he loved her, so
-they were married.</p>
-
-<p>“My father went North on business, accompanied
-a gentleman to his home one night with whom he had
-some business. Burglars broke into the house, and the
-host was shot down and robbed. Before he died he
-stated under oath that it was my father who had killed
-him, that they had a business deal on hand, that my
-father knew he had thousands of dollars in his home,
-and had come into his room at night and killed him.</p>
-
-<p>“My father had been in a distant wing of the house,
-had arisen at the noise of the struggle, had gone to
-the aid of his friend, to come face to face with you as
-you fled. You were dressed just as he was, you had
-killed your man, robbed him, and were flying. Stunned
-by the recognition, my father had been incapable of action,
-and, tottering to a seat, had remained there until
-arrested as the murderer.</p>
-
-<p>“Determined not to hang for your crime, and feeling
-that there was no hope for him, he sprang upon
-the constable who guarded him, choked him into unconsciousness,
-secured the keys of his manacles, freed
-himself, and fled. He wrote my mother that he was
-not guilty of the crime, but circumstantial evidence
-was against him, his insane flight added seeming proof,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_84"></a>[84]</span>
-and she unfortunately believed that he had committed
-the deed, and wrote to him.</p>
-
-<p>“Thus a wide gulf was between them, and he became
-a homeless wanderer and fugitive. He went to
-dwell among the Indians, and, having been educated as
-a physician, he became a medicine man in the tribe,
-checked a smallpox epidemic in their midst, and became
-a great chief, honored and loved by them. Discovering
-gold in his wanderings, he hid it away and
-at last decided to make good use of it. So he left the
-Indian village, carrying his gold on pack horses, and,
-going to a settlement, shipped it home to my mother.</p>
-
-<p>“It was a fortune for us, and she gladly received
-it, for her income was not large, and long before she
-had repented of her belief in my father’s guilt, and
-tried in vain to find him.</p>
-
-<p>“One day, just one year ago, my mother received
-a letter from the judge of the court in the city where
-the murder was committed which had wrecked my
-father’s life. It told of the confession of a prisoner,
-who had died in prison, that my father was innocent
-of the crime, that it was his brother who had been the
-murderer&mdash;he, the prisoner, being his ally&mdash;and that
-he saw the recognition of his brother by my father, and
-the shock it gave him.</p>
-
-<p>“But the murderer had committed other crimes,
-forcing him to become a fugitive, and so he could not
-be found, nor could my father, who afterward, I<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_85"></a>[85]</span>
-learned, had entered the army on the border. My
-mother was dying then, and I had to cling to her. She
-died, and soon after I had my lawyer find out if
-Sergeant Louis Fallon was my father, and he did so.</p>
-
-<p>“Then I wrote him that I would come to him. You
-know the rest, and I know that you have wronged my
-father beyond all forgiveness. Yes, you are his crime-stained
-brother, Loyd Lamar.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_86"></a>[86]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_IX">CHAPTER IX.<br />
-<span class="fs70">BUFFALO BILL’S BOLD VENTURE.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>The council of war which Lieutenant Walter Worth
-had said he would hold that night in the camp near the
-secret crossing of the river, where it was found that
-the outlaw had escaped across into the Indian country,
-continued until late at night, the young officer,
-Surgeon Denmead, the sergeant, and Buffalo Bill being
-the four present.</p>
-
-<p>Talking the matter over, in the light of all the facts
-with which they were acquainted, they were certain
-that Lucille had been captured by the outlaw leader.</p>
-
-<p>The letter which the outlaw had told the sergeant
-he would write to entrap her had been sent, and so
-there was no doubt but that he had been on hand to
-receive his prize.</p>
-
-<p>The Indians had told the sergeant the last night
-he had crossed the river that the outlaw had gone to
-Pioneer City by a secret ford.</p>
-
-<p>That trail had been found where it had left the
-river, and the trail where it had entered the river going
-back had also been discovered.</p>
-
-<p>This proved that the outlaw had secured his captive
-and hastened with her to the Indian camp.</p>
-
-<p>To rescue her, then, was the question, and Sergeant
-Fallon at once said:</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_87"></a>[87]</span></p>
-
-<p>“There is but one thing for me to do, and that is
-to put on my disguise and go into the Indian village
-after her.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sergeant, and I will go with you,” said Buffalo
-Bill firmly.</p>
-
-<p>“It would be madness for you to do so, Cody.”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, no, sergeant, for I would go as an ally, not
-to keep you company. I would go on foot, not
-mounted.</p>
-
-<p>“We can cross the river, and while you go down to
-the ford, I will go over here.”</p>
-
-<p>“You can proceed by the regular trail, while I will
-take it afoot to the mountains, there make for the
-bald peak we can see, and there you can find me, as
-I will look for you.</p>
-
-<p>“Afoot, I can readily hide. I will leave no trail,
-and am afraid of no redskins trapping me, for I have
-been within hailing distance of their villages scores
-of times.”</p>
-
-<p>“Pardon me, lieutenant, but do you think Mr. Cody
-should make the venture?”</p>
-
-<p>“No, sergeant, I do not.”</p>
-
-<p>“Nor do I,” said the surgeon.</p>
-
-<p>“See here, that young woman is a captive, and I tell
-you there should be more than one to aid in her rescue.</p>
-
-<p>“I know Indians from ’way back, and I’ll guarantee
-to go to their village and return.</p>
-
-<p>“You, in your disguise, are all right, sergeant, and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_88"></a>[88]</span>
-you may be able to help me escape with her, and come
-away yourself later.</p>
-
-<p>“We can pick out certain points in the mountains
-which we can discern, where we can meet, and I feel
-we can accomplish your daughter’s rescue; yes, and
-get hold of that outlaw by some means also, for I’ll
-not be happy until his chips are called in.</p>
-
-<p>“I go, too, sergeant.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, Cody, I see you are determined, so I yield,
-for I have every confidence in your powers to give
-the redskins the slip, but what are we to do?”</p>
-
-<p>“Stay right here, lieutenant, until we bring Miss
-Lucille back, for we may need your support and need
-it bad.”</p>
-
-<p>“All right. I will do as you suggest; but you and
-the sergeant arrange your plans of action between
-you.”</p>
-
-<p>“We will, sir, to-morrow.”</p>
-
-<p>The next morning the scout and the sergeant went
-up on the range and picked out half a dozen objects
-on the distant mountains across the river, and agreed
-to make them points of rendezvous.</p>
-
-<p>Then the sergeant said:</p>
-
-<p>“Mr. Cody, I wish to confide in you.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, sergeant.”</p>
-
-<p>“I have a brother who was a wild young fellow, and
-believed that I had treacherously cheated him out of his
-ladylove, when I knew nothing about his love for her,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_89"></a>[89]</span>
-and she became my wife. She was not Lucille’s
-mother, she being the daughter of my second wife.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, my brother never forgave me, and some years
-after he committed a crime of which I was accused,
-and it made an outcast, a fugitive of me.</p>
-
-<p>“He married and came West, and the other night
-when I looked into the face of the man known as
-Eagle, the outlaw, I felt sure that he was my brother.</p>
-
-<p>“I have not seen my unfortunate brother for many
-years, but the face, as I saw it by the flickering camp
-fire’s light, the voice, impressed me that it was Loyd
-Lamar.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, if he is my brother, he knows that Lucille is
-my daughter, and that is a relief to my mind. If
-the outlaw is my brother, and I would almost take
-oath that he is, I have but one request of you, and
-that is to kill him, and not capture him to be taken
-to the fort and hanged.”</p>
-
-<p>“My dear sergeant, I had promised myself I would
-do that, on account of his wife, and I will be that more
-anxious to save him from the gallows now that he is
-suspected of being your brother,” was Buffalo Bill’s
-reply.</p>
-
-<p>That afternoon they started upon their perilous mission,
-Buffalo Bill crossing the river at the spot where
-the camp was and the sergeant riding down to the
-upper ford, to go over after dark and continue on by
-the trail to the mountains.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_90"></a>[90]</span></p>
-
-<p>But the sergeant in crossing came to grief, for there
-stood on the other bank as sentinel a young brave who
-was striving to win a name for himself.</p>
-
-<p>He saw in the moonlight a horse and rider crossing
-the ford; so, taking aim, the redskin fired, pulling
-trigger just as he discovered that it was not a paleface
-but an Indian.</p>
-
-<p>The sergeant felt a stinging pain in his shoulder,
-the blood began to flow; he, therefore, turned back,
-fearing that he was seriously wounded, and did not
-know why he had been fired on.</p>
-
-<p>Fortunately Surgeon Denmead was there, and at
-once went to work on him, remarking after a while:</p>
-
-<p>“I have got the ball, Worth, and, with care, the
-wound will not be fatal, though serious.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_91"></a>[91]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_X">CHAPTER X.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE RESCUER REACHES THE GOAL.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>One afternoon, a week after Lucille’s coming to
-the Indian village as a captive, and while Lucille and
-the chief, Death Face, who had proved to be half
-white, were seated upon the little piazza looking at the
-sunset, the young man on the chair, the maiden in
-the hammock, there suddenly dashed around the corner
-of the cabin a tall form, brandishing a revolver in each
-hand. He had his revolver leveled full at the young
-man, as he called out sternly:</p>
-
-<p>“Up with your hands, renegade, or you die!”</p>
-
-<p>“Buffalo Bill!” cried Lucille, in suppressed tones,
-as though realizing, even in her surprise, the danger of
-speaking that name there. Then she quickly added:</p>
-
-<p>“For God’s sake do not kill him, for he is my
-friend.”</p>
-
-<p>Death Face sprang to his feet, yet made no move
-to draw a weapon, but stood gazing defiantly into the
-face of the scout, who, at the words of Lucille, lowered
-his weapons and said quickly:</p>
-
-<p>“Let me step into the cabin, for I may be seen
-here.”</p>
-
-<p>Quickly Lucille seized his hand and fairly dragged
-him into the cabin, while she said reproachfully:</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, why did you come here, for your life will be
-the forfeit?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_92"></a>[92]</span></p>
-
-<p>“I came for you, Miss Lucille, but I did not expect
-to find you in a white man’s cabin, free and with
-company.”</p>
-
-<p>“I will explain all later, but now you must go into
-hiding, for if you were discovered&mdash;&mdash;”</p>
-
-<p>“Not a redskin has seen me, I assure you. I have
-been four days coming from the river to this cabin,
-which I saw from the ridge above, as I did you also,
-and this young man, who I thought must be some
-renegade.</p>
-
-<p>“I crept up behind the cabin, having seen you seated
-on the piazza, and, dashing around, covered him; but
-you say he is your friend.”</p>
-
-<p>“You are safe here, Buffalo Bill, for I cannot but
-call you so, and you shall know the whole story. So
-sit down, for it is a long one, and there are secrets
-in it which you must not breathe to any one.”</p>
-
-<p>“You have my pledge not to betray anything, Miss
-Lucille,” said Buffalo Bill, and then he heard the story
-of her father’s strange life, her uncle’s, and her own.</p>
-
-<p>The scout listened with an interest that was intense,
-and when he had heard all, said in a low tone:</p>
-
-<p>“And I have a story to tell, too, Miss Lucille, and
-it is that you need no longer dread your wicked uncle,
-the outlaw. I crossed the river at the spot where
-you did, and that night camped not far away. The
-next morning the outlaw rode full upon me: we saw
-each other at the same time, but I was a little the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_93"></a>[93]</span>
-quickest, and my bullet pierced his brain. I had
-crossed the river upon a small raft the soldiers had
-made for me, and so I staked his horse out, when I
-was sure that he was alone, and, putting the body
-on the raft, poled back to the other shore. There I
-found that your father, who was to have crossed at
-the ford, and go with me to rescue you, had returned,
-having been fired on by the Indian sentinel and slightly
-wounded.”</p>
-
-<p>“You mean it&mdash;slightly wounded?” cried Lucille.</p>
-
-<p>“I tell the truth, for Surgeon Denmead was in camp
-and extracted the bullet. I had a talk with your father
-and he was doing well, but did not wish me to risk
-coming. How glad I now am that I did, for I have
-found you, though I have not rescued you.”</p>
-
-<p>“And my outlaw uncle?”</p>
-
-<p>“Lieutenant Worth had his soldiers bury him, for
-the lieutenant is waiting on the river for your return.
-Just as I was leaving another force came up which had
-taken your trail from Monument Hill and followed it
-to the river, so both are there.</p>
-
-<p>“I recrossed the river then on the raft, waited until
-night, and, mounting the horse of the outlaw, made
-a flank movement to reach the camp, determined to
-play Captain Eagle, if I met a redskin, for we were
-not unlike in size and face, and I speak the Indian
-tongue fairly well, while the horse and the coat and hat
-I appropriated would help me out, I knew.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_94"></a>[94]</span></p>
-
-<p>“I did not care to risk it by day, so flew by night
-only, reached the ridge, reconnoitered, and here I am,
-Miss Lucille; and my advice is that we get out of this
-at once.”</p>
-
-<p>Lucille turned to Death Face, who said:</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, we will go. I will bring ponies, too, and we
-will go up the ridge trail, where Buffalo Bill’s horse
-is, and then, together, we will go down to the river.
-If we meet any bands, Death Face, the chief, passes unquestioned.”</p>
-
-<p>So it was decided, and, while the young man went
-to make his arrangements for leaving the Indian camp
-forever, Lucille and Yellow Bird prepared for their
-escape, Buffalo Bill keeping in hiding.</p>
-
-<p>Under the guidance of the young chief, the trail to
-the river was made in perfect safety, Buffalo Bill being
-taken for the outlaw, and Lucille and Yellow Bird
-for braves by the bands of Indians they passed.</p>
-
-<p>No one questioned Death Face, and on he rode
-with his escaping party, Lucille and Yellow Bird having
-their faces painted, and in their leggings, riding
-in masculine fashion, while the pack horses they had
-along were well loaded with things taken from the
-Manly cabin and the young chief’s tepee.</p>
-
-<p>Reaching the river before dawn, the Indians left
-them, and Lucille added to her costume her riding
-habit and felt better able to face the soldiers on the
-other side.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_95"></a>[95]</span></p>
-
-<p>They crossed on the raft, which made several trips,
-the horses swimming over; then, mounting, they rode
-on to the soldiers’ camp.</p>
-
-<p>Such a welcome as greeted them, when Buffalo Bill
-and the sergeant’s daughter were recognized, cannot
-be described, for the soldiers seemed to have gone wild.</p>
-
-<p>In the week that had passed since he was wounded
-the sergeant had much improved.</p>
-
-<p>The meeting between father and daughter was most
-affecting, while tears came into the brave man’s eyes
-as he grasped Buffalo Bill’s hand and said:</p>
-
-<p>“I owe all this to you, Cody, and Lucille tells me
-she has told you all.”</p>
-
-<p>Fearful of risking his daughter so near the redskins,
-the sergeant said he was able to travel. The
-march was, therefore, begun after the noon meal, the
-trail taken being the same one that Lucille had traveled
-with the outlaw.</p>
-
-<p>The command was three days getting back to the
-fort, but when they came in sight, and it was seen
-that Lucille had been rescued, again there was a wild
-scene of rejoicing.</p>
-
-<p>Then, too, the sergeant had more joy added to his
-cup of bliss, for the last coach through had brought
-him his commission, “for special and gallant services,”
-as a first lieutenant in the army of the United States.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_96"></a>[96]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XI">CHAPTER XI.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE GUARD OF HONOR.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>After a month’s stay at the fort, under the plea
-of his wound unfitting him for service, for it was still
-troublesome, Lieutenant Fallon resigned his commission,
-feeling that he had been vindicated in having won
-it, unaided, and, with his daughter, went eastward, and
-thence to Texas, to his old ranch home.</p>
-
-<p>In a short time there was a wedding at the ranch,
-for thither had gone Lieutenant Walter Worth to
-claim his bride. Shortly after the lieutenant’s departure,
-Buffalo Bill set forth upon a new mission which
-promised a harvest of adventures.</p>
-
-<p>Having been appointed, for a special purpose, chief
-of scouts of the Tenth United States Cavalry, a regiment
-of black troopers, Cody rode off on one of his
-lone trails to reach the command at its frontier post.</p>
-
-<p>He loved the adventure and danger attending this
-new mission, yet sought it also for the benefit he could
-bring to those who dwelt upon the advance borderland,
-and depended upon just such men as himself to protect
-them from the redskins of the wild West.</p>
-
-<p>The noted scout had been ordered to Fort Aspen for
-his special duty, as the commandant, Major Armes,
-had made the request that he should be, on account of
-the threatened hostility of the Indians, and, also, as<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_97"></a>[97]</span>
-Buffalo Bill was the man who knew that country better
-than any other frontiersman.</p>
-
-<p>Major Armes also had been much troubled by the
-lawless bands of gold hunters who had sought to invade
-the Indian country, risking massacres, and keeping
-the redskins constantly worried over the determination
-of these palefaces to get a foothold in their
-hunting grounds and then force them farther toward
-the “Land of the Setting Sun.”</p>
-
-<p>Many bands of lawless invaders of the beautiful
-country had recklessly penetrated the mountain and
-valley recesses in search of the precious yellow metal,
-and they had thus avoided the chain of soldiers the
-government had put there to keep them out.</p>
-
-<p>One band after another had met its doom in the forbidden
-land, and been wiped out utterly by the Indians,
-who had left not one of them to tell the story of the
-massacre.</p>
-
-<p>They had taken their lives in their own hands, and,
-against all warnings and efforts of the soldiers, had
-broken through the military barrier and penetrated the
-Indian country, to meet there quick death.</p>
-
-<p>Even several emigrant trains, with women and children
-along, had foolishly ventured, and Buffalo Bill
-had reported that the groups of whitened bones he had
-found told the story of their fate.</p>
-
-<p>Though the soldiers were trying to protect their
-country from invasion, the hostile Sioux were as bitter<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_98"></a>[98]</span>
-toward them as toward those who sought to make
-homes there, and war, merciless and unending, had
-been declared.</p>
-
-<p>“If I had Buffalo Bill, as my chief of scouts, I believe
-he could, with his knowledge of the country, of
-these Indians, and his great skill as a frontiersman,
-head off these would-be settlers and bands of gold seekers
-from what they regard as a promised land, and this
-done, the Sioux would be more willing to make peace
-with the army, realizing that our desire was to protect
-them.”</p>
-
-<p>So wrote Major Armes, the commandant of Fort
-Aspen, to Colonel Carr, in seeking to have the valuable
-services of William F. Cody as chief of scouts.</p>
-
-<p>And the letter further said:</p>
-
-<p>“The Tenth Cavalry of colored troops also needs
-just such a man as Buffalo Bill to steady them and
-give them perfect confidence in the one who leads them
-upon deadly trails.</p>
-
-<p>“They one and all have perfect confidence in Buffalo
-Bill, believe that he bears a charmed life&mdash;as I also
-am inclined to believe&mdash;and they know that the Indians
-dread him, regard him with a certain superstitious
-fear, and his influence is very great along the
-whole border.</p>
-
-<p>“I, therefore, respectfully urge that he be sent to
-Fort Aspen, for a while at least, if only to bring confidence
-to the garrison.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_99"></a>[99]</span></p>
-
-<p>The result of Major Armes’ letter was that the next
-courier through to Fort Aspen brought dispatches stating
-that Buffalo Bill should come very soon, and that,
-spoken to upon the subject, he had said that, instead of
-making up a scouting band of white scouts, he would
-pick colored soldiers to be his allies.</p>
-
-<p>In other words, he would have a company of black
-scouts from the Tenth Cavalry.</p>
-
-<p>Major Armes at once notified the garrison that Buffalo
-Bill was coming to Fort Aspen, and what his intention
-was regarding the band of black scouts.</p>
-
-<p>There was excitement at once in the garrison, and
-the colored troopers were delighted that the great
-borderman was going to show his confidence in them
-by taking his scouts from their regiment.</p>
-
-<p>“Now we’ll blow de Injuns off de farm.”</p>
-
-<p>“You better believe I speaks fer bein’ a nigger
-scout.”</p>
-
-<p>“Annudder nigger heah does say de same.”</p>
-
-<p>“Wonder if Massa Bill gwine ter brack hissef up
-so as ter look like us?”</p>
-
-<p>“Won’t dem red niggers git up an’ lead us brack
-scouts arter ’em?”</p>
-
-<p>“An’ I guesses dem palefaces as wants ter go inter
-de Promised Lan’ will tarn back an’ settle somewhar
-else.”</p>
-
-<p>Such remarks and others of a like kind ran the
-rounds of the colored troopers, when they heard the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_100"></a>[100]</span>
-good news that Buffalo Bill was coming, and better still
-that he intended to pick men from their regiment for
-his scouts.</p>
-
-<p>Major Armes was much pleased, and knowing about
-the time the scout was expected, he ordered a negro
-sergeant and twenty men to take the trail as a guard
-of honor and meet him a day’s ride from the fort.</p>
-
-<p>The sergeant and his picked men were as proud as
-peacocks at the duty and the envy of all the rest of
-the regiment, who had to remain behind.</p>
-
-<p>Had the colored troopers had their say, all would
-have gone to meet the scout and Fort Aspen would
-have been left without a garrison.</p>
-
-<p>And so the black escort set out upon the trail to meet
-the noted scout.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_101"></a>[101]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XII">CHAPTER XII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">CORRALLED BY INDIANS.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>The sergeant in command of the escort was Mobile
-Buck, and he was so enrolled. He was a fine soldier
-and a brave one, and had won his rank for his good
-qualities.</p>
-
-<p>Sergeant Mobile Buck was vary cautious, however,
-and he wisely decided that it would be better to have
-an advance guard of one man to take chances of an
-ambush, than to have his whole force in danger, so
-he kept a trooper well ahead.</p>
-
-<p>What that solitary trooper thought of his being
-selected for that post of honor will never be known,
-as his sacrifice saved the sergeant and his other men.</p>
-
-<p>It was when some thirty miles from the fort, and
-when nearing the time for going into camp, wild yells
-were heard half a mile ahead, and soon back came the
-colored trooper’s horse, riderless.</p>
-
-<p>This and the yells told the story, and the sergeant
-was quick to take advantage of a retreat to a little hill,
-rocky and wooded, he had found only a mile back. He
-ordered his corporal to retreat there and go into camp,
-against the advice of several of his men that the safest
-place to fall back on would be the fort, and in a hurry,
-too.</p>
-
-<p>But Sergeant Mobile Buck called to two of his men<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_102"></a>[102]</span>
-to remain with him, and he set out to discover the
-trouble ahead, how many Indians there were, and what
-he had better do under the circumstances.</p>
-
-<p>He soon discovered more than he cared to, for fully
-half a hundred Indians were in sight, with no telling
-how many more were hidden near by.</p>
-
-<p>Back he rode to the retreating place, fully convinced
-that the advice offered by a few, to fall back on the
-fort, was wise.</p>
-
-<p>But he discovered as he came in sight of the hill,
-that the corporal and his men were in trouble, for there
-were a number of Indians there also, advancing to the
-attack.</p>
-
-<p>“That cuts off retreat,” said Sergeant Buck, and he
-charged for the hill with his two companions.</p>
-
-<p>This charge checked the attack of the redskins and
-greatly pleased Corporal Black, who did not belie
-his name, as he was as black as charcoal.</p>
-
-<p>The corporal was only too anxious to be relieved of
-his command, and have the sergeant assume responsibility.</p>
-
-<p>“We are in for it and no mistake, corporal. How
-many Injuns have you seen?” said the sergeant, as he
-rode into the retreat.</p>
-
-<p>“Some says dere is hundreds of ’em, but I ain’t
-seen dat many yit, though I has seen more’n I wants
-ter,” was the reply.</p>
-
-<p>“There were about fifty that ambushed Buck, maybe<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_103"></a>[103]</span>
-more, and perhaps as many yonder, so we are cut off,
-I fear.”</p>
-
-<p>“Did dey kill po’ Brick?” asked the corporal.</p>
-
-<p>“I guess they did, for they are Injuns.”</p>
-
-<p>“An’ scallip him, too?”</p>
-
-<p>“I don’t know, for that wasn’t easy, as his hair
-was cut close.”</p>
-
-<p>“So hit was, but mine ain’t,” and the corporal felt
-of his hair, which he feared was long enough to get
-a grip on.</p>
-
-<p>The sergeant smiled, then took in the chances of defending
-the hill, being glad to see that the corporal had
-put the horses in as secure a place as could be found
-and posted his men in fighting positions.</p>
-
-<p>The corporal might be scared, but his military training
-stood him in need.</p>
-
-<p>“Grass, but no water here; yet we can hold ’em off
-for a while, for some man has got to slip out to-night
-and go back to the fort for help,” said the sergeant.</p>
-
-<p>All had been listening eagerly to his words; but
-each one looked away at this suggestion, fearing he
-would be the man picked out to go.</p>
-
-<p>“Maybe Massa Bill Cody come along and sabe us,”
-said the corporal.</p>
-
-<p>There was a cheer at this, and it showed just what
-the colored troopers thought of Buffalo Bill’s powers
-to help them.</p>
-
-<p>The sergeant seemed pleased, also, and he set to<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_104"></a>[104]</span>
-work to strengthen his position, place his men where
-they could do the most good and ordered them to throw
-up the earth about each one of them so as to protect
-them.</p>
-
-<p>They were only too anxious to do this, and worked
-like beavers.</p>
-
-<p>“There they come&mdash;steady, men, and wait until I
-order you to fire!” the sergeant said calmly.</p>
-
-<p>The Indians had now united their forces, and it was
-evident that they belonged to the same band, had been
-watching the troopers for some time, and had arranged
-to ambush them all: only the advance guard of poor
-Brick, sent ahead by the sergeant, had spoiled their
-plan, as they had fired on him with their arrows, believing
-that the others were close upon his heels.</p>
-
-<p>Having united their two bands, a hundred in number,
-all came with a rush upon the intrenched troopers,
-yelling like madmen, their ponies at full speed, and
-sending showers of arrows before them with an occasional
-shot from a rifle, where a brave was so unfortunate
-as to have firearms, then not common among
-the redskins.</p>
-
-<p>“We’ve got ter do ’em, men, or they’ll down us,”
-shouted the sergeant, and a moment after he cried:</p>
-
-<p>“Aim to kill&mdash;fire!”</p>
-
-<p>Some of the troopers may have fired at random;
-but more did not, and down went ponies and riders,
-while the repeating rifles of the soldiers keeping up<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_105"></a>[105]</span>
-their rattle, and deadly rattle it was, checked the onward
-rush of the redskins, for they wavered, turned,
-and fled for the shelter of the nearest timber.</p>
-
-<p>The colored troopers were jubilant with delight.</p>
-
-<p>Without a white officer they had beaten off the redskins,
-who were five to one against them, and killed
-or wounded a number of braves and ponies.</p>
-
-<p>Sergeant Mobile Buck was a hero of heroes, and he
-felt it, too. Whatever his men might feel about it, he,
-at least, was glad he had come. It gave the sergeant
-confidence, and it helped the men.</p>
-
-<p>One trooper had been killed, shot through the throat
-with an arrow, and three others slightly wounded.</p>
-
-<p>But the dead man was removed out of sight, and
-the wounds of the three men dressed, weapons reloaded,
-the position strengthened, and supper cooked
-and sent around, for night was at hand.</p>
-
-<p>“I doesn’t like dem dead red Injuns lyin’ out dere,”
-said a trooper, with an awe of the dead and darkness.</p>
-
-<p>“Never mind, we’ll have more of ’em soon,” said
-the sergeant.</p>
-
-<p>Then darkness came and the men waited, each man
-a sentinel, for there was no sleep for those black defenders
-of the hill that night.</p>
-
-<p>All was silent and darkness, suddenly broken by
-the words:</p>
-
-<p>“Who commands here?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_106"></a>[106]</span></p>
-
-<p>The voice was clear and stern, and came from a
-point close at hand. Then a tall form arose from behind
-a group of rocks.</p>
-
-<p>“Massa Buf’ler Bill!”</p>
-
-<p>The cry came almost in a shout, and every man left
-his position and rushed to where the scout stood, for
-he it was, in truth, who had invaded the retreat of the
-corralled negro soldiers.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_107"></a>[107]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XIII">CHAPTER XIII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE RIDE FOR HELP.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>The darkness hid the tears of joy in the eyes of the
-colored troopers, at the coming of Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>The scout had crept into the corral unseen, and he
-said sternly:</p>
-
-<p>“If I could get in here, redskins can&mdash;who is commander
-here?”</p>
-
-<p>“I am, sir, Sergeant Mobile Buck, and we were
-going to meet you, Chief Cody.”</p>
-
-<p>“I am glad to meet you, Sergeant Buck; but you
-have only colored troops?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir, from the Tenth Cavalry, and Major
-Armes told us we could come and meet you on the trail,
-and mighty glad we are to see you, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“I saw your man ahead killed, but could not save
-him, for he rode right into an ambush I was watching,
-and his doing so saved me. Then I watched developments
-and saw you retreat here, so waited until dark
-to creep in, for there are more Indians coming and you
-are in a bad way.”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, Lordy!”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill laughed.</p>
-
-<p>“You are not dead yet, boys,” he said, “and you
-made a good fight when they attacked you; but you will
-not be attacked again until morning, about dawn, and
-then by a force large enough to run you down.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_108"></a>[108]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Jist you take us to de fort, Massa Bill, fer you
-kin do it, sah,” said one, and all held the same opinion.</p>
-
-<p>“No, you could never leave here, and I’ll have to
-sneak out; but my horse and pack animal are a mile
-away, on the trail to the fort, and I’ll go there for
-help, and it will take three or four troops to do it,
-too.</p>
-
-<p>“The fort is about twenty-five miles from here, and
-I’ll make it in three hours, for I’ll hide my pack animal
-soon as I can, and I will be back with help in four
-hours more.</p>
-
-<p>“That will get us here just in time, and you keep
-watch for all you are worth, strengthen your position
-all you can, have your rifles and revolvers ready, and
-you can fight them off, if they do attack, until we get
-here.”</p>
-
-<p>“Don’t yer think I better go wid yer, Massa Bill?”
-asked a trooper, who preferred to take his chances
-with Buffalo Bill alone to remaining with his score
-of comrades.</p>
-
-<p>“No, every man is wanted here.”</p>
-
-<p>“Dat’s so, an’ I wishes you was goin’ ter stay, too,
-sah,” and this remark voiced the idea of all.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, sergeant, send your men back to their posts,
-and let them know if they go to sleep some of them
-may wake up in the Indians’ happy hunting grounds.</p>
-
-<p>“Then Sergeant Buck go with me to the end of the
-timber, for I wish a word with you.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_109"></a>[109]</span></p>
-
-<p>The troopers were sent again to their posts of duty,
-and the sergeant went with Buffalo Bill to a gully,
-by which he intended to retreat, for it was not guarded
-as horses could not go that way.</p>
-
-<p>“Sergeant, you have done well in your fight, and
-I appreciate your having come to meet me. It saved
-me. Tell your men I want each one of them in my
-band of scouts, so I have my eye upon them. You
-may have to fight again, but do it to the death as I’ll
-get help to you as soon as I can. Good night, and
-luck.”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill grasped the hand of the brave negro,
-who replied:</p>
-
-<p>“We’ll die game, sir, if we have to; but we depend
-on you, Massa Bill, for you’re the only man who can
-save us, and you will, sir, I know you will.”</p>
-
-<p>The deep voice quivered, and Buffalo Bill turned
-away, going rapidly down the gully to where he had
-left his horses.</p>
-
-<p>He passed within a dozen feet of an Indian outpost
-of several braves, heard them talking, and the smoke
-of their pipes reached him, while he saw a spark of
-fire.</p>
-
-<p>But he went on, reached his horses, mounted and
-rode off at a sweeping gallop toward the fort.</p>
-
-<p>At length he halted and muttered:</p>
-
-<p>“It is taking big chances, but I will do it. I can hide
-my pack horse there and it will cut off a dozen miles,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_110"></a>[110]</span>
-if I do risk the lives of my horse and myself in making
-the leap, which is all of twenty feet.”</p>
-
-<p>He turned off the trail, just as the moon, on the
-wane, rose to light his way.</p>
-
-<p>A roar came to his ears, a roar of falling water, and
-he soon halted on the banks of a foaming stream.</p>
-
-<p>“My pack horse will be safe here,” said Cody, and
-he quickly unsaddled the animal.</p>
-
-<p>Then he stripped his own horse of his heavy Mexican
-saddle, laid with it his rifle and belt of arms, save
-one revolver, took off his boots, hunting coat, and
-broad-brimmed sombrero, and approached the steep
-banks of the river.</p>
-
-<p>It was a cliff, and all of twenty feet down to the
-water. A quarter of a mile below was a fall over
-which the stream wildly rushed, and across from him
-a hundred yards or more lay the other shore, the banks
-low and sandy.</p>
-
-<p>“It will save a dozen miles, Buckskin, and we can
-make it&mdash;we must!” he said, in his decided way, and
-he quickly made a bridle of his stake of rope, leaped
-across the bare back of his splendid horse, wheeled
-suddenly and rode rapidly toward the cliff.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, Buckskin, make the leap, and by it save the
-lives of my black troopers!” cried Buffalo Bill, as
-he urged his horse directly out upon the mad leap.</p>
-
-<p>Buckskin did not hesitate; he seemed to feel, with<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_111"></a>[111]</span>
-his master, that only by the leap from the dizzy height
-could he save the lives of human beings by cutting off
-a dozen miles in the trail and getting help from the fort
-to them before they would be wiped out by the Indians.</p>
-
-<p>The noble horse leaped far out from the cliff, hung
-in the air, it seemed, for one precious second, and then
-went down swiftly into the raging flood.</p>
-
-<p>He struck hard, sank from sight, though Buffalo
-Bill held his revolver far above his head to prevent
-its getting wet, for those were not the days of the
-present improved cartridges.</p>
-
-<p>Then the horse arose, and his rider guided him toward
-the other shore.</p>
-
-<p>It was a wild current, and they were swept rapidly
-down toward the falls; but the horse swam with vigor,
-and stripped of his saddle and trappings he was not
-hampered, Buffalo Bill helping him with all his power.</p>
-
-<p>At length, the shore was reached, the hoofs touched
-bottom, and Buffalo Bill dismounted to give the horse
-a rest.</p>
-
-<p>But only for a minute, for, remounting, he set off at
-a sweeping gallop for the fort, from that point not half
-a dozen miles.</p>
-
-<p>“I have saved all of an hour and a half, if not more.
-You did it splendidly, Buckskin,” said the scout, and
-coming back into the trail, he sent the horse flying
-along at full speed.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_112"></a>[112]</span></p>
-
-<p>Within half an hour the light of the fort came into
-view, and it was not yet midnight.</p>
-
-<p>“Ho, sentinel, let me in&mdash;I am Buffalo Bill, the scout&mdash;and
-sound the alarm, for help is needed at once, or
-Sergeant Mobile Buck and his men will all be wiped
-out!”</p>
-
-<p>This startling salute and alarm at once roused the
-garrison to action, and Buffalo Bill dashed to the headquarters
-of Major Armes, and reported his coming
-to that officer and asked for three troops of the Tenth
-Cavalry to go to the rescue.</p>
-
-<p>“God bless you, Cody, you shall have them, and
-within ten minutes,” cried Major Armes, and the order
-was given.</p>
-
-<p>Within half an hour, mounted upon a fresh horse,
-Buffalo Bill rode away from the fort at the head of
-over a hundred black cavalrymen, to the rescue of
-Sergeant Buck and his band.</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll set the pace, Captain Keyes, and those who
-cannot keep up can follow.</p>
-
-<p>“We must make it within three hours, sir,” said
-Buffalo Bill, and Captain Edward Keyes answered:</p>
-
-<p>“Go ahead, Cody, and we’ll be with you.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_113"></a>[113]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XIV">CHAPTER XIV.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE BLACK TROOPERS AT BAY.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>As Buffalo Bill knew just how urgent the demand
-for haste might become, he set a pace that, though he
-knew many of the troopers might not be able to keep
-up, yet many would do so, and these could make the
-attack on the Indians, while the others would constantly
-be coming up as reënforcements.</p>
-
-<p>Major Armes had also promised to send a wagon
-with rations, a six-pounder gun, and a company of infantry,
-mounted, as a reserve, in case the Indians
-should be in still larger force than Buffalo Bill had
-supposed them to be.</p>
-
-<p>To the black troopers in the little hill retreat it was
-a sad sight to see Buffalo Bill leave them, though they
-knew that by his going alone was there a chance for
-their rescue.</p>
-
-<p>They knew their danger, and the warning the scout
-had given them, that “if he could get into their retreat
-an Indian could also do so,” had made them keep the
-closest watch, and not an instant did they close their
-eyes.</p>
-
-<p>“If I wakes up arter a nap, I wants it ter be in this
-world, not de next, so I doesn’t go ter sleep,” said a
-trooper, and he voiced the sentiments of all.</p>
-
-<p>To add to their wakefulness the corporal, in going<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_114"></a>[114]</span>
-his rounds, was seen to suddenly fall and lie motionless.</p>
-
-<p>The sergeant hastened to his side to find that an arrow
-had penetrated his eye&mdash;he was dead.</p>
-
-<p>Sergeant Mobile Buck dragged the body into hiding
-and wisely said nothing. He then went the rounds of
-the men himself, and very cautiously, for he knew that
-Indians were within arrow range and watching.</p>
-
-<p>Then the sergeant discovered how it was that the
-corporal had lost his life, for the moon was rising,
-and he had stood with its light behind him, his form
-in bold relief against its silvery face.</p>
-
-<p>“Be careful of showing yourselves with the moon
-behind you, for there are Indians watching for a
-chance to send an arrow at you,” said the sergeant,
-and he was cautious how he moved, for not only did he
-desire to escape what he had warned others of, but he
-thought also of the men, should he be killed or seriously
-wounded, and how readily they would get into
-a panic with no one to govern them.</p>
-
-<p>So the hours passed, the sergeant going on his
-rounds every half hour, and one time discovering a
-dark object out upon the open plain, and which he
-was sure was not there when last he passed that way.</p>
-
-<p>“Give me your gun, Benton,” he said to the sentinel
-nearest the dark object.</p>
-
-<p>The trooper obeyed, and the sergeant took a rest<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_115"></a>[115]</span>
-with the carbine over a rock, aimed well and pulled
-trigger.</p>
-
-<p>A wild yell, a form springing into the air, measuring
-a few feet, and a heavy fall followed.</p>
-
-<p>“You must keep better watch, Benton, for that
-redskin would have plugged you in half an hour
-more,” said the sergeant.</p>
-
-<p>Benton was thoroughly alarmed now, and said:</p>
-
-<p>“Yas, sah, you done sabe my life, an’ I ain’t gwine
-ter fergit it, nuther. You bet I’s keepin’ watch now,
-sergeant, I is.”</p>
-
-<p>The shot had startled the troopers, as it was answered
-by yells from the Indians across in the timber.</p>
-
-<p>But the sergeant continued his round, and to each
-man he told of Benton’s narrow escape, until several
-shots were fired at rocks fearing they might be large
-groups of Indians.</p>
-
-<p>That a random shot thus fired sounded a death-knell
-a choking war cry told.</p>
-
-<p>The sergeant had got the rifles of the corporal and
-of the other slain trooper, and kept them ready for
-use when the time came.</p>
-
-<p>But he continued his rounds through the night.</p>
-
-<p>Then he ordered all to be ready, for he felt sure an
-attack would be made.</p>
-
-<p>That Buffalo Bill had not got back was a cause of
-deepest anxiety, but the sergeant was brave and told
-his men that the scout with help was doubtless close<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_116"></a>[116]</span>
-at hand, only waiting for the Indians to attack the retreat,
-and this gave them hope.</p>
-
-<p>Soon a dark mass was visible, moving out from the
-distant timber. The Indians were advancing to the
-attack, and they were mounted.</p>
-
-<p>“Men, we’ll empty these extra guns at them first,
-for they’ll reach them, and then you fire only when I
-give the order,” cried the sergeant.</p>
-
-<p>The three guns rattled forth their seven shots each,
-and they must have hit hard, for the redskins wavered,
-yelled like demons, and came on with a rush.</p>
-
-<p>“Fire!”</p>
-
-<p>All the rifles opened fire, and the shots told, for
-ponies fell and riders dropped to the ground.</p>
-
-<p>But the rush was on, the Indians were in heavy
-force, hundreds against a score of black troopers, and
-the showers of arrows, the maddened yells and the roar
-of the charging ponies, struck terror to the hearts of
-the troopers.</p>
-
-<p>“Hold ’em, men, or all is lost,” shouted the sergeant,
-adding:</p>
-
-<p>“Revolvers now!”</p>
-
-<p>But as the rattle of revolvers began and the redskins
-were almost up to the retreat, above the wild yells of
-the redskins arose the piercing, thrilling notes of a
-bugle, followed by the ringing war cry of Buffalo Bill,
-and a stern command from Captain Keyes:</p>
-
-<p>“Ride them down, men!”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_117"></a>[117]</span></p>
-
-<p>The bugle notes broke upon the ears of the redskins
-just in time to deprive them of their prey, for, wheeling
-to one side of the retreat, they drove on at full
-speed, for they knew that United States cavalry was
-upon them and in large force.</p>
-
-<p>“After them, men!” shouted Buffalo Bill, and with
-Captain Keyes by his side, and nearly a hundred
-troopers following, they rode hot on the heels of the
-flying redskins.</p>
-
-<p>It was a complete surprise, of the kind that causes
-a stampede, and the Indians only sought to escape their
-pursuers until they reached a place where they could
-rally and ambush their foes.</p>
-
-<p>But Captain Keyes was too good a soldier to be
-caught in a trap, with tired-out horses and men, and
-he called a halt when his command drew near a heavily
-timbered hill.</p>
-
-<p>“Halt here, men, and let them think this is all the
-force, while Cody, you go back, meet the other men
-and flank yonder ridge with them, ordering a courier to
-go to the reserve and fetch them, with the gun, to
-your aid with all speed.”</p>
-
-<p>It was almost daylight now, and the tired men rested
-where they were in line of battle, while Buffalo Bill
-rode back, checking the troopers still coming up and
-ordering them to keep out of sight in the timber, while
-he went to the retreat of those who had been rescued
-in the nick of time.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_118"></a>[118]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XV">CHAPTER XV.<br />
-<span class="fs70">A VERY STRANGE FIND.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>“The goo’ Lor’ bress you, Massa Bill!” came a cry
-in chorus from a dozen men, as the scout approached
-the retreat.</p>
-
-<p>Sergeant Mobile Buck came out to meet Buffalo Bill,
-and wrung his hand hard, while he said:</p>
-
-<p>“You did it, sir&mdash;you saved us, and just in time,
-for my men were giving way.</p>
-
-<p>“I lost five killed, sir, and half a dozen wounded,
-though only two seriously.</p>
-
-<p>“It will do the men good, sir, this fight, and they’ll
-follow you, Mr. Cody, to the devil!”</p>
-
-<p>“And I want you and every man of them for my
-squadron of scouts, sergeant, as I will need yourself,
-a corporal, and twenty-four men.</p>
-
-<p>“Now look to your wounded and then bury your
-dead, for I’ll have breakfast sent to you from the main
-camp over in the timber yonder, where they are now
-cooking for Captain Keyes and his men, who will remain
-where they are until I can flank yonder hill, for
-we have as many more men in reserve and a gun.”</p>
-
-<p>“That’s good, sir, and Mr. Injun will get it bad,
-won’t he?” said the delighted sergeant, while Buffalo
-Bill rode through the retreat and called out:</p>
-
-<p>“You had it hot and deadly here, I see, boys, but you<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_119"></a>[119]</span>
-fought like wild cats, all of you, and I am proud of
-my black scouts, for I want you all.”</p>
-
-<p>A cheer answered the words of the scout, and he
-rode rapidly back into the timber, where the stragglers
-had come up with the pack animals, a camp had been
-formed, and breakfast was being prepared.</p>
-
-<p>Sending a white scout on his trail of the night before
-to bring his pack horse, saddle and bridle from
-where he had left them on the river bank, Buffalo
-Bill hastily had breakfast with a half a hundred troopers,
-and led them by a flank movement to get in the rear
-of the Indians on the ridge. He had long before sent a
-courier to tell the reserve force, the troopers with their
-gun, to branch off at a trail, which would head him off
-at a point where they could reach the rear of the redskins.</p>
-
-<p>All went just as he had hoped it would, the reserve
-met the command under Buffalo Bill, and by hard
-riding, were after the Indians, halted on the ridge and
-watching Captain Keyes in the valley in their front,
-feeling that he was afraid to attack them, were surprised
-by a shell bursting in their midst on the hill.</p>
-
-<p>It fairly dazed them with surprise and dread, and
-only when shell after shell began to crash among them,
-and Captain Keyes mounted his men for a rush on the
-ridge, did they break in a wild stampede.</p>
-
-<p>These, too, saw that they were between two fires,
-Captain Keyes and the force of Buffalo Bill with the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_120"></a>[120]</span>
-gun, and there was but one way to escape, and that was
-to desert their ponies and take to the deep cañons leading
-into the mountains where a horse could not find
-footing.</p>
-
-<p>It was hard for an Indian to do, to leave his pony,
-but it was a question of life and death, and they fled
-on foot, thus making it a glorious victory for the palefaces.</p>
-
-<p>Sending a courier to have his pack animal and a
-fresh horse brought him, Buffalo Bill went on the trail
-of the redskins, to see if they continued their flight,
-or halted to try and make an effort to regain their
-horses when night came, and Captain Keyes came up
-with his men to go into camp with the entire force.</p>
-
-<p>It was nearly midnight when Buffalo Bill, on foot,
-returned to the camp.</p>
-
-<p>“They’ve got enough for the present, sir, and are all
-on the jump for their village; but I will go out mounted
-at dawn and alone, keeping on their trail for a day, at
-least, until sure what they will do,” he said to Captain
-Keyes.</p>
-
-<p>“And shall I camp here, Cody, or return to the
-fort?” asked the captain.</p>
-
-<p>“Better rest here until day after to-morrow, sir,
-and then return by slow march toward the fort, so I
-can overtake you, if they meet other bands and return,
-for there may be more of them.</p>
-
-<p>“If I see nothing suspicious, sir, please say to Major<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_121"></a>[121]</span>
-Armes that I will return to the fort within two or three
-days.”</p>
-
-<p>“All right, Cody, and I hear you are going to have
-a squadron of negro scouts?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir, for it will give the colored troops confidence,
-and I believe I can make good scouts of them,
-while the Indians are as scared of the black soldiers as
-the latter are of them&mdash;they don’t just understand their
-being black and call them ‘Heap Black Paleface
-Braves.’”</p>
-
-<p>“Not a bad name, either, if they will only prove
-braves; but the Indians are experts in giving names.</p>
-
-<p>“Now get what rest you can, for you need it, and I
-know of no man who could do what you have.”</p>
-
-<p>Ten minutes after Buffalo Bill was fast asleep; but
-at dawn he woke up, and his pack horse and a fresh
-riding animal having come up, he had breakfast,
-mounted, and rode away on his lone trail.</p>
-
-<p>That day every sign pointed to the fact that the Indians
-had been so badly beaten that though they had
-met a couple of bands of their comrades, they did not
-turn back, but went on to their villages together.</p>
-
-<p>It was toward evening of his second day’s trail, as
-he came to a good camping place, that Buffalo Bill decided
-to halt for the night, when he was startled by
-hearing a human voice calling to him, and the words
-spoken in a low tone.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_122"></a>[122]</span></p>
-
-<p>Out of a thicket staggered a tall, gaunt form, with
-black face, haggard, and showing deep lines of suffering,
-while his clothing was in rags, his feet wrapped in
-deerskins, a foxskin cap upon his head, a tattered
-blanket, and a rifle, revolver, and knife his weapons.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_123"></a>[123]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XVI">CHAPTER XVI.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE NEGRO MESSENGER.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>“Well, my poor fellow, who and what are you?”
-asked Buffalo Bill, as he dismounted and stood before
-the vagabond negro.</p>
-
-<p>“I’s mighty near starved ter death, an’ I’d died soon
-ef I hadn’t had you find me, boss,” was the answer.
-“I seen you comin’, and I lay low and was goin’ ter let
-you pass me by, sah, only I seen yer face, and know’d
-yer were a good man.</p>
-
-<p>“If you had been an Injun, sah, or one ob dem bad
-white men I seen in dis country, I’d ’a’ jist pulled my
-gun on yer and got yer horse an’ rashuns ter eat, fer
-de Good Book do say dat preservin’ o’ one’s life am de
-bestest law o’ natur’, sah.”</p>
-
-<p>“So you would have chanced killing me?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yas, sah, and it w’u’d hev been a big chance, too,
-as I has got but one load in my gun an’ one in my
-revolver.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, I am glad you didn’t take the chances; but I
-would have found you, anyhow, as I intended to camp
-right here for the night.”</p>
-
-<p>“Den I is sabed, sah, I is sabed, fer I gits somet’in to
-eat, an’ sabin’ me, sah, means a heap, fer dere is lives
-dependin’ dis werry minit upon dis nigger.”</p>
-
-<p>“Where&mdash;&mdash; But you must be fed first, and then you<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_124"></a>[124]</span>
-can tell me. Sit there, and I’ll soon have a fire, and
-cook supper.”</p>
-
-<p>“Boss, I is mos’ so weak I has got ter let you do de
-work, an’ you see, sah, I is wounded, too.”</p>
-
-<p>“Poor fellow!” Buffalo Rill glanced at a bullet
-wound in the negro’s side.</p>
-
-<p>Hastily the scout set to work, pitched his camp in a
-secluded spot on the bank of a little stream, and, taking
-from his pack saddle a pair of extra blankets, he spread
-them on the ground and told the negro to lie down.</p>
-
-<p>He quickly gathered some wood, built a fire among
-some rocks, and, after staking out the horses, started to
-prepare a venison steak, bacon, hoecake, and coffee
-for supper.</p>
-
-<p>The negro would have eaten ravenously, so nearly
-starved was he, only the scout made him go slow, and
-did not give him half what he craved.</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll give you some more after a while; but now I’ll
-build a shelter for you, as I think you’ll have to rest
-here for a few days, at least.”</p>
-
-<p>The shelter was built and made comfortable, and
-then the scout cut off from the swollen, blistered, and
-bruised feet the deerskin covering that served as shoes,
-took a liniment from his pack, and, after having the
-man stand in the water for some time, put it upon
-them, after which he dressed the wound in his side,
-which, though painful, was not serious.</p>
-
-<p>“Who gave you this?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_125"></a>[125]</span></p>
-
-<p>“A bad white man, sah, who pretended ter be my
-friend, but arter he heerd my story, he shot me, an’ he
-meant ter kill me, only I got one in on him, sah.</p>
-
-<p>“Then I heerd a man call out, an’ voices talking, so
-I lit out, thinkin’ they must be his frien’s, an’ I come
-rapid, sah, thinkin’ I c’u’d reach the fort afore I died.”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill was now convinced that the negro had a
-secret of importance to tell, so he gave him another
-steak, some hoecake, and a cup of coffee, and watched
-him eat it with the look of a half-starved animal.</p>
-
-<p>“I am mighty glad I met you, my man. What is
-your name?”</p>
-
-<p>“Black Bill, dey calls me, sah.”</p>
-
-<p>“All right, that is one bond between us, for my
-name is Bill. Did you ever hear of Buffalo Bill?”</p>
-
-<p>“Is I hear ob him, sah? Indeed I has, an’ dere ain’t
-nobody livin’ dat ain’t.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, I am Buffalo Bill.”</p>
-
-<p>The look on the negro’s face at this information
-fairly startled the scout.</p>
-
-<p>“You is de very man I’s lookin’ fer,” exclaimed the
-negro finally, after he had recovered from his surprise.
-“Yas, sah, I knows you is Massa Buf’ler Bill, I does,
-as he tole me jist how ye looked.”</p>
-
-<p>“Who did?”</p>
-
-<p>“De gemman who sent me ter find yer, sah.”</p>
-
-<p>“Who was it?”</p>
-
-<p>“Massa John Hill, sah.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_126"></a>[126]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Ah! My old friend, John Hill?”</p>
-
-<p>“Dat’s him, sah.”</p>
-
-<p>“I thought he went East.”</p>
-
-<p>“He did went dere, sah, but he come back.”</p>
-
-<p>“Where is he?”</p>
-
-<p>“Whar de debble c’u’dn’t fin’ him, sah, fer he do be
-los’.”</p>
-
-<p>“Lost! Where?”</p>
-
-<p>“In de Big Horn country, sah, whar I left him an’
-t’others. Dere’s a heap ob ’em, Massa Buf’ler Bill,
-men, wimmens, an’ chil’en.”</p>
-
-<p>“When did they go there?”</p>
-
-<p>“Months ago, sah. Yer see, sah, I ust ter b’long ter
-Doctor Miner, a gent from de Souf, who hed los’ his
-fortin by de war; but I didn’t leab him, sah, an’ we was
-comin’ West ter hunt gold, when we come across a
-outfit of folks as was also gold huntin’, fer Massa
-John Hill hed met ’em an’ tole ’em he know’d whar ter
-git it.</p>
-
-<p>“So, sah, we all comed along an’ he guided us inter
-de Big Horn country, an’ we go down inter a valley an’
-make home dere.</p>
-
-<p>“But dere was bad men in dat outfit, and four ob
-’em one night tuk blastin’ powder we fotch along an’
-blow up rocks ter stop de only path down a cañon we
-hed leadin’ inter or out ob dat valley.</p>
-
-<p>“It were beautiful when we got dere, but dere were<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_127"></a>[127]</span>
-no way ob gittin’ out, sah, fer it were all around wid
-mount’in cliffs, an’ mount’in sheep c’u’dn’t git out.</p>
-
-<p>“Yer see, all de gold we hed dug was done by day
-an’ left up in de cañon, de men goin’ home to de valley
-at night.</p>
-
-<p>“Dat’s why dem four bad men got dat powder an’
-blow up dat cañon, an’ we c’u’dn’t git out.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yet, you did.”</p>
-
-<p>“I has been a sailorman, sah, an’ I don’t git dizzy,
-an’ I said as how I’d climb dem cliffs, an’ I did, by
-buildin’ ladders wid poles I cut, choppin’ down a tree
-here an’ dere, an’ arter weeks of work I got out, an’
-den I fetch up my weepin an’ some grub, an’ Massa
-John Hill he told me ter go ter Fort Fettermore an’
-fine you, an’ tell you he sent fer yer ter come an’ save
-dere lives; but ter tell no one else but you, an’ when
-you come wid your scouts, you was ter bring ropes in
-plenty, so as ter git ’em out of dat lonesome valley.”</p>
-
-<p>“And those four men?”</p>
-
-<p>“Dey overdid it, sah, fer dey didn’t git a horse,
-mule, or waggin out ob de valley fust, an’ dey hed ter
-hoof it wid dere gold, or de gold we all hed got, an’
-carry it, an’ I guesses it were mighty slow work.</p>
-
-<p>“I guesses, sah, dey set off de blow-up business afore
-dey was ready, fer all de pervisions were in de valley,
-sabe what was kept in de cabin on de cliffs fer de men’s
-dinner.”</p>
-
-<p>“How long have you been on the trail, Bill?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_128"></a>[128]</span></p>
-
-<p>“’Bout a month, sah, fer I hed to reckon as how
-ter go, an’ got los’, so my grub gin out, my ammunition,
-too, an’ I has hed a terribul time, sah, so I had.”</p>
-
-<p>“You look it; but you met white men on the way?”</p>
-
-<p>“One, sah an’ heerd others. Dey was gold hunters,
-sah.”</p>
-
-<p>“Not the four men who left the valley?”</p>
-
-<p>“No, sah, dat one I seen wasn’t.”</p>
-
-<p>“This is a strange story you tell me, Black Bill, but I
-believe you.”</p>
-
-<p>“Praise de Lor’, sah, fer now you kin sabe ’em all.”</p>
-
-<p>“I will try,” said Buffalo Bill firmly.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_129"></a>[129]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XVII">CHAPTER XVII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">TWO SHOTS.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Black Bill would have talked all night had the scout
-allowed him to do so; but Cody checked him again,
-dressed his wound and feet, and gave him a little more
-to eat, after which he made him go to sleep.</p>
-
-<p>The scout looked to the comfort of his horses, and
-then, wrapping his blankets about him, lay down to
-rest.</p>
-
-<p>At dawn, Buffalo Bill arose, built a fire, cooked a
-substantial breakfast, having caught several fine fish
-from the stream, and then he awoke the negro, who
-was still sleeping soundly.</p>
-
-<p>Black Bill was then allowed to eat all he wished, and
-the scout gave him a change of his clothing to put on,
-and looked after his injuries.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, Black Bill, you are not fit even to ride, but
-you soon will be. This is a good camp for you, and
-you will be comfortable. I will leave you my pack
-horse, make you comfortable, give you plenty of food
-and ammunition for your weapons, and I’ll kill a deer
-before I go. Then you can fish and take it easy.”</p>
-
-<p>“Whar is you goin’, Massa Buf’ler Bill?”</p>
-
-<p>“To Fort Aspen, with all speed, for I shall get there
-a number of negro scouts I want with me, the ropes
-John Hill says we will need, pack horses well laden
-with provisions, and I’ll be back here in four days.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_130"></a>[130]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Yas, sah.”</p>
-
-<p>“Now, I do not think you will see any Indians here,
-for they have skipped for their villages, and this camp
-is on no trail. If you should, you must mount my
-pack horse and get away, for I will leave my compass,
-and you must keep directly west.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yas, sah.”</p>
-
-<p>“It might be that the white men may be trailing
-you; but, if so, you must make your escape, and be on
-the watch for any danger.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yas, sah, I kin do pretty well ter take keer o’ myself.”</p>
-
-<p>“I don’t doubt it. In four days you will be well
-enough to ride, and we’ll start for that valley you
-have told me of, and get those people out of their
-trouble.”</p>
-
-<p>Half an hour after, Buffalo Bill, having made his
-black comrade thoroughly comfortable, mounted his
-horse and departed on his trail to the fort.</p>
-
-<p>Black Bill looked after him wistfully as long as he
-was in sight, but, looking back, the scout saw him
-wave a farewell, and muttered:</p>
-
-<p>“I am sorry to leave him, yet I must do so, as I can
-do nothing else, for he could not stand the ride to
-the fort and back, and lives depend on quick work, if
-I am not mistaken.”</p>
-
-<p>And the scout put his horse at a swift and steady
-pace.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_131"></a>[131]</span></p>
-
-<p>But he had not ridden many miles when suddenly
-he saw an Indian bound from the ground and spring
-to the shelter of a tree, his bow and arrows in hand.</p>
-
-<p>It was a long shot, and the scout had to fire quickly,
-and did so. It seemed as though there was a double
-report; but the redskin fell, and no others were visible.</p>
-
-<p>Cody knew that he had killed the Indian, and rode
-toward him, dismounted, and bent over the body, when
-suddenly a human form confronted him and a voice
-said:</p>
-
-<p>“Pard, I guesses I’ll take the scalp o’ this Injun, an’
-as I holds ther drop on you, ye’d better be kinder discreetlike.”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill was certainly caught off his guard by
-the appearance of the stranger upon the scene where he
-least expected to see a human being, unless a stray
-Indian.</p>
-
-<p>Yet it was a white man, and certainly an odd-looking
-one. He was dressed in rudely tanned buckskin from
-head to foot, for he wore a cap of that material, ornamented
-with the tail of a fox for a tassel. He was a
-man of large size, muscular build, and looked hard as
-a pine knot, while his hair was long, unkempt, and
-iron-gray, and his beard short and grizzly, half hiding
-a face by no means prepossessing in the features that
-were visible.</p>
-
-<p>The stranger was armed with an old rifle, a muzzle-loader,
-a revolver of rather ancient manufacture, a<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_132"></a>[132]</span>
-couple of single-barrel pistols, and a large bowie knife,
-while at his back hung a long bow and two quivers of
-arrows.</p>
-
-<p>The eyes that gazed upon Buffalo Bill with a triumphant
-leer were vicious, small, and glittering with
-hate, that seemed their natural expression.</p>
-
-<p>He held his revolver upon Buffalo Bill to cover his
-heart, and seemed to feel that he was wholly master
-of the situation.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, who in thunder are you, you old sinner?”
-demanded Buffalo Bill, seemingly not in the slightest
-degree taken aback by the sudden appearance of one
-that seemed to be a foe.</p>
-
-<p>“I are ther Bad Man o’ ther Big Horn,” was the
-cool reply.</p>
-
-<p>“The what?” and Bill smiled.</p>
-
-<p>“Ther Bad Man o’ ther Big Horn.”</p>
-
-<p>“You don’t mean it?”</p>
-
-<p>“I do.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, you do look as if you could get away with
-a big horn.”</p>
-
-<p>“Look a-hyur, stranger pard, is yer pokin’ fun at
-me?” angrily asked the man.</p>
-
-<p>“No, you are pokin’ that old gun at me,” was the
-cool response.</p>
-
-<p>“Who is you, anyhow?” asked the man, struck with
-the superb bearing and handsome, fearless face of the
-scout.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_133"></a>[133]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Sitting Bull,” answered Bill, most innocently.</p>
-
-<p>“Do yer take me fer a fool?”</p>
-
-<p>“Like as not you are one of the renegades said to
-belong to his tribe,” was the bold remark of the scout.</p>
-
-<p>“No, but I are friendly with ther Injuns.”</p>
-
-<p>“That means you dare not live among your own
-race, for you look as though you might have been a
-white man once.”</p>
-
-<p>The basilisk eyes of the stranger fairly blazed at this,
-and his brow grew dark with rage, while he answered
-quickly:</p>
-
-<p>“Ef I are, yer’ll never live ter tell thet yer seen me.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll stake that I do. Come, put up your money, or
-make no threats.”</p>
-
-<p>“Waal, you is a bold one, and I’d like ter know yer
-handle.”</p>
-
-<p>“The boys in camp call me Buffalo Bill.”</p>
-
-<p>Instantly the man’s face changed again, growing
-livid with passion, while he hissed forth:</p>
-
-<p>“You is Bill Cody, is you?”</p>
-
-<p>“When I am at home, that is my name,” was the
-reply, and Bill continued: “Now tell me your name,
-for the more I see of your face the more I feel we have
-met before.”</p>
-
-<p>“We have.”</p>
-
-<p>“What deviltry were you in when I saw you last, old
-man?”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll tell yer jist what I were doing then: It were<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_134"></a>[134]</span>
-a long time ago, and you was a mere boy then, and
-you was guide fer a train I went ter rob one night,
-and&mdash;&mdash;”</p>
-
-<p>“You are Ginger Sam, by Jove!” cried Buffalo Bill,
-recalling the man’s face, after nearly twenty years.</p>
-
-<p>“Yep.”</p>
-
-<p>“I remember you now, you miserable old sinner, and
-how you and your gang hired as teamsters to the train
-and intended to massacre all hands one night and get
-the booty.”</p>
-
-<p>“Thet’s so; but you overheard two o’ ther boys
-talkin’, and ther’ were hangin’ done by ther train
-people, and I’d hev gone ther same way if I hadn’ lit
-out. Yer thwarted me then, Bill Cody, and I’ve heerd
-o’ yer doin’ big things o’ late on these hyur borders, an’
-I intend ter cut yer days short.”</p>
-
-<p>“And I have heard how you played your old tricks
-of deviltry until you could not live in a border settlement,
-and here is where you came to hide your ugly
-head, was it?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yas, and it’s better than hangin’.”</p>
-
-<p>“You are a bad citizen, Ginger Sam,” said Bill Cody,
-with a light laugh, although the man still kept him covered
-with his revolver.</p>
-
-<p>“I’m a citizen thet shall take in Buf’ler Bill, fer ye’ve
-no business in these hyur parts, and, hevin’ comed
-hyur, I’ll see that yer remain, fer I’m ther Bad Man
-o’ ther Big Horn, I told yer.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_135"></a>[135]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Do you see that dead Indian lying there?” asked
-Bill.</p>
-
-<p>“I do.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, you had better spend your time burying him
-than in killing me, for it will be more profitable business.”</p>
-
-<p>The outlaw was astounded at the cool nerve displayed
-by Buffalo Bill in his danger, and could not understand
-his light, bantering tone. He meant to kill
-Cody, there was no doubt; but as a cat will play with
-a mouse to torture it, he wished to make Buffalo Bill
-suffer terror and despair, so he delayed firing the fatal
-shot, feeling that he had the scout wholly at his mercy.</p>
-
-<p>“I kilt that Injun.”</p>
-
-<p>“Why, I shot him myself!” said Buffalo Bill. “What
-a liar you are!”</p>
-
-<p>“I tell yer I was jist leavin’ ther timber when I seen
-thet Injun, hevin’ got sight o’ me, I s’pose. So I
-cracks away, an’ I seen him flop over an’ then lie still;
-but I lays close, fer I thought t’others mou’t be near,
-an’ then I seen you come out o’ thet timber from this
-p’int.</p>
-
-<p>“I flanked yer, and I’ve been lookin’ at yer, an’ now
-yer says you kilt ther red.”</p>
-
-<p>“And I tell you the truth, and I can prove it.”</p>
-
-<p>“How kin you?”</p>
-
-<p>“Where did you aim to hit him?”</p>
-
-<p>“In the heart.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_136"></a>[136]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Well, look and see if there are two bullet wounds in
-his body, for I heard your shot, I remember now, and
-have no doubt but that you fired at him; but he was
-dying when you did so. Look for the two wounds.”</p>
-
-<p>The man stooped to do so, and, with the bound of
-a panther, Buffalo Bill was upon him.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_137"></a>[137]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XVIII">CHAPTER XVIII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE BAD MAN OF THE BIG HORN.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Thrown off his guard by the manner of the scout
-and by his interest in searching for the second wound
-in the body of the Indian, Ginger Sam went right into
-the trap which was set for him, and did just what Buffalo
-Bill had been endeavoring he should do.</p>
-
-<p>Quick as lightning in his movements, Buffalo Bill
-had sprung forward and seized the hand that held the
-revolver, before the outlaw could come to an upright
-position, and at the same time he presented one of his
-own weapons full in the face of his foe, while he said,
-in the coolest manner possible:</p>
-
-<p>“If you wish to keep in good health, Ginger Sam,
-you’ll do as I tell you!”</p>
-
-<p>The outlaw was livid with rage, and seemed to feel
-that his last day on earth had come.</p>
-
-<p>“Do yer intend ter kill me?”</p>
-
-<p>“I do not know what I shall do with you in the end,
-but at present I intend to disarm you. Drop old
-Daniel Boone’s rifle you hold in your hand there.”</p>
-
-<p>“It mout break it.”</p>
-
-<p>“I guess not, for it’s too old a settler to be hurt by a
-little tumble. Drop it, I say!”</p>
-
-<p>“It mout go off an’ shoot yer from ther concussion.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_138"></a>[138]</span></p>
-
-<p>“My revolver will go off and shoot you from the
-muzzle, if you don’t obey!”</p>
-
-<p>“Down she goes.”</p>
-
-<p>The outlaw dropped it in such a way, at the same
-time giving it a kick, that showed he would like to have
-it explode in the fall and kill his captor.</p>
-
-<p>But it did not, and, kicking it one side, Bill commanded:</p>
-
-<p>“Now, unbuckle your belt and let it fall!”</p>
-
-<p>“Now, thet would be dangerous.”</p>
-
-<p>“Do as I tell you, and be careful not to let your hand
-touch those blunderbusses you carry, or you won’t
-know what killed you.”</p>
-
-<p>The man uttered an oath, but obeyed, and the belt of
-arms fell to the ground.</p>
-
-<p>“Now step this way.”</p>
-
-<p>Bill drew him a few steps away from his rifle and
-belt, and then, with a sudden violent wrench of the
-wrist, tore the revolver from the outlaw’s hand, and
-pitched it over with the other weapons.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, Bad Man of the Big Horn, I was born tired,
-and don’t like work, so take your knife and set to work
-to build a house under this tree,” said Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>“A house?” asked the surprised man.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“What kind of a house?”</p>
-
-<p>“One that will fit a dead man.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_139"></a>[139]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Yer mean a grave?” asked the outlaw, in a tone of
-horror.</p>
-
-<p>“I do.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yer don’t mean ter kill me, and fust make me dig
-my own grave?”</p>
-
-<p>“No, you are not worth burying; but I wish to bury
-that Injun, there, and being lazy, as I told you, I want
-you to dig his grave.”</p>
-
-<p>The outlaw seemed to feel relieved in knowing that
-he was not the one to occupy the grave, and he at once
-set to work, and with his knife began to throw out the
-earth quite rapidly.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill sat near, coolly watching him, and keeping
-him covered with his revolver, and noticing the
-rapid work of the outlaw, he said:</p>
-
-<p>“I guess you were sexton for some graveyard, Ginger
-Sam, before you took to thieving?”</p>
-
-<p>“Thet are jist what I were, Bill Cody,” replied the
-man, stopping in his work.</p>
-
-<p>“And you took to robbing by night the people you
-buried by day, and got caught at it, I guess, so had to
-dig for the West?”</p>
-
-<p>“Waal, you hits things pretty squar’, Bill Cody, fer
-they did plant a leddy in my yard one day, thet were
-durned fool enough ter leave it in her will thet she
-were ter be buried in her di’mints an’ t’other jew’lry.</p>
-
-<p>“I know’d ther kin folks w’u’d dig her up some
-night, ef I didn’t, so I did, an’ them as was comin’<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_140"></a>[140]</span>
-ter do it seen me, an’ I jist hed ter light out from them
-parts.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, you look the ghoul you are: but go on with
-your work, for life’s too short to listen to your sins,
-old man!”</p>
-
-<p>The ex-sexton resumed his work, with a sigh, and
-soon had an opening which brought from the scout the
-remark:</p>
-
-<p>“No Injun could wish for more than that, Ginger
-Sam, and you are the boss gravedigger of the Big
-Horn, whatever your other sins may be. Now wrap
-that Injun in his blanket and lay him in it.”</p>
-
-<p>“Won’t yer scalp him?”</p>
-
-<p>“No. Come, delay no further, but bury that man,
-for I wish to be on my way,” said Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>“Whar goin’?”</p>
-
-<p>“You’ll know all in good time.”</p>
-
-<p>The man muttered an oath, but obeyed orders, and
-when the redskin had been buried, Buffalo Bill bound
-Ginger Sam securely with one end of his lariat, and
-forced the man to go on his way in the lead.</p>
-
-<p>After gaining a point where the trail led across a
-river, Buffalo Bill said:</p>
-
-<p>“Cross over, Ginger!”</p>
-
-<p>“What do yer want ter cross fer?” was the surly
-response.</p>
-
-<p>“I have my reasons, so wade in.”</p>
-
-<p>“No; I don’t keen ter git wet.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_141"></a>[141]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Very well, take the back trail for the grave you
-dug; it will hold two,” said Bill indifferently.</p>
-
-<p>The outlaw shuddered, and replied quickly:</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll cross the river.”</p>
-
-<p>“Right are you, Sammy, my boy.”</p>
-
-<p>Into the water they went, and, once on the other
-shore, where a number of trails divided, Buffalo Bill
-selected the one that would lead him to the fort.</p>
-
-<p>“Thet trail only goes up into ther hills,” said the
-outlaw nervously.</p>
-
-<p>“It is into the hills I wish to go.”</p>
-
-<p>“Ther’ ain’t nothin’ up thar yer want.”</p>
-
-<p>“There’s where you are off your base, Ginger, for
-there is.”</p>
-
-<p>“What do yer want?”</p>
-
-<p>“I desire that you shall take the quickest trail to the
-fort.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll die fust,” was the savage reply.</p>
-
-<p>“You had better do as I ask, for I am not one to
-palaver.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll not go a step.”</p>
-
-<p>“Then I’ll lead you there,” was the quiet reply.</p>
-
-<p>The outlaw saw that Buffalo Bill was in earnest, and
-his thoughts flashed like lightning through his brain.</p>
-
-<p>His gaze falling upon the lariat end, held loosely in
-the hand of Buffalo Bill, his eyes suddenly gleamed
-with inborn resolve, and he said resignedly:</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_142"></a>[142]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Waal, pard, as I don’t know thet I kin kick agin’
-yer, I’ll do as you say.”</p>
-
-<p>“Right, Sammy! Now, move on!”</p>
-
-<p>The outlaw obeyed, taking the trail once more with
-nimble step.</p>
-
-<p>As it wound along the edge of a ravine, through the
-bed of which dashed a stream, the outlaw suddenly
-sprang over the precipice into the depths below.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill caught hard at the end of the lariat, as
-it tightened, but could not hold on, and the end slipped
-through his hand, and a plunge following told him that
-his captive had fallen into the waters below.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_143"></a>[143]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XIX">CHAPTER XIX.<br />
-<span class="fs70">A DOUBLE ESCAPE.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Hardly had the splash of the descending form
-reached Cody’s ears, when he was on foot and peering
-over the precipice. He saw that the water was swift-running
-and deep, and that the stream wound out of
-sight a few rods below by turning a rocky point. Instantly
-he decided upon his course, and cast aside his
-arms and outer clothing. At once he took the leap.</p>
-
-<p>It was thirty feet down to the water, but he struck
-feet foremost, and without injury.</p>
-
-<p>In the meantime, a perfect swimmer, Ginger Sam
-knew just what was before him, although his arms
-were bound behind his back.</p>
-
-<p>Keeping under water until he had rounded the point,
-which the current and his own efforts soon enabled him
-to do, he then rose to the surface and began to make
-for the shore.</p>
-
-<p>It was hard work, with only his feet to aid his efforts,
-and, retarded as he was by his clothing and the
-lariat, but he made it at last, and under the shelter of
-the overhanging hill had just sat down to rest, smiling
-grimly at his escape, when round the point shot Buffalo
-Bill, swimming with tremendous strokes.</p>
-
-<p>The hunted man uttered a cry of alarm, and, springing
-to his feet, darted away at great speed.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_144"></a>[144]</span></p>
-
-<p>But the scout had always been noted for his fleetness
-on foot, and he bounded along at a pace that overhauled
-the outlaw, who was hampered, too, by his
-bound arms and the dragging lariat.</p>
-
-<p>Seeing that Buffalo Bill was gaining upon him, he
-finally came to a halt, and sang out lustily:</p>
-
-<p>“Don’t shoot me!”</p>
-
-<p>“I have nothing to shoot you with, but I’ve a notion
-to drown you,” answered Bill Cody, as he laid no light
-hand upon the other’s shoulder.</p>
-
-<p>“Don’t do it, Bill, for ’twan’t no fault o’ mine. Yer
-see, my foot slipped when I turned round ter speak
-ter you, an’ when I found myself free, I concluded I’d
-try an’ stay so.”</p>
-
-<p>“As a scientific liar, Sam, you are ’way up; but,
-come, no funny business, but go!”</p>
-
-<p>There was nothing for the outlaw to do but to obey,
-and he did that promptly, taking a route that soon
-brought them to where the faithful horse was standing
-guard most patiently in the spot where his master had
-left him.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, I am due at the fort, for I have important
-work on hand and do not wish to be delayed, so I will
-tie you to a tree here until my return, or I’ll take you
-to your cabin, for I am sure you have a camp near.
-Which shall it be?”</p>
-
-<p>“I’d be eaten up by b’ar an’ sich ef yer tied me to
-a tree.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_145"></a>[145]</span></p>
-
-<p>“So I fear, and that would keep you from being
-hanged, so where is your cabin?”</p>
-
-<p>“I got a den.”</p>
-
-<p>“Then lead to it, and quick.”</p>
-
-<p>The man saw that the scout was in earnest, so said:</p>
-
-<p>“We has got ter climb and leave yer boss here, so
-untie my han’s, fer we goes up thet cliff.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll do it, and if you attempt to run, look out for a
-shot.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’m inter it now, so I won’t kick.”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill then untied the man’s hands, told him
-to stand on the cliff until he hitched his horse, and, as
-he turned to do so, quick as a flash the man made the
-leap again.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill sprang to the cliff, but did not follow
-him.</p>
-
-<p>“I have not the time to lose, and I won’t shoot him
-when he comes into view,” he muttered.</p>
-
-<p>Soon the man appeared, smiling boldly, and apparently
-believing Buffalo Bill was in pursuit.</p>
-
-<p>But with his arms free, he felt the chances were that
-he could get away, as the scout was not armed.</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll not shoot you this time, though I could do so&mdash;we’ll
-meet again,” shouted the scout.</p>
-
-<p>But the outlaw had at once dove deep, when he saw
-the scout on the cliff, rifle in hand.</p>
-
-<p>Then Buffalo Bill mounted his horse, after hiding
-Ginger Sam’s weapons, and rode rapidly away, for<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_146"></a>[146]</span>
-already had he lost too much time. He pushed his
-horse hard, as he felt he could do so, with the animal
-to get rest at the fort, and, making but short halts,
-he kept on through the night, to strike at dawn the
-camp of Captain Keyes, who had taken up the trail
-for the fort, going by easy marches with his wounded
-soldiers and Indians.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_147"></a>[147]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XX">CHAPTER XX.<br />
-<span class="fs70">BLACK SCOUTS ON THE TRAIL.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>After a hearty breakfast, Buffalo Bill confided to
-Captain Keyes his experience, for he wished to keep
-the story of finding the negro, Black Bill, a secret from
-all save the commanding officer.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, captain, I wish to pick my men and go at once
-on the trail, for, from what that negro tells me, I fear
-those people are in a bad way.</p>
-
-<p>“I know they have no right in the Big Horn country,
-but they are there, in great danger, and there are
-women and children to be rescued.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, I have every confidence in Sergeant Mobile
-Buck, and I wish a corporal who is an equally good
-man for the work ahead.</p>
-
-<p>“Then I feel I can trust the men with Buck in his
-corral, and I wish twenty-six all told, so, if you will
-pick out the balance to make up the number, I know I
-will have just the band I can rely on.</p>
-
-<p>“Then, too, sir, I wish to take all the tools you may
-have along, every lariat, stake line, and rope in the
-outfit, plenty of provisions on pack animals, and the
-cannon powder, as I may need it for blasting, from
-what Black Bill tells me.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, Captain Keyes, if you will fit me out at once
-with the men and things I need, it will be a great favor,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_148"></a>[148]</span>
-and we’ll be on the return trail within a couple of
-hours.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll do it, Cody, for what you tell me about these
-people interests me greatly.</p>
-
-<p>“I know just the men to send with you, and all we
-have in the outfit which you can use is at your disposal,”
-said Captain Keyes.</p>
-
-<p>Sergeant Buck was at once called, and Buffalo Bill
-told him he wished him, a corporal, and twenty-four
-men to take the trail with him, Captain Keyes adding:</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, and we are to pick the men, sergeant, for
-Chief Cody will only take colored soldiers, and they are
-to be his scouts.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’m mighty glad, sir, and I know we can get good
-men, sir,” was the answer.</p>
-
-<p>A corporal was first selected, and though he was the
-hue of ink, he rejoiced in the nickname of Milk White,
-being generally called “Corporal Milk.”</p>
-
-<p>With his aid, and he was a splendid soldier, strong
-as a giant, and an all-round good man, the twenty-four
-colored scouts were selected, the entire squad of Sergeant
-Buck’s original escort being taken along, save
-the wounded, for all wished to go with “Massa Buf’ler
-Bill.”</p>
-
-<p>The scout took along extra rifles for all, carried on
-the pack animals, every horse was picked for speed
-and endurance, a large supply of provisions was taken,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_149"></a>[149]</span>
-with every rope and lariat in the command, and a big
-supply of ammunition and cannon powder.</p>
-
-<p>Within two hours, as Buffalo Bill had said, the band
-of black scouts mounted and rode away from the command,
-all wondering what the reason might be for the
-strange expedition.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill rode at the head, the sergeant following
-with fourteen men, and then came the corporal with
-his ten men as a guard to the pack animals and a reserve
-force.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill felt proud of his black scouts, and determined
-to push rapidly on to the lone camp of Black
-Bill, where a halt for a couple of days’ rest was to be
-made, and to enable the wounded and half-starved
-negro to recuperate.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill also intended to take this time to mount
-his own pack animal, which would be fresh, and try
-and strike the trail of Ginger Sam, who would not be
-expecting him back from the fort for some days.</p>
-
-<p>He had by no means given up hope of capturing
-that gallows bird.</p>
-
-<p>So Buffalo Bill pushed rapidly on with his scouts,
-and halted only when it was near sunset, for dinner
-and supper combined, and the men turned in for sleep
-until after midnight.</p>
-
-<p>Then a start was made, and early that afternoon the
-camp of Black Bill was reached.</p>
-
-<p>To the sergeant and corporal the scout had told of<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_150"></a>[150]</span>
-his coming upon the starving and wounded negro; but
-to the men the surprise was very great, upon coming
-across the lone camp.</p>
-
-<p>Black Bill greeted the chief of scouts with a shout,
-saying that he was getting well fast, and he knew he
-would be ready for the trail at once, if need be.</p>
-
-<p>“No, take a couple of days more, for I do not wish
-you to move until really able to do so.”</p>
-
-<p>The chief of scouts did not remain long in camp, but
-started, mounted on his pack animal, to go to the place
-where he had left Ginger Sam and try to pick up his
-trail. He was confident that the man had a cabin
-somewhere near there, as he had known the cliff trail
-so well, and by leaping from it into the stream he could
-make a landing and escape.</p>
-
-<p>The scout felt sure that Ginger Sam was in that
-country looking for gold, and doubtless allied with the
-Indians, while again he might have another comrade
-with him. He was determined to know and capture
-the outlaw if he could, to kill him if he had to do so.</p>
-
-<p>He reached the place where the man had landed from
-the stream, and, to one of his great scouting skill, he
-readily trailed the tracks of the large and heavy boots,
-soaked as they had been with water.</p>
-
-<p>It soon became a hard trail to follow, but after a
-mile it led into a cañon, and there the scout beheld a
-small, rude cabin.</p>
-
-<p>The door was closed, and the scout slipped up cautiously,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_151"></a>[151]</span>
-to find it tied on the outside. It was empty,
-but it was evident that Ginger Sam had been there, for
-he had changed his wet boots for others.</p>
-
-<p>The ashes in the fireplace were cold, and Buffalo
-Bill seemed to grasp the situation, for he said:</p>
-
-<p>“He came here and left without weapons; he has
-gone, and where but to the Indian village to get more.</p>
-
-<p>“That will take him a week or longer, so I will visit
-him upon our return, for he doubtless has a gold find
-near here, so that keeps him alone in these wilds, for
-alone he certainly is.</p>
-
-<p>“He may have struck it rich, and so will I when I
-find him, as there are old scores to settle with that
-man.”</p>
-
-<p>Then, fastening the door as he found it and returning
-to where he had left his horse, for he had followed
-the trail on foot, Buffalo Bill started for the camp of
-his black scouts.</p>
-
-<p>The negro courier from the penned-up settlers of the
-valley had made himself solid with one and all of the
-black scouts, who did all they could to hasten the recovery
-of his strength. He had recuperated wonderfully,
-and was so anxious to start upon the trail of
-rescue that Buffalo Bill decided to make a start the
-next afternoon and travel by half-day trails until Black
-Bill was able to stand what the others could.</p>
-
-<p>So the next day the chief and his scouts started upon
-the trail of rescue.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_152"></a>[152]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXI">CHAPTER XXI.<br />
-<span class="fs70">TO THE RESCUE.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Feeling that he was on a trail of rescue, Black Bill
-rallied so fast that he began to scout on ahead, and one
-day as Buffalo Bill came near to where the negro lay
-full length upon the ground, he had reached the summit
-of a range and was gazing over at something he had
-discovered on the other side.</p>
-
-<p>Creeping up to the side of the negro, Buffalo Bill
-peered over cautiously, and he, too, lay low, and motioned
-to the coming scouts to come quietly and see the
-discovery that Black Bill had made.</p>
-
-<p>“Massa Bill, jist look a-yonder, sah, and see what I
-found,” said the negro.</p>
-
-<p>“You can have them, Black Bill, for I don’t want
-them,” answered Buffalo Bill, as he looked in the direction
-the negro pointed.</p>
-
-<p>The discovery was an Indian village. There it was
-in the valley, a hundred tepees, at least, and with a
-large herd of ponies feeding near. It did not look
-like a permanent village, and the experienced eye of
-Buffalo Bill now told him that it was not. It was an
-Indian village upon the march, and apparently halting
-there in the valley for rest and game for a few
-days.</p>
-
-<p>One by one, the black scouts came up and dropped<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_153"></a>[153]</span>
-down at full length by the side of their chief to peer
-over the range.</p>
-
-<p>They had expected some important discovery, but
-they saw more than they cared to see.</p>
-
-<p>Not a word was spoken other than a low ejaculation
-of surprise or a whistle at the startling discovery.</p>
-
-<p>Every eye was upon Cody, every ear waiting to
-catch his words. But he had taken his field glass from
-its case and was already surveying the river, the valley,
-the Indian village through it. What he was thinking
-his face did not reveal.</p>
-
-<p>“Ain’t yer goin’ ter skeer ’em, Massa Buf’ler Bill?”
-asked the guide.</p>
-
-<p>“You mean by playing ghosts, Bill?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sah.”</p>
-
-<p>“There’s safety in numbers, and I don’t think they
-would scare so much as we would wish them to.”</p>
-
-<p>“Jist try it, sah.”</p>
-
-<p>“We will try it when a plan I have fails, when we
-have to do so.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sah.”</p>
-
-<p>“Night is not very far off, none of the Indians will
-be coming up here at this hour, and we can follow
-down the range until we get opposite to where their
-ponies are.</p>
-
-<p>“From there we can see where the guards are, and
-how many if, indeed, they have any watching their
-ponies.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_154"></a>[154]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Then as soon as it is dark we can go down into
-the valley, mount some of the best ponies and stampede
-the whole herd.”</p>
-
-<p>The scouts all gave a chuckle of delight.</p>
-
-<p>“We can dash away with them, and keep pushing
-them along.</p>
-
-<p>“Of course, as you know, some of the braves will
-have ponies near their tepees, and will follow, but
-they won’t see us, and, if there are many of them, we
-can push on ahead of the herd, if the pace becomes too
-hot.</p>
-
-<p>“In this way we can get by these redskins without
-being seen.</p>
-
-<p>“The Indians will not know what stampeded their
-ponies, and we will leave them to find out the best way
-they can.”</p>
-
-<p>This plan of Buffalo Bill met with the approval of
-each man, though Black Bill seemed to regret not being
-able to get a chance to “skeer dem red Injuns silly,” as
-he expressed it.</p>
-
-<p>Down the range, out of sight of the Indian camp,
-went the scouts, until Buffalo Bill halted at a spot just
-above where the herd of ponies were feeding.</p>
-
-<p>Finding a hiding place, the chief swept the valley
-with his glass, and soon discovered that there were
-only a couple of youths in charge of the herd, and they
-were seated upon their ponies in the shadow of the
-trees along the river bank.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_155"></a>[155]</span></p>
-
-<p>“There are boys in charge, pards, but soon after
-night braves will come to relieve them, we may be
-sure, so we will be ready to move the moment the
-shadows deepen in the valley.</p>
-
-<p>“Three of you go to the farther end of the herd and
-mount, and we will go to the end near the village, so
-when you start they’ll follow under our driving.</p>
-
-<p>“You take the lead, corporal, and keep the ponies
-going at full speed when they get started.”</p>
-
-<p>The men understood the plan, and in half an hour it
-was dark.</p>
-
-<p>Of course, supper was not to be thought of then,
-and, while Corporal Milk led the way to the lower end
-of the herd, Buffalo Bill and those with him rounded up
-the ponies feeding nearest to the Indian village.</p>
-
-<p>Good ponies were caught without trouble, the scouts
-mounted, and, with their lariats for bridles, began to
-urge the herd forward.</p>
-
-<p>The men lay low on the backs of the ponies, so as
-not to be seen, and, as the corporal and those with him
-dashed off on the leaders, the other scouts pushing the
-herd upon them, the two startled Indian boys could
-just get out of the way as the stampeded animals went
-flying down the valley.</p>
-
-<p>What stampeded them those two boys could not tell,
-but their shrill cries gave the alarm, as well as did the
-thunder of hundreds of hoofs.</p>
-
-<p>There were braves in the village who had ponies<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_156"></a>[156]</span>
-near their tepees, and as soon as they could they dashed
-off in pursuit.</p>
-
-<p>But the stampeded ponies had over a mile the start
-before the warriors could get away, and that meant a
-long, hard chase unless the ponies stopped of their
-own free will.</p>
-
-<p>There were not over a score of braves who had
-ponies near by, and, as they came upon the two boys,
-the latter had a strange story to tell, of the whole herd
-raising their heads as one animal, uttering wild snorts,
-and going off as though possessed of evil spirits.</p>
-
-<p>On down the valley swept the herd, and, as mile
-after mile was gone over, the slow ponies and used-up
-ones began to lag behind.</p>
-
-<p>But Corporal Milk and his men led the way, and
-Buffalo Bill and those with him kept the pace a hot one,
-forcing the ponies that could run and endure the strain
-close on the heels of the leaders.</p>
-
-<p>Behind them they knew the warriors were coming
-with all the speed they could to try and head off the
-herd.</p>
-
-<p>But a stern chase is a long one always, especially
-when the leaders have a start of over a mile, and several
-hours thus passed before at last the shadowy outlines
-of the pursuers could be seen.</p>
-
-<p>“We must push to the lead now, pards, at all hazards.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_157"></a>[157]</span></p>
-
-<p>“We have to desert our ponies, and, fortunately, we
-have the timber along the river to hide us,” said Buffalo
-Bill.</p>
-
-<p>The ponies they rode then were pushed the harder,
-and they began to pass animal after animal. The center
-of the herd was reached, then they forged nearer
-and nearer to the front, the ponies they passed halting
-as they went by them, and thus checking the more
-rapid pursuit of the braves in chase.</p>
-
-<p>At last Buffalo Bill saw Corporal Milk’s tall form
-ahead, and the next moment the scouts were all
-bunched together.</p>
-
-<p>“Off to the right, here. All lie low on your own
-horses now, and no one speak aloud, for there are a
-score of braves pursuing,” said Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>The word was passed in a low tone from one to the
-other, the scouts wheeled to the right, the shadow of
-the timber along the river was reached, and each man
-slipped from the back of the animal he rode, pulled off
-the lariat bridle from his pony, and bounded into the
-shelter of the trees.</p>
-
-<p>Lashed with the lariats to urge them on, the group
-of ponies just deserted, though fagged out, ran on
-down the valley, and suddenly in chase swept half a
-dozen braves.</p>
-
-<p>“They had gained well on us, but they’ll soon head
-those ponies off and return up the valley,” said Buffalo
-Bill.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_158"></a>[158]</span></p>
-
-<p>“It was a successful stampede,” remarked the corporal.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes; now to push along for a few miles, as soon as
-those braves go back.”</p>
-
-<p>This the braves were not long in doing, going back
-at a canter and driving the ponies so recently deserted
-by riders before them, yet with no thought of the reason
-of the wild stampede.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_159"></a>[159]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXII">CHAPTER XXII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">BLACK BILL’S LONE HAND.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>After going a couple of miles the black scouts returned
-to Sergeant Buck and his men, and they all
-pushed on once more, flanking the Indian village.</p>
-
-<p>They came to a small stream running down from the
-mountains, and this the chief followed up until it
-was seen to come out of a cañon.</p>
-
-<p>Here was a good camping place, so a fire was built
-in a crevice of the rocks, supper was gotten, and the
-scouts turned in for the night, well tired out after their
-hard day’s work.</p>
-
-<p>Up with the light, they were determined to press on
-before having breakfast, and fortunate for them it was,
-as they had not gone half a mile, and were just nearing
-the mouth of the cañon they had camped in, when
-Buffalo Bill, who was well in the advance, was seen to
-come to a sudden stop.</p>
-
-<p>The scouts halted, also. They saw their chief step
-cautiously back into a thicket, then move to the right
-and there stand gazing at what had attracted his attention
-and halted him so suddenly.</p>
-
-<p>After a moment he motioned them to approach.</p>
-
-<p>They did so, and, gaining a point of observation,
-beheld, not a quarter of a mile distant, a band of half
-a hundred Indians just going into camp. They had<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_160"></a>[160]</span>
-picketed their ponies, and were gathering wood with
-the intention of having breakfast there.</p>
-
-<p>“Those fellows are on a rapid march, and evidently
-belong to the village up the river, and are going home.</p>
-
-<p>“I judge they have come from across the Big Horn,
-and have struck the trail of their village and now have
-halted for rest and food.</p>
-
-<p>“Pards, we cannot get out of this cañon until they
-have passed on, for we can’t scale those cliffs, not being
-birds, and you know this stream tumbles over a precipice
-at the head of this trap.</p>
-
-<p>“Corporal, you remain here with me, and we’ll see
-what we can discover more about that band, while the
-rest of you return up the cañon and take it easy.”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill and Corporal Milk then remained in hiding,
-watching the redskins, while the remainder of the
-band returned up the cañon, which at its entrance was
-a quarter of a mile in width, but narrowed to a few feet
-at its end, and there the creek tumbled over a cliff into
-a waterfall.</p>
-
-<p>The Indians, the scouts saw, were some threescore
-in number, and their ponies stood with heads lowered
-as though they had been very hard ridden.</p>
-
-<p>Several fires had been built, and the smell of broiling
-venison floated up the cañon, while the redskins
-could be seen gathered about the fire, eating heartily.</p>
-
-<p>There was a thicket near that hid half of their camp<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_161"></a>[161]</span>ing
-place, but Buffalo Bill quickly ran his field glass
-over the band, and at last said:</p>
-
-<p>“Those redskins have been up to some deviltry, I am
-certain.</p>
-
-<p>“They have no plunder or scalps, but they have
-not been on a hunt, or they would have their game with
-them.</p>
-
-<p>“Then, too, there is so much game in this country
-they would not have to go after it.”</p>
-
-<p>“They’ve been on a war trail near some of the forts,
-sir, and look as though they had been worsted in a
-fight,” said the corporal.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, that is about it. Doubtless they have been in
-the neighborhood of Fetterman, as they came up the
-right bank of the Big Horn.”</p>
-
-<p>“Do you observe any wounded among them, sir?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, now I am looking for wounded I see a number
-who appear to have been used rather severely in a
-fight. I see that they appear in no hurry now, having
-crossed the Big Horn and struck the trail of their village;
-but their arrival there will cause wailing instead
-of rejoicing&mdash;&mdash; Holy smoke! Look there!”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill pointed toward the other side of the
-cañon, where, quietly walking out upon the plain, was
-no less a personage than the giant negro, Black Bill.
-He had come out of the cañon, and was walking deliberately
-down toward the Indian camp, the latter not
-yet having discovered him.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_162"></a>[162]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Blast that darky! He will ruin us!” cried Corporal
-Milk, as he looked toward the spot where Buffalo Bill
-had pointed and discovered Black Bill going deliberately
-toward the Indian camp.</p>
-
-<p>“He will be killed if we don’t save him. Run, corporal,
-and call the boys!” cried Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>He was about to obey, when the sergeant came running
-up, and not far behind him were the other scouts.</p>
-
-<p>“Do you see that nigger, chief?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“He’s mad, or a traitor. He was there with us up
-the cañon, and said he could scare the reds to death.
-Then he got up and walked away, and soon after we
-discovered that he had gone toward the other side of
-the cañon. We followed, and you see what he has
-done!”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes; perhaps he has got us into a hole from which
-there is no escape. Stand ready, men, to see what the
-outcome will be.”</p>
-
-<p>The men were all ready for a fight or a race, as it
-might turn out for them.</p>
-
-<p>Every eye was upon the negro, who was now too far
-off to recall. He was walking calmly along, straight
-toward the Indian camp, and they, strange to say, had
-not yet discovered him.</p>
-
-<p>They were still broiling venison steak on the end of
-sticks and eating it in a way that showed their hunger
-by no means satiated.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_163"></a>[163]</span></p>
-
-<p>Feeling secure where they were, confident that they
-would not be pursued that far into their country, and
-not knowing that their village could not be over half a
-day’s journey ahead of them, they were taking matters
-coolly, to recover from the strain they had evidently
-been under for some time.</p>
-
-<p>Still the giant negro guide walked on, while the
-scouts could only stand ready for action, watch him,
-and wait for the finale. He appeared not in the least
-disturbed as he moved toward the Indian camp.</p>
-
-<p>But suddenly there was heard a wild, almost unearthly
-cry.</p>
-
-<p>It was of terror and ferocity commingled, and it
-was echoed by half a hundred throats, while it brought
-every brave to his feet.</p>
-
-<p>There was one glance of wild eyes toward the negro,
-gigantic in form, black as ink, and gliding rather than
-seeming to walk toward them, and with yells of fright
-they sprang for their ponies.</p>
-
-<p>There was not a moment of hesitation, and their
-cries told the story of their stampede and terror, for
-loud was heard in their own tongue:</p>
-
-<p>“The black spirit! The evil spirit of the Big Horn!”</p>
-
-<p>Leaping upon their ponies, here and there two braves
-upon the back of one horse, leaving their camp outfits,
-saddles and all, they started off as fast as they could
-mount.</p>
-
-<p>They could be seen lashing their ponies furiously,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_164"></a>[164]</span>
-and looking back in terror, and were all soon spread
-out as they sped up the valley.</p>
-
-<p>Then Black Bill was seen by the amazed and watching
-scouts to start in a run after them.</p>
-
-<p>This added to their flight and terror, and the blows
-falling upon the worn-out ponies could be distinctly
-heard by the wondering scouts.</p>
-
-<p>The scouts could hardly restrain from a cheer, but
-Buffalo Bill said:</p>
-
-<p>“Remember, boys, we are scouts of silence on this
-trail.”</p>
-
-<p>Not an Indian was now visible, the last one having
-turned a bend in the valley that shut them out of sight.</p>
-
-<p>The negro, however, still kept on after them.</p>
-
-<p>Then he, too, turned the bend and disappeared.</p>
-
-<p>Still Buffalo Bill gave no order to move.</p>
-
-<p>For some time they waited, but Black Bill did not
-reappear.</p>
-
-<p>The Indian camp remained as they had left it.</p>
-
-<p>If there was a badly wounded redskin there he was
-not visible.</p>
-
-<p>The fires still burned, and several Indian ponies were
-grazing near, but no human being could be seen.</p>
-
-<p>At last an exclamation came from several of the
-scouts together.</p>
-
-<p>The guide was returning down the valley, but was
-yet a mile away.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_165"></a>[165]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXIII">CHAPTER XXIII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">BLACK BILL’S PRISONER.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>As Black Bill came on down the valley, the scouts
-wished to go out to meet him, to greet him with a
-cheer.</p>
-
-<p>But this Buffalo Bill would not allow.</p>
-
-<p>“We do not yet know who may have been left in the
-camp, pards.”</p>
-
-<p>Upon second thought, this was considered the wisest
-plan, and they kept in their place of concealment and
-waited.</p>
-
-<p>Down the valley in silence walked the guide, and at
-last reached the camp. He disappeared behind the
-little thicket of pines, then reappeared, and, walking to
-a grazing pony, slung his lariat.</p>
-
-<p>The animal was cleanly caught and led back to the
-thicket.</p>
-
-<p>Then some minutes passed away, and once more the
-negro reappeared. He was leading the pony, and upon
-the animal, supported by several saddles and blankets
-and tied there with lariats, was an Indian brave.</p>
-
-<p>That he was badly wounded the scouts could see
-at that distance. The head of the pony was checked
-up, so that he could not feed, and then he was led to
-the trail and started up the valley on the trail of the
-Indian village and the braves who had stampeded.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_166"></a>[166]</span></p>
-
-<p>Until the pony disappeared from sight around the
-bend the giant negro stood watching him. Then he
-turned back to the deserted camp and disappeared in
-the thicket.</p>
-
-<p>Still Buffalo Bill did not allow the scouts to show
-themselves.</p>
-
-<p>After another long wait, the negro reappeared, and,
-looking toward the cañon, he beckoned several times.
-“Now, pards, we’ll go.”</p>
-
-<p>With this, Buffalo Bill led the way, and they walked
-rapidly toward the Indian camp, Black Bill having
-returned to the thicket.</p>
-
-<p>When Buffalo Bill and his men reached the camp,
-they beheld a strange scene.</p>
-
-<p>The redskins had deserted everything. But that
-was not all, for they had left the badly wounded Indian
-Black Bill had sent off, and two dead comrades,
-the latter having evidently just died of their wounds.
-And they had left still more, for, lying in the pine
-thicket was a prisoner.</p>
-
-<p>It was a white man. He was securely bound, painfully
-so, and, as the scouts rode up, they saw Black
-Bill kneeling by his side and unfastening the thongs
-that were about his hands and feet, which were much
-swollen.</p>
-
-<p>A glad cry broke from the lips of Buffalo Bill as he
-advanced toward the prisoner.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_167"></a>[167]</span></p>
-
-<p>It was Don Miller, a gold hunter the scout knew
-well.</p>
-
-<p>“Ah, Miller, I am glad indeed to see you, and I have
-found it hard to believe you dead,” said the chief, “as
-I heard you were.”</p>
-
-<p>“Only half dead, Cody; but you have saved me.”</p>
-
-<p>“And glad we are to do so.”</p>
-
-<p>“All the rest were killed&mdash;I am the last of my band
-of hunters.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, and the man I would have risked much to
-save, for I have not forgotten what I owe you, Miller.
-Scouts, this is my friend, a gold-boomer captain, Don
-Miller.”</p>
-
-<p>The men pressed about him and grasped his swollen
-hands, which Black Bill had released.</p>
-
-<p>Turning to the negro guide, Buffalo Bill said:</p>
-
-<p>“Well, Bill, you have kept your word and frightened
-the redskins into fits, so I know now surely that
-there is virtue in what you have asserted about black
-spirits being a terror to the Indians of this Big Horn
-country.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sah, dey runs like de debbil when dey sees
-a nigger. I done tell dis gemman here so. But,
-Massa Bill, we must git out of here right quick, for
-dem Injuns will come right back after dere prisoner in
-a short time.”</p>
-
-<p>This was decided upon at once, and preparations to
-start were begun.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_168"></a>[168]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Yer see, sah, we must not disturb de camp ’ceptin’
-de gemman and de gold, and as I hab sent off dat
-wounded Injun he’ll tell ’em about me.</p>
-
-<p>“I didn’t open my mouth to him, was still as death,
-but jist took him up, put him on a pony, and tied
-him on all right. Then I started him off. He think
-I am de black evil speeret of de Big Horn, and when
-dey come back dey’ll find I has let de prisoner go, and
-what I hab done wid de gold dey won’t care.”</p>
-
-<p>“Black Bill, you have got a very level head. It is
-just what we will do. Come, boys! We must carry
-Mr. Miller and the gold, too.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll divide the gold, pards, for saving me as you
-did,” said Don Miller.</p>
-
-<p>“If you can find a man in my band who would touch
-a dollar’s worth of it for a service to you I wouldn’t
-have him with me five minutes after I knew it,” said
-Buffalo Bill, somewhat hotly, and the men joined heartily
-in their chief’s opinion.</p>
-
-<p>A quarter of an hour after their arrival in camp
-the scouts started off, with Buffalo Bill in the lead.</p>
-
-<p>The Indian camp was left just as it was found, with
-the exception of the gold and the rescued prisoner.</p>
-
-<p>The gold boomer’s horse and the ponies were left
-grazing near the dead redskins, where they had been
-placed by their comrades, and there was nothing to
-reveal that other than the supposed “evil spirit,” a
-black ghost, had been there.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_169"></a>[169]</span></p>
-
-<p>The superstitious dread of the Indians all knew
-would allow them to believe that the evil spirit had
-been angry with them for taking the paleface.</p>
-
-<p>The scouts turned toward the base of the mountains
-and went along the range.</p>
-
-<p>Mile after mile they held on until a stream was come
-to, flowing out of a cañon, a march of fully a dozen
-miles had been made, and in a secure spot Buffalo Bill
-encamped his men.</p>
-
-<p>Then the swollen limbs of the rescued prisoner were
-bathed, arnica put on them, and a good meal cooked
-for all to enjoy, for Buffalo Bill saw that a bend in the
-range would completely hide the smoke from the Indians
-up the valley.</p>
-
-<p>It was a good place, too, where the gold could be
-hidden, for Don Miller proudly said there was not a
-man in the party but whom he would trust with the
-secret.</p>
-
-<p>If the people of the valley were found, the retreat
-would be up the Big Horn to that point, at least,
-whether they were making for Fort Aspen or Fort
-Fetterman, and the gold could be taken up and carried
-along or a special expedition made for it.</p>
-
-<p>So the gold, in bright, glittering particles, from the
-size of a pinhead to an acorn, and nuggets as large as
-a hen’s egg, were packed more closely and hidden in a
-crevice in the cliff overhanging the cañon.</p>
-
-<p>The march was not resumed that day, for Buffalo<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_170"></a>[170]</span>
-Bill wished to see whether the Indians did follow, and,
-if so, that was a splendid place for a stand, if as “black
-spirits” the scouts could not frighten them off, and had
-consequently a fight on their hands.</p>
-
-<p>The next morning, as not an Indian had been seen,
-the party took up the march.</p>
-
-<p>Don Miller expressed himself as feeling much better,
-and said that he would be all right soon.</p>
-
-<p>On his account it was slow traveling, but Buffalo
-Bill felt that he owed his life to the gold-boomer captain,
-and could not do too much for him, and the men
-had the same feeling toward him for what he had done
-for their chief.</p>
-
-<p>Thus another day passed, and Buffalo Bill knew that
-they had got well up toward the Big Horn Mountains,
-and if the people of the valley lived they could not be
-so very far from where the camp then was.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_171"></a>[171]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXIV">CHAPTER XXIV.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE LOST VALLEY.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Still another day and another went by, and each
-night brought the scouts farther and farther into a
-most beautiful country, yet one that thus far had been
-most fatal to all palefaces venturing there, lured to risk
-life and untold hardships and suffering in search of
-the yellow dross that buys men so readily, body and
-soul.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill once owed his life to Don Miller when
-he was a scout, and liked the man; but he had given
-up scouting, and had gone to lawless gold hunting in
-the Big Horn, and the report had come that his whole
-party had been massacred; but Cody was only glad that
-his friend had escaped.</p>
-
-<p>Noon the next day brought them to a perfect garden
-spot in the Big Horn Mountains. The springs were
-as clear as crystal and as cold as ice, the trees grand,
-and the little valleys most inviting for a camp.</p>
-
-<p>Black Bill boldly asserted that the Indians would
-never come there, that they believed these mountains
-the abode of the evil spirits.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill knew, in spite of Miller’s protestations
-and nerve, that Don was not yet well, but good food,
-rest, and bathing in these springs would help him; so
-he decided to go regularly into camp there.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_172"></a>[172]</span></p>
-
-<p>They need have no dread of Indians there, and they
-had left no trail to be followed easily.</p>
-
-<p>They would halt there, for the men needed the rest,
-and he and Black Bill would take short searches to
-try and find the Lost Valley and its mysterious people.</p>
-
-<p>Several times in the last day the giant negro had
-halted and regarded his surroundings in a fixed way.
-He seemed to be trying to recall some feature in the
-landscape as though he had seen it before.</p>
-
-<p>It had been two months and more since he was there
-before, if he had passed that way in his wanderings,
-and then the trees were bright green, in midsummer.</p>
-
-<p>Now they were changing to autumn tints, and, as
-is well known, this changed the whole aspect of the
-country.</p>
-
-<p>The springs the negro had not seen, though there
-were people from the Lost Valley who had been there.</p>
-
-<p>“Black Bill has been near here before, I feel certain,
-Sergeant Buck, and our plan is to scout about the
-mountains until we strike some locality familiar to
-him.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, chief, that is just it, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“We can all have a rest, and Miller is really not well
-yet.”</p>
-
-<p>“No, sir, and it is not any wonder, when you think
-them red devils had his hands tied behind him during
-all their retreat, and his legs so tightly bound that the
-flesh was cut into.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_173"></a>[173]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Yes; but he will rally quickly here and soon will
-be well.</p>
-
-<p>“He is a brave and noble-hearted man, if he did
-break the law by invading this country as a gold
-boomer.”</p>
-
-<p>“He is all you say of him, chief, and the boys are
-very much attached to him, sir.</p>
-
-<p>“Then, too, sir, he’s another strong arm and brave
-heart, if we get into trouble, which I now believe we
-will not, as Black Bill seems to be a terror the redskins
-won’t face,” said Sergeant Buck.</p>
-
-<p>“But will you pick the camp?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p>The spot selected was all that could be wished.</p>
-
-<p>Wikiups were built as a shelter, for the cold nights
-were coming on, and the men made themselves most
-comfortable right near a large spring.</p>
-
-<p>Leaves furnished good mattresses to spread blankets
-upon, the provisions were plentiful, and very little use
-had been made of the ammunition, save to kill game.</p>
-
-<p>As there was no game near the spring, it was decided
-to send several scouts on a hunt the next day to
-get deer, and in the streams the fish were plentiful.</p>
-
-<p>The scouts had realized the virtue of being blacked
-up in that country, and Don Miller had transferred
-himself also, in appearance at least, to a negro.</p>
-
-<p>Without a guard, the scouts lay down to sleep, and
-nothing disturbed their slumbers.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_174"></a>[174]</span></p>
-
-<p>The next morning Corporal Milk took a party hunting
-up the valley with him, and Buffalo Bill and Black
-Bill began their real search for the Lost Valley.</p>
-
-<p>The hunters were gone all day, and when they returned
-to the camp at sunset they carried very heavy
-loads of game of various kinds.</p>
-
-<p>But the scouts who remained in the camp could give
-no reply as to what had become of Buffalo Bill and the
-negro.</p>
-
-<p>They had not put in an appearance, and it was certainly
-thought that they should have done so.</p>
-
-<p>“Was it any one else than the chief, I would be
-anxious,” said Sergeant Buck hopefully; but all could
-see that he was anxious, even though it was the chief.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill had said that they would be back before
-night. He had not returned. It had been his intention,
-they knew, to go out each day with the negro, and
-in a different direction, to try and come upon some
-scene Black Bill would recognize.</p>
-
-<p>If he did not do so from that camp, they would move
-to another, and in that time Don Miller would be as
-well as any of them, and they would see what discovery
-could be made.</p>
-
-<p>But here, the very first day of the search, the chief
-of the scouts and the giant negro did not return. What
-could it mean?</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill was not the man to get lost anywhere.
-He could find his way in the darkness right through<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_175"></a>[175]</span>
-an unknown country. It was a talent with him&mdash;an instinct&mdash;and
-his men never feared for him, save from
-an ambush from an enemy, or treachery.</p>
-
-<p>There were several of the scouts who still doubted
-the black guide. They could not feel the faith in him
-which their chief did. In spite of the seeming honesty
-of the negro, they doubted him. He was an object
-of mystery to them&mdash;a man to dread.</p>
-
-<p>They could not believe that he had started alone to
-find aid, to look up Buffalo Bill, and yet could not find
-his way back to the point whence he had started.
-It looked strange to them. Now he had gone off alone
-with the chief of scouts, and they had not returned.
-This to some looked like treachery.</p>
-
-<p>The scouts awaited supper for some time, and then
-ate it, as the chief and the negro did not return.</p>
-
-<p>The meal was, however, not enjoyed by any one.</p>
-
-<p>Bedtime came, and yet what could be done? No
-one could go out at night to look for the missing chief
-and the negro.</p>
-
-<p>If nothing had happened, then Buffalo Bill would
-find the way to the camp in a mountain storm.</p>
-
-<p>All knew that the scout did not go without his
-blanket, a haversack of food, and was prepared to
-spend the night anywhere he might be overtaken.</p>
-
-<p>A search of the traps of the negro showed that he
-had gone also prepared for a stay, if necessary.</p>
-
-<p>At last the scouts decided to retire and put the best<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_176"></a>[176]</span>
-face on the nonreturn of the chief by saying that they
-had doubtless gone so far, made some discovery, and
-to carry out their intention had decided to camp where
-they were for the night, to be on the spot early in the
-morning, rather than return to camp.</p>
-
-<p>“We will start on the hunt, pards, if they are not
-here to breakfast,” said Sergeant Buck.</p>
-
-<p>Dawn came, but the chief and the negro had not
-returned.</p>
-
-<p>One of those who appeared to be most anxious about
-the chief was Don Miller. He wanted to go on the
-search.</p>
-
-<p>“We will all go, and divide in twos, and if we cannot
-find their trail we will go the way we think they
-must have gone.</p>
-
-<p>“You take care of the camp, Mr. Miller, and each
-one of us, as he gives up the search, will come in; only
-I do not wish any man to give up until he is certain that
-he cannot find the chief, and must get back here by
-night.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, I want every man back here in camp by night.</p>
-
-<p>“You will see where we are located, and no man
-need get lost.</p>
-
-<p>“Come right back to camp if any discovery is made;
-and, I tell you, boys, we must find the chief.</p>
-
-<p>“If he has been treacherously dealt with, as I see
-some of you believe, then we know who did it, and we
-must find him.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_177"></a>[177]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Now, pards, let us be off!” said Sergeant Buck.</p>
-
-<p>Such was the sergeant’s speech to his comrades, and
-they all started on their search.</p>
-
-<p>And in the lone camp, Don Miller remained by
-himself, watching them as they disappeared on different
-trails, and musing to himself in a very determined
-way:</p>
-
-<p>“Buffalo Bill must be found, dead or alive; and, if
-dead, he shall be avenged!”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_178"></a>[178]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXV">CHAPTER XXV.<br />
-<span class="fs70">UNSEEN FOES.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>When Buffalo Bill and the guide left the camp together,
-the chief went down the valley leading from
-the Big Horn Mountains, where the camp had been
-located, hoping to pass some scene that the negro would
-recall at sight.</p>
-
-<p>Could he do this, Buffalo Bill felt little doubt but
-that they could in that way find the Lost Valley, for the
-scout had perfect faith that the negro was sincere in all
-that he had said, and that it was not the creation of
-mind diseased.</p>
-
-<p>Brave as he was, good plainsman, also, it would be
-readily understood by Buffalo Bill how the negro
-failed to find a given locality when he had been guided
-thither by some one else, and had simply left there to
-endeavor to find his way to a place where he could
-get word of him, the chief of scouts, who was to be
-secretly urged to come to the rescue of people in distress.</p>
-
-<p>Why some one else&mdash;the guide of the party, for instance&mdash;had
-not been sent on this mission Buffalo Bill
-had been unable to find out from Black Bill.</p>
-
-<p>Starting out alone with Black Bill, and having arrived,
-as it were, almost upon the scene to which the
-negro had wished to bring him, Buffalo Bill thought<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_179"></a>[179]</span>
-that, perhaps, he would tell him more than he thus
-far had done, and to encourage him to do so he had
-said:</p>
-
-<p>“Well, you think we are near the Lost Valley?”</p>
-
-<p>“Sure, sah; very sartin.”</p>
-
-<p>“What do you tell by?”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, sah, dere is trees, and mountains, and valleys
-dat looks familiarlike, though I can’t jist place ’em;
-but I is sartin I has seen ’em before.”</p>
-
-<p>“Did you ever go far from the valley?”</p>
-
-<p>“Not very, sah; but I hunted ’round, maybe ten and
-a dozen miles away.”</p>
-
-<p>“Suppose you find some spot that you recall thoroughly,
-will you go right to the valley?”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, Massa Bill, I’ll go as near as I kin, and then
-let you decide what is ter be done.”</p>
-
-<p>“All right; keep your eyes open, and see if you can
-find any place you remember to have seen before.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sah; I’m a-lookin’ hard, sah.”</p>
-
-<p>They went on together for some miles, and the valley
-they were following opened into a larger one.</p>
-
-<p>As they came out into the larger valley, the guide
-halted suddenly, rubbed his eyes, looked about him, and
-said earnestly:</p>
-
-<p>“Massa Buf’ler Bill, I knows whar I is.”</p>
-
-<p>“What do you recognize about this valley?”</p>
-
-<p>“If I is right, sah, you see dem cliffs ’way yonder?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_180"></a>[180]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Dem is over de cañon where dey used ter git gold.”</p>
-
-<p>The negro started off in a way that told the scout
-that he was in earnest, that he had certainly got his
-bearings from some familiar scene before him. He
-kept up a rapid pace, Buffalo Bill keeping close by his
-side.</p>
-
-<p>The cliffs loomed up nearer and nearer, and at last
-the scout and the negro were almost under their
-shadow.</p>
-
-<p>“You see dat break yonder in de cliffs?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“It is a cañon, sah. It runs back from where you see
-de open place, and dere big springs yonder dat flow
-down the cañon, and dere whar dey found de gold.”</p>
-
-<p>The negro went forward alone, and began to climb
-up the steep rocks to the break in the cliff. Watching
-him, Buffalo Bill saw him peep cautiously over, as
-though he expected to see an enemy beyond.</p>
-
-<p>A moment he remained thus, and then came a distant
-report of a rifle that echoed and reëchoed among
-the cliffs, and Buffalo Bill saw the negro sink down
-upon his face as though dead.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill was fairly startled at what he beheld.
-He had not thought of danger there to himself or to
-the negro. The shot had come so unexpectedly that,
-for a moment, he did not know where to look for an
-enemy.</p>
-
-<p>It appeared to have ended the life of the guide, for<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_181"></a>[181]</span>
-he had fallen in a heap and lay motionless, like a dead
-man.</p>
-
-<p>But the scout was not one to hesitate long when action
-was needed, or to allow a crime to go unpunished
-when he could bring the perpetrators to book.</p>
-
-<p>Thoughts went like lightning through his mind. He
-thought of the people of Lost Valley that the negro had
-risked so much to rescue. Could they have killed their
-rescuer?</p>
-
-<p>How far was the Lost Valley from where he then
-was?</p>
-
-<p>Of course, it must be those from the valley who had
-fired on the black giant. But who they were he must
-know, and where they were, as well as why that murderous
-shot had been sent at a rescuer.</p>
-
-<p>Bounding forward while these thoughts were raging
-through his brain, the scout reached a large rock
-at the base of the cliff.</p>
-
-<p>As he did so, a man sprang in view through the
-break of the cliff, and within a few feet of the form
-of the negro. He was a large man, heavily bearded,
-long-haired, and he held a rifle in his hand.</p>
-
-<p>With a wave of his hand to some one unseen, he
-called out:</p>
-
-<p>“Come, Tom; for I told you I was right. It’s ther
-giant nigger of the valley.”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill heard the voice answer afar off, but did<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_182"></a>[182]</span>
-not catch what was said; yet he heard the reply of the
-man in full view of him, for he replied to the other:</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, dead as ther devil. I chipped him atween ther
-eyes. Come along.”</p>
-
-<p>The scout remained behind the bowlder. He could
-afford to wait; for he knew that another enemy was
-near, and would soon be in sight. The one in sight
-had fired on the negro, knowing who he was, and being
-anxious to kill him. He had spoken, too, of the valley;
-so he must know where that was.</p>
-
-<p>His words told Buffalo Bill that Black Bill was
-dead, and, in the very moment of his success in bringing
-him to the rescue of people who, if these two were
-a specimen of them, did not deserve rescue.</p>
-
-<p>“I think I’ve got the best of this,” muttered Buffalo
-Bill, and, slinging his rifle at his back, he drew a revolver
-in each hand.</p>
-
-<p>“Ho, Rocks, yer got him,” Buffalo Bill heard, for
-he dared not look toward the speaker for fear of being
-seen.</p>
-
-<p>“It’s ther nigger, ain’t it?” asked the man who had
-fired the shot.</p>
-
-<p>“Sure.”</p>
-
-<p>“How’d he get out?”</p>
-
-<p>“Who knows; fer I thought he’d given up tryin’
-long ago.”</p>
-
-<p>“He didn’t, though, if he’s here.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_183"></a>[183]</span></p>
-
-<p>“No, he didn’t; but there can’t be any more of ’em
-out.”</p>
-
-<p>“You bet ther ain’t, and they won’t be no more; so
-we’ve got it our way, sure.”</p>
-
-<p>“We has, ef our two pards come back all right.”</p>
-
-<p>“They’ll git here, fer gold will fetch ’em, you bet.”</p>
-
-<p>“Then we’ll be rich for our nat’ral lives.”</p>
-
-<p>“We will; and hev something ter leave after death.</p>
-
-<p>“We played to win, and we got ther game; only I
-don’t like this nigger gettin’ out.”</p>
-
-<p>“Me nuther.”</p>
-
-<p>“More might be gettin’ out now.”</p>
-
-<p>“Not ef they’re comin’ ther way he did; fer thar
-ain’t many men kin do it that I’m acquainted with.”</p>
-
-<p>“Nor me; but I wish our two pards would git back
-with the horses, for it’s after time some weeks, and
-provisions is running low.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, and gold won’t buy food in this country.”</p>
-
-<p>“No; all we has got won’t git us a meal if we was
-starving.”</p>
-
-<p>“That’s so; but suppose we keep a eye on ther valley,
-for if we see more of ’em gittin’ out, it means death
-ter us, if we don’t fust kill them.”</p>
-
-<p>“It does; but we’ll do ther killin’, as has just been
-done in this case of ther nigger; but let’s drag him
-down inter ther soft ground, go through his pockets,
-and see what he’s wuth to us outside of the killin’, and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_184"></a>[184]</span>
-then he kin be left for coyotes ter chaw on, fer it’s too
-much like work ter plant him.”</p>
-
-<p>With this, the two men took hold of the negro, and
-their oaths revealed to Buffalo Bill that they were dragging
-him along down the steep hillside, and found it
-no easy task.</p>
-
-<p>Nearer and nearer they came, and the scout moved
-to the side of the rock nearest to which they must pass.</p>
-
-<p>A moment more and they came within ten feet of
-him, and would have come full upon him, when suddenly
-they were confronted by a tall form, and heard
-the words:</p>
-
-<p>“Hands up, both of you!”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_185"></a>[185]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXVI">CHAPTER XXVI.<br />
-<span class="fs70">FACE TO FACE WITH ENEMIES.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>The sudden appearance of the chief of the black
-scouts before them, appearing like an apparition to the
-two men, who had no thought of danger near, caused
-them to cry out in mingled terror and utter surprise.</p>
-
-<p>The form of the negro, which they were half bearing,
-half dragging along, was dropped with a suddenness
-that was by no mean showing a proper respect
-for the dead.</p>
-
-<p>The two men stood for an instant like statues, and
-before them towered the tall, athletic form of Buffalo
-Bill. He held a revolver in each hand, and was ten
-feet from them.</p>
-
-<p>“Hands up, I said!”</p>
-
-<p>The men had not heeded the first command, perhaps
-from utter helplessness, in their amazement. Now
-they did heed, and quickly.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill stepped forward toward the one nearest
-him, unbuckled his belt, thus disarming him of his
-knife and revolvers, and then drew the strap of his
-rifle over his head.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, your turn, sir!”</p>
-
-<p>The man did not move.</p>
-
-<p>“Step here, quick, or I’ll reach you with a bullet!”</p>
-
-<p>The scout saw that the men had discovered that they<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_186"></a>[186]</span>
-were two to one, and were plotting resistance. But
-the hint of reaching for him with a bullet brought the
-man quickly to within the length of the scout’s arm.
-He, too, was disarmed of his belt and weapons and his
-rifle.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, I wish to tie you, and if I see the first show
-of funny business, you will hand in your chips.”</p>
-
-<p>The men made no resistance, but they were glancing
-toward each other furtively, and certainly were plotting
-to escape.</p>
-
-<p>“Lie flat on your faces, both of you, and put your
-hands behind your backs!” came the order.</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll tie ’em, Massa Buf’ler Bill.”</p>
-
-<p>The words fairly startled the scout, with all his
-iron nerve. It was as though a dead man was speaking
-to him.</p>
-
-<p>The two men uttered a yell of fright, and, for a moment,
-seemed about to risk bullets in the face of superstitious
-fear.</p>
-
-<p>Had it been nighttime, the added dread that darkness
-brings to the superstitious would have sent them
-away on the jump.</p>
-
-<p>“Why, Black Bill, I thought that you were dead,
-and, thank Heaven, it is not so!” said Buffalo Bill earnestly.</p>
-
-<p>“No, massa; it was a close call, for dat bullet done
-cut my head, and I guess will kill me yet.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_187"></a>[187]</span></p>
-
-<p>“I is awful dizzy in my head like, but I kin tie dese
-gemmens, all right.”</p>
-
-<p>With this, the negro passed his hand across his head,
-took his lariat from over his shoulder, and began to tie
-the two men, Buffalo Bill keeping them covered with
-his revolver, and aiding in binding them securely.</p>
-
-<p>“The one lariat will do for them both, and keep them
-tied together&mdash;there, now we have them; but you cannot
-stand up?”</p>
-
-<p>“It don’t seem as though I could, sir,” said the black,
-who kept sitting on the ground.</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll see to your wound right off.”</p>
-
-<p>With this, the scout placed the weapons on the
-ground, wheeled the prisoners face to face, and bound
-them thus with his own lariat.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, Black Bill,” and he began to examine the
-wound.</p>
-
-<p>It was in the center of the forehead; but, having
-been fired upward, the bullet had glanced on the frontal
-bone, cut along under the scalp for several inches, and
-then made its way out, leaving a long gash, not serious,
-though the shock of the blow had felled the black
-and rendered him unconscious for some minutes.</p>
-
-<p>Bathing the wound with water from his canteen, and
-binding it up with a bandage moistened with arnica, the
-scout said:</p>
-
-<p>“You are all right now, and the dizzy feeling will
-soon wear off.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_188"></a>[188]</span></p>
-
-<p>“It don’ hurt, sah; but it do feel like a mule hed
-kicked me.”</p>
-
-<p>“Rest is what you want, and we’ll go to the camp of
-these two men, for it cannot be far away.”</p>
-
-<p>The men had stood watching the every movement
-of the scout, and talking in whispers to each other.</p>
-
-<p>“We ain’t got no camp,” said one.</p>
-
-<p>“See here, men, you sought to kill this negro pard
-of mine, and that he escaped death is a marvel. I
-heard all that you said, and I know that you have a
-camp here, for you came from the camp of those who
-settled in this basin.”</p>
-
-<p>“That’s so, Massa Bill, fer I knows ’em both, one
-being named Tom Vail and t’other they calls Rocks.
-Dey had two pards, and we all thought dey got kilt de
-day of de ’arthquake. I knows ’em, sah; but why dey
-want ter kill me I doesn’t know, fer I never did ’em
-no harm, and den I thought dey was dead, and felt
-sorry for ’em, but dere must be two more of ’em, sah,
-so look out, Massa Bill.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, there are two more of them, though they are
-not here just now, but are due. I know a little about
-these fellows myself, for they gave themselves away
-when they thought they had killed you. Come, lead
-the way to your camp, or I’ll find a way to make you,
-and which you will not like.”</p>
-
-<p>The scout had unwound his lariat, so that they
-could walk side by side, and the two men saw that there<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_189"></a>[189]</span>
-was no nonsense to be put up with on their part, so
-one said:</p>
-
-<p>“We has a leetle camp down the valley, if yer wants
-ter go there.”</p>
-
-<p>“Lead the way. Black Bill, I’ll help you,” and, supporting
-the negro with his arm, Buffalo Bill followed
-on behind the two men, as they shuffled along down
-the valley, the weapons of each man being hung about
-their necks so that they would have to carry them.</p>
-
-<p>The two prisoners walked slowly, partly because
-their legs were tied so as to prevent rapid traveling,
-and also because they did not wish to go. They were
-livid with rage and fear, with hate and anxiety, for
-they did not know what would be their fate, while they
-saw their hopes dashed to earth in a second of time.</p>
-
-<p>Down the valley they went for a mile, perhaps, the
-walk seeming to benefit the negro, and, at last, they
-turned into a small cañon in which grew a grove of
-pines, and at the head of which was a spring.</p>
-
-<p>“De cañon whar de people hunt fer gold not far
-from here, Massa Bill,” said the negro, and then he
-added:</p>
-
-<p>“I jist guesses dat’s what dese men is here for,
-while t’others is in ther Lost Valley, for something had
-been de matter, sartin.”</p>
-
-<p>The camp now came into view, a stoutly built log
-cabin, with door and shutters of hewn timber, and a
-shed along the front.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_190"></a>[190]</span></p>
-
-<p>It was near the spring, was sheltered by the overhanging
-cliffs and the pines, and, winter or summer,
-was a safe and comfortable retreat.</p>
-
-<p>“De people built de cabin, Massa Bill; put it up
-fer dere provisions, which dey kept here, ter keep
-from going back to de valley, sah, every night, and
-dey only all went on Sundays.”</p>
-
-<p>“So you did find your camp, eh?” said Buffalo Bill
-to the two men, and he made them fast to a tree, back
-to back.</p>
-
-<p>Then he spread the negro’s blanket for him upon
-the pine straw, and said:</p>
-
-<p>“Now, you lie down there, while I reconnoiter this
-camp, which is a very snug affair, I see.”</p>
-
-<p>The two prisoners muttered oaths, the black lay
-down at full length, and Buffalo Bill threw open the
-door of the cabin and the shutters, which gave light
-within.</p>
-
-<p>It was a large cabin, and there were a number of
-bunks in it along the rear wall.</p>
-
-<p>There were shelves, too, with provisions, and a table,
-cooking utensils, weapons, and picks, shovels, axes,
-and hatchets.</p>
-
-<p>A haunch of venison hung under the shed outside,
-with bacon, hams, and dried fish, showing that the
-men were still well supplied with provisions.</p>
-
-<p>In a plot of ground back of the cabin there were<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_191"></a>[191]</span>
-potatoes, cabbages, and turnips growing, and places to
-store them away for the winter.</p>
-
-<p>“You fellows have had the best, I see, and I am
-going to know about you before I am done with you,”
-said Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>Then he added that he would cook dinner for all
-hands, and draw on the cabin’s larder for his supplies.</p>
-
-<p>A fire was smoldering outside of the cabin, and this
-was replenished, and soon a dinner of roast potatoes,
-bacon, venison, hoecake, and coffee was prepared.</p>
-
-<p>Black Bill was asleep; but woke at the scout’s call,
-saying that he felt much better, save for a headache.</p>
-
-<p>“It is well it is no worse. Now, see what a good
-dinner we have; or, I may say, supper, for it is getting
-late. I guess we’ll camp here to-night and return
-to our camp to-morrow; or I will go and bring the
-boys here, for you must keep quiet for a few days.”</p>
-
-<p>“What is you doing here in the Big Horn country,
-anyhow?” said Rocks, as Buffalo Bill untied the hands
-of the prisoners for them to eat their dinner.</p>
-
-<p>“That is just what I came here to ask you, and, as
-a government officer, I have the call.”</p>
-
-<p>“The nigger calls you Buffalo Bill.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“Is you him?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“I has heerd of yer,” said Rocks, watching the scout
-with interest.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_192"></a>[192]</span></p>
-
-<p>“So has I,” Tom Vail added.</p>
-
-<p>“You may hear of me before I leave this country
-of the Big Horn.”</p>
-
-<p>“Did ther nigger bring you here?”</p>
-
-<p>“About that.”</p>
-
-<p>“What for?”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill was willing to be questioned. He might
-find out what Black Bill had so far not made known
-to him. So he answered:</p>
-
-<p>“You know this country belongs to the Indians, and
-the government wishes to protect them in it, and will
-not send troops here, unless compelled to do so to punish
-murdering redskins.</p>
-
-<p>“You men, and others like you, are aware that the
-Big Horn is rich with gold finds, care nothing for the
-government’s pledges to the Indians, and invade the
-mountains and valleys as gold boomers.</p>
-
-<p>“This keeps the Indians restless, revengeful, and
-hostile, causing them to kill bands of whites where
-found, raid settlements away from their lands, and
-thus force the military to punish them severely for
-what you gold boomers have driven them to do.</p>
-
-<p>“You are, therefore, lawbreakers, and become murderers,
-for you kill the Indians, and they in turn kill
-the gold boomers and many innocent whites as well.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, I know that there is a settlement here, and,
-though they may have done no harm to the Indians,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_193"></a>[193]</span>
-they are still lawbreakers, and must leave the country.”</p>
-
-<p>“You’ll have a lively time getting ther people of
-ther Lost Valley out of this country, Buffalo Bill.”</p>
-
-<p>“It may be; but they must go,” was the determined
-rejoinder of the chief of scouts.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_194"></a>[194]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXVII">CHAPTER XXVII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">A DISCOVERY.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill would have liked to have returned to his
-own camp that night, but he saw that Black Bill was
-still somewhat dazed by the wound in his head, and
-he did not just know how it would turn out.</p>
-
-<p>The scout had known similar wounds prove fatal
-when least expected, and if the negro was left to
-guard the two prisoners he might lapse into unconsciousness,
-and there be a possibility of the men getting
-free.</p>
-
-<p>Then, too, he knew what had been said by the two
-men of the pards they were expecting.</p>
-
-<p>They were overdue and might never come; and
-again, if they did happen to come that very night it
-would mean sure death to Black Bill, should he be
-left there alone.</p>
-
-<p>So the scout decided to remain, and, after the meal
-was over, he secured the prisoners, left the negro in
-charge, and started out on a search. He was not long
-in finding a trail leading into a wild cañon, through
-which flowed a stream, like a river in wet weather, but
-at other times dry.</p>
-
-<p>Going down this, the scout saw that he had struck
-the gold beds of the people of the Lost Valley.</p>
-
-<p>It was a case of placer mining, the wash from the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_195"></a>[195]</span>
-mountains of the particles of gold, and yet the pick
-and shovel had been brought into use also in the bed
-of the cañon.</p>
-
-<p>“They have gotten considerable gold out of here,
-that is certain, and these men have been steadily at
-work, I see; but where are the people of the Lost
-Valley, for only these two murderous scamps seem to
-be anywhere about.”</p>
-
-<p>So musing, Buffalo Bill went on through the cañon,
-came out into a large valley, and, climbing to the top
-of a lofty cliff, looked about, glass in hand.</p>
-
-<p>It was nearly sunset; and the rays of light were cast
-far down the valley, and the eyes of the scout fell
-upon moving objects there.</p>
-
-<p>At once he turned his glass upon them.</p>
-
-<p>“They are horsemen!” he cried, “and they are coming
-this way.”</p>
-
-<p>A moment after he continued:</p>
-
-<p>“There are two of them, but they are leading five
-horses. By Jove! I believe they are the pards of these
-two murderers, just returning. How lucky I did not
-return to my camp!</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, they must be their two comrades; and, if these
-men are murderers, they can be no better that are
-coming.</p>
-
-<p>“They are all of half a dozen miles away, and it
-will be an hour and a half before they can reach the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_196"></a>[196]</span>
-cabin, and darkness will be in soon. I’ll go and prepare
-for them.”</p>
-
-<p>The scout took another long look at the far-distant
-horsemen, then descended from the cliff, walked rapidly
-back through the gold cañon, and reached the
-cabin just as dusk fell.</p>
-
-<p>“Men, I am sorry to have to gag you and make
-you more secure, but I am determined to be upon
-the safe side. Are you well enough, Bill, to help me?”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, yes, sah.”</p>
-
-<p>“Then get two sticks, put a piece of blanket over
-the head of each, and have it so you can tie it back of
-their heads.</p>
-
-<p>“I will tie these men in their bunks, when they have
-been gagged and they will give us no trouble or anxiety.”</p>
-
-<p>“It will kill us,” shouted Rocks.</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, no; you don’t die so easily.”</p>
-
-<p>The two men, bound as they were, sought to resist,
-but they soon found that they were as children in
-the hands of the scout, and they were placed in their
-bunks, made fast there, and the gags put in their
-mouths so that they could utter no sound.</p>
-
-<p>To test this the scout gave each one a severe pinch,
-to make them cry out, but a low groan was all that
-they could utter.</p>
-
-<p>“You see, I discovered some visitors coming, and
-who I am sure are the pards of these two men coming<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_197"></a>[197]</span>
-for them; so we wish no outcries of alarm, for I shall
-capture them also.”</p>
-
-<p>The two men could hear, if they could not talk, and
-they writhed and moaned at what they heard.</p>
-
-<p>“You, Black Bill, hide in the pines, rifle in hand,
-and be ready to drop those men if they attempt to run
-away.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sah, I’ll do it.”</p>
-
-<p>“Hide a short distance off in the pines. Are you
-ready?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sah.”</p>
-
-<p>“All right. I’ll wait in the cabin to welcome them.”</p>
-
-<p>The negro shouldered his rifle and walked to a place
-of hiding, with the scout by his side.</p>
-
-<p>Then Buffalo Bill returned to the cabin and closed
-the door, to wait the arrival of the visitors.</p>
-
-<p>That the chief of scouts had made no mistake in
-his surmise as to who the two horsemen were was
-proven by the sound of hoofs coming up the cañon.</p>
-
-<p>The guide saw by the moonlight two men, with five
-led horses, two carrying packs, pass by him. He heard
-one say:</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll be sartin afore I make a break, for we don’t
-know what has happened in ther three months we
-has been away.”</p>
-
-<p>“All right; I’ll wait here,” was the answer.</p>
-
-<p>The first speaker then rode on alone to the cabin
-and called out:</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_198"></a>[198]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Ho, pards, kin yer give a couple of friends lodgin’
-fer ther night?”</p>
-
-<p>The two prisoners writhed in agony of spirit, but
-Buffalo Bill, imitating the voice of Rocks, and having
-learned the names of the two men, called out:</p>
-
-<p>“Hooray! Is that you, Jim Sims and Alex Sands?”</p>
-
-<p>“It are. Any one with you?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes; two pards is here. Wait until I open the
-door, and you bet we is glad ter see yer, fer Tom is
-laid up jist now and feelin’ mighty bad.”</p>
-
-<p>“Hoop-la! Come on, Alex!” cried Jim Sims in a
-joyful tone.</p>
-
-<p>“They are here, and all’s O.K., with the goose hanging
-high.”</p>
-
-<p>The tone was exultant, and Jim Sims leaped from
-his horse, stepped to the door, and was suddenly seized
-by the throat with a grip of iron, hurled to the dirt
-floor and heard the words:</p>
-
-<p>“Utter a sound of warning to your pard and you
-are a dead man!”</p>
-
-<p>The man was silent with fright, and, in an instant,
-the lariat of Buffalo Bill had been passed round and
-round his arms, pinioning them to his body, while his
-weapons had been removed.</p>
-
-<p>“Come in, Alex, and see poor Tom,” said Buffalo
-Bill, and the other man, having dismounted, stepped
-into the cabin, to be felled his full length by a stunning
-blow dealt him by Buffalo Bill full in the face.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_199"></a>[199]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Ho, Black Bill!” called out the scout, and the negro
-sprang into the cabin at the call, having followed the
-last man closely.</p>
-
-<p>The latter found himself bound before he recovered
-from the scout’s stunning blow full in the face, but
-he gasped:</p>
-
-<p>“Who is yer, cuss yer?”</p>
-
-<p>“A government officer on the track of gold boomers,
-four of whom we have just roped in, for there lie your
-pards Tom and Rocks, in as bad way as you are.”</p>
-
-<p>“Is this one all secure?”</p>
-
-<p>“You bet he is, Massa Buf’ler Bill.”</p>
-
-<p>“Buffalo Bill! That means we hang, Jim!” cried
-Alex Sands, in bitter tones.</p>
-
-<p>“So you are Buffalo Bill, is yer?” asked Jim Sims.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes; anything else I can do for you?” The scout
-naturally felt elated over his successful capture without
-firing a shot or having taken a life.</p>
-
-<p>“No, cuss yer, yer hev done too much.”</p>
-
-<p>“We’ll take the gags out of the fellows’ mouths
-now, as we have these two secure,” and, going over to
-the bunks, the two gags were removed, water was
-handed the men, and the four were at liberty to talk
-together, as soon as all four were secured in bunks
-for the night.</p>
-
-<p>Then Buffalo Bill and the negro went to care for
-the horses, and a good grass plot was found down the
-cañon, where the animals were staked out.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_200"></a>[200]</span></p>
-
-<p>The two packsaddles were well filled with supplies,
-and two of the other horses had bridles and saddles on
-them for the use of the men who were to ride them
-back to civilization when the gold boomers returned
-with their riches.</p>
-
-<p>From the conversation of the four, Buffalo Bill soon
-gleamed that the two had had a hard time of it going
-through on foot, but had reached Helena at last, and,
-after a long rest, had bought horses and supplies, and,
-watching their chance, had started back again for the
-Big Horn Basin for their pards, and cheered by the
-riches they would become possessors of and going to
-bring back with them to civilization.</p>
-
-<p>The firelight showed Buffalo Bill that the two men
-had hard faces, about on a par with his first two prisoners,
-and he knew that it would not do to leave them
-alone, bound as they were, with Black Bill, until the
-negro felt wholly himself again, and so he said:</p>
-
-<p>“Now, we will turn in, Black Bill, and get a good
-night’s rest, and to-morrow I’ll go after the boys and
-bring them over here, for this seems to be about the
-end of our trail.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_201"></a>[201]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXVIII">CHAPTER XXVIII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">A LIVING TOMB.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>When morning dawned, the scout and the giant
-black were on their feet.</p>
-
-<p>The latter said that he was all right, only his head
-was sore and felt twice as heavy as usual.</p>
-
-<p>The prisoners were taken out of the bunks in the
-cabin and tied to trees near the outside fire, where
-breakfast was put on by the negro, while the scout
-went to lead the horses to water and to change them
-to a fresh grazing ground.</p>
-
-<p>This was accomplished by the time the guide had
-breakfast done, and, as the chief came up, he found
-the prisoners talking earnestly with the black, who
-called out:</p>
-
-<p>“Massa Bill, what you think dese bad gemmens want
-me to do just now?”</p>
-
-<p>“Kill me, I suppose, and set them free.”</p>
-
-<p>“Lordy, Massa Bill, you read minds same as you
-does a book.”</p>
-
-<p>“It does not require much mind-reading to know
-that they offered you big money to turn against
-me.”</p>
-
-<p>“That’s just what they did do, sah; offer to give me
-half de gold dey have got ter set ’em free and let ’em
-kill you.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_202"></a>[202]</span></p>
-
-<p>“They didn’t know you, Black Bill. But I don’t
-blame them, for killing is their trade, and they naturally
-wish to go free. Come, men, and we’ll have
-breakfast,” said the scout, with no show of resentment
-toward his prisoners.</p>
-
-<p>The meal over with, Buffalo Bill decided to start at
-once for the scout’s camp, leaving Black Bill to guard
-the four prisoners, who were greatly cast down at their
-failure to bribe the negro to allow them to go free,
-and which they could only do by putting the chief out
-of the way.</p>
-
-<p>They had, indeed, offered him half the gold that they
-had, and said he could accompany them on their way.</p>
-
-<p>That the guide would prove false to him Buffalo Bill
-did not for a moment believe, and he called him aside
-and said:</p>
-
-<p>“Last night I would not leave you alone, with those
-fellows, black pard, for I was not just sure how that
-head of yours would pan out after that wound, and
-feared they might best you. But now you are all right,
-and I will go to our camp after the boys.</p>
-
-<p>“You keep your eyes upon these men, for they are
-as tricky as snakes, and bound as they are, they are
-four, you one, and they may find some way of getting
-the best of you should you be off your guard for a
-moment.”</p>
-
-<p>So saying, he shouldered his rifle, and started off for
-the scout’s camp. He had not gone very far before he<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_203"></a>[203]</span>
-saw two men approaching. At a glance he recognized
-Sergeant Buck and a soldier.</p>
-
-<p>They saw him about the same time, and gave a shout
-of joy.</p>
-
-<p>“We are after you, chief, for, as you did not put in
-an appearance last night we got anxious about you.”</p>
-
-<p>“Where’s the black giant?” called out Sergeant
-Buck.</p>
-
-<p>“Safe, but by a miracle only, for he got a wound
-that was a very close call.”</p>
-
-<p>“Fell on the rocks, sir, I suppose?”</p>
-
-<p>“No, he was shot.”</p>
-
-<p>Then Buffalo Bill told of the discovery so far made,
-and the capture of the gold boomers, and learning
-that the scouts were scattered in search of him, he
-said:</p>
-
-<p>“You return, sergeant, and bring the outfit here, for
-I will have some one down the valley to meet you. If
-the boys do not come in until night, come to-morrow,
-and Ben will go with me now, and see if we cannot
-make further discoveries.”</p>
-
-<p>Sergeant Buck at once set off on the return trail, and
-Buffalo Bill and Ben went back down the valley.</p>
-
-<p>As the break in the cliff was reached Buffalo Bill
-led the way up the steep hillside, and the two continued
-on through the narrow pass.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill had an idea that he would make some<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_204"></a>[204]</span>
-discovery by going through that pass that severed the
-range.</p>
-
-<p>As they drew near the farther end, they could see
-through the opening that a large valley lay far below
-them, a thousand or more feet.</p>
-
-<p>The pass had narrowed to less than a hundred feet,
-and arose in solid walls of rock far above them.</p>
-
-<p>When within a short distance of the end, Buffalo
-Bill halted suddenly and cried:</p>
-
-<p>“See there, Ben!”</p>
-
-<p>“This end of the pass has been blasted out with
-powder.”</p>
-
-<p>“That is just what it was, Ben, and&mdash;we have found
-it&mdash;see? The Lost Valley lies before us!”</p>
-
-<p>The chief of scouts, since his meeting with the black
-giant, almost used up by starvation and wounds, had
-had his mind set on the penned-up settlers in the Lost
-Valley. He had given his pledge to the negro to answer
-the call upon him for aid, to go with him on what
-to other men would have seemed an aimless trail. He
-had pushed on against all dangers, all obstacles, and
-his intention was to triumph.</p>
-
-<p>There before him was the Lost Valley.</p>
-
-<p>It was no wonder that a triumphant smile hovered
-about the mouth of Buffalo Bill and his dark eyes
-glowed with joy. He had come to the end of the long
-and perilous trail.</p>
-
-<p>Where they stood, beneath their feet, and all around<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_205"></a>[205]</span>
-them, the rocks were blackened with powder. There
-had been a heavy blast there, as they could see. And
-that blast of powder had shattered the cliff, and hurled
-a small mountain of rock down into the valley far below.</p>
-
-<p>It had broken off the edge of the cliff right at the
-end of the pass most abruptly.</p>
-
-<p>Right beneath their feet the cliff broke off and went
-downward almost like an artificial wall for a thousand
-feet or more.</p>
-
-<p>The two scouts advanced to the edge and their eyes
-became riveted in wonder at what they beheld.</p>
-
-<p>Below them was a valley, or, rather, a basin, for it
-was surrounded on every side by towering cliffs. No
-break could be seen anywhere, no cañon pushing into
-the surrounding wall of rock.</p>
-
-<p>It was not a valley surrounded by mountain ranges,
-but a valley completely encircled by cliffs rising one
-thousand feet.</p>
-
-<p>But that was not all, for right in its center was a
-large lake, with wooded shores.</p>
-
-<p>Around the lake, in the timber, were scattered a
-score of cabins. A herd of cattle, horses, and mules
-were there, too. A group of wagons were in one
-place. Men, women, and children were also visible.</p>
-
-<p>The crowing of a rooster was heard down in the valley,
-and a flock of sheep was feeding right beneath the
-cliff on which the scouts were standing.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_206"></a>[206]</span></p>
-
-<p>For a long time Buffalo Bill gazed through his field
-glass at the strange sight, and then without a word
-handed it to Scout Ben.</p>
-
-<p>He, too, looked long and attentively, and when he
-removed the glasses from his eyes Buffalo Bill said:</p>
-
-<p>“How to get down there is the question.”</p>
-
-<p>“There must be some way, sah.”</p>
-
-<p>“I can discover no break anywhere in the walls. We
-must start those people out pretty soon, for it will be
-slow traveling with a wagon train, and we must not
-be caught on the way. Come, we will go after Black
-Bill.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_207"></a>[207]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXIX">CHAPTER XXIX.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE RESCUE.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Black Bill, revolver in hand, lay on the pine straw,
-guarding his prisoners, who were tied to trees in front
-of him.</p>
-
-<p>Neither the negro nor his prisoners heard the scout
-approaching, but the latter heard Rocks saying:</p>
-
-<p>“See here, nigger, don’t you be fool enough to think
-all four of us is goin’ ter hang, and that one of us
-won’t git away, and that we will kill you sure as the
-sun shines if you don’t let us go.</p>
-
-<p>“That fool, Buffalo Bill, has gone off trustin’ you,
-and our horses ain’t far away, so we can all pack some
-provisions on, load up with gold, and be far away
-afore he comes back.</p>
-
-<p>“As you say you are all on foot, ther scouts kin
-never catch us, and you’ll git gold enough to last you
-all your days as a rich man.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’d ruther be a poor honest man than a rich one
-what had betrayed the gemman I owes my life to more
-than one time.</p>
-
-<p>“You gemmen is as bad as you kin be, and I’m onter
-your whole game now, though them in the valley don’t
-know it.</p>
-
-<p>“When dey does, your necks won’t be worth nothin’,
-I is a-thinkin’, gemmens.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_208"></a>[208]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Good for you, black pard.”</p>
-
-<p>The negro sprang to his feet, and was face to face
-with Buffalo Bill and Ben. The four prisoners
-scowled and muttered curses.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, Black Bill, we have found your valley.”</p>
-
-<p>“Done found it, Massa Bill?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, we went through the break in the cliff where
-you so nearly lost your life yesterday.</p>
-
-<p>“I have sent to our camp after the boys; but it must
-have been a very hard and dangerous task, from what
-I have seen of the descent, to get that train down into
-that sunken valley, a very Devil’s Den I would call it.”</p>
-
-<p>“De pass led through and down de side of de cliff,
-sah. It were mighty dangerous fer wagons, sah, but
-all right for de people ter walk.</p>
-
-<p>“Saturday nights dey all went down in de valley
-ober Sunday.</p>
-
-<p>“One Saturday, Massa Bill, all went but four men&mdash;here
-dey is, right here now.</p>
-
-<p>“Dey had been working on de cliff road, blastin’ it
-out wid powder, for we brought our wagons along,
-with plenty of powder, sah.</p>
-
-<p>“Just at sunset dere came what we all thought was
-a ’arthquake or volcano, and de whole front of de cliff
-fell into de valley. Dere was rocks and fire and smoke
-go way up inter de air, and three people in de valley
-was kilt dead.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_209"></a>[209]</span></p>
-
-<p>“When dey all got deir senses de next day, Sunday,
-dey came to de conclusion dat de four men, dese
-very gemmens here, hab let de powder git on fire and
-blew up de cliff and dem, too.</p>
-
-<p>“But I now know dat dese gemmens blowed up dat
-cliff on purposse, sah, dat dey might git all de gold
-what was found in de cañon and keep it. But, Massa
-Bill, dem poor people in de valley was same as in jail,
-for dey couldn’t git out.”</p>
-
-<p>“These four men did prepare that powder mine to
-blow off the edge of that cliff and keep those people
-in the valley, which you call lost, and they were a lost
-people as well.”</p>
-
-<p>Standing on the very edge of the precipice, Buffalo
-Bill began to watch the cliffsides with his glass.</p>
-
-<p>“Try and make them see you, Bill,” said the scout.</p>
-
-<p>The negro fired his rifle, and gave a loud halloo.</p>
-
-<p>Many faces were upturned at once, women and children
-were seen running here and there, and a wild
-cheer arose as the negro was recognized.</p>
-
-<p>The scene was a startling one, for the people in the
-valley were wild with joy.</p>
-
-<p>Writing with a pencil upon several pages of his notebook,
-Buffalo Bill put them in his handkerchief,
-wrapped it around a large stone, and tossed it down
-into the valley. There was a wild rush for it at once.</p>
-
-<p>“I told them that we were here, planning to get them
-out of their valley.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_210"></a>[210]</span></p>
-
-<p>“That I had noticed that the winding trail along
-the face of the cliff had been blocked up where the
-rocks had fallen below, and also that it would readily
-be reached by lariats from here, and we would find a
-way to rescue them.”</p>
-
-<p>“You’ll do it, Massa Bill, and I kin see now, sah,
-dat a few lariats tied together will reach de old trail
-yonder.”</p>
-
-<p>“We can blast the rocks out that fell and choked up
-the trail, and we can bring that whole outfit out of
-that valley, though it may take us a week, perhaps
-longer, to do so.</p>
-
-<p>“I will write them what to do.”</p>
-
-<p>Another note was written and thrown down as before.</p>
-
-<p>Captain John Hill himself picked it up, and his voice
-reached those on the cliff:</p>
-
-<p>“God bless you, Buffalo Bill.”</p>
-
-<p>“If you will spare us some powder, we can blast this
-end clear.”</p>
-
-<p>“There is another pass farther along, which you
-can blast out down to the trail.”</p>
-
-<p>“Good!”</p>
-
-<p>“We will begin work to-morrow, for all my men will
-be here then,” was shouted back in the clear tones of
-Buffalo Bill, and a great cheer told him he had been
-heard, and hope filled every heart.</p>
-
-<p>Within one week the scouts slept in the valley, and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_211"></a>[211]</span>
-the next morning all hands went to work repairing
-wagons, harness, and shoeing the horses and mules,
-while preparations were made by the women for leaving
-the place, which had so long been to them a living
-tomb.</p>
-
-<p>Just two weeks after the arrival of the scouts, the
-march was begun.</p>
-
-<p>One wagon at a time was taken up the ledge trail;
-the women and children followed, then the extra
-horses, and next the cattle, sheep, and all that could
-be carried along.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_212"></a>[212]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXX">CHAPTER XXX.<br />
-<span class="fs70">OUT OF DEVIL’S DEN.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>The march from the Devil’s Den, as Buffalo Bill
-called the sunken valley, was a long one and slow,
-with wagons, stock and all on the move, for chasms
-had to be bridged. Ten miles a day was a fair rate
-of travel at first.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill led the way by the spot where Don
-Miller’s gold had been buried, and this was recovered.</p>
-
-<p>In fairly good time Fort Aspen was reached.</p>
-
-<p>When nearing the fort, Buffalo Bill appointed Don
-Miller as guide to the wagon train, and, with his black
-scouts, he started on a secret expedition.</p>
-
-<p>The chief of scouts had a certain object in view, and
-he wished each one of his men to share the honor
-with him, if the expedition proved to be the success
-he hoped it would.</p>
-
-<p>Of course, Black Bill also went along, for he had
-become the very shadow of Buffalo Bill, and was the
-hero of the whole band of black scouts.</p>
-
-<p>The object of Buffalo Bill was to capture Ginger
-Sam, whom he felt sure he would find at his cabin in
-winter quarters.</p>
-
-<p>At night the cabin was reached and quietly surrounded,
-and at daylight, when the cabin door was
-opened by Ginger Sam, he looked squarely into the
-muzzle of Buffalo Bill’s revolver.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_213"></a>[213]</span></p>
-
-<p>Up went his hands and he said:</p>
-
-<p>“Waal, you wins ther game.”</p>
-
-<p>“I will, when I play my last card, Ginger Sam.”</p>
-
-<p>“What are that?”</p>
-
-<p>“A rope,” was the significant reply.</p>
-
-<p>“You don’t intend ter hang me?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, with four more of your kind I found in the
-Big Horn and whom Major Armes will make short
-work of, as he will you, and that will about clear this
-country of such cattle as you. I knew you were bad
-as they make ’em, but I have a friend who knows you
-to be a renegade and the secret instigator of half the
-Indian deviltry done here. I refer to Don Miller,
-whom the Indians captured, and understanding Sioux
-well, he asked about you, as he thought you might get
-them not to kill him, for once he had saved your life.
-But get your traps ready, for after breakfast we start
-for the fort.”</p>
-
-<p>The next afternoon Buffalo Bill, his black scouts, and
-his prisoner reached Fort Aspen, and the welcome the
-garrison gave them, and also the rescued settlers, for
-they had arrived the day before, was enough to repay
-the men all the hardships they had endured.</p>
-
-<p>“Another one to hang, Cody?”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, he’s a little late, for the other four were
-hanged this morning; but it is never too late to do a
-good act, and there has been a price on that man’s
-head for a long time.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_214"></a>[214]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Yes, the four wretches who proved such traitors to
-the settlers, I had tried at once, and they were quickly
-sentenced, and to-morrow this man’s life shall end,
-for white outlaws must expect no mercy here.</p>
-
-<p>“But, Cody, let me thank you for your splendid
-services in behalf of Fort Aspen and its garrison, and
-believe me, a full report of what you have done shall
-go to headquarters without delay.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_215"></a>[215]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXXI">CHAPTER XXXI.<br />
-<span class="fs70">ANOTHER STRANGE STORY.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>About a week later, Cody returned to Fort Advance
-one night from a lone expedition, just as all the
-garrison were looking upon him as dead, believing
-that he had at last met the doom so many had predicted
-he would, and wondering why he had not long
-before done so.</p>
-
-<p>“Corporal of the guard! Cody is returning,” repeated
-the sentinel, as he recognized a horseman coming
-at a lope over the plain.</p>
-
-<p>And such a cheer as went up at the words of the
-sentinel was seldom heard, for that Buffalo Bill had
-discounted all predictions and again proved his title
-to “bearing a charmed life,” was a joy to one and all
-in the fort.</p>
-
-<p>He looked worn and haggard, and his horse was
-gaunt and weary, as they passed in through the stockade;
-but the greeting was a grand one.</p>
-
-<p>Even Colonel Carr had begun to regard the scout
-as dead, for many anxious days had passed since he
-had left the post on his recent mission.</p>
-
-<p>Straight to headquarters he rode, dismounted,
-turned his horse loose to go to the stable, and was met
-by Colonel Carr on the piazza, so glad was that officer
-to welcome the great scout back again.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_216"></a>[216]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Come in, Cody, and I feel as though I was welcoming
-you back almost from the grave.”</p>
-
-<p>“Not so bad as that, colonel, though I have been
-on a long trail, and a strange one, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“I do not doubt it&mdash;you show it in your face, and
-I was sorry that I allowed you to go on the search.”</p>
-
-<p>“And I am glad that I went, sir, for I found the
-secret valley, and I discovered enough to know that
-the inhabitants need looking after. But I have a new
-plan to submit to you, sir. I’ve found a mystery that
-must be uncovered.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, tell me about your trip.”</p>
-
-<p>“I went on the trail, after leaving Fort Aspen,
-which a Mexican who died there told me to take,
-and it led me into a country seldom traveled, down
-in the land of an old deserted fort, Rosal.</p>
-
-<p>“I struck the Rosal range and found there a large
-lake in a most beautiful valley, situated by itself, for
-all approaches to it are desert lands, beyond which
-no one would suspect to find a garden spot of beauty.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, I have heard only indirectly of such a country
-there, but not that it was settled.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, it is settled, as you shall hear:</p>
-
-<p>“The valley is beautiful, fertile, the surroundings
-well timbered, grass abundant, and there is a large,
-deep lake of clear and icy water.</p>
-
-<p>“I was surprised, I can tell you, sir, when I saw<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_217"></a>[217]</span>
-it, and yet my suspicions were only beginning with
-the first view from the range summit.</p>
-
-<p>“But first, sir, two days ago I ran upon an adventure
-and a strange one.</p>
-
-<p>“As I began to enter the unknown and beautiful
-lake land, I came unexpectedly upon what had been
-once the home, doubtless, of some old Spanish or
-Mexican don; but it was in ruins, almost, and seemed
-to have been long deserted.</p>
-
-<p>“Halting to gaze at it, I was startled to hear voices,
-the first I had heard for days, and in English.</p>
-
-<p>“There was a shot, a cry in a woman’s voice, oaths
-in Mexican, and I knew that some one was in trouble,
-so I rode to the rescue.</p>
-
-<p>“It didn’t last long, for I saw a man in Mexican
-uniform lying on the ground, a young girl near him,
-their horses close by, and they had been held up by
-several outlaws.</p>
-
-<p>“One I dropped, the others skipped, and I found I
-had rescued a Mexican officer and the young girl,
-who, while on a ride had been attacked by road agents,
-who had not expected help near.</p>
-
-<p>“A glancing shot on the head had stunned the officer,
-knocking him from his saddle.</p>
-
-<p>“As the men dashed off and escaped me, for I
-didn’t press them close, I admit, there being more
-than I wanted, one called out: ‘I’ll remember you
-for this, Buffalo Bill.’”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_218"></a>[218]</span></p>
-
-<p>“This showed that he knew you.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“But go on with your strange story.”</p>
-
-<p>“In a few words, sir, the officer had revived, and
-from the young girl I learned that she lived some
-distance away, and the outlaws had sought to force
-from her some secret, what I did not know, and, as I
-felt that the villains believed I had help near, and finding
-out that I had not would return, I urged a quick
-movement to a place of safety.</p>
-
-<p>“The girl and the officer quickly mounted, the latter
-still half dazed from his wound, and I told them
-I would remain behind to check pursuit and then follow
-upon their trail.</p>
-
-<p>“I did remain for a while, then left, but I stuck to
-the trail I had been traveling, thinking that they
-might think there was a crowd if I followed the girl
-and the officer.</p>
-
-<p>“As I rode along I suddenly spied a glittering object
-on the ground, and picking it up I was surprised
-to find that it was a bracelet studded with gems. I
-will show it to you later, for I have it.</p>
-
-<p>“Feeling sure that the lady had dropped it, I retraced
-my steps and picked up their trail, only to
-lose it, and I am certain that they covered up their
-tracks to throw me off the track.</p>
-
-<p>“Search as I might, I could not pick up the trail
-of the officer and the girl, so I gave it up at last and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_219"></a>[219]</span>
-went on to the valley, to halt at a fine ranch I came
-upon and there ask hospitality.</p>
-
-<p>“But to tell you first of this strange valley and its
-people.</p>
-
-<p>“The settlement numbers a thousand people, is an
-adobe village, and the dwellers there are Mexicans,
-with a mixture of Americans and Indians.</p>
-
-<p>“From Silver Lake’s settlement the ranches branch
-out in the valley, and there are some fine haciendas
-among them, the rancheros being rich in cattle and
-horses, and a mixture of Americans and Mexicans of
-the better class.”</p>
-
-<p>“You surprise me, Cody, and interest me greatly,”
-said Colonel Carr.</p>
-
-<p>“I was greatly surprised and interested myself, sir,
-during the two days and nights I was in the valley.</p>
-
-<p>“All seems peaceful there, too, and yet upon that
-valley rests a cruel curse, for it is under a ban of
-outlawry that is most mysterious, and the more terrible
-because the actors are unseen, unknown, and
-therefore secret foes.</p>
-
-<p>“Upon this strange community hangs my mission
-of duty that I ask to go upon.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well?”</p>
-
-<p>“I was struck with the beauty of the valley, the
-apparent wealth of the rancheros, and where I stopped
-was the home of an American, who was half Mexican,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_220"></a>[220]</span>
-for he had had a Texan for his father, who had
-married a lady of Mexico. He received me with the
-greatest hospitality, and we became so friendly that
-he told me that night, as we sat together, of the ban
-upon the fair valley.</p>
-
-<p>“I questioned him closely, for I wished to know
-all that I could discover, and he made known, though
-with considerable dread at doing so, that the curse
-upon the community was from the deeds of a secret
-foe or rather foes. Who that foe was no one could
-tell, and yet he was most in evidence at every ranch
-in the valley, upon which he levied tribute or blood
-money, I may say, and got it.”</p>
-
-<p>“But how did he do this?”</p>
-
-<p>“By a placard stuck on the gate of a ranch house,
-or hacienda, demanding a certain sum to be placed
-in a designated spot on a day or night named, under
-the penalty, if refused, of a death in the family.”</p>
-
-<p>“This must be looked to, Cody.”</p>
-
-<p>“That is just what I am after, colonel.”</p>
-
-<p>“But why do not the rancheros have the nerve to
-put this unseen robber to the test?”</p>
-
-<p>“They have, sir, and to their bitter cost.”</p>
-
-<p>“He has carried out his threats, then?”</p>
-
-<p>“He has, sir, promptly and without mercy, and
-that is why they no longer refuse the demands upon
-them.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_221"></a>[221]</span></p>
-
-<p>“I can hardly wonder at it, when an unseen foe
-strikes at those they love.”</p>
-
-<p>“He does more, sir, for he has taken from each
-home a hostage, keeping them comfortably, as they
-are allowed to write home, but holding them against
-refusal of his demands, and threatens to thus keep
-them until he gains the purpose for which he is striving,
-a certain amount of money, I take it, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“There is no doubt of it, and it is a novel way of
-gaining his ends; but still I believe he can be checkmated.”</p>
-
-<p>“I feel confident of it, sir, and for that reason I
-wish your permission to go to that valley and solve
-that mystery, hunt down that unseen and unknown
-foe.</p>
-
-<p>“You know that Scout Texas Jack brought with
-him a dozen Texans as scouts, and they are all saddle
-sharps, superb lassoists, dead shots, speak Spanish
-more or less fluently, and are utterly fearless.”</p>
-
-<p>“They are all that you say, Cody.”</p>
-
-<p>“Now, colonel, I wish to take Texas Jack and his
-Texans and go to that valley and take possession of
-a deserted hacienda I saw there and turn ranchero,
-buying cattle and horses, and establishing myself there
-for the one purpose of discovering the daring leader
-who thus threatens, robs, and persecutes these people,
-and I am sure, sir, that I can unearth a mystery that
-will fully compensate for our time.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_222"></a>[222]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Cody, you can go, and take the men you ask for.
-You have been there, understand the situation, and
-know what you are doing, so I leave all to you.”</p>
-
-<p>“Now, colonel, as the owner of this bracelet dodged
-me, beyond all doubt, I have it to return to her and
-will do so. Here it is, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“Why, it is worth a small fortune, Cody,” said the
-colonel, gazing earnestly at the handsome bracelet.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_223"></a>[223]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXXII">CHAPTER XXXII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">UNDER A CURSE.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill went on to tell how hard he had tried
-to find the owner of the bracelet, and what he considered
-proof that she and the wounded Mexican
-officer had covered up their tracks.</p>
-
-<p>“I gave that deserted ranch a close call, sir,” resumed
-the scout, “for I was interested in it, and it
-was really a grand old ruin, avoided, as I found out
-later, by all, and feared, for it is known as the Haunted
-Hacienda, and the believers in ghosts all are sure
-that it is the haunt of evil spirits.</p>
-
-<p>“I took it all in and made up my mind that it would
-be valuable for me to haunt when I returned to the
-valley with the force I was going to ask you to let me
-have, and which you have kindly given me.</p>
-
-<p>“I rode on up the valley to the settlement of Silver
-Lake City without meeting a soul.</p>
-
-<p>“That city, as they call it, is beautifully situated,
-and is composed of adobe houses, the people seeming
-to have very little to do. Some mine in the mountains,
-others of the men are cowboys on the ranches
-down the valley, there are several stores, saloons, and
-a blacksmith shop or two, with an old mission chapel
-and a priest. There is a halfway inn there, and if the
-landlord is not a villain, then his looks belie him.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_224"></a>[224]</span></p>
-
-<p>“I told him I was looking for a ranch, and he told
-me there was none for sale.</p>
-
-<p>“I asked him about the deserted hacienda, and he
-said that no one would live there, as it was haunted
-by evil spirits, and he either believed it, or could lie
-with as straight a face as I ever saw.</p>
-
-<p>“He said the place belonged to some one in Mexico,
-who had inherited it; that every one who had last
-lived there had died overnight, from what cause no
-one knew, for there were no signs of violence upon
-them, but all were found dead in the morning, as also
-every horse, cow, sheep, and dog in the walled-in
-place.”</p>
-
-<p>“This is a remarkable story, Cody.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, but he told it as the truth, and there stands
-the deserted hacienda, with the graves, thirty-three in
-number, in one corner of the grounds.</p>
-
-<p>“I asked the landlord as much as I dared, to try
-and find out who the maiden and the Mexican officer
-were. From what I could learn from him, if the one
-I rescued was the one he had in mind, the young lady
-is known as Suelo, the Recluse. She is the daughter
-of a Mexican nobleman, I heard, but lives alone at
-her hacienda, which is a fine one, with only her
-servants and a score of Mexican cattlemen, and all
-appear to worship her.</p>
-
-<p>“But no one in the valley knows much about her,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_225"></a>[225]</span>
-the landlord said, and who the Mexican officer was
-he did not know.</p>
-
-<p>“I did not tell him I had rescued them, but merely
-said I had met them, and her beauty and his fine looks
-and uniform impressed me.</p>
-
-<p>“I called upon the priest, but he was absent, and
-so I determined to bring the bracelet on with me, and
-when I go back I shall look up the owner, and then,
-sir, I shall take the deserted hacienda as my ranch.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, Cody, you are the best judge of just what
-to do; but I assure you I will not only be anxious
-about you, but will watch the result with great interest.
-If you need aid I will give you letters to the
-nearest posts, so you will be able to call on them for
-what men you may wish.”</p>
-
-<p>“Thank you, sir. My idea was to stop at the government
-corrals on my way down&mdash;for you know they
-send the cattle southward to feed in winter&mdash;and borrow
-a lot of steers and horses to drive to my ranch
-and care for, thus carrying out the idea that I had
-gone to the valley to settle and make it my home.</p>
-
-<p>“I shall tell the priest that I will pay rent when the
-owner demands it, and thus keep my taking possession
-of the deserted ranch from appearing a lawless
-act.”</p>
-
-<p>“It would be a good idea. Come to me when you
-are ready to start, and I will give you all letters necessary
-to have you carry out your plans,” said the commandant,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_226"></a>[226]</span>
-and Buffalo Bill departed, to prepare for
-his latest mission.</p>
-
-<p>All the garrison at the fort wondered what was
-going on when they saw Buffalo Bill ride away from
-the post at the head of fourteen of the best scouts,
-most daring Indian fighters, and wildest riders on
-the frontier.</p>
-
-<p>Men and horses had been picked for a purpose, it
-could be plainly seen. They had extra animals along,
-and half a dozen pack mules, well loaded with a camp
-outfit, provisions, and ammunition.</p>
-
-<p>Those that saw them waiting for the start beheld
-Texas Jack, the noted ranger scout from the Lone
-Star State, and next in rank to Buffalo Bill at the
-post.</p>
-
-<p>“Where are you going, Jack?” asked an officer of
-cavalry, passing the squad of wild riders.</p>
-
-<p>“Don’t know, sir. Got orders to get ready for a
-long trail, and am prepared for a fight, foot race, or
-siege, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“I have not heard of any news that causes Colonel
-Carr to send out Cody and his picked saddle sharps,”
-continued the officer.</p>
-
-<p>“Nor have I, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“Have none of the men an idea?”</p>
-
-<p>“Not one, sir, and we are waiting for Cody, now,
-for he has gone to the colonel for last orders.”</p>
-
-<p>As Texas Jack spoke, Buffalo Bill appeared, coming<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_227"></a>[227]</span>
-from the colonel’s quarters. He was splendidly
-mounted and armed.</p>
-
-<p>“Which way, Cody?” asked the major of the post.</p>
-
-<p>“Southward on a scout, major,” was Buffalo Bill’s
-reply, and, saluting, he rode to the head of the line,
-and gave the order to march.</p>
-
-<p>The scouts obeyed, following in two files, Texas
-Jack at the head of one, Winfield leading the other,
-while two men brought up the rear, to keep the pack-mules
-closed up.</p>
-
-<p>That the band of wild riders were curious about
-their going, was certain; but not a hint came from
-their chief, and not a man dared to question him.</p>
-
-<p>The start had been made after dinner, and after a
-ride of twenty-five miles a halt was made for the
-night.</p>
-
-<p>The next day forty miles were placed behind them,
-and the scouts knew that the chief had started upon
-a long journey.</p>
-
-<p>So it went on for day after day, from forty to fifty
-miles being made, the cattle being well cared for, with
-long noonday halts, until the chief of scouts bore
-toward the right, into a land that was unknown to
-his followers.</p>
-
-<p>“We will leave Santa Fe well to our left,” said
-Texas Jack to Winfield one day.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, but why does not the chief give us a hint of
-where we are going?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_228"></a>[228]</span></p>
-
-<p>“He will, in good time.”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, yes; but it is an important trail, I feel sure,
-and connected with his trip southward which he has
-just returned from.”</p>
-
-<p>“No doubt it is; but the government cattle corrals
-must be in this course.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, and I believe we are going after cattle; but
-to-morrow will tell, as the corrals and grazing grounds
-are on the headwaters of the San Juan, and that is
-the way we are pointed now, and we must reach there
-before two more camps.”</p>
-
-<p>The same style of conversation and guesswork the
-other scouts indulged in, and still the chief said nothing
-as to their destination, and all decided that it was
-to the corrals to drive back cattle.</p>
-
-<p>But that night, when they went into camp, Buffalo
-Bill said, after all had had supper:</p>
-
-<p>“Pards, I have had nothing to say as to our mission,
-as there was little to tell you. But, as we strike
-the government corrals at noon to-morrow, I wish to
-say that we are to get there a large herd of cattle, and
-a band of a hundred or more horses.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, we supposed that was what we were going
-for, chief,” said Texas Jack.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill smiled, and replied:</p>
-
-<p>“Colonel Carr thought it best for me not to tell you
-my purpose until we neared the corrals, and then, if
-any of you wished to back out, you could remain there,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_229"></a>[229]</span>
-and I could find other men in your places; but I think
-I picked those men who will stand by me.”</p>
-
-<p>“Just try us!” cried Texas Jack, and the other men
-all cried out in the same vein.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, though we are going to get cattle and horses,
-we drive them south instead of north, and I tell you
-plainly that we are going to a pleasant valley where
-I am to turn ranchero, and you are to be my cattlemen.</p>
-
-<p>“That I do this for other motives than posing as a
-ranchero, you may all be certain, and that there will
-be hot work ahead of us I feel very confident.</p>
-
-<p>“Does any man wish to remain at the corrals?”</p>
-
-<p>The response to this question of Buffalo Bill was
-so earnest that he knew he had nothing to fear from
-any one of his riders.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_230"></a>[230]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXXIII">CHAPTER XXXIII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE HACIENDA.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>After an uneventful journey, Buffalo Bill rode up
-to the little inn where he had before halted, and was
-greeted by the same Mexican landlord, whom he had
-not particularly fancied.</p>
-
-<p>Speaking English well, the landlord recognized the
-handsome scout, and said in a way that was meant to
-be hospitable, but which was full of curiosity:</p>
-
-<p>“Ah, señor, you again come this way&mdash;is your stay
-to be short, as before?”</p>
-
-<p>“On the contrary, Señor Riel, I am here to stay.”</p>
-
-<p>“Ah, señor! you like the Silver Lake Valley, then?”</p>
-
-<p>“Very much.”</p>
-
-<p>“You are a gambler, perhaps, señor, or you have
-no business?”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, no, I am a ranchero, and have come to settle
-down the valley, near the lake.”</p>
-
-<p>“You amaze me, señor, for there is no ranch to
-sell there.”</p>
-
-<p>“There is one unoccupied, and may be for sale.
-I shall take possession of it, herd my cattle in the
-surrounding country, and, when the owner appears,
-will pay him what is just. Now, tell me, Señor Riel,
-if the padre is at home&mdash;&mdash; Oh, I see him there
-now,” and Buffalo Bill walked rapidly away to where<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_231"></a>[231]</span>
-a small, dark-faced man was standing, dressed as a
-Mexican priest.</p>
-
-<p>“The Padre Juan, I believe?” he asked politely.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, my son, but I know you not.”</p>
-
-<p>“No; I am an American, and once passing through
-this valley, decided to find a home here. I called upon
-you, but you were away from home, and I have just
-arrived to settle here.”</p>
-
-<p>“How can I serve you, señor?”</p>
-
-<p>“I have some miles away my cattle and horses, and
-my destination is the old deserted hacienda down the
-valley on the lake. I would ask you if you can place
-me in communication with the owner?”</p>
-
-<p>“I cannot, my son, for the one who fell heir to that
-truly accursed place is a stranger, and was never here.
-It is a blot upon the valley, and will be a home of ill
-omen should you dwell there, which Heaven forbid.”</p>
-
-<p>“I thank you, padre, but my men and cattle are
-near, and to-morrow night I will take possession of
-the ill-omened place, as you call it, with the pledge to
-you to pay what is right for its use. As we are all
-men, we need but little household furniture, and that
-I can buy at your stores here in Silver Lake City.”</p>
-
-<p>“But, my son, let me tell you that this whole valley
-is under a curse, and if you remain here, especially
-within that dreary hacienda with its record of death,
-you but become another upon whom suffering must
-fall.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_232"></a>[232]</span></p>
-
-<p>“I will take all chances, padre, and as the deserted
-hacienda is to be my home, let me say that I will be
-happy to entertain you there whenever you pass that
-way.”</p>
-
-<p>“Thank you, señor, thank you, but only in case duty
-called me would I cross the threshold of that house,
-for it is haunted by the crudest of memories, if not
-worse. I wish you well, señor, but I have warned you&mdash;it
-was my duty.”</p>
-
-<p>Returning to the landlord of the little adobe tavern,
-Buffalo Bill told him that he wished to make some
-purchases, and to get a wagon to take them to the
-deserted hacienda.</p>
-
-<p>“You will go there, then, señor?”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“You do not heed the warnings, then?”</p>
-
-<p>“I am not superstitious, and so warnings of imaginary
-evils have no dread for me; but, if warned of a
-real danger, I heed, as I flatter myself that I am no
-fool.”</p>
-
-<p>The landlord shook his head; and then said he
-would furnish the means of transportation for what
-the señor cared to purchase, and he would take him
-to the best places at which to buy them.</p>
-
-<p>The purchases were soon made, loaded in a wagon,
-and started upon the way for the hacienda, the scout,
-after having dinner at the tavern, starting on after<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_233"></a>[233]</span>
-the men, for they were already well on their way to
-the new home of Buffalo Bill in the mysterious valley.</p>
-
-<p>The wagon was soon overtaken, and afterward the
-herd, and Buffalo Bill said:</p>
-
-<p>“We now camp, pards, and to-morrow early we go
-into our home.”</p>
-
-<p>The night halt was made, an early start followed
-the next morning, and before noon the cattle were
-halted upon the rich meadowland on either side the
-lake, several scouts left to guard them, while the rest
-rode on after their chief, who had gone on ahead to
-the hacienda.</p>
-
-<p>“If that is not an owl’s roost I’m mistaken,” said
-one.</p>
-
-<p>“It may be an outlaws’ retreat.”</p>
-
-<p>“The place may be haunted.”</p>
-
-<p>Some laughed, some did not, others looked grave,
-and said nothing. The superstitions of a few had
-been aroused.</p>
-
-<p>But into the walled-in plaza rode the scouts, followed
-by the wagon, and there stood Buffalo Bill, but
-his left sleeve was stained with blood, his face had
-a bruise upon it, and he had the appearance of one
-who had been in a terrible struggle.</p>
-
-<p>“Boys,” he said calmly, “make yourselves at home,
-for I am master here.”</p>
-
-<p>Telling Texas Jack where to halt the cattle and
-horses, to have a guard of several men over them,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_234"></a>[234]</span>
-and then come on with the others and the wagon and
-animals.</p>
-
-<p>The chief of scouts had cantered on alone to the
-hacienda.</p>
-
-<p>As he approached it, he saw that all appeared there
-as he had left it a month before.</p>
-
-<p>To him it looked as though no one had visited the
-place, and he saw not even a skulking coyote. This
-put him on his guard, for he knew that when he had
-visited the place first many coyotes had run out. Now,
-having found none about, he at once concluded that
-some one had been there within the last few minutes.
-So he was on his guard. Leaving his horse in the
-grounds, he entered the hacienda.</p>
-
-<p>It was a large structure, one story in height, built
-of adobe, and in the center was a square towerlike
-structure, with a top that looked very much as though
-the whole space within the walls, several acres in area,
-could be swept by even revolvers in the hands of persons
-stationed there on the tower roof. In the rear
-was a lofty cliff. It commanded, too, a wide range
-with rifles, and that it was intended for a stronghold
-there was no doubt in the scout’s mind.</p>
-
-<p>There were about thirty rooms in the building, some
-furnished with chairs and bedsteads, but of all else
-the place had been swept clean.</p>
-
-<p>Selecting the rooms that were to be their quarters,
-and being glad to see that the place within the walls<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_235"></a>[235]</span>
-would readily hold all their horses and cattle in an
-emergency when the entrance was repaired, Buffalo
-Bill was passing out through a long and dimly lighted
-corridor, when he beheld before him what appeared
-to be two diamonds glittering in the half darkness.</p>
-
-<p>But he was not deceived, he had seen just such
-balls of fire often before in his eventful life, and he
-was as quick as a flash in dropping his hand upon a
-weapon in his belt.</p>
-
-<p>It was his knife, and he had just time to draw it
-and raise the point, when, with a savage growl there
-sprang upon him a huge mountain lion.</p>
-
-<p>The weight of the animal hurled Buffalo Bill backward,
-and he fell against the rough wall with considerable
-force, bruising his face badly, while he also
-felt the teeth of the mad animal buried in his arm.</p>
-
-<p>But he had got his knife on guard, and the long,
-sharp blade had cut into the heart of the lion, the
-force of the spring driving it to the hilt.</p>
-
-<p>Half dazed by the fall against the wall and the
-blow of the huge body against him, Buffalo Bill yet
-recognized that he must cut, and once more he drove
-his knife deep into the shaggy hide.</p>
-
-<p>But to his joy he recognized that there was no need
-of his doing more, for the animal upon him was a
-dead weight, the first knife thrust had entered his
-heart, and the teeth that had been driven into the
-scout’s arm had not been closed upon it, for the mountain<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_236"></a>[236]</span>
-lion had sprung to a quick and sudden death, the
-keen blade catching, by an accident, just in the right
-spot to kill.</p>
-
-<p>Throwing off the weight, Buffalo Bill arose to his
-feet.</p>
-
-<p>Was it from the concussion that he had received
-that made strange figures appear before his eyes, or
-did he really behold a ghostly form, clad in white, at
-the end of the long, dark corridor, one arm pointing
-straight outward, the other down at the ground.</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll tackle you, too, for ghosts are more to my
-liking than mountain lions,” said Buffalo Bill grimly,
-and he rubbed his eyes to see that they were not deceiving
-him, and, drawing his revolver now he rushed
-forward to grapple with this new foe.</p>
-
-<p>But then, as he felt that it was no vision of the
-brain, but in reality a ghostly looking form, not fifty
-feet from him, he halted and called out in a voice
-that echoed through the corridor:</p>
-
-<p>“Hands up, there, or I’ll fire and kill you!”</p>
-
-<p>But the order was not obeyed, the form still standing
-mute and motionless, and pointing as before.</p>
-
-<p>Instantly came a red flash from the scout’s revolver,
-and a sharp report rang through the hacienda.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_237"></a>[237]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXXIV">CHAPTER XXXIV.<br />
-<span class="fs70">HAUNTED.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill at once moved rapidly toward the spot
-where he had seen the white form. Twice he fired
-his revolver as he approached to light up the scene.
-But he saw nothing.</p>
-
-<p>The rear of the corridor had no egress, only a window
-some eight feet from the floor. Upon either side
-were doors, full a dozen feet from the end of the
-corridor, but one of these was closed too securely to
-open, and the other was the one he had entered the
-long hall from and led into the rooms he had selected
-for himself and comrades to dwell in.</p>
-
-<p>Not a particle of superstition had the scout, but
-here was a mystery he could not solve.</p>
-
-<p>How had the mountain lion got into that corridor?
-He had not entered by the door, for that was closed
-and locked on the other side. He could not have
-come through the window, even had he been able to
-leap that high, for it was closed. The other door was
-locked or bound on the other side, but to have come
-through that way it could only have been done with
-the aid of a human being. All the doors, save the one
-the scout had entered by, were closed. How, then,
-could the mountain lion have got into the corridor
-without human help, and who was the white-robed
-form at whom he fired?</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_238"></a>[238]</span></p>
-
-<p><ins class="corr" id="tn238" title="Transcriber’s Note—“Lighting match after mach” changed to “Lighting match after match”.">Lighting match after match</ins>,
-Buffalo Bill looked about him. He could discover nothing to show how
-the lion and the white form had entered.</p>
-
-<p>There lay the lion dead. The spectral visitant was
-gone. And yet he had aimed to kill, and Cody knew
-that he was not one to miss.</p>
-
-<p>Going out of the door through which he had entered,
-the scout closed it behind him, and, leaving the
-building, walked out into the bright sunlight.</p>
-
-<p>His sleeve was wet with blood, and he was feeling
-weak and a little shaky.</p>
-
-<p>But just as he was going to the brook to bathe his
-wounds, Texas Jack, Winfield, and eight of the men
-came at a canter into the plaza.</p>
-
-<p>They saw that there had been a death struggle, and
-he did not keep them waiting long to know what it
-was.</p>
-
-<p>“I have had a fight with a mountain lion I found
-in the hacienda, Jack, and killed him, fortunately, before
-he did me much harm. Get my medicine case
-from my saddle, and you, Stevens, see just how badly
-he bit my arm, for you are the surgeon of the outfit.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, chief,” answered Stevens, who had gone to
-Texas to practice medicine, but had devoted himself
-to scouting instead.</p>
-
-<p>The chief’s wounds were soon shown, and the
-marks of the teeth of the animal were seen below and
-above.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_239"></a>[239]</span></p>
-
-<p>“It is not nearly as bad as I would expect from the
-teeth of a mountain lion,” said Stevens, whom his
-comrades called “Doc.”</p>
-
-<p>“He must have been small,” said Winfield.</p>
-
-<p>“No, he was large enough. I have him in the hacienda;
-but that is not all I found, boys.”</p>
-
-<p>“I see that your face is bruised and head cut,” Doc
-Stevens said. “What was it, chief?”</p>
-
-<p>“A ghost.”</p>
-
-<p>Some of the men looked startled at this announcement,
-while others laughed.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, boys, I saw a human form, clad in white,
-and, as it did not obey my order to hands up, I fired.
-But I could find nothing when I looked for the dead
-body.”</p>
-
-<p>The words of the chief created an impression, for
-all knew that he was not in a joking humor.</p>
-
-<p>“The truth is, pards,” Cody went on to say, “we
-are not wanted in this valley, and I will tell you why.
-I had no idea that there was such a settlement as this
-in this valley, and I wish to know if you had ever
-heard of it?”</p>
-
-<p>“I have been through here, before, ten years ago,
-and it surprised me then, chief, but I have met no
-one else who knew that there was a settlement here.
-Then its people were Mexicans, Indians, negroes, and
-a few Americans.”</p>
-
-<p>The one who spoke was Lone Star Sam, a handsome,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_240"></a>[240]</span>
-dashing fellow, reserved, courteous, whom his
-comrades regarded as a man with a past that had left
-its impress upon him, for he never spoke of it.</p>
-
-<p>“What did you find out about it, Sam?”</p>
-
-<p>“Very little, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“What brought you here?”</p>
-
-<p>“I was in search of one I was anxious to find, and,
-hearing of this settlement from a Mexican officer, I
-came here to see if my man was here.”</p>
-
-<p>“Was he?”</p>
-
-<p>“He was not.”</p>
-
-<p>“Did you stay long at that time?”</p>
-
-<p>“About a month, chief.”</p>
-
-<p>Then Buffalo Bill told his story, and let the scouts
-understand what discovery he had made, and what
-Señor Otega, the ranchero down the valley, had made
-known to him, though he did not say where he had
-got the information.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, boys, we are here to find out where these
-secret outlaws are. They are doubtless leagued for
-gold alone, but revenge may play a part in their actions
-also. That they have a retreat is assured by their
-keeping their captives as hostages. Where this retreat
-is we must find out. Who they are we must
-know, and when we have set our trap we must spring
-it in a way that will leave escape for none. A dozen
-there may be, perhaps more, to work so well and successfully.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_241"></a>[241]</span></p>
-
-<p>“The landlord&mdash;Riel is his name&mdash;I do not trust,
-so beware of him; yes, and every one else, even the
-Padre Juan in Silver Lake, as he, too, may be a wolf
-in the garb of a sheep, though I think not. Trust no
-one, but keep your eyes and ears open, and be prepared
-at any time to fight for your lives.</p>
-
-<p>“I am, remember, an American ranchero, and you
-are my cattlemen. We are here to stay, you can tell
-the inquisitive, and secretly we are here to ferret out
-the mysteries of this valley.</p>
-
-<p>“The curse that rests upon it is a mystery, the secret
-band of robbers and kidnapers is another, my having
-met that Mexican officer and maiden is a third, while
-the masked man and his four unmasked followers is
-a fourth mystery. Then there is this deserted and
-haunted hacienda, and let me warn you that it has
-begun its underhand work already, for human hands
-led that mountain lion in where I found him, and the
-white-robed form I fired at was no apparition, and
-you are all too sensible to believe that such a thing
-could be.</p>
-
-<p>“Now come up and see our quarters, and get the
-packs off the mules and unload the wagon, for I wish
-to get lanterns, and, first of all, make a thorough
-search of the old place. Where are the two wagon
-drivers?”</p>
-
-<p>“Back with the men I left with the herd, for nothing
-would induce them to come any nearer to this<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_242"></a>[242]</span>
-hacienda, so one of the boys brought the wagon on,
-and when it is unloaded, will drive it back and let
-them skip, for they wish to be well on their way before
-night overtakes them, and swear they would not
-have come a step had the landlord told them where
-they were to take their load.”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill laughed at the fears of the two Mexicans
-who had come with the wagon, and Texas Jack
-went on to say:</p>
-
-<p>“And, chief, those two fellows vowed that there
-was not a man in the valley you could get to come to
-this hacienda, day or night.”</p>
-
-<p>“All right. We don’t want any to come. But we
-are men, and here we remain until I accomplish what
-I came for.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_243"></a>[243]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXXV">CHAPTER XXXV.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE SEARCH OF THE RUIN.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>The corridor of the hacienda was first entered
-through the wing the chief of scouts had selected for
-occupation, and it was seen that all, save the door
-through which he had made his entrance and exit, was
-securely fastened.</p>
-
-<p>Whoever it had been the chief had fired at, could
-only have entered by that single door, as far as could
-be seen.</p>
-
-<p>The rear window was opened then, and showed
-that it had been closed for a long time. So did the
-wide front doors, which filled almost the other end
-of the corridor. But the other doors, save that one
-through which Buffalo Bill had entered, showed plainly
-that they had not been opened for a long while.</p>
-
-<p>That door the chief himself had opened from
-within the wing, and yet the lion had been found in
-the corridor, as also had the white apparition, whatever
-it was.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, if a mountain lion could get in here, a ghost
-ought to. The lion was certainly not a specter brute,
-as I have proof,” said the chief, with a grim smile.
-“We will now look over the rest of the building.”</p>
-
-<p>And they did so, going into each wing, the chapel,
-and the basement in the solid rock beneath it, the
-second story, and up to the tower.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_244"></a>[244]</span></p>
-
-<p>This done, and finding nothing more than that it
-had been the haunt of owls and bats, the party blew
-out their lanterns and returned to the wing where
-their comrades had been hard at work.</p>
-
-<p>With water from the stream, and brooms, they had
-cleaned up the rooms well, a fire had been built in the
-large open chimney, the tables got out, chairs set
-around, the cooking utensils put in the fireplace, the
-bedding placed in the sleeping rooms, and in little
-more than three hours the hacienda, in that wing at
-least, presented a very comfortable appearance.</p>
-
-<p>Then the wagon was returned to the two waiting
-Mexicans, and the broken-down plaza entrance was
-repaired, as it was decided best, for a few nights at
-least, to drive the horses and cattle into the walled
-grounds about the hacienda, so that they would begin
-to understand that it was home.</p>
-
-<p>Just before sunset the stock was driven up, and
-the gateway having been finished, so as to make it
-strong again, it was closed for the night, and the
-scouts went to get supper.</p>
-
-<p>Two guards were appointed for the night, one in
-the hacienda, one at the entrance to the grounds, and
-Buffalo Bill selected men whom he knew were not of
-a superstitious turn of mind, remarking to Texas
-Jack:</p>
-
-<p>“If we put on a man who was looking for ghosts,
-this is the very place to find them, and he would be<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_245"></a>[245]</span>
-alarming us constantly with challenges of apparitions,
-so I just put on men who have no fear of the
-dead.”</p>
-
-<p>“You are right, for though there is not a man in
-the band who would not fight big odds if he knew he
-was facing men, several of the boys would skip at
-the sight of anything in this ruin they did not understand.
-I am sorry that you told them the ghost story.”</p>
-
-<p>“No, it was best, for if this hacienda is the haunt of
-outlaws as I believe it has been, it will be by springing
-the supernatural upon us, that they will endeavor
-to frighten us away.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, that is so, and from that standpoint it was
-best; but the cleverness of that apparition act shows
-that they have some means of getting in and out that
-we are not on to yet, chief.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, it won’t be long before we are, if the men
-are not stampeded by a supposed ghost,” was Buffalo
-Bill’s answer.</p>
-
-<p>In the band of brave men congregated in the hacienda
-that night, about half of them had a superstitious
-dread of the old deserted mission ranch.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill saw just how these men felt, and he
-read the faces of those who had no dread. So he said,
-as all were seated in the ranch waiting to retire:</p>
-
-<p>“Remember, pards, I believe that efforts will be
-made to drive us out of here to-night. Not by direct<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_246"></a>[246]</span>
-force, for, with our numbers, they will not attempt
-any attack.</p>
-
-<p>“But this hacienda is very old. Strange deeds have
-been done here, crimes committed, and most mysterious
-happenings have occurred.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, there is no such thing, as all of you know,
-as spooks and ghosts, for the dead never come back
-to earth in spirit form. But, relying upon the fears
-of many that believe in spooks, wicked men play the
-ghost act to frighten all away from this place for a
-purpose of their own.</p>
-
-<p>“My idea is that this place has been the abode of
-outlaws, and our coming here thwarts their game to
-keep hidden. As they dare not attack us openly, they
-will play the specter game and try and stampede us.</p>
-
-<p>“But that will not go with you, and as an extra precaution
-to-night I will keep four men on duty instead
-of two. Two of you can be together: a couple in the
-hacienda, the others about the grounds.</p>
-
-<p>“But, remember, neither of the guards must move
-into the domains of the others, for my orders are to
-shoot everything on two legs you see prowling about,
-be it ghost or man.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, Jack, you go on duty with three men until
-midnight, and I will relieve you then with three more.”</p>
-
-<p>This plain talk quieted the foolish dread of those
-who had been feeling anxious as to what might happen,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_247"></a>[247]</span>
-and Texas Jack went on duty with three men
-whom he called to follow him, being careful to select
-two of the three whom he knew had an uncanny fear
-of the place.</p>
-
-<p>One of them he left on guard at the hacienda with
-a comrade who had no fear of ghosts, and the other
-he took out in the grounds with him, though showing
-no sign that he suspected either.</p>
-
-<p>The horses were huddled together in one corner
-of the walled-in plaza, and the cattle were in another,
-all quiet and apparently wondering why they were
-penned up.</p>
-
-<p>As the guards left the hacienda the others turned
-in for the night, and were soon fast asleep, Buffalo
-Bill setting the good example by dropping off instantly
-into a deep slumber.</p>
-
-<p>Soon after the guards had gone on duty, the horses
-began to grow uneasy, just why Texas Jack could
-not understand. As they still continued their restlessness,
-he told the man who was with him to stand
-guard at the gateway while he went among the restive
-animals.</p>
-
-<p>But the man preferred to go with him, and he said
-no more.</p>
-
-<p>The two quieted the horses, to find that the cattle
-also were getting restive, and, cowboy fashion, Texas
-Jack began to sing to them, for, as he muttered to
-himself:</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_248"></a>[248]</span></p>
-
-<p>“If they stampeded they may break out, and about
-half the nags will go with them.”</p>
-
-<p>The cattle also became quieted under the weird
-chanting of the Texan, and then the horses once more
-became restive.</p>
-
-<p>“Say, Pinto Paul, you stay about the horses while
-I soothe the split-hoofs with the melody of my voice,
-which can lull them to rest,” said the Texan, in a
-light vein.</p>
-
-<p>“Jack, give me an order to tackle the mate of that
-mountain lion the chief killed, or to brace up against
-a couple of outlaws, and I’ll do it, but don’t expect
-me to play a lone hand, for I don’t intend to do it.”</p>
-
-<p>“You are surely not scared, Paul?”</p>
-
-<p>“I tell you that this is no place for living men
-when the dead are prowling about.”</p>
-
-<p>Texas Jack saw that Pinto Paul was in deadly
-earnest, and he said no more, merely remarking:</p>
-
-<p>“Well, Paul, if you think I am a foil to the ghosts
-we’ll stay together, and we’ll keep by the gate, so as
-to head the cattle if they make a break for it, and I’ll
-keep up my song.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_249"></a>[249]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXXVI">CHAPTER XXXVI.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE FIRST NIGHT.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>The plaintive song of the Texan did have a soothing
-effect upon both cattle and horses.</p>
-
-<p>Thus the time passed away out in the grounds,
-while in the hacienda when all became quiet it seems
-that the spooks began to get in their work also.</p>
-
-<p>The first the guards heard was a low moan which
-sounded like a man in suffering, but just where it
-came from the two guards could not tell.</p>
-
-<p>The superstitious one of the two was for rousing
-the men at once, but his comrade said:</p>
-
-<p>“What for? We see no one, and it is merely a
-trick to frighten us, for the chief is right; this is an
-outlaws’ haunt.”</p>
-
-<p>When there joined in with the moaning the sound
-of a woman weeping, Mustang Frank began to show
-real fright, but Lone Star Sam calmed him, and the
-two listened to the strange sounds. As though a
-man’s moaning and woman’s weeping were not
-enough, there joined as a treble the sound of a child
-crying like one in pain.</p>
-
-<p>“Let’s arouse the chief.”</p>
-
-<p>“No, Frank, it is nearly midnight, and he’ll be on
-hand then. Besides, we cannot shoot, mind. This
-place is haunted by men whose interest it is to frighten
-us away; but we won’t scare a little bit, Frank.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_250"></a>[250]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Speak for yourself, pard, for I’m about scared
-silly this blessed minute.”</p>
-
-<p>Lone Star laughed.</p>
-
-<p>“Listen!” he said. “I thought we would have more
-of it, for hear that dog join in the quartet, only I
-don’t like the music&mdash;ah! here comes the chief.”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill just then came out into the corridor.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, pards, we are having a serenade, I hear.
-But it is time for you to turn in, just twelve, and I’ll
-watch here, while Haskell stands by the outer door;
-but remain on duty until I return from seeing Texas
-Jack.”</p>
-
-<p>“Do you mean any one can sleep, chief, with this
-going on?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, Frank. We were not born in the woods to
-be scared by an owl,” was the answer, and Buffalo
-Bill left the corridor and met Winfield, and the other
-two men who were to go on guard.</p>
-
-<p>They were Haskell and Broncho Rawlings, and
-both of them were very nervous, for they had heard
-the weird sounds echoing through the hacienda.</p>
-
-<p>“Winfield, you and the others come with me to
-where Texas Jack and Pinto Paul are on duty, and
-we will see if they have been disturbed by these outlaws
-playing ghosts.”</p>
-
-<p>On they walked and found Texas Jack having as
-much trouble to soothe Pinto Paul as he had to keep
-the cattle quiet.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_251"></a>[251]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Anything wrong, Jack?”</p>
-
-<p>“The cattle and horses are very restless, and Paul
-thinks ghosts are about, but we have seen nothing,
-though we have heard the howling of a dog and hooting
-of an owl.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, Jack, I will relieve you and Pinto Paul, and
-Broncho Rawlings will stand guard over the cattle
-while I take the gate. You, Winfield, return to the
-hacienda and relieve Sam, taking Haskell with you.”</p>
-
-<p>This was done, Broncho Rawlings taking his stand
-among the cattle, and at once beginning to sing as
-Texas Jack and Pinto Paul had done, for they were,
-indeed, restless.</p>
-
-<p>Winfield and Haskell returned to the hacienda, accompanied
-by Texas Jack and Pinto Paul, who muttered:</p>
-
-<p>“I suppose it will be out of the frying pan into the
-fire in the old ghost nest.”</p>
-
-<p>The men were all awake now, yet not up. But
-Texas Jack showed no dread, simply remarking that
-a ghost would be made of those in reality who were
-playing the spook act, and he turned in.</p>
-
-<p>Pinto Paul, meanwhile, stirred up the fire for light,
-not heat, and sat by it, merely remarking:</p>
-
-<p>“Now, I’m not sleepy a little bit, pards.”</p>
-
-<p>Winfield meanwhile had placed Haskell on guard
-at the outer door of the hacienda, while he went in
-to relieve Lone Star Sam and Frank.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_252"></a>[252]</span></p>
-
-<p>These came into the large sleeping room, and while
-Lone Star calmly went to bed, Mustang Frank joined
-Pinto Paul at the fire, remarking:</p>
-
-<p>“I’m with you, pard, for I always was scared of a
-danger I couldn’t see.”</p>
-
-<p>“Me, too.”</p>
-
-<p>“This old rookery is a graveyard from ’way back,
-and, you bet, ghosts are on the prowl this night, for
-they’ve invited no company, and don’t keep a hotel
-for men in the flesh, such as we are. Just listen to
-that music, will you?”</p>
-
-<p>Weird sounds rang through the hacienda.</p>
-
-<p>When Buffalo Bill had gone into the corridor he had
-intended to relieve Lone Star and Mustang Frank.
-But when he visited the spot where Texas Jack was
-on guard he thought that the entrance to the ranch
-was the best place for him, after he had heard the
-Texan’s report. He knew if the cattle and horses
-were restless some one was causing them to be so by
-prowling about among them, and in some way exciting
-them.</p>
-
-<p>If that “some one” could only stampede the whole
-lot, causing them to break through the gateway, then
-he and his scouts would be in a bad way indeed.</p>
-
-<p>It was true that the gateway had been repaired,
-but not as well as was intended, for timber would
-have to be cut and hauled there to make it secure,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_253"></a>[253]</span>
-and a rush of steers would break down the barrier
-that was there.</p>
-
-<p>That any other demonstration would be made in
-the hacienda than the weird sounds already heard,
-Buffalo Bill did not believe, so he decided that he
-would keep his stand at the gate and let Rawlings
-guard the cattle, singing to them to quiet them.</p>
-
-<p>The moment the others had walked away, Buffalo
-Bill had quickly crouched down in the shadow of
-the wall, just at the entrance. He heard no sound save
-the impatient tramping of the horses, the singing of
-Broncho Rawlings, and an anxious lowing of a frightened
-steer.</p>
-
-<p>An hour passed, and he saw that the horses were
-becoming more restless.</p>
-
-<p>A moment after his keen eyes detected a white
-object running along the wall. It came from the
-corner where the horses were.</p>
-
-<p>Keeping his position, Buffalo Bill watched the
-white object as he could distinctly see it.</p>
-
-<p>The song of Broncho Rawlings was still kept up,
-and the cattle, too, became restive in spite of the
-lulling notes of the melody.</p>
-
-<p>“Broncho soothes them, but if I attempted to sing
-to them I’d stampede the whole outfit, yes, scouts and
-all,” said Buffalo Bill, with a full realization that music
-was not one of his accomplishments.</p>
-
-<p>The chief of scouts was upon the opposite side,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_254"></a>[254]</span>
-crouching in the shadow of the massive adobe column
-on either side of the entrance.</p>
-
-<p>The white figure came straight toward him, and
-had Pinto Paul been where Buffalo Bill was, he would
-have stampeded with alacrity.</p>
-
-<p>The white figure did not seem to be able to see
-well, for the scout had not been discovered yet.</p>
-
-<p>Halting at the entrance, not twenty feet from Buffalo
-Bill, the “ghost” showed what its intention was.
-It intended to break down the barrier, and thus leave
-an open way for the cattle to stampede.</p>
-
-<p>But the entrance had been better closed than the
-midnight prowler in white thought, as it had some
-difficulty in its attempt.</p>
-
-<p>Just then there came from the hacienda, rising far
-above the singing of Broncho Rawlings and all other
-sounds, wild and piercing shrieks.</p>
-
-<p>The ghost seemed determined to break down the
-barrier as he heard the sound, but was suddenly
-startled by the stern command:</p>
-
-<p>“Hands up, there, or I’ll fire!”</p>
-
-<p>A cry broke from the white-robed form, and, with
-a bound, he was off, when sharp, loud, and deadly
-came the report of a revolver.</p>
-
-<p>Just as Buffalo Bill pulled the trigger it seemed as
-though the white form fell heavily, and then Buffalo
-Bill’s voice was heard:</p>
-
-<p>“Turn out, all, to quiet the cattle.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_255"></a>[255]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXXVII">CHAPTER XXXVII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">A DEAD GHOST.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Out of the hacienda came Texas Jack and the
-others, while, springing before the entrance, Buffalo
-Bill called out soothingly to the cattle, the other scouts
-doing the same as they came out.</p>
-
-<p>There was a moment of suspense, but then the herd
-calmed down, as all the scouts, thoroughly trained
-cattlemen, began to sing to them.</p>
-
-<p>Then Texas Jack went to the aid of Buffalo Bill,
-calling out as he advanced:</p>
-
-<p>“Winfield stands guard with several men in the
-hacienda, and I came to see who fired that shot, chief.”</p>
-
-<p>“I did. There is a dead ghost lying yonder, and I
-hope it will end this fool dread of spooks,” was Buffalo
-Bill’s reply.</p>
-
-<p>Seeing that the cattle were being quieted by the
-scouts, Texas Jack walked toward the white object
-lying thirty feet away, at the foot of the high wall.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, Jack, it’s a flesh ghost, isn’t it?” called out
-Buffalo Bill, as he saw his pard bend over it.</p>
-
-<p>“It is, sir, and I’ll call several of the men to guard
-the gate while we carry it up to the hacienda to have
-a look at it.”</p>
-
-<p>“Do so.”</p>
-
-<p>Several men at once came at the call, among them
-Pinto Paul.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_256"></a>[256]</span></p>
-
-<p>“There’s the ghost, Pinto Paul; at least, he is more
-ghost now than he was a short while ago,” said Texas
-Jack.</p>
-
-<p>“What is it?” he asked, in an awed way.</p>
-
-<p>“A dead man, now, who was playing ghost a while
-since. He did not know that I was on duty at the gate
-there, for he heard Broncho Rawlings singing, and
-supposed he was alone on watch.</p>
-
-<p>“As the ghost was trying to take down the barrier,
-to let the cattle out, I held him up, but, as he did not
-heed, I fired on him. I did not fire to kill, but to wing
-him, but just as I pulled trigger he fell into a hole
-I remember is there, and caught the bullet in a vital
-spot. But it shows that spirits can be killed, Pinto.”</p>
-
-<p>The scout made no reply, for he was beginning to
-see that if the hacienda was haunted it must be by
-flesh and blood of ghostly forms.</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll give you a hand, Jack,” said Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>But the Texan dragged the white form out of the
-gully into which he had fallen, and shouldered it
-without an effort.</p>
-
-<p>As he moved off toward the hacienda Buffalo Bill
-joined him, calling out to the scouts to keep the cattle
-quiet, while he went to investigate the ghost in the
-glare of the light.</p>
-
-<p>Arriving at the hacienda, Texas Jack deposited his
-load before the fire, and lighted a couple of lanterns,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_257"></a>[257]</span>
-while Buffalo Bill walked to the corridor where Winfield
-was on guard.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, Winfield, how goes it?”</p>
-
-<p>“All quiet, now, sir; but that shrieking was a bloodcurdler,
-even to me, and I feared it would stampede
-some of the boys along with the cattle.”</p>
-
-<p>“No, we headed them off. But keep your ears open
-for the slightest sounds, now, though I do not believe
-we will have any more disturbances. The ghost is
-laid, I think.”</p>
-
-<p>So saying, Buffalo Bill returned to the large room.</p>
-
-<p>The fire had been brightened up, and, with the light
-of several lanterns, the room was very light.</p>
-
-<p>Texas Jack had laid the form upon the floor before
-the fire, and, with a couple of the men who had come
-in, was standing looking at it. It was clad in a white
-garment, made to resemble a shroud, and the head was
-also wrapped around, though two holes had been
-made for the eyes to peer through. On each side,
-near the belt, there were two slits, through which
-the arms could be thrust.</p>
-
-<p>The white covering was taken from the form by
-Buffalo Bill and Texas Jack, and a dark, foreign face
-was exposed.</p>
-
-<p>“It is a Mexican,” said Texas Jack.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, and he came to kill, if need be.”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill pointed to the belt of arms the man
-wore. He was attired half in Mexican, half in frontier<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_258"></a>[258]</span>
-garb, and his face was an evil one. Also, about his
-waist was a buckskin belt that contained several hundred
-dollars in gold.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, Jack, we need not report the killing of this
-man, at least just yet. We will wait and see if we
-hear of it, and, if so, the man who makes it known
-we will spot. I trust, now, the boys will not fear
-ghosts any more.”</p>
-
-<p>“I hope not, chief.”</p>
-
-<p>“Send each one of them here to have a look for
-himself, and they will know that I was right when I
-said an effort would be made to scare us away from
-here.</p>
-
-<p>“As we did not scare, they will try some other plan
-to get rid of us; but, one thing is certain, that these
-men have some way of entering and leaving the hacienda
-we do not know of, but must find out.</p>
-
-<p>“You see there is not a sound now, for they know
-that one of their spirits has come to grief.”</p>
-
-<p>Texas Jack went out after the men, and they all
-took a look at the “ghost,” made their comments, saw
-where the bullet of the chief had struck him in the
-head, and then the body was put in a vacant room,
-a guard placed in the grounds, at the gate, and the rest
-of the scouts returned to their blankets, Pinto Paul
-remarking:</p>
-
-<p>“Well, I take no more stock in ghosts, though I
-don’t just love this old owl’s nest.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_259"></a>[259]</span></p>
-
-<p>The night passed away without much sleep for a
-few of the scouts. There was not another sound
-heard in the hacienda, and the horses and cattle quieted
-down. This proved to the men that they had been
-frightened by the white-robed form going about among
-them.</p>
-
-<p>The body of the dead Mexican was buried in the
-walled inclosure, while Winfield prepared breakfast
-and put things to rights.</p>
-
-<p>After the meal was over, he and six of the scouts
-took the cattle to graze, while Texas Jack and the
-others started upon a thorough search of the old
-mission ranch. They were anxious to find out just
-where their disturbers of the night before had hidden,
-or, if concealed in the place, how they had got
-into it, and made their exit.</p>
-
-<p>Having posted men here and there on the watch,
-one in the tower, one upstairs, one in the grounds,
-and seen the others start in the search, Buffalo Bill
-put on his best rig and rode away, his men wondering
-where, and why he had dressed up. He rode his best
-horse, carried a rifle slung to his saddle, and seemed
-prepared to meet friend or foe.</p>
-
-<p>That he carried no provisions along, after saying
-that he would not return until night, was also a surprise
-to the scouts, who knew that their chief was
-not one to miss a meal except on compulsion.</p>
-
-<p>Down the valley rode the scout, and, following the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_260"></a>[260]</span>
-lake shore its length, he turned, after going half a
-score miles, in a trail leading to the left toward the
-mountain range on the eastward.</p>
-
-<p>Up among the foothills he saw a fine hacienda
-which he knew was the place where he had spent the
-night in passing through the valley a month before.</p>
-
-<p>Toward this he wended his way, for he wished to
-talk with Señor Otega.</p>
-
-<p>The señor it was who had told him of the secret
-band of robbers in the valley, of the curse that rested
-upon the people, and this had influenced him in coming
-there to solve the mystery, to hunt down the outlaws.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_261"></a>[261]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXXVIII">CHAPTER XXXVIII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">ON SECRET WORK.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill did not care to trust even Señor Otega
-with any secrets, for he knew not who he could place
-confidence in; but, having now come to the valley,
-being on the spot, he might find out from the señor
-some information that might be of value to him.</p>
-
-<p>He wished to see just who the maiden he had rescued
-was, who the band of outlaws might be, when
-Señor Otego had said that not one of the secret foes
-of the people in the valley had ever been seen.</p>
-
-<p>Then who was the officer in the Mexican uniform,
-and why was he in the valley thus attired, why the
-victim of these men?</p>
-
-<p>It was to get at the bottom facts, as well as he
-could, that Buffalo Bill had started upon his visit to
-Señor Otega.</p>
-
-<p>As he neared the ranch he saw the cattle and horses
-feeding near, the cowboys, five in number, guarding
-them and gazing curiously at him, and to these he
-nodded as he rode near, and said pleasantly:</p>
-
-<p>“Good morning, pards.”</p>
-
-<p>They returned his salute in silence, and were evidently
-surprised at seeing a stranger.</p>
-
-<p>Going on up to the hacienda he saw Señor Otega
-just about to mount his horse, but discovering him,
-he turned toward him, and said:</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_262"></a>[262]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Why, señor, you in our valley again? You are
-welcome, I assure you.”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill responded to the questions, and then
-said:</p>
-
-<p>“But my coming prevents you from going on a
-ride, I fear?”</p>
-
-<p>“No, for I can go another time, as there is no
-great hurry. I was merely intending to ride over to
-see the stranger who had taken possession of the old
-mission ranch and urge that he give up such a thought,
-for I deem it my duty to advise him.”</p>
-
-<p>“Thanks, señor. Do you know who he is?”</p>
-
-<p>“An American of wealth, I believe, who came
-here with his people, cattle, horses, and all.”</p>
-
-<p>“Permit me to say, señor, that I am the one. I took
-possession yesterday.”</p>
-
-<p>“You surprise me.”</p>
-
-<p>“And it is a surprise to me that you should know
-it so soon.”</p>
-
-<p>“I learned it last night, from my men. But, señor,
-I am the more distressed, now, as I learn you are the
-man, for I like you, and to go to that terrible place
-is but to go to your doom.”</p>
-
-<p>“Not so bad as that, I hope, Señor Otega. The
-fact is, I fell in love with your beautiful valley, and,
-anxious to find a home, I decided to settle here, and
-the old hacienda was the only place I could get. So
-I came here from the northward, bringing my cattle,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_263"></a>[263]</span>
-horses, outfit, and cowboys with me, and I assure you
-we shall be most comfortable. You see, I took an
-early opportunity to call upon you.”</p>
-
-<p>But Señor Otega seemed to be lost in thought, and
-said, in an absent-minded way:</p>
-
-<p>“Come in, come in! Why did you come to this
-valley, señor?”</p>
-
-<p>“To settle here, at least for a while.”</p>
-
-<p>“You have your people with you?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, all of them, and real men, too.”</p>
-
-<p>“I am glad. But why did you seek a home beneath
-that doomed roof?”</p>
-
-<p>“Do you remember telling me the curse that rested
-upon this valley? You told me that your daughter
-had been taken from you by an unseen foe.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“Has she been restored to you?”</p>
-
-<p>“Alas, no! She is still a prisoner. Only yesterday
-I paid the tax of one thousand pesos put upon me.”</p>
-
-<p>“It is an outrage.”</p>
-
-<p>“It is the seventh I have paid, señor, and I believe
-there are to be five more, if not still more, before
-she is returned to us.”</p>
-
-<p>“And other families pay this same tax?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, señor.”</p>
-
-<p>“It is infamous.”</p>
-
-<p>“But they do not all pay the same sum, señor, for
-the taxgatherer knows well the circumstances of each<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_264"></a>[264]</span>
-of his victims, and collects accordingly. He does
-not put upon any one a sum that cannot be paid, for
-when I pay a thousand, a poor man pays a hundred,
-and one pays five thousand pesos, señor.”</p>
-
-<p>“Who is that?”</p>
-
-<p>“A young girl, the Señorita Suelo Sada, known as
-The Fair Hermit.”</p>
-
-<p>“Ah! who did you say she was?”</p>
-
-<p>“One left a large fortune by a kinsman, who owned
-the ranch where she lives, and she came here to
-dwell, but receives no visitors, has no friendships,
-and lives such a life of utter seclusion we call her here
-in the valley the hermitess, the beautiful recluse, and
-other such names.”</p>
-
-<p>“Who of her family are with her?”</p>
-
-<p>“Not one.”</p>
-
-<p>“Does she dwell all alone?”</p>
-
-<p>“All alone, señor, save her servants and cattlemen,
-of whom there are quite a number, but they, too, hold
-themselves aloof from all others, and the stockmen
-are known as the hermit cowboys.”</p>
-
-<p>“Then how can these secret taxgatherers, as we
-may call them, make a demand upon the Señorita
-Sada for so large a sum, as they cannot have any of
-her loved ones, señor?”</p>
-
-<p>“Ah, but they have. She is betrothed to a Mexican
-officer, I hear, and he came here on a visit to her, was
-seized on his way home, and is now held a prisoner<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_265"></a>[265]</span>
-by these men whom no one knows. I learn the demand
-is made upon her regularly for five thousand
-pesos, and she pays it.”</p>
-
-<p>“Is the officer a man of any prominence?”</p>
-
-<p>“He is a captain of lanceros, señor, in the Mexican
-army.”</p>
-
-<p>“It is strange that his government has taken no
-steps to release him.”</p>
-
-<p>“There is a threat to put him to death if such an
-attempt is made.”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill did not tell about his rescue of the fair
-hermit and the officer.</p>
-
-<p>“Do you know his name, señor?”</p>
-
-<p>“It is said to be Del Sol.”</p>
-
-<p>“You know the padre in Silver Lake City.”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, yes, Padre Juan.”</p>
-
-<p>“Can he do nothing to help you?”</p>
-
-<p>“He is under a ban also&mdash;a threat&mdash;if he does.”</p>
-
-<p>“And the landlord of the inn? The Señor Riel?”</p>
-
-<p>“Señor Cody, I do not like that man, I do not trust
-him, though he, too, is under the ban, as his son, an
-only child, is a prisoner. Still, I have a dread of
-him.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, Señor Otega, the secret foe can only capture
-me or one of my men, to get a ransom, and we’ll
-watch that they do not.</p>
-
-<p>“I did not come here to pay ransom to robbers;<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_266"></a>[266]</span>
-but I came here to settle, and I like our home, haunted
-though it may be.</p>
-
-<p>“I told you that I intended to help you, and I am
-here to do so; but, remember, not a word of that to
-any one, for it might thwart my plan.”</p>
-
-<p>“I will be silent, señor, for something tells me you
-are here for good, to be relied on. I was going over
-to the old mission ranch to warn whoever had settled
-there to leave, for I did not know it was you.
-Are you sure that nothing disturbed you last night?”</p>
-
-<p>“We heard sounds, the cattle were restless, but no
-harm befell us, señor, and we’ll take chances, for that
-is what we are here for.”</p>
-
-<p>“How many men have you, señor.”</p>
-
-<p>“I thought it best to bring at least half a dozen,”
-was Buffalo Bill’s evasive reply, for he did not wish
-his force to be known, even to Señor Otega. He had
-not allowed the two Mexicans who drove the wagon
-from Silver Lake City to see more than six men beside
-himself, keeping the others off beyond the cattle.</p>
-
-<p>“It will be best to have just double the number they
-think I have,” was the chief of scouts’ way of thinking.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill remained to dinner at the hospitable
-ranch, and the señora, a sad-faced, lovely woman,
-gave him a warm greeting, for she had been pleased
-with his frank and genial manner upon his last visit
-to their home.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_267"></a>[267]</span></p>
-
-<p>Late in the afternoon the scout started upon his
-return, the señor accompanying him a few miles on
-the trail.</p>
-
-<p>Learning that he had just moved in, the Señora
-Otega insisted that she be allowed to add to his comfort,
-and when he was ready to go he found a pack
-horse ready for him to carry along, and it had been
-loaded with grapes, vegetables, preserves, and a large
-quantity of choice provisions, which the good lady
-insisted that he must accept from her.</p>
-
-<p>“Just turn the pack horse loose to-night, and he
-will come home and give you no further trouble,”
-said the señor.</p>
-
-<p>The scout was touched by the señora’s kindness,
-and as he rode away with her husband, he said:</p>
-
-<p>“You told your wife, then, that I was here to help
-you?”</p>
-
-<p>“Not a word, señor; but I told her when you left
-a month ago that you were Buffalo Bill, the great military
-scout, and had promised to be our friend; and,
-with a woman’s quick intuition where her love is interested,
-she feels sure that you have come to save our
-poor daughter.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, I saw that she was trying to read me, and I
-appreciate her kind gifts to make me comfortable.
-We will enjoy her bounty greatly.”</p>
-
-<p>As they reached the lake shore the sun was touching
-the horizon, and the señor halted.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_268"></a>[268]</span></p>
-
-<p>“I will turn back here, Señor Cody, for my wife
-will be anxious. You see, we have lately received
-quite a handsome legacy, and if it were known, then
-our secret foes would capture me or my wife and
-demand a much larger ransom.”</p>
-
-<p>“Then return home at once, and I regret that you
-came thus far with me.”</p>
-
-<p>“You have the most dangerous trail to travel, Señor
-Cody, and a long ten miles.”</p>
-
-<p>“I am used to dangerous trails, señor, but if I
-thought danger might beset you I would return with
-you.”</p>
-
-<p>“Not unless you remain all night, señor.”</p>
-
-<p>“I could not do that. The ghosts in the old hacienda
-might put my men to flight.”</p>
-
-<p>The sun had now sunk behind the western range of
-mountains, and the lake valley was already darkening
-under the fall of night.</p>
-
-<p>“That man is all right, for he told me of a legacy
-lately received. I came here prepared to doubt every
-one, but I’ll set him down as a square man,” muttered
-Buffalo Bill, as he rode along the lake shore,
-under the shelter of the fringe of timber, beneath
-which led the trail up the valley.</p>
-
-<p>Señor Otega had turned his horse toward home,
-and set out at a rapid canter.</p>
-
-<p>Reaching a belt of timber, the animal was walking
-along at his ease, the night having set in, when, without<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_269"></a>[269]</span>
-a warning, there settled over the señor’s head a
-coil of rope, and he found his arms pinioned to his
-side, while he heard the words in Spanish:</p>
-
-<p>“Resist, Señor Otega, and you are a dead man. I
-have men here to master you.”</p>
-
-<p>Señor Otega thought first of his wife, and he
-groaned in agony of spirit.</p>
-
-<p>“What does this outrage upon me mean, for you
-call me by name, and hence know me?”</p>
-
-<p>“It means that you are a prisoner, and the Señora
-Otega will be taxed to keep you alive,” was the reply.</p>
-
-<p>Señor Otega now, to his chagrin, saw that he had
-been lassoed by one man, and he had seized his bridle
-rein and stood by him, with a revolver leveled at his
-head.</p>
-
-<p>But there came a flash, a report, and the kidnaper
-sank in his tracks by the side of the señor’s horse.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_270"></a>[270]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXXIX">CHAPTER XXXIX.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE SCOUT’S RETURN.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>At first thought Señor Otega had believed that he
-had been the one shot at, and as his horse set a good
-example of flight, he determined to encourage him
-in it, believing there were other outlaws about.</p>
-
-<p>But ere the horse had made half a dozen bounds,
-a voice called out:</p>
-
-<p>“Ho, señor, I fired that shot!”</p>
-
-<p>Señor Otega recognized the voice at once. It had a
-ring in it that once heard could not be forgotten. So
-he wheeled his horse, and rode back to find the one
-who had rescued him standing by the side of the fallen
-outlaw.</p>
-
-<p>“Señor Cody!”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes; I had a dread that your coming with me as
-far as you did might get you into trouble, so I turned
-back to dog your steps, unseen by you, and see you
-enter your ranch in safety.”</p>
-
-<p>“How glad am I that you did, señor!”</p>
-
-<p>“I was not very far behind you, nearer you than I
-thought, for you must have slackened your speed, and
-I distinctly heard the voice of your captor.</p>
-
-<p>“I instantly sprang from my saddle, and, advancing
-on foot, realized that you had been captured, and I
-saw one man, but took the chances of there being
-more.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_271"></a>[271]</span></p>
-
-<p>“As he was an outlaw, I thought it best to put him
-out of the way.”</p>
-
-<p>“God bless you,” was all the ranchero could at first
-say.</p>
-
-<p>But he soon conquered his emotion and told just
-what his captor had said to him.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill listened attentively, and then said
-abruptly:</p>
-
-<p>“This man was sent to kidnap you?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“Is he alone?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“His being there shows that he saw you leave your
-home, was watching your return, shadowing you in
-fact.”</p>
-
-<p>“No doubt of it, señor.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, I wish you to be guided by me in this matter.”</p>
-
-<p>“I will.”</p>
-
-<p>“Say nothing, even to your wife, of this attack on
-you to-night. I mean that no one must know of this
-attack on you, señor.”</p>
-
-<p>“But why, Señor Cody?”</p>
-
-<p>“This man was sent to do this work. If he does
-not return to report, they will not know what has
-become of him, for I shall strap his body upon his
-horse, which must be near, take the animal to the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_272"></a>[272]</span>
-lake, lead him in, and thence along the shore in the
-water to a spot near my ranch.</p>
-
-<p>“I will search the body for any telling articles there
-may be on it, and will hide away his saddle and bridle.”</p>
-
-<p>“But the horse, señor?”</p>
-
-<p>“I will give him into the keeping of my men for a
-day, and after they have branded him and disguised
-him, his own master, if alive, would not know him,
-and one of them will ride him, so he will not go back
-to his home, at least, not just now.”</p>
-
-<p>“You know what you are about, Señor Cody?”</p>
-
-<p>“I hope so. Now we will find that horse, mount
-his master on him, and I’ll lead him back through the
-timber, not in the trail.”</p>
-
-<p>“And your horse, señor?”</p>
-
-<p>“Is trained, señor, and will keep always in the trail
-as I start him until we reach the lake shore, and there
-I will mount him.”</p>
-
-<p>“What will this dead man’s comrades think?”</p>
-
-<p>“In my opinion they will track him, find his trail
-leading here, then back to the lake, where they will
-lose it.</p>
-
-<p>“They will see that your horse was halted here,
-remained for some time, and the tracks will reveal
-that two men were here, their comrade and you. They
-will take my footprints for yours, so you must not
-dismount.</p>
-
-<p>“But when I have removed the body, you must<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_273"></a>[273]</span>
-move your horse about all over the spot, to mark
-out all traces of where it lay, for the ground is soft,
-I notice, beneath my feet. Then you go on homeward,
-and continue to gallop until you get there.”</p>
-
-<p>“But that will not explain that dead man’s absence?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, for they will believe that, being alone, when
-he captured you, why you simply bribed him to let
-you go.”</p>
-
-<p>Going into the timber, Buffalo Bill was not long in
-finding the horse of the outlaw, and the body of the
-dead kidnaper was tied across the saddle with his
-own lariat, and then the animal and that of Señor
-Otega were moved all about, until every trace of
-where the man had fallen had been destroyed.</p>
-
-<p>Bidding the señor good night, and promising to
-pay him another visit in good time, Buffalo Bill walked
-back to his own horse and the pack animal, turned
-toward the old ranch, threw the rein of the other
-over the saddle horn, and started them off at a walk.</p>
-
-<p>Then he returned to the kidnaper’s horse, and led
-him through the timber, and then back over the two
-miles to the lake shore. There he overtook his horse
-and the pack animal, and they were taken into the lake,
-but at different points.</p>
-
-<p>Along the beach, ankle deep in the lake, they continued
-their way, over the miles that lay between the
-point where they had entered the water and the old
-Mission Ranch.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_274"></a>[274]</span></p>
-
-<p>At last the scout left the lake at a place where his
-trail led direct to the hacienda. He saw the glimmer
-of a light there, and he knew that it must be at the
-gate, and placed as a beacon to guide him home. Not
-a horse or a steer did he see, and he felt that they
-had all been driven into the grounds again for safety.</p>
-
-<p>As he neared the gate, the cheery voice of Texas
-Jack called out:</p>
-
-<p>“Is that you, chief?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, Jack.”</p>
-
-<p>“We were getting anxious about you, and not one
-of the men has retired.”</p>
-
-<p>“What, more ghosts?”</p>
-
-<p>“Not the shadow of one, but the men wished to
-remain up to see if you came in all right.”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, yes, I am all right. But I have a pack animal
-loaded with good things, for I have been off on a
-visit, and, Jack, I have another horse here, with his
-dead master upon him.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, walls have ears, they say, and for fear the
-old hacienda may have some secret closets where foes
-are watching, I do not wish the men to breathe a word
-of this dead man.</p>
-
-<p>“First, he must be searched, then buried to-night
-in the grave with the other one, and his horse must
-be disguised.”</p>
-
-<p>“I understand, chief.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_275"></a>[275]</span></p>
-
-<p>“In the morning drive the cattle and horses over
-my trail to the lake.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, chief.”</p>
-
-<p>Feeling that he could leave all to Texas Jack, Buffalo
-Bill dismounted and entered the walled-in
-grounds, discovering that the men had during the day
-made a barrier that nothing could break through.
-Then he went on to the hacienda, for he was both
-tired and hungry.</p>
-
-<p>The men welcomed their chief in a way that showed
-how glad they were to see him back, and that they felt
-a most warm regard for him.</p>
-
-<p>But he said nothing of his adventure other than to
-tell them to go out and see Texas Jack.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill had no desire to say anything in the
-hacienda that other ears than those his words were
-intended for should hear. He was very suspicious
-about the old structure, for, though it seemed one
-could discover if there were secret closets about it, he
-very well knew that such had not been found out, and
-they were certainly there.</p>
-
-<p>This was proven by the mountain lion in the corridor,
-the sounds of moaning and weeping, and the
-howling of a dog the night before. Those sounds
-could only have been made by persons in concealment.</p>
-
-<p>The scouts had discussed the matter among themselves
-when out of the place, and off from it, for the
-chief had warned them about talking when in the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_276"></a>[276]</span>
-hacienda, and, where they could understand that men
-could have uttered the moans and other sounds, they
-could not comprehend just how the weeping of a
-woman and the voice of a child could have been heard.</p>
-
-<p>“Pards, those ghosts must enter here by way of
-the cliff up yonder, so to-night we’ll put a strong
-guard there to head them off,” said Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>And so it was planned for the next night.</p>
-
-<p>Going out to Texas Jack, they saw the dead body,
-and it was quietly buried; then they took the horse
-in hand, and soon had him cleverly metamorphosed.</p>
-
-<p>The saddle and bridle were taken into the hacienda
-and hidden, and all were told that they must utter not
-a word within the house that they did not wish to be
-known as there might be eavesdroppers whom they
-did not wish to know their plans.</p>
-
-<p>This all attended to, Texas Jack went up to the
-hacienda to report, and that also he had what had
-been taken from the dead man put away for inspection
-on the morrow.</p>
-
-<p>There was a guard of four men that night, two in
-the hacienda, two in the grounds.</p>
-
-<p>Soon after midnight Buffalo Bill was awakened by
-low groans. Where they came from he could not
-tell. He arose in the darkness, and tried to trace the
-sound to its source. But in vain.</p>
-
-<p>Lone Star was on guard in the corridor, but he, too,
-knew not whence they came.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_277"></a>[277]</span></p>
-
-<p>Then followed the sound of weeping in a woman’s
-voice, as upon the night before.</p>
-
-<p>“Go, Sam, and see if there is any disturbance
-among the cattle. I will keep watch until you return,”
-said Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>Lone Star left, and the chief took his stand just in
-the middle of the corridor, and listened attentively.</p>
-
-<p>As he listened, there was heard the wailing of a
-child, as though in pain. And the moans, the weeping,
-and the wailing continued.</p>
-
-<p>“It all comes from the center of this hacienda,
-either from overhead or from underneath, which I
-cannot tell,” mused the scout.</p>
-
-<p>Suddenly there rang out the wild, piercing shriek
-of the night before.</p>
-
-<p>For a moment Buffalo Bill was startled, so close to
-him did it seem.</p>
-
-<p>The men were all awakened by it, and upon their
-feet in an instant.</p>
-
-<p>There was an alarm sounded, but just then Lone
-Star Sam returned, and reported the horses and cattle
-quiet.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, and the same game must be played here to
-quiet these ghosts,” said Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>Lone Star had heard the shriek, for it had even
-reached the men on guard at the gate. He said every
-scout was up and ready for business.</p>
-
-<p>“This must not be,” said Buffalo Bill. “They must<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_278"></a>[278]</span>
-pay no attention to any sounds they hear, and then
-we will master the situation.”</p>
-
-<p>This order was given secretly to each one of the
-men, and they returned to their beds, though some
-did not care to sleep, as that unearthly shriek still
-echoed in their ears.</p>
-
-<p>The morning dawned, and then Buffalo Bill gave
-orders to each man to retire the next night early, and
-to pay no attention to moans, groans, weeping, wailing
-or shrieks.</p>
-
-<p>“We will disappoint them, pards. And more, only
-one man need stand guard to-night in the hacienda,
-and one at the gate.</p>
-
-<p>“If there is cause for alarm, a pistol shot will be
-the signal to bring up to the spot where we are needed,
-but remember, nothing less than seeing a ghost to-night
-counts, for hearing them is nothing.”</p>
-
-<p>These orders were given away from the hacienda,
-where no one could hear, if concealed within the walls.</p>
-
-<p>The men to guard the cattle left early with the herd
-and the horses, and the trail of Buffalo Bill’s horse
-and the led animals was blotted out to the lake.</p>
-
-<p>One of the men even rode the horse of the dead
-kidnaper out on duty.</p>
-
-<p>His heavy tail had been thinned out more than
-half, as also had his bushy mane, while two brands
-had been put upon him that looked old. This was
-done by folding a cloth, saturating it in water, placing<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_279"></a>[279]</span>
-it upon the side of the animal, and then holding the
-red-hot brand against it until the hair was scalded off,
-but the flesh not burned.</p>
-
-<p>This gave it an old look, and the horse certainly
-would not be known by the man who had owned him.</p>
-
-<p>Just at midnight a low moaning was heard. As
-the wind had come up, and was whistling about the
-old hacienda, it made the moaning seem more dismal
-than ever. Then deep groans were heard.</p>
-
-<p>A few scouts moved uneasily at this, but no one
-rose, no one spoke.</p>
-
-<p>The weeping of a woman followed, without causing
-any disturbance among the sleepers, if any one
-was really asleep. Next was heard the plaintive wailing
-of a child.</p>
-
-<p>Still no one stirred. A few minutes after there was
-a perfect chorus of these melancholy sounds, and still
-the scouts lay quiet.</p>
-
-<p>Suddenly, without warning, the same unearthly,
-terrible shriek which had before brought all the scouts
-to their feet echoed through the old hacienda.</p>
-
-<p>To say that some of the scouts started would be
-but the truth. But all had their orders from Buffalo
-Bill, and not a man moved. The shriek had caused
-hardly any more disturbance than had the moans,
-weeping, and wailing.</p>
-
-<p>But, as though angry at having remained unnoticed,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_280"></a>[280]</span>
-the shrieker sent forth peal after peal, until Buffalo
-Bill called out:</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, quit that racket, ghost, and go back to your
-grave; for we can’t help you.”</p>
-
-<p>The scouts laughed, and in a moment the sounds
-ceased altogether.</p>
-
-<p>Nothing more disturbed the night’s rest, and the
-morning dawned with the secret sleuths the victors.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill rose early, and while breakfast was
-being got ready he went out and scaled the cliff.</p>
-
-<p>“Pards, to-night some of us will camp out upon
-that cliff,” he said upon his return.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_281"></a>[281]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XL">CHAPTER XL.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE SHOT ON THE CLIFF.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>The secret sleuths all seemed particularly pleased
-with their chief and themselves, when they felt that
-they had not been turned out of their beds by the
-carrying on of the “ghosts” during the night.</p>
-
-<p>Those who had been most superstitious took heart
-also, and began to feel that the “dead folks” were not
-so much to be dreaded, after all.</p>
-
-<p>The guard at the entrance had reported that the
-cattle had shown no restlessness, and he had neither
-seen nor heard anything to alarm him, save the wild
-shrieks up at the hacienda.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill had picked out four men to accompany
-him to the cliff, when night came, to remain there on
-watch.</p>
-
-<p>A guard was also to be stationed in the tower, one
-at the gate and another at the entrance of the living
-wing.</p>
-
-<p>In case of an alarm five more scouts were to hasten
-over the wall, and, led by Lone Star, who knew the
-way, go to the help of those upon the cliff.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill had selected to accompany him Texas
-Jack, Kit Kingdon, Rio Grande Dick, and Blue Jacket
-Bob, all of them splendid fellows in a close fight.</p>
-
-<p>And all were to take their rifles along.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_282"></a>[282]</span></p>
-
-<p>They were to carry their blankets as well, so that
-all could sleep except one who watched.</p>
-
-<p>Quietly they slipped out of the gate, after dark,
-and, Buffalo Bill leading the way, they went around
-the wall to the cliff and began the steep climb by the
-aid of the trees.</p>
-
-<p>It was no easy task by day, and doubly dangerous
-in the darkness.</p>
-
-<p>But the climb was made in safety, and when the
-plateau was reached the five men formed a line, and,
-spreading their blankets upon the ground, lay down to
-watch.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill had taken the center position, and he
-told his men that they could go to sleep, as he would
-remain on guard and call them if he had any grounds
-for alarm.</p>
-
-<p>The men were thus stretched right across the
-plateau from one cliffside to another, and about a
-hundred yards apart, just over the ranch.</p>
-
-<p>But though each man spread his blanket, he did not
-go to sleep.</p>
-
-<p>All were too anxious to make some discovery that
-would enable them to entrap the outlaws.</p>
-
-<p>If there was an alarm, they were to rally toward
-their chief, and if their foes proved too numerous
-they were to give a signal for help from the hacienda,
-and then retreat toward the cliff overlooking it.</p>
-
-<p>Midnight came and passed without any sound, and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_283"></a>[283]</span>
-then Texas Jack, who held the end position on the
-right, beheld a form in white coming from the cliff
-that looked down from the range over the plateau,
-and which rose several feet above it. He was instantly
-on the alert, and expecting that the one he saw was
-not alone, he dared not yet give the alarm.</p>
-
-<p>Nearer and nearer drew the form in white, gliding
-quickly along, until suddenly Texas Jack called out
-sharply:</p>
-
-<p>“Halt! Hands up!”</p>
-
-<p>There was a startled cry, a quick shot at random
-toward Texas Jack, and the white form was off like
-a deer toward the cliff.</p>
-
-<p>Seeing that he must get away, Texas Jack raised
-his rifle and fired as the shadowy form was disappearing
-in the darkness.</p>
-
-<p>Instantly all was excitement on the plateau, the
-scouts rallying quickly toward Texas Jack, who had
-darted forward in pursuit, calling to his comrades to
-follow.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill was the first to reach his side, and he
-was bending over a man lying upon the ground and
-groaning with pain.</p>
-
-<p>“Stay and see what you can get out of him, Jack.
-Blue Jacket, run to the cliff and give the alarm for
-Lone Star Sam and his party to come in. Dick, light
-those lanterns and have them ready, but under cover,
-and then all of you follow me.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_284"></a>[284]</span></p>
-
-<p>With these orders Buffalo Bill moved rapidly on
-toward the cliff, and as quickly as possible his men
-followed, two of them with lanterns.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill reached the cliff of the range rising
-above the spur, and as the others came they stretched
-out along its base.</p>
-
-<p>Blue Jacket Bob called out to say that Lone Star
-Sam and the others were coming, and in a quarter of
-an hour they were on hand, and half a dozen lanterns
-were following like fireflies along the wall of rock
-which towered above the plateau.</p>
-
-<p>But not another soul was seen, nothing was found,
-and the whole cliff seemed to be nowhere scalable.</p>
-
-<p>But the scouts kept up their search until the dawn,
-determined to see then if there was any discovery that
-could be made.</p>
-
-<p>Stevens, the surgeon, had been called to the wounded
-man, and as Buffalo Bill went to where he lay, just
-as day broke, he found the scout doctor seated by
-his side, Texas Jack having left the unfortunate fellow
-to his care.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, doc, how is he?”</p>
-
-<p>“Perfectly conscious, sir, but he will utter no
-word.”</p>
-
-<p>“His pallid face shows that death is not far off.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir; I have told him that he must die, that
-he can live but an hour or more, and that I could do
-nothing for him, though I have tried. But the wound<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_285"></a>[285]</span>
-is mortal.” Stevens showed where the bullet had torn
-its way.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill knelt by the side of the dying man,
-who was beyond doubt an American, for his hair was
-light in hue, and his eyes dark blue. He was dressed
-in buckskin leggings, a blue woolen shirt, moccasins,
-and a slouch hat, but, in strange contrast, about him
-was wrapped a large white robe, intended to be white,
-though much soiled. He had had on a belt of arms,
-but it had been removed by Texas Jack to make him
-more comfortable.</p>
-
-<p>The man’s blue eyes rested upon Buffalo Bill with
-a strange expression in them.</p>
-
-<p>“My poor fellow, I am sorry I can do nothing for
-you,” said Buffalo Bill kindly.</p>
-
-<p>The man shook his head.</p>
-
-<p>“Can you not talk?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.” The word was distinctly uttered.</p>
-
-<p>“Will you not tell me if I can serve you in some
-way?”</p>
-
-<p>Again the wounded man shook his head.</p>
-
-<p>“Why were you playing ghost, for you thus brought
-your death upon yourself?”</p>
-
-<p>No reply.</p>
-
-<p>“Have you no kindred, no friends to whom you
-wish to send a last word?”</p>
-
-<p>“I will leave no word.”</p>
-
-<p>“But would it not be best?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_286"></a>[286]</span></p>
-
-<p>“No.”</p>
-
-<p>“If you wish your friends to know of your death,
-upon my word I will not tell them what you are.”</p>
-
-<p>“Let me die in silence.”</p>
-
-<p>“Doc, can you not give him something to relieve his
-sufferings?”</p>
-
-<p>“He refused it&mdash;he will soon be beyond suffering.”</p>
-
-<p>Just then Texas Jack approached, and as he did so
-Buffalo Bill said:</p>
-
-<p>“Texas Jack, the poor fellow is dying, but will
-utter no word to commit himself or betray his comrades.”</p>
-
-<p>The blue eyes of the dying man rested upon the
-face of Texas Jack in an earnest way:</p>
-
-<p>“Jack Omohundro, I know you. We were boys
-together in far-away Virginia. And your hand has
-ended my career. So be it, for I might have met a
-worse death&mdash;&mdash; Ah! I see that you know me now,
-but do not betray me here, nor to the people at home,
-who believe me dead years ago. Give me your hand,
-Jack.”</p>
-
-<p>Into the bright eyes of the Texan, who had witnessed
-many a death scene, came tears that rolled
-down his bronzed cheeks, as he grasped the hand,
-while he said softly:</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, Ned, I know you, my boyhood friend. We
-never dreamed of this in those old days. I will not
-betray you.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_287"></a>[287]</span></p>
-
-<p>The Texan’s form quivered with emotion, and a
-smile swept over the face of the dying man.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill’s fine face grew stern as death, but it
-was to force back the flood of feeling that rushed
-upon him, and Doc Stevens hastily drew his sleeve
-across his eyes.</p>
-
-<p>“Jack, I will atone all I can for my evil past, I will
-tell you that which will let me die easy in mind, for
-it will save many from sorrow and suffering, yes, and
-some lives, too&mdash;listen to me while I can talk.”</p>
-
-<p>The scouts walked away, but the dying man recalled
-Buffalo Bill, who had removed his broad sombrero,
-as Texas Jack’s fell from his bowed head.</p>
-
-<p>Bold, fearless, reckless fellows that they were, the
-scouts all saw that their chief was respecting a death
-scene, even though it was an outlaw that was dying.
-They beheld the attitude of their lieutenant, Texas
-Jack, saw that his hand clasped that of the dying man,
-and they bared their heads in compassion, for they
-knew that there was some link that bound the two
-together.</p>
-
-<p>Later came the last words of the dying man:</p>
-
-<p>“Jack, old friend, good-by.”</p>
-
-<p>All heard the words, saw the smile, and then beheld
-the ashen hue deepen on the face of the dying man,
-as the end came.</p>
-
-<p>Texas Jack folded the hands upon the breast, and
-wrapped the white shroudlike robe about the form.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_288"></a>[288]</span></p>
-
-<p>“He was my boyhood friend, pards, and as he asked
-me to keep his secret it will die with me,” said the
-Texan. And to his dying day Texas Jack never
-made known the identity of the outlaw.</p>
-
-<p>After the body of the dead outlaw had been decently
-buried down in the ranch graveyard, Texas
-Jack motioned to the chief of scouts, and the two
-walked apart together.</p>
-
-<p>“You heard his strange story?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, Jack.”</p>
-
-<p>“And who the leader of these secret foes is?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, he is known as El Diabolo, the Cowboy King,
-is feared by everybody, and is the chief of cowboys
-on the ranch of the girl hermit.”</p>
-
-<p>“And you will act upon the information he gave
-us, Bill?”</p>
-
-<p>“Of course, but not too hastily, as I wish to make
-a clean sweep of all the guilty ones, and have none of
-the innocent suffer.”</p>
-
-<p>“You are wise in that; but if you could trust your
-friend, Señor Otega, he might help greatly.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, but I’ll know just who to trust before I make
-a move. I shall make a visit to Silver Lake City
-and see how matters are there, for I wish to see the
-priest, and also have a talk with Riel, the innkeeper.
-In fact, I expect to go on a still hunt and be much
-away, so you take full control here, and at the right
-time we will act and make no mistake.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_289"></a>[289]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XLI">CHAPTER XLI.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE FIGHT IN THE SLEUTHS’ CAMP.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Several days passed away, and Buffalo Bill was absent
-from the camp, for, acting under his orders,
-Texas Jack had encamped his men outside of the hacienda
-and away from its immediate surroundings.</p>
-
-<p>The chief of scouts was what the men called “playing
-a little game,” in this, for it could give those who
-haunted the hacienda the idea that the scout sleuths
-were afraid to stay there any longer.</p>
-
-<p>The truth was that Buffalo Bill was on a still hunt
-of detective work, and each one of his men was aiding
-him all in his power.</p>
-
-<p>The scout had not been gone a day from the camp
-before visitors began to drop in there, a thing that
-had never happened while they were at the hacienda.</p>
-
-<p>Just how it happened Texas Jack and his men did
-not know, or if they did they kept it to themselves;
-but trouble came, and at night, when the scouts were
-away from the camp.</p>
-
-<p>Blue Jacket Bob and Rio Grande Dick were the
-two men left in camp, and following the arrival of
-three strangers came a fatal fight.</p>
-
-<p>To the surprise of Blue Jacket Bob, two of the
-cowboy visitors were from the ranch of Señor Otega,
-and the other was from the hacienda of the fair hermit,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_290"></a>[290]</span>
-and known to belong to the band who served
-the cowboy king, the Señorita Suelo’s chief of cowboys.</p>
-
-<p>Perhaps they had expected to find only one guard
-at the cowboy camp and rob it; but the two men they
-found there had proven more than a match for them.</p>
-
-<p>When Buffalo Bill returned to camp he found Texas
-Jack and the men, save two, off on scouting duty; but
-of those two one was dead, Rio Grande Dick, and Blue
-Jack Bob was wounded.</p>
-
-<p>With Buffalo Bill came Señor Otega.</p>
-
-<p>Doc Stevens had joined his chief back on the trail,
-fortunately as it proved, and as the three rode into
-camp there stood Blue Jacket Bob in the moonlight,
-and he called out:</p>
-
-<p>“Doc, I have a wound in my arm for you to dress,
-and it needs it, for I could not go to look you up,
-being all alone in camp.”</p>
-
-<p>“Why, where is Rio Grande Dick?”</p>
-
-<p>“I am sorry to say, sir, that he is dead.”</p>
-
-<p>“Dead! How was it, Bob?”</p>
-
-<p>But Buffalo Bill could see that Blue Jacket Bob
-was suffering, and he insisted that he should not make
-a report until his wound had been tended.</p>
-
-<p>This was now done by Doc Stevens, who said:</p>
-
-<p>“It is not dangerous, but he has lost considerable
-blood. Here is the bullet&mdash;give him a drink, please.”</p>
-
-<p>The bullet had been extracted from the shoulder,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_291"></a>[291]</span>
-a drink of brandy was given the wounded man, and
-as soon as he was made comfortable he said:</p>
-
-<p>“There lies poor Dick over there, chief.”</p>
-
-<p>“How was it, Bob?”</p>
-
-<p>“You see that man lying yonder?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“He was one of the cowboy king’s men.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, I remember him, and next in authority to
-him,” said Señor Otega.</p>
-
-<p>“I guess he was; there is his horse hitched where he
-left him. He came to our camp with two men. One
-said to us that they had brought a friend of theirs
-over who wanted to know us, and he had some fine
-liquor and cigars, and wished us to join him. I said
-that we did not drink, but would smoke with them,
-and asked them to be seated.</p>
-
-<p>“We all sat down here, and were talking when he
-called out suddenly: ‘Now!’</p>
-
-<p>“The three men, with that, at once drew their revolvers
-and turned them on us.</p>
-
-<p>“But, though we were taken by surprise, we are
-quick on the draw, and our revolvers were going off
-with theirs, and for a second or so it was lively here.</p>
-
-<p>“We all sprang to cover of the timber, of course,
-and so we had it.</p>
-
-<p>“I don’t think it lasted half a minute, and then I
-found I was the only one standing up, and I was
-wounded.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_292"></a>[292]</span></p>
-
-<p>“I walked over to where those three traitors lay,
-but they were dead. I then went to poor Dick. He
-was gasping, but murmured something about a plot
-to kill us. Then he grasped my hand, and the poor
-boy was gone.”</p>
-
-<p>As he spoke, Bob brushed tears from his eyes, and
-there were others who felt the drops trickle down
-their bronzed cheeks as they thought of their dead
-comrade.</p>
-
-<p>The scouts had listened with rapt attention to Blue
-Jacket Bob’s story, and Buffalo Bill said:</p>
-
-<p>“Bob, you have done nobly, old fellow, and there is
-proof lying before us of your plucky fight against
-odds. Now, señor, what is your opinion of the treachery
-of your men to-night?”</p>
-
-<p>“They came to rob this camp, señor, and failed,
-though they had one of the fair hermit’s cattlemen as
-an ally.”</p>
-
-<p>“What a pity that they all got killed, that we cannot
-entrap one alive, or wound and capture one!”</p>
-
-<p>“It is, indeed, a pity, Señor Cody. But you recall
-that I told you the secret foes had spies on every ranch,
-or were suspected of having?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, Señor Otega.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, these two were the spies, doubtless, on my
-ranch.”</p>
-
-<p>“I see.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_293"></a>[293]</span></p>
-
-<p>“And the other man was a comrade of theirs, and
-hence a spy on the ranch of the fair hermit.”</p>
-
-<p>“I guess you are right.”</p>
-
-<p>“Now, what is to be done with these bodies, for
-poor Dick we will take with us for burial at the
-ranch?”</p>
-
-<p>“It would be best if you ride over with me and report
-the affair to the alcalde.”</p>
-
-<p>“Who is he?”</p>
-
-<p>“The landlord, the Señor Riel.”</p>
-
-<p>“All right,” and to Texas Jack, who just rode up:</p>
-
-<p>“Jack, you and three others be within call if I
-need you, for I may have to shoot the alcalde,” said
-Buffalo Bill, to the surprise of Señor Otega, who
-cried:</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, señor!”</p>
-
-<p>“If ever there was a scamp, Señor Otega, that landlord
-is one, and I shall stand no nonsense with him.”</p>
-
-<p>“All right, sir, and you’ll find us within call,” said
-Jack.</p>
-
-<p>With this, Buffalo Bill and the Señor Otega
-mounted their horses and rode away from the camp.
-Texas Jack, Lone Star Sam, and Mustang Frank following
-soon after.</p>
-
-<p>The landlord was found in the Fandango Hall, at
-Silver Lake City, but he was called into his office by
-Señor Otega, who said at once:</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_294"></a>[294]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Señor Alcalde, we have an unfortunate affair to
-report to you.”</p>
-
-<p>“The Señor Cody I suppose has killed some one?”</p>
-
-<p>The look the man got from the scout made him
-wince, but the words were calmly uttered:</p>
-
-<p>“You must not jump at conclusions, sir, or I might
-be tempted to punish impertinence. I am here to report
-to you that two of our men were left to guard
-camp, while the rest were away. We returned to find
-that one of our men had been killed, the other
-wounded, and the three men who had gone there to
-rob the camp were lying dead, having been shot by
-our comrade, Blue Jacket Bob.”</p>
-
-<p>“This is bad, very bad.”</p>
-
-<p>“The three men were those whom we had reason to
-believe friends, for two were Señor Otega’s cowboys,
-and the other was a cattleman of the band of the cowboy
-king, and he it was who arranged the robbery,
-which ended in the loss of their lives.”</p>
-
-<p>“This is bad, very bad. I must demand the man
-who did this killing, and while the Señor Otega goes
-to fetch him I will hold you as hostage, Señor Cody.”</p>
-
-<p>“You shall neither take Blue Jacket Bob, nor will
-you keep me here. I have reported the facts, and it is
-a pretty state of affairs when we cannot protect our
-camp and our lives. If you wish a trial, name the day
-and we will be here.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_295"></a>[295]</span></p>
-
-<p>“And I will guarantee on bond, Señor Alcalde, for
-the appearance of the accused man,” said Señor Otega.</p>
-
-<p>“I must have a guarantee from them also.”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill laughed and replied:</p>
-
-<p>“You doubt my word, and I have reason to doubt
-you, and, in fact, do. No, I’ll pledge my word, and
-remember, the Señor Otega here shall give no bond
-for us, and we will be here on the day you set for
-trial.”</p>
-
-<p>“I wish a guarantee.”</p>
-
-<p>“See here, Landlord Riel, you shall have one. With
-your own people you would consider this justifiable
-killing of three robbers and murderers. We are here
-in this valley as are others, and you shall not make
-us an exception.”</p>
-
-<p>“But I must punish murder,” said the landlord, all
-in a tremor.</p>
-
-<p>“There was no murder, save the killing of my poor
-comrade by those men who were murderers and robbers.
-Blue Jacket Bob acted in self-defense, and I’ll
-tell you to your face, if you dare to attempt to hold me
-a prisoner, or arrest my comrade, I’ll make known to
-these people the confession of one of those three men,
-and a dying man does not lie.</p>
-
-<p>“I alone know that confession, Landlord Alcalde,
-or whatever you choose to call yourself, and I will
-make it known, and leave it for you to prove that
-dying lips lied.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_296"></a>[296]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Do you grasp my meaning as I intend you shall,
-Señor Riel?”</p>
-
-<p>Señor Otega stood amazed at the bold words of
-Buffalo Bill. He knew perfectly well that there had
-been no dying confession; he was surprised and
-startled at the daring shown by the scout, and flinging
-into the face of a man whom every one in the valley
-feared, a charge of guilt, as it were. He glared at
-the alcalde, expecting a terrible outbreak.</p>
-
-<p>Instead, he saw that his face was livid, that his lips
-were drawn back from his white teeth like a snarling
-dog, and that they were clicking together with a nervous
-chill.</p>
-
-<p>“Señor Otega retire a moment, please, for I wish to
-ask our friend here of this man’s confession.”</p>
-
-<p>The voice of the alcalde was hardly audible.</p>
-
-<p>A glance at Buffalo Bill, and the Señor Otega saw
-a sign for him to go.</p>
-
-<p>“I will soon join you, señor, as the alcalde will
-not detain me long,” said the scout pleasantly.</p>
-
-<p>When the door closed behind Otega, the alcalde
-said in a low tone:</p>
-
-<p>“Who made this confession you speak of?”</p>
-
-<p>“I do not know the name of the man of the cowboy
-king’s band,” was the evasive reply.</p>
-
-<p>“Ah! it was he?”</p>
-
-<p>“Shall I tell you that the confession appeared like
-that of a man who sought to destroy you, alcalde; but<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_297"></a>[297]</span>
-where there is smoke you will always find fire, and
-were I to speak there are plenty to listen, though I
-myself might not believe that you can be guilty.</p>
-
-<p>“Suppose we square this matter by your giving me
-a discharge for my comrade; in other words, that he
-acted in self-defense, and you bury the three bodies at
-your expense.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, yes, señor, that will do, for I have no desire
-to prosecute you or your comrades. You are strangers
-in our valley, and I will give you the paper asked, and
-in return your lips are sealed about the confession of
-that dying man. As you said, it was the malignant
-confession on the eve of death, to ruin me, for we
-had had some trouble several times, and there is not
-a word of truth in it.”</p>
-
-<p>“I did not tell you what he had said.”</p>
-
-<p>“No, no.” The alcalde looked most anxious.</p>
-
-<p>“Just write out the paper for my pard, please&mdash;his
-name is Robert Mead, nicknamed Blue Jacket Bob.”</p>
-
-<p>“I see.” The alcalde hastily filled in a discharge
-and handed it to the scout, saying as he did so: “Now,
-there is no charge, you know.”</p>
-
-<p>“Thanks, señor.”</p>
-
-<p>“Now, what did that wicked man have to say about
-me?”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, I heard enough to know you were in some
-way allied to these secret foes of the valley, and kept<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_298"></a>[298]</span>
-by fear of death of making known all that you are
-aware of.”</p>
-
-<p>“Nonsense, señor, utter nonsense! Still, it is best
-not to let it be known that I had such a charge against
-me, and you are not to speak of it, you know.”</p>
-
-<p>“Not one word I ever heard from that dying man
-against you, señor, shall ever pass my lips, at least as
-long as you don’t forget.”</p>
-
-<p>“Then that will be all right. I will call in the Señor
-Otega, and you are to have a glass of wine with me.”</p>
-
-<p>“Thanks, but I do not often drink; the Señor Otega
-never does, and you must excuse us. But you will
-send over after the bodies, for we shall leave camp
-to-night.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, I will return with you, with two of my men,
-and take them in charge.”</p>
-
-<p>Señor Otega was again surprised when the alcalde
-and the scout came out together, and as Texas Jack
-saw them approaching he and his comrades hastened
-back to camp.</p>
-
-<p>The alcalde had two men and a wagon to follow
-him, and the bodies of the three robbers were taken
-back into the settlement, where there was already
-plenty more work for the landlord in his magisterial
-capacity, there having been a riot in the Fandango
-Hall, and half a score of men lay around dead, while
-many more were wounded.</p>
-
-<p>“Those three dead from our camp will fit in with<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_299"></a>[299]</span>
-the ones slain at the fandango,” said Señor Otega, as
-he rode with Buffalo Bill as they started on their
-homeward trail just before dawn.</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, yes, the alcalde will fix things up all right, and
-I have Blue Jacket Bob’s acquittal paper here,” replied
-Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>“And, señor, how did you manage it?”</p>
-
-<p>“Easy enough.”</p>
-
-<p>“Well, you played the boldest game I ever saw, and
-you are the first one who ever frightened Alcalde Riel,
-I assure you. Why, not one of those men made a
-confession.”</p>
-
-<p>“No, but if he thought they did, and he was guilty,
-it was just as well as though they had.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, just as well.” Señor Otega was lost in admiration
-at the bold deed of Buffalo Bill in bringing
-the alcalde to terms.</p>
-
-<p>Back to his ranch went Señor Otega, while Buffalo
-Bill and his men returned on the trail that would take
-them by the way of the temporary camp where poor
-Rio Grande Dick had lost his life.</p>
-
-<p>The chief of scouts found that his orders to get
-ready to return to the haunted hacienda had been carried
-out, and all were in readiness for the move.</p>
-
-<p>Rio Grande Dick had been given decent burial, and
-the men felt that their chief had been doing some
-splendid secret-service work during his short absence
-from them.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_300"></a>[300]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Pards, I have found out enough to convince the
-most skeptical of you, that is the most ardent believer
-in ghosts, that every spook we will have to deal with
-can be brought down with a bullet,” said Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>“I have gleaned certain information that fastens
-the crimes in this valley upon a man, yes, men whom
-no one suspects; but what we do now will bring the
-guilty to the end of their rope.</p>
-
-<p>“Though you did not know it, there was one of
-our band left alone and in hiding in the haunted hacienda,
-and what he discovered proved that we are
-on the right track.”</p>
-
-<p>Though Buffalo Bill did not even hint as much,
-the men were sure that their chief had been that lone
-watcher in the ruins of the fatal ranch.</p>
-
-<p>Continuing in his easy way, Buffalo Bill said:</p>
-
-<p>“Now, men, we return to that old spook nest next,
-and we stay there until we lay the ghosts, mark my
-words.</p>
-
-<p>“All I ask is for each man to give me his full support,
-and we’ll soon strike the end of our trail.”</p>
-
-<p>The answer was a cheer, and the march was taken
-up for the fatal ranch.</p>
-
-<p>If there was one of the scouts who longer felt dread
-of the ruin, that is, a superstitious dread, he did not
-show it.</p>
-
-<p>The place was again occupied, and after a talk with
-the men, before they reached the hacienda, it was<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_301"></a>[301]</span>
-agreed by one and all that not a word should be uttered
-there that would in any way give their plans
-away.</p>
-
-<p>That night a move would be made by Buffalo Bill
-which should lay the foundation for the laying of the
-spooks, and all were on the eager watch for what was
-to come.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_302"></a>[302]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XLII">CHAPTER XLII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">A STARTLING VISIT.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Night came and Buffalo Bill was on guard at the
-gate with Winfield.</p>
-
-<p>The cattle and horses had not been driven in, as the
-scouts had returned home, and there were enough for
-four for night duty and four for day duty, with the
-others to look to the duties about the hacienda, and
-be ready for any service they might be called upon
-to do.</p>
-
-<p>As Buffalo Bill had signified his intention of going
-on an expedition the next day, he carried his blankets
-down to the entrance to sleep there, and have Texas
-Jack call him.</p>
-
-<p>Jack awoke the chief just at dawn, asking:</p>
-
-<p>“Now, what does it mean, chief?”</p>
-
-<p>“I am going to make a call&mdash;in fact, a couple of
-them, for I shall dine with Señor Otega, and from
-there go on to the hacienda of the fair hermit.”</p>
-
-<p>“Do you mean it, chief?”</p>
-
-<p>“Certainly.”</p>
-
-<p>“Don’t go there.”</p>
-
-<p>“Is it the fair hermit you distrust, or her cowboys?”</p>
-
-<p>“It is the king of the cowboys I have no faith in,
-and his men will do as he tells them, as my dying
-friend said.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_303"></a>[303]</span></p>
-
-<p>“I do not doubt that.”</p>
-
-<p>“He is bitter over our coming here, as all of them
-are, and he will seek to do you harm in some way, I
-am sure.”</p>
-
-<p>“My dear Jack, that is just why I want you and the
-boys along.”</p>
-
-<p>“Ah!”</p>
-
-<p>“You are to follow my trail, you know, and, stopping
-at the Otega ranch later in the afternoon, some
-time after my departure from there, he will give you
-a couple of men to accompany you, guiding you to the
-hacienda of the fair hermit.</p>
-
-<p>“You can then go as near as you dare, meet me
-upon my departure, and on the return, instead of
-having one man to waylay, as they will expect, they
-will find half a dozen, and I will not fall into the
-trap.”</p>
-
-<p>“I see.”</p>
-
-<p>“I do not know that they would kill me, I rather
-think they would not; but just now I wish to take no
-chances&mdash;wish to keep out of trouble&mdash;as I am playing
-a little secret game myself, which you will all be
-let into as soon as I make a discovery or two I hope to.</p>
-
-<p>“Now, follow in a couple of hours, and when you
-reach the Otega ranch go there alone, leaving the men
-in hiding.”</p>
-
-<p>With this Buffalo Bill rode along the trail, now
-well known to him, leading to the home of Señor<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_304"></a>[304]</span>
-Otega. He was watchful as he rode along, as he
-deemed it necessary that he should be.</p>
-
-<p>It was within half an hour of dinner time when he
-reached the Otega ranch, and he was received by the
-señor and his lovely wife most cordially.</p>
-
-<p>“You are going to be our guest for several days, I
-hope?”</p>
-
-<p>“Thank you, no, for I must go on my way this
-afternoon.”</p>
-
-<p>“I am sorry; but we will soon have dinner.”</p>
-
-<p>Señora Otega left the room to see to it, when the
-señor remarked:</p>
-
-<p>“Now, which way, señor, for I am sorry to see you
-alone on a trail?”</p>
-
-<p>“I have company, sir, but they are not visible.”</p>
-
-<p>“Good!”</p>
-
-<p>“My friend, Texas Jack, will be here this afternoon,
-and will you give him a couple of men whom you feel
-that you can really trust as guides?”</p>
-
-<p>“I can give him a dozen men, Señor Cody, but candidly,
-and with shame I say it, I know of but one man
-on my ranch whom I would fully trust. The fact is,
-I do not know in whom to place confidence. They
-may be all faithful, and yet one may not be so, and
-that one might be the person I select for you.”</p>
-
-<p>“That is very true.”</p>
-
-<p>“But one man I am sure of, Palma, my cowboy
-chief, and he will go with you where you please.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_305"></a>[305]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Thanks, señor, he will do, and if you will allow
-him to go with Texas Jack I will feel obliged.”</p>
-
-<p>“But you, señor?”</p>
-
-<p>“I am going to make a visit, señor, to the hacienda
-of the fair recluse.”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, señor!”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, and I wish you to give me full directions for
-reaching there.”</p>
-
-<p>“I will, yet&mdash;&mdash; I do not wish to see you go there.”</p>
-
-<p>“Why not?”</p>
-
-<p>“The cowboy king.”</p>
-
-<p>“Is not the Señorita Suelo a protection upon her
-own ranch?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, but&mdash;&mdash;”</p>
-
-<p>“Well?”</p>
-
-<p>“She will not see you.”</p>
-
-<p>“I will make the trial at least.”</p>
-
-<p>“But why go there?”</p>
-
-<p>“I have a special desire to see her.”</p>
-
-<p>“In your mysterious but seemingly sure way you
-are working for an end, señor, and I say Heaven
-speed you.”</p>
-
-<p>“When I come back from my visit to the hacienda
-of the Señorita Suelo, I will get your cowboy chief to
-come to the Mission Ranch for a visit of several days,
-and he will guide us around to the other side of that
-range, for up there is the retreat of the secret foes.”</p>
-
-<p>“I believe you are right. But I also will go, for<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_306"></a>[306]</span>
-you, a stranger, must not run all the risk in working
-for us here in this valley, who have suffered at the
-hands of the secret foes. I will accompany you, señor,
-and you may need my aid, as well as that of Palma.”</p>
-
-<p>“I shall be only too happy to have you go, señor,
-for I shall go there for work, deadly work.”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill rode away from the home of Señor
-Otega half an hour after he had enjoyed one of the
-señora’s most substantial dinners.</p>
-
-<p>The ranchero was sorry to see him go, yet he was
-beginning to feel that all the scout understood he
-would accomplish. He had given him full directions
-for reaching the hacienda of the fair recluse.</p>
-
-<p>It was situated down the valley from him, at the
-foot of the lake, and just half a score of miles from
-the Otega ranch.</p>
-
-<p>As he drew near it, after a brisk ride, Buffalo Bill
-was glad to discover that there were innumerable
-hiding places for Texas Jack and his men, and their
-approach could not be seen by any one in the hacienda.</p>
-
-<p>Some of the cowboys herding cattle gazed at the
-scout with interest as he rode along, but he seemed
-neither to avoid nor care to meet them.</p>
-
-<p>One, however, rode in such a way as to cross his
-trail, and he said, as he drew near:</p>
-
-<p>“Going to the hacienda, señor?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes.”</p>
-
-<p>“The cowboy king is not there.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_307"></a>[307]</span></p>
-
-<p>“I wish to see the Señorita Suelo.”</p>
-
-<p>“She receives no strangers, señor.”</p>
-
-<p>“I shall at least try to see her.”</p>
-
-<p>“It will be useless.”</p>
-
-<p>“Has she not cattle and horses for sale?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, señor, but the cowboy chief attends to that.”</p>
-
-<p>“In his absence who does?”</p>
-
-<p>“You will have to come again, señor.”</p>
-
-<p>“I will ride on, however, and request to see the
-señorita.”</p>
-
-<p>“It will only be refused.”</p>
-
-<p>“Very well, I can then turn back. But when will
-the cowboy king return?”</p>
-
-<p>“To-night, señor.”</p>
-
-<p>Thanking the man, Buffalo Bill rode on, and soon
-approached the heavy gate of the hacienda.</p>
-
-<p>A man stood within, looking through a small window,
-and said, somewhat rudely:</p>
-
-<p>“The señorita entertains no strangers beneath her
-roof.”</p>
-
-<p>“I have not asked it, my man. But you will go and
-say to the señorita that the Señor Cody desires to see
-her for a few minutes.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll go, señor, but she will not see you.”</p>
-
-<p>He returned within ten minutes and said:</p>
-
-<p>“The señorita regrets to decline to see the señor,
-and that she is not able to offer him hospitality beneath
-her roof.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_308"></a>[308]</span></p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill smiled, and, taking from his pocket a
-notebook, he tore out a leaf and wrote upon it:</p>
-
-<p>“‘If taken from the wrist the charm is broken.’
-The Señor Cody begs to restore the charm.”</p>
-
-<p>“Hand this to the señorita, my man.”</p>
-
-<p>A silver dollar slipped into the hand prevented any
-reply, as the man had upon his lips a refusal to bear
-the message. But he walked off, and Buffalo Bill
-waited with no show of anxiety as to the result.</p>
-
-<p>This time the gatekeeper was gone for a much
-longer time than before, and when he returned there
-was a puzzled look upon his face, as he said:</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll allow you to enter, señor, for the señorita will
-see you?”</p>
-
-<p>“I felt that she would see me,” was the quiet reply
-of Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>“She has done so, but&mdash;&mdash;”</p>
-
-<p>“But what?” asked Buffalo Bill, looking the evidently
-greatly surprised gatekeeper straight in the eye.</p>
-
-<p>“The señor is doubtless an old friend of the
-señorita?”</p>
-
-<p>This was ventured as though the man was cautiously
-feeling his way.</p>
-
-<p>“I may and may not be a friend.”</p>
-
-<p>The man halted at this and said:</p>
-
-<p>“Well, I am very sure of one thing, señor.”</p>
-
-<p>“It matters nothing to me what you think; do as<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_309"></a>[309]</span>
-you were told to do&mdash;lead me to the presence of the
-señorita.”</p>
-
-<p>The man had a dogged look and manner. He appeared
-as though he meant not to obey the bidding;
-but there was that in the look of the scout which commanded
-obedience.</p>
-
-<p>And so he moved on once more.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_310"></a>[310]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XLIII">CHAPTER XLIII.<br />
-<span class="fs70">THE FAIR HERMIT.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>“Visitors are not allowed here, and, were the cowboy
-king at home, he would not have admitted you,”
-said the man to Cody, as though determined to make
-another effort to talk.</p>
-
-<p>“My visit is to the Señorita Suelo, not to her servant,
-the cowboy chief,” was the stern reply.</p>
-
-<p>The gateman winced, for the cowboy king evidently
-was all powerful in that hacienda.</p>
-
-<p>The gateman did not lead the visitor into the hacienda,
-but, halting at the flower-garden gate, said:</p>
-
-<p>“The señor will find the señorita in yonder arbor.”</p>
-
-<p>“She does not intend to have any eavesdroppers,
-that is certain,” muttered the scout to himself.</p>
-
-<p>A short walk brought him to the arbor, a perfect
-bower of beauty amid the flowers that were upon all
-sides.</p>
-
-<p>The señorita arose from a hammock, a book in her
-hand, as the caller approached.</p>
-
-<p>“Señor, be seated,” she said, and she appeared embarrassed.</p>
-
-<p>“Señorita, I have no right, perhaps, to intrude myself
-upon you, knowing the unwritten law of your
-house that no stranger must enter, but I have done so
-to return to you a trinket that belongs to you&mdash;one I
-picked up upon the scene when last we met.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_311"></a>[311]</span></p>
-
-<p>As Buffalo Bill spoke, he held out the bracelet he
-had found upon the spot where he had rescued the
-Mexican officer and the maiden from the outlaws.</p>
-
-<p>The face of the fair Mexican flushed and paled in
-turn, and, stepping forward, she said earnestly:</p>
-
-<p>“Señor, can you ever forgive me for my treatment
-of you that day, leaving you, as we did, after your
-saving the señor captain from certain death, and rescuing
-me from the power of cruel foes?</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, the bracelet must have been torn from my
-wrist unnoticed by my captors in the struggle.</p>
-
-<p>“You read what is written within it, señor, so the
-charm is broken. I will never wear it again; no, never!
-For what is there graven has come true&mdash;the charm
-is broken.”</p>
-
-<p>She turned her head, and for a moment was silent,
-when Buffalo Bill spoke:</p>
-
-<p>“I am sorry you no longer have faith in the charm;
-but I am glad to have returned it to you.”</p>
-
-<p>“Señor, I am glad you have done so, for it has given
-me the chance to meet you to tell you how I appreciate
-all you did that day. Why we left you so unceremoniously
-I cannot tell, for my lips are sealed.”</p>
-
-<p>“And who were those foes of yours, señorita?”</p>
-
-<p>“I do not know.”</p>
-
-<p>“And the señor captain&mdash;did he recover from the
-cruel treatment they gave him?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, señor.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_312"></a>[312]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Señorita, I have a request to make.”</p>
-
-<p>“I will grant it.”</p>
-
-<p>“The favor I would ask is that when I come again
-to see you, you will see me.”</p>
-
-<p>“I have promised; but you must not come when the
-cowboy king is here, señor.”</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill’s face did not change a muscle at this
-remarkable request of the fair recluse.</p>
-
-<p>The girl looked at him somewhat anxiously, while
-he answered graciously:</p>
-
-<p>“It shall be as you wish, señorita. I will now bid
-you adios and thank you for having received me.”</p>
-
-<p>“Then thanks are due to you, señor, and I wish you
-would tell me if in any way I can serve you.”</p>
-
-<p>“By allowing me to call again, as you have promised,
-if I deem it best to come.”</p>
-
-<p>“You have my promise.”</p>
-
-<p>“And may I again ask if you have any idea of who
-the men were who attacked you that day?”</p>
-
-<p>“I have not.”</p>
-
-<p>“Were they not the secret foes?”</p>
-
-<p>“No, señor.”</p>
-
-<p>“I did not know but that they might be,” said Buffalo
-Bill, in a peculiar way.</p>
-
-<p>“No, señor, they were not of that band. Their
-masked leader was a foe to&mdash;to&mdash;the señor captain,
-and to me. I know; but, just who he is I am not aware.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_313"></a>[313]</span>
-He wanted gold, and revenge, as well, it seemed, but
-he thwarted his purpose as far as getting money was
-concerned, for, but for your coming, as you so bravely
-did, he would have killed the señor captain, and from
-me he would have obtained nothing. The outlaws
-were strangers in the valley, señor, save their chief,
-and just who he was I do not know, as I have stated.”</p>
-
-<p>“Perhaps when I call again, señorita, I may be able
-to inform you as to his identity.”</p>
-
-<p>“Ah! can you?”</p>
-
-<p>“I may,” was the cautious reply, and, declining the
-offer of refreshments, the scout took his leave, the
-señorita offering her hand as she bade him farewell.</p>
-
-<p>“Señor, this valley is full of dangerous characters,
-and one knows not whom to trust. You are going
-alone upon a dangerous trail, and I warn you that you
-may be halted and held up, as they say here. This will
-protect you from robbery, perhaps from death. Wear
-it!” and she took from the silk scarf about her neck
-a pin of unique design and fastened it upon the lapel
-of Buffalo Bill’s jacket.</p>
-
-<p>“Señorita, I will keep it as a souvenir of you; it
-will doubtless be a charm to protect me. I thank you.”</p>
-
-<p>Again bidding the beautiful girl good-by, Buffalo
-Bill left the garden, crossed the plaza to where his
-horse awaited him, and rode toward the gate.</p>
-
-<p>There stood the keeper, who now saluted him with
-marked respect, again saying:</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_314"></a>[314]</span></p>
-
-<p>“You are the first stranger, señor, who ever gained
-entrance to this hacienda.”</p>
-
-<p>As Buffalo Bill rode along he was not forgetful of
-being in great danger, and he was surprised when he
-did not see the ranch cowboys he had seen when he
-was on his way to visit the fair hermit. He was riding
-quietly along when he saw a horseman approaching, a
-splendid-looking man, well mounted, and with silver-mounted
-Mexican saddle and bridle.</p>
-
-<p>Buffalo Bill knew him at once from what he had
-heard of the cowboy king.</p>
-
-<p>Both saluted and halted, the cowboy king saying:</p>
-
-<p>“Off your trail, señor?”</p>
-
-<p>“No, for I have been to the hacienda.”</p>
-
-<p>“And why?”</p>
-
-<p>“That I consider none of your business.”</p>
-
-<p>“I shall make it my affair, Señor Cody, and you
-are covered by my men,” responded the cowboy king.</p>
-
-<p>It was true, for four men were peering over a rock
-with rifles leveled at the scout, who said:</p>
-
-<p>“So it seems; but do you not respect this badge?”
-and he pointed to the pin Suelo had given him.</p>
-
-<p>“Not this time, for you are too dangerous a man to
-be at large. I know you, Buffalo Bill.”</p>
-
-<p>“And I know you, now, for you were a deserter
-from the army, and later became a finished cutthroat;
-but I thought you were dead, Dallas Mowbray.”</p>
-
-<p>“No, I left the northern country several years ago,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_315"></a>[315]</span>
-as it became too hot for me, and came back to the
-Southwest, for I am really a Mexican, you know, and
-was once an officer of the Mexican army, but was
-exiled for certain acts. You see, I don’t mind telling
-you, as I regard you as good as dead.”</p>
-
-<p>“Thanks; but while there is life, there is hope.”</p>
-
-<p>“So I have found out; but I’ll fix you now&mdash;ho,
-men, come here!”</p>
-
-<p>The four men came, their rifles still loaded; but
-as they neared the scout there were several shots heard&mdash;then
-one.</p>
-
-<p>The first came from some thick timber close at hand,
-and the four men with rifles dropped dead.</p>
-
-<p>The single shot was from Buffalo Bill’s revolver,
-who was quick to take advantage of the volley in his
-favor. He had sent a bullet through the heart of the
-cowboy king.</p>
-
-<p>The next moment Texas Jack, four of his pards,
-with Señor Otega and his cowboy chief, Palma, came
-into view.</p>
-
-<p>“You were just in time, Jack, and I thank you all.</p>
-
-<p>“Find the horses of those four men, strap the bodies
-in the saddles, and we’ll take them to our ranch to-night,
-and to-morrow there will be two visits for us
-to make, and in full force, for I can see the beginning
-of the end of our trail.”</p>
-
-<p>“As I also can, chief,” answered Texas Jack.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_316"></a>[316]</span></p>
-
-<h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XLIV">CHAPTER XLIV.<br />
-<span class="fs70">REVEALED.</span></h2>
-</div>
-
-
-<p>Again did Buffalo Bill pay a visit to the hacienda
-of the fair hermit. It was the day following his meeting
-with the cowboy king.</p>
-
-<p>Again he was received, and in the garden, as before,
-while the señorita said:</p>
-
-<p>“You have come sooner than I expected, señor; but
-it is well, as the cowboy king is not here.”</p>
-
-<p>“Why do you fear that man?”</p>
-
-<p>“Ah! I cannot tell.”</p>
-
-<p>“What is he to you?”</p>
-
-<p>“Do not ask me.”</p>
-
-<p>“Do you love him?”</p>
-
-<p>“No!”</p>
-
-<p>“I am glad, for I can tell you that you need no
-longer fear him.”</p>
-
-<p>“What do you mean?” she gasped.</p>
-
-<p>“Señorita, I have read your secret, for that man
-was the Mexican officer I saved with you from those
-men that day nearly two months ago.”</p>
-
-<p>“You recognize him, then?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, and as a vile cutthroat who joined our army,
-robbed the paymaster, deserted, and became a fugitive
-and an outlaw, at last, as we believed, being killed,
-but, instead, coming here. Did you not know him as
-all that was bad?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_317"></a>[317]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Señor, I was deceived by him, for I believed him
-an officer of the Mexican army. I was left this place,
-and he urged me to marry him secretly, and I did so,
-then coming here to live, and obeying him blindly. At
-times he came here, I believing he was on duty when
-he was away.</p>
-
-<p>“It was when he was here that you rescued us, and
-from men I now think were not outlaws, but those
-who suspected him of certain deeds and determined
-to kill him. Perhaps they were my own cowboys, who
-sought to kill him, not wishing a master over them.</p>
-
-<p>“Of late, I have had reason to doubt him, and I
-meant to know the truth, even if he killed me, as he
-has often threatened to do.”</p>
-
-<p>“Have no fear now, for he is dead.”</p>
-
-<p>“No, no, it cannot be, for he bears a charmed life.”</p>
-
-<p>“It has ended&mdash;the charm is broken, as was the case
-when you lost your bracelet.”</p>
-
-<p>“Which he gave to me; but do you know that he is
-dead?”</p>
-
-<p>“I killed him, Señorita Suelo Sada,” calmly said
-Buffalo Bill.</p>
-
-<p>“You?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, I made you a widow, I am glad to say, for
-that man was the leader of the secret foes of this
-valley, the one who has put the curse upon it which
-all have dreaded.”</p>
-
-<p>“God bless you, señor, for those words. You have<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_318"></a>[318]</span>
-freed me from worse than death. But only lately did
-I suspect that he was really bad at heart, and the words
-I got came to me by a secret letter, and I was told to
-closely watch his movements and I would discover
-the truth.</p>
-
-<p>“My servants here are innocent, all in the hacienda,
-but I believe all the cowboys are guilty, and were
-members of his band.”</p>
-
-<p>“I know that they were; but let me tell you that they
-are all prisoners now, for I led my men to their retreat
-last night, on the cliffs, back of my ranch, and through
-a secret entrance into the old hacienda, surprised their
-hidden camp.</p>
-
-<p>“They had there a score of prisoners, men, women,
-and children, held for ransom, and I learned the story
-from dying lips, and enough more to enable us, under
-Señor Otega and his chief of cowboys, to find the
-secret entrance to the cliffs.</p>
-
-<p>“We set free all who were there, killed the five
-guards over them, and to-day rounded up and captured
-your cowboys, seven in number, who shared the
-ransoms paid with their chief.</p>
-
-<p>“You were not guilty, I know, Señorita Suelo Moro,
-for such is your name as Dallas Moro’s wife; but you
-will be so thought by many in this valley, and my
-advice is that you at once leave here and seek a home
-elsewhere, where no cloud hangs over your life, and
-Señor Otega will see to your property here.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_319"></a>[319]</span></p>
-
-<p>“Señor Cody, again I say, ‘God bless you,’ and from
-my heart I thank you more than words can tell. I
-have an ample fortune of my own, independent of
-this accursed ranch, where I have known only sorrow;
-but what I have done he forced me to do. To Señor
-Otega I leave this ranch, cattle and all, for him to
-dispose of, and pay back to those who have paid ransom,
-every dollar they have been cheated out of.</p>
-
-<p>“Señor, with my few faithful servants I will leave
-here at sunset, and into your hands will I give the
-paper by which Señor Otega can act for me.”</p>
-
-<p>From his heart Buffalo Bill pitied the beautiful and
-unhappy woman, and he was glad, a few hours after,
-to see her and her few faithful servants depart from
-the hacienda forever, while Señor Otega willingly accepted
-the duty, to carry out the mission she had intrusted
-to him, through Cody.</p>
-
-<p>As quickly as Buffalo Bill and his secret sleuths had
-entered the mysterious valley, they departed from it,
-carrying with them their horses and cattle, and their
-prisoners also, to deliver over to the commandant of
-the fort nearest the scene, who held control of that
-part of the country.</p>
-
-<p>Among the prisoners was Riel, the innkeeper, who,
-next to the cowboy king, was the guilty one in the
-many crimes committed in the beautiful valley.</p>
-
-<p>It is needless to say that quick punishment was
-visited upon all the prisoners, and Buffalo Bill and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_320"></a>[320]</span>
-his sleuths of the saddle gained great praise for their
-splendid services rendered, and Colonel Carr sent a
-special report to headquarters about the great chief of
-scouts’ brilliant achievement.</p>
-
-<p>As to the beautiful valley, it is as peaceful to-day as a
-Quaker village, and the fair hermit of the hacienda is
-forgotten, for she was never heard of again by those who
-dwelt in the Silver Lake settlement, while the haunted
-ranch remains but a ruin, surrounded by its graves.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pfs80 p2">THE END.</p>
-
-
-<div class="blockquot">
-<p>No. 104 of the <span class="smcap">Buffalo Bill Border Stories</span>, entitled
-“Buffalo Bill’s Barricade,” is a rattling good story of
-Indian warfare among the red men themselves, helped
-out by the great scout, who as usual, is on the side of
-those who are fighting for the right.</p>
-</div>
-
-<hr class="chap pg-brk" />
-
-<p class="pfs120 p2">A REQUEST</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter illowe4_6875" id="endillo">
- <img class="w100 p1" src="images/end_illo.jpg" alt="" />
-</div>
-
-<div class="blockquot">
-<p>Conditions due to the war have made it very difficult
-for us to keep in print all of the books listed in our
-catalogues. We still have about fifteen hundred different
-titles that we are in a position to supply. These
-represent the best books in our line. We could not afford,
-in the circumstances, to reprint any of the less
-popular works.</p>
-
-<p>We aim to keep in stock the works of such authors as
-Bertha Clay, Charles Garvice, May Agnes Fleming,
-Nicholas Carter, Mary J. Holmes, Mrs. Harriet Lewis,
-Horatio Alger, and the other famous authors who are
-represented in our line by ten or more titles. Therefore,
-if your dealer cannot supply you with exactly the
-book you want, you are almost sure to find in his stock
-another title by the same author, which you have not
-read.</p>
-
-<p>It short, we are asking you to take what your dealer
-can supply, rather than to insist upon just what you
-want. You won’t lose anything by such substitution, because
-the books by the authors named are very uniform
-in quality.</p>
-
-<p>In ordering Street &amp; Smith novels by mail, it is advisable
-to make a choice of at least two titles for each
-book wanted, so as to give us an opportunity to substitute
-for titles that are now out of print.</p>
-
-<p class="center">STREET &amp; SMITH CORPORATION,<br />
-<span class="pad5">79-89 Seventh Avenue, New York City.</span></p>
-</div>
-
-<hr class="chap pg-brk pb4" />
-
-<div class="transnote">
-<p class="center bold">Transcriber’s Notes</p>
-
-<div class="blockquotx">
-<p>The Table of Contents at the beginning of the book was created by
-the transcriber.</p>
-
-<p>Inconsistencies in hyphenation such as “gold-boomer”/“gold boomer”
-have been maintained.</p>
-
-<p>Minor punctuation and spelling errors have been silently corrected
-and, except for those changes noted below, all misspellings in the
-text, especially in dialogue, and inconsistent or archaic usage,
-have been retained.</p>
-</div>
-
-<ol>
-<li><a href="#tn2">Page 2</a>: “A Congress of the Rough-riders of the World” changed to “A Congress of the Rough Riders of the World”.</li>
-
-<li><a href="#tn238">Page 238</a>: “Lighting match after mach” changed to “Lighting match after match”.</li>
-
-</ol>
-
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin-top:4em'>*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK BUFFALO BILL'S BIG SURPRISE ***</div>
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Updated editions will replace the previous one&#8212;the old editions will
-be renamed.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG&#8482;
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for an eBook, except by following
-the terms of the trademark license, including paying royalties for use
-of the Project Gutenberg trademark. If you do not charge anything for
-copies of this eBook, complying with the trademark license is very
-easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose such as creation
-of derivative works, reports, performances and research. Project
-Gutenberg eBooks may be modified and printed and given away--you may
-do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks not protected
-by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the trademark
-license, especially commercial redistribution.
-</div>
-
-<div style='margin:0.83em 0; font-size:1.1em; text-align:center'>START: FULL LICENSE<br />
-<span style='font-size:smaller'>THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE<br />
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK</span>
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-To protect the Project Gutenberg&#8482; mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase &#8220;Project
-Gutenberg&#8221;), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg&#8482; License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person
-or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.B. &#8220;Project Gutenberg&#8221; is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation (&#8220;the
-Foundation&#8221; or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg&#8482; mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg&#8482; name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg&#8482; License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg&#8482; work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country other than the United States.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg&#8482; License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg&#8482; work (any work
-on which the phrase &#8220;Project Gutenberg&#8221; appears, or with which the
-phrase &#8220;Project Gutenberg&#8221; is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-</div>
-
-<blockquote>
- <div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
- other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
- whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms
- of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online
- at <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>. If you
- are not located in the United States, you will have to check the laws
- of the country where you are located before using this eBook.
- </div>
-</blockquote>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase &#8220;Project
-Gutenberg&#8221; associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg&#8482; License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg&#8482;.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; License.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg&#8482; work in a format
-other than &#8220;Plain Vanilla ASCII&#8221; or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg&#8482; web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original &#8220;Plain
-Vanilla ASCII&#8221; or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg&#8482; License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg&#8482; works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works
-provided that:
-</div>
-
-<div style='margin-left:0.7em;'>
- <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'>
- &bull; You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg&#8482; works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg&#8482; trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, &#8220;Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation.&#8221;
- </div>
-
- <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'>
- &bull; You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg&#8482;
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg&#8482;
- works.
- </div>
-
- <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'>
- &bull; You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
- </div>
-
- <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'>
- &bull; You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg&#8482; works.
- </div>
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the manager of
-the Project Gutenberg&#8482; trademark. Contact the Foundation as set
-forth in Section 3 below.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.F.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain &#8220;Defects,&#8221; such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the &#8220;Right
-of Replacement or Refund&#8221; described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you &#8216;AS-IS&#8217;, WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg&#8482; work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg&#8482; work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg&#8482;
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Project Gutenberg&#8482; is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg&#8482;&#8217;s
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg&#8482; collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg&#8482; and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at www.gutenberg.org.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non-profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation&#8217;s EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state&#8217;s laws.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-The Foundation&#8217;s business office is located at 809 North 1500 West,
-Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up
-to date contact information can be found at the Foundation&#8217;s web site
-and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Project Gutenberg&#8482; depends upon and cannot survive without widespread
-public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine-readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular state
-visit <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org/donate/">www.gutenberg.org/donate</a>.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg&#8482; concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg&#8482; eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Project Gutenberg&#8482; eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>.
-</div>
-
-<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg&#8482;,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-</div>
-
-</body>
-</html>
diff --git a/old/64262-h/images/colophon.jpg b/old/64262-h/images/colophon.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 508d371..0000000
--- a/old/64262-h/images/colophon.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/64262-h/images/cover.jpg b/old/64262-h/images/cover.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index b899474..0000000
--- a/old/64262-h/images/cover.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/64262-h/images/end_illo.jpg b/old/64262-h/images/end_illo.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 8d61758..0000000
--- a/old/64262-h/images/end_illo.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ